[ Contents ] [ C-Kermit ] [ Kermit Home ]

Supplement to Using C-Kermit, Second Edition

For C-Kermit 7.0

As of C-Kermit version:  7.0.196
This file last updated:  8 February 2000

Authors: Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone
Address: The Kermit Project
         Columbia University
         612 West 115th Street
         New York NY 10025-7799
         USA
Fax:     +1 (212) 662-6442
E-Mail:  kermit-support@columbia.edu
Web:     http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
Or:      http://www.kermit-project.org/
Or:      http://www.columbia.nyc.ny.us/kermit/


NOTICES

This document:
Copyright © 1997, 2000, Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone. All rights reserved.

Kermit 95:
Copyright © 1995, 2000, Trustees of Columbia University in the City of New York. All rights reserved.

C-Kermit:
Copyright © 1985, 2000,
Trustees of Columbia University in the City of New York. All rights reserved. See the C-Kermit COPYING.TXT file or the copyright text in the ckcmai.c module for disclaimer and permissions.

When Kerberos(TM) and/or SRP(TM) (Secure Remote Password) and/or SSL protocol are included:
Portions Copyright © 1990, Massachusetts Institute of Technology.
Portions Copyright © 1991, 1993 Regents of the University of California.
Portions Copyright © 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 by AT&T.
Portions Copyright © 1997, Stanford University.
Portions Copyright © 1995-1997, Eric Young <eay@cryptosoft.com>.

For the full text of the third-party copyright notices, see Appendix V.


WHAT IS IN THIS FILE

This file lists changes made to C-Kermit since the second edition of the book Using C-Kermit was published and C-Kermit 6.0 was released in November 1996. Use this file as a supplement to the second edition of Using C-Kermit until the third edition is published some time in 2000. If the "most recent update" shown above is long ago, contact Columbia University to see if there is a newer release.

For further information, also see the CKCBWR.TXT ("C-Kermit beware") file for hints, tips, tricks, restrictions, frequently asked questions, etc, plus the system-specific "beware file", e.g. CKUBWR.TXT for UNIX, CKVBWR.TXT for VMS, etc, and also any system-specific update files such as KERMIT95.HTM for Kermit 95 (in the DOCS\MANUAL\ subdirectory of your K95 directory).

This Web-based copy of the C-Kermit 7.0 update notes supersedes the plain-text CKERMIT2.TXT file. All changes after 19 January 2000 appear only here in the Web version. If you need an up-to-date plain-text copy, use your Web browser to save this page as plain text.


ABOUT FILENAMES

In this document, filenames are generally shown in uppercase, but on file systems with case-sensitive names such as UNIX, OS-9, and AOS/VS, lowercase names are used: ckubwr.txt, ckermit70.txt, etc.


ADDITIONAL FILES

Several other files accompany this new Kermit release:

SECURITY.TXT
Discussion of Kermit's new authentication and encryption features:

IKSD.TXT
How to install and manage an Internet Kermit Service Daemon. Also see cuiksd.htm for instructions for use.

TELNET.TXT
A thorough presentation of Kermit's new advanced Telnet features and controls.


THE NEW C-KERMIT LICENSE

The C-Kermit license was rewritten for version 7.0 to grant automatic permission to packagers of free operating-system distributions to include C-Kermit 7.0. Examples include Linux (GNU/Linux), FreeBSD, NetBSD, etc. The new license is in the COPYING.TXT file, and is also displayed by C-Kermit itself when you give the VERSION or COPYRIGHT command. The new C-Kermit license does not apply to Kermit 95.


ACKNOWLEDGMENTS

Thanks to Jeff Altman, who joined the Kermit Project in 1995, for much of what you see in C-Kermit 7.0, especially in the networking and security areas, and his key role in designing and implementing the Internet Kermit Service Daemon. And special thanks to Lucas Hart for lots of help with the VMS version; to Peter Eichhorn for continuous testing on the full range of HP-UX versions and for a consolidated set of HP-UX makefile targets; and to Colin Allen, Mark Allen, Roger Allen, Ric Anderson, William Bader, Mitch Baker, Mitchell Bass, Nelson Beebe, Gerry Belanger, Jeff Bernsten, Mark Berryman, John Bigg, Volker Borchert, Jonathan Boswell, Tim Boyer, Frederick Bruckman, Kenneth Cochran, Jared Crapo, Bill Delaney, Igor Sobrado Delgado, Clarence Dold, Joe Doupnik, John Dunlap, Max Evarts, Patrick French, Carl Friedberg, Carl Friend, Hirofumi Fujii, Andrew Gabriel, Gabe Garza, Boyd Gerber, David Gerber, George Gilmer, Hunter Goatley, DJ Hagberg, Kevin Handy, Andy Harper, Randolph Herber, Sven Holström, Michal Jaegermann, Graham Jenkins, Dick Jones, Terry Kennedy, Robert D Keys, Nick Kisseberth, Igor Kovalenko, David Lane, Adam Laurie, Jeff Liebermann, Eric Lonvick, Hoi Wan Louis, Arthur Marsh, Gregorie Martin, Peter Mauzey, Dragan Milicic, Todd Miller, Christian Mondrup, Daniel Morato, Dat Nguyen, Herb Peyerl, Jean-Pierre Radley, Steve Rance, Stephen Riehm, Nigel Roles, Larry Rosenman, Jay S Rouman, David Sanderson, John Santos, Michael Schmitz, Steven Schultz, Bob Shair, Richard Shuford, Fred Smith, Michael Sokolov, Jim Spath, Peter Szell, Ted T'so, Brian Tillman, Linus Torvalds, Patrick Volkerding, Martin Vorländer, Steve Walton, Ken Weaverling, John Weekley, Martin Whitaker, Jim Whitby, Matt Willman, Joellen Windsor, Farrell Woods, and many others for binaries, hosting, reviews, suggestions, advice, bug reports, and all the rest over the 3+ year C-Kermit 7.0 development cycle. Thanks to Russ Nelson and the board of the Open Software Initiative (http://www.opensource.org) for their cooperation in developing the new C-Kermit license and to the proprietors of those free UNIX distributions that have incorporated C-Kermit 7.0 for their cooperation and support, especially FreeBSD's Jörg Wunsch.


NOTE TO KERMIT 95 USERS

Kermit 95 and C-Kermit share the same command and scripting language, the same Kermit file-transfer protocol implementation, and much else besides.

Like the book Using C-Kermit, this file concentrates on the aspects of C-Kermit that are common to all versions: UNIX, VMS, Windows, OS/2, VOS, AOS/VS, etc. Please refer to your Kermit 95 documentation for information that is specific to Kermit 95.

C-Kermit 7.0 corresponds to Kermit 95 1.1.19.


C-KERMIT VERSIONS AND VERSION NUMBERS

"C-Kermit" refers to all the many programs that are compiled in whole or in part from common C-language source code, comprising:

and several others. These "system-independent" modules are combined with system-dependent modules for each platform to provide the required input/output functions, and also in some cases overlaid with an alternative user interface, such as Macintosh Kermit's point-and-click interface, and in some cases also a terminal emulator, as Kermit 95.

The C-Kermit version number started as 1.0, ... 3.0, 4.0, 4.1 and then (because of confusion at the time with Berkeley UNIX 4.2), 4B, 4C, and so on, with the specific edit number in parentheses, for example 4E(072) or 5A(188). This scheme was used through 5A(191), but now we have gone back to the traditional numbering scheme with decimal points: major.minor.edit; for example 7.0.196. Internal version numbers (the \v(version) variable), however, are compatible in C-Kermit 5A upwards.

Meanwhile, C-Kermit derivatives for some platforms (Windows, Macintosh) might go through several releases while C-Kermit itself remains the same. These versions have their own platform-specific version numbers, such as Kermit 95 1.1.1, 1.1.2, and so on.

C-Kermit Version History:

  1.0       1981-1982         Command-line only, 4.2 BSD UNIX only
  2.0       (*)               (who remembers...)
  3.0       May 1984          Command-line only, supports several platforms
  4.0-4.1   Feb-Apr 1985 (*)  First interactive and modular version
  4C(050)   May 1985
  4D(060)   April 1986
  4E(066)   August 1987       Long packets
  4E(068)   January 1988
  4E(072)   January 1989
  4F(095)   August 1989 (*)   Attribute packets
  5A(188)   November 1992     Scripting, TCP/IP, sliding windows (1)
  5A(189)   September 1993    Control-char unprefixing
  5A(190)   October 1994      Recovery
  5A(191)   April 1995        OS/2 only
  6.0.192   September 1996    Intelligent dialing, autodownload, lots more (2)
  6.1.193   1997-98 (*)       Development only
  6.1.194   June 1998         K95 only - switches, directory recursion, more
  7.0.195   August 1999       IKSD + more (CU only as K95 1.1.18-CU)
  7.0.196   1 January 2000    Unicode, lots more

(*) Never formally released (4.0 was a total rewrite)
(1) Using C-Kermit, 1st Edition
(2) Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition


CONTENTS

 I.  C-KERMIT DOCUMENTATION

 II. NEW FEATURES

     (0) INCOMPATIBILITIES WITH PREVIOUS RELEASES
     (1) PROGRAM AND FILE MANAGEMENT AND COMMANDS
         1.0.  Bug fixes
         1.1.  Command Continuation
         1.2.  Editor Interface
         1.3.  Web Browser and FTP Interface
         1.4.  Command Editing
         1.5.  Command Switches
               1.5.1. General Switch Syntax
               1.5.2. Order and Effect of Switches
               1.5.3. Distinguishing Switches from Other Fields
               1.5.4. Standard File Selection Switches
               1.5.5. Setting Preferences for Different Commands
         1.6.  Dates and Times
         1.7.  Partial Completion of Keywords
         1.8.  Command Recall
         1.9.  EXIT Messages
         1.10. Managing Keyboard Interruptions
         1.11. Taming the Wild Backslash -- Part Deux
	       1.11.1. Background
	       1.11.2. Kermit's Quoting Rules
               1.11.3. Passing DOS Filenames from Kermit to Shell Commands
	       1.11.4. Using Variables to Hold DOS Filenames
	       1.11.5. Passing DOS Filenames as Parameters to Macros
	       1.11.6. Passing DOS File Names from Macro Parameters to the DOS Shell
               1.11.7. Passing DOS Filenames to Kermit from the Shell
         1.12. Debugging
         1.13. Logs
         1.14. Automatic File-Transfer Packet Recognition at the Command Prompt
         1.15. The TYPE Command
         1.16. The RESET Command
         1.17. The COPY and RENAME Commands
         1.18. The MANUAL Command
         1.19. String and Filename Matching Patterns
         1.20. Multiple Commands on One Line
         1.21. What Do I Have?
         1.22. Generalized File Input and Output
	       1.22.1. Why Another I/O System?
	       1.22.2. The FILE Command
	       1.22.3. FILE Command Examples
	       1.22.4. Channel Numbers
	       1.22.5. FILE Command Error Codes
	       1.22.6. File I/O Variables
	       1.22.7. File I/O Functions
	       1.22.8. File I/O Function Examples
         1.23. The EXEC Command
         1.24. Getting Keyword Lists with '?'
     (2) MAKING AND USING CONNECTIONS
         2.0. SET LINE and SET HOST Command Switches
	 2.1. Dialing
	      2.1.1. The Dial Result Message
	      2.1.2. Long-Distance Dialing Changes
	      2.1.3. Forcing Long-Distance Dialing
	      2.1.4. Exchange-Specific Dialing Decisions
	      2.1.5. Cautions about Cheapest-First Dialing
	      2.1.6. Blind Dialing (Dialing with No Dialtone)
              2.1.7. Trimming the Dialing Dialog
              2.1.8. Controlling the Dialing Speed
              2.1.9. Pretesting Phone Number Conversions
              2.1.10. Greater Control over Partial Dialing
              2.1.11. New DIAL-related Variables and Functions
              2.1.12. Increased Flexibility of PBX Dialing
              2.1.13. The DIAL macro - Last-Minute Phone Number Conversions
              2.1.14. Automatic Tone/Pulse Dialing Selection
              2.1.15. Dial-Modifier Variables
              2.1.16. Giving Multiple Numbers to the DIAL Command
	 2.2. Modems
	      2.2.1. New Modem Types
	      2.2.2. New Modem Controls
	 2.3. TELNET and RLOGIN
              2.3.0. Bug Fixes
	      2.3.1. Telnet Binary Mode Bug Adjustments
	      2.3.2. VMS UCX Telnet Port Bug Adjustment
	      2.3.3. Telnet New Environment Option
	      2.3.4. Telnet Location Option
              2.3.5. Connecting to Raw TCP Sockets
              2.3.6. Incoming TCP Connections
	 2.4. The EIGHTBIT Command
	 2.5. The Services Directory
         2.6. Closing Connections
	 2.7. Using C-Kermit with External Communication Programs
              2.7.0. C-Kermit over tn3270 and tn5250
	      2.7.1. C-Kermit over Telnet
	      2.7.2. C-Kermit over Rlogin
              2.7.3. C-Kermit over Serial Communication Programs
	      2.7.4. C-Kermit over Secure Network Clients
	      2.7.4.1. SSH
	      2.7.4.2. SSL
	      2.7.4.3. SRP
	      2.7.4.4. SOCKS
              2.7.4.5. Kerberos and SRP
         2.8. Scripting Local Programs
         2.9. X.25 Networking
              2.9.1. IBM AIXLink/X.25 Network Provider Interface for AIX
              2.9.2. HP-UX X.25
         2.10. Additional Serial Port Controls
         2.11. Getting Access to the Dialout Device
         2.12. The Connection Log
         2.13. Automatic Connection-Specific Flow Control Selection
         2.14. Trapping Connection Establishment and Loss
         2.15. Contacting Web Servers with the HTTP Command
     (3) TERMINAL CONNECTION
         3.1. CONNECT Command Switches
         3.2. Triggers
         3.3. Transparent Printing
         3.4. Binary and Text Session Logs
     (4) FILE TRANSFER AND MANAGEMENT
         4.0. Bug Fixes, Minor Changes, and Clarifications
	 4.1. File-Transfer Filename Templates
	 4.1.1. Templates in the As-Name
	 4.1.2. Templates on the Command Line
	 4.1.3. Post-Transfer Renaming
	 4.2. File-Transfer Pipes and Filters
         4.2.1. Introduction
	 4.2.1.1. Terminology
	 4.2.1.2. Notation
	 4.2.1.3. Security
	 4.2.2. Commands for Transferring from and to Pipes
	 4.2.2.1. Sending from a Command
	 4.2.2.2. Receiving to a Command
	 4.2.3. Using File-Transfer Filters
	 4.2.3.1. The SEND Filter
	 4.2.3.2. The RECEIVE Filter
	 4.2.4. Implicit Use of Pipes
	 4.2.5. Success and Failure of Piped Commands
         4.2.6. Cautions about Using Pipes to Transfer Directory Trees
	 4.2.7. Pipes and Encryption
         4.2.8. Commands and Functions Related to Pipes
	 4.2.8.1. The OPEN !READ and OPEN !WRITE Commands
	 4.2.8.2. The REDIRECT Command
         4.2.8.3. Receiving Mail and Print Jobs
	 4.2.8.4. Pipe-Related Functions
         4.3. Automatic Per-File Text/Binary Mode Switching
	 4.3.1. Exceptions
	 4.3.2. Overview
	 4.3.3. Commands
	 4.3.4. Examples
         4.4. File Permissions
	 4.4.1. When ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION is OFF
	 4.4.1.1. Unix
	 4.4.1.2. VMS
	 4.4.2. When ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION is ON
	 4.4.2.1. System-Specific Permissions
	 4.4.2.1.1. UNIX
	 4.4.2.1.2. VMS
	 4.4.2.2. System-Independent Permissions
         4.5. File Management Commands
         4.5.1. The DIRECTORY Command
         4.5.2. The CD and BACK Commands
         4.5.2.1. Parsing Improvements
         4.5.2.2. The CDPATH
	 4.5.3. Creating and Removing Directories
	 4.5.4. The DELETE and PURGE Commands
         4.6. Starting the Remote Kermit Server Automatically
         4.7. File-Transfer Command Switches
         4.7.1. SEND Command Switches
         4.7.2. GET Command Switches
         4.7.3. RECEIVE Command Switches
         4.8. Minor Kermit Protocol Improvements
	 4.8.1. Multiple Attribute Packets
	 4.8.2. Very Short Packets
         4.9. Wildcard / File Group Expansion
	 4.9.1. In UNIX C-Kermit
	 4.9.2. In Kermit 95
	 4.9.3. In VMS, AOS/VS, OS-9, VOS, etc.
         4.10. Additional Pathname Controls
         4.11. Recursive SEND and GET: Transferring Directory Trees
	 4.11.1. Command-Line Options
	 4.11.2. The SEND /RECURSIVE Command
	 4.11.3. The GET /RECURSIVE Command
	 4.11.4. New and Changed File Functions
	 4.11.5. Moving Directory Trees Between Like Systems
	 4.11.6. Moving Directory Trees Between Unlike Systems
         4.12. Where Did My File Go?
         4.13. File Output Buffer Control
         4.14. Improved Responsiveness
         4.15. Doubling and Ignoring Characters for Transparency
         4.16. New File-Transfer Display Formats
         4.17. New Transaction Log Formats
         4.17.1. The BRIEF Format
         4.17.2. The FTP Format
         4.18. Unprefixing NUL
         4.19. Clear-Channel Protocol
         4.20. Streaming Protocol
	 4.20.1. Commands for Streaming
	 4.20.2. Examples of Streaming
	 4.20.2.1. Streaming on Socket-to-Socket Connections
	 4.20.2.2. Streaming on Telnet Connections
         4.20.2.3. Streaming with Limited Packet Length
         4.20.2.4. Streaming on Dialup Connections
         4.20.2.5. Streaming on X.25 Connections
         4.20.3. Streaming - Preliminary Conclusions
         4.21. The TRANSMIT Command
	 4.22. Coping with Faulty Kermit Implementations
	 4.22.1. Failure to Accept Modern Negotiation Strings
	 4.22.2. Failure to Negotiate 8th-bit Prefixing
	 4.22.3. Corrupt Files
	 4.22.4. Spurious Cancellations
	 4.22.5. Spurious Refusals
	 4.22.6. Failures during the Data Transfer Phase
	 4.22.7. Fractured Filenames
	 4.22.8. Bad File Dates
         4.23. File Transfer Recovery
         4.24. FILE COLLISION UPDATE Clarification
         4.25. Autodownload Improvements
     (5) CLIENT/SERVER
         5.0. Hints
	 5.1. New Command-Line Options
	 5.2. New Client Commands
	 5.3. New Server Capabilities
         5.3.1. Creating and Removing Directories
         5.3.2. Directory Listings
         5.4. Syntax for Remote Filenames with Embedded Spaces
         5.5. Automatic Orientation Messages upon Directory Change
	 5.6. New Server Controls
	 5.7. Timeouts during REMOTE HOST Command Execution
     (6) INTERNATIONAL CHARACTER SETS
         6.0. ISO 8859-15 Latin Alphabet 9
         6.1. The HP-Roman8 Character Set
         6.2. Greek Character Sets
         6.3. Additional Latin-2 Character Sets
         6.4. Additional Cyrillic Character Sets
         6.5. Automatic Character-Set Switching
         6.6. Unicode
	 6.6.1. Overview of Unicode
	 6.6.2. UCS Byte Order
	 6.6.2. UCS Transformation Formats
	 6.6.3. Conformance Levels
	 6.6.4. Relationship of Unicode with Kermit's Other Character Sets
	 6.6.5. Kermit's Unicode Features
	 6.6.5.1. File Transfer
	 6.6.5.2. The TRANSLATE Command
	 6.6.5.3. Terminal Connection
	 6.6.5.4. The TRANSMIT Command
	 6.6.5.5. Summary of Kermit Unicode Commands
         6.7. Client/Server Character-Set Switching
     (7) SCRIPT PROGRAMMING
         7.0. Bug Fixes
         7.1. The INPUT Command
	 7.1.1. INPUT Timeouts
	 7.1.2. New INPUT Controls
	 7.1.3. INPUT with Pattern Matching
	 7.1.4. The INPUT Match Result
	 7.2. New or Improved Built-In Variables
	 7.3. New or Improved Built-In Functions
         7.4. New IF Conditions
         7.5. Using More than Ten Macro Arguments
         7.6. Clarification of Function Call Syntax
         7.7. Autodownload during INPUT Command Execution
         7.8. Built-in Help for Functions.
	 7.9. Variable Assignments
	 7.9.1. Assignment Operators
	 7.9.2. New Assignment Commands
	 7.10. Arrays
	 7.10.1. Array Initializers
	 7.10.2. Turning a String into an Array of Words
	 7.10.3. Arrays of Filenames
	 7.10.4. Automatic Arrays
	 7.10.5. Sorting Arrays
	 7.10.6. Displaying Arrays
         7.10.7. Other Array Operations
         7.10.8. Hints for Using Arrays
         7.10.9. Do-It-Yourself Arrays
         7.10.10. Associative Arrays
         7.11. OUTPUT Command Improvements
         7.12. Function and Variable Diagnostics
         7.13. Return Value of Macros
         7.14. The ASSERT, FAIL, and SUCCEED Commands.
         7.15. Using Alarms
         7.16. Passing Arguments to Command Files
         7.17. Dialogs with Timed Responses
         7.18. Increased Flexibility of SWITCH Case Labels
         7.19. "Kerbang" Scripts
         7.20. IF and XIF Statement Syntax
         7.20.1. The IF/XIF Distinction
         7.20.2. Boolean Expressions (The IF/WHILE Condition)
         7.21. Screen Formatting and Cursor Control
         7.22. Evaluating Arithmetic Expressions
         7.23. Floating-Point Arithmetic
         7.24. Tracing Script Execution
         7.25. Compact Substring Notation
         7.26. New WAIT Command Options
         7.26.1. Waiting for Modem Signals
         7.26.2. Waiting for File Events
         7.27. Relaxed FOR and SWITCH Syntax
     (8) USING OTHER FILE TRANSFER PROTOCOLS
     (9) COMMAND-LINE OPTIONS
         9.0. Extended-Format Command-Line Options
	 9.1. Command Line Personalities
	 9.2. Built-in Help for Command Line Options
	 9.3. New Command-Line Options
    (10) C-KERMIT AND G-KERMIT

III. APPENDICES

III.1. Character Set Tables
III.1.1. The Hewlett Packard Roman8 Character Set
III.1.2. Greek Character Sets
III.1.2.1. The ISO 8859-7 Latin / Greek Alphabet
III.1.2.2. The ELOT 927 Character Set
III.1.2.3. PC Code Page 869
III.2. Updated Country Codes

IV. ERRATA & CORRIGENDA: Corrections to "Using C-Kermit" 2nd Edition.
V. ADDITIONAL COPYRIGHT NOTICES


I. C-KERMIT DOCUMENTATION

The user manual for C-Kermit is:

Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone, Using C-Kermit, Second Edition, Digital Press / Butterworth-Heinemann, Woburn, MA, 1997, 622 pages, ISBN 1-55558-164-1.

CLICK HERE for reviews.

The present document is a supplement to Using C-Kermit 2nd Ed, not a replacement for it.

US single-copy price: $52.95; quantity discounts available. Available in bookstores or directly from Columbia University:

  The Kermit Project
  Columbia University
  612 West 115th Street
  New York NY  10025-7799
  USA
  Telephone: +1 (212) 854-3703
  Fax:       +1 (212) 662-6442

Domestic and overseas orders accepted. Price: US $44.95 (US, Canada, and Mexico). Shipping: $4.00 within the USA; $15.00 to all other countries. Orders may be paid by MasterCard or Visa, or prepaid by check in US dollars. Add $65 bank fee for checks not drawn on a US bank. Do not include sales tax. Inquire about quantity discounts.

You can also order by phone from the publisher, Digital Press / Butterworth-Heinemann, with MasterCard, Visa, or American Express:

  +1 800 366-2665   (Woburn, Massachusetts office for USA & Canada)
  +44 1865 314627   (Oxford, England distribution centre for UK & Europe)
  +61 03 9245 7111  (Melbourne, Vic, office for Australia & NZ)
  +65 356-1968      (Singapore office for Asia)
  +27 (31) 2683111  (Durban office for South Africa)

A German-language edition of the First Edition is also available:

Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone, C-Kermit - Einführung und Referenz, Verlag Heinz Heise, Hannover, Germany (1994). ISBN 3-88229-023-4. Deutsch von Gisbert W. Selke. Price: DM 88,00. Verlag Heinz Heise GmbH & Co. KG, Helstorfer Strasse 7, D-30625 Hannover. Tel. +49 (05 11) 53 52-0, Fax. +49 (05 11) 53 52-1 29.

The Kermit file transfer protocol is specified in:

Frank da Cruz, Kermit, A File Transfer Protocol, Digital Press, Bedford, MA, 1987, 379 pages, ISBN 0-932376-88-6. US single-copy price: $39.95. Availability as above.

News and articles about Kermit software and protocol are published periodically in the journal, Kermit News. Subscriptions are free; contact Columbia University at the address above.

Online news about Kermit is published in the comp.protocols.kermit.announce and comp.protocols.kermit.misc newsgroups.


II. NEW FEATURES

Support for the Bell Labs Plan 9 operating system was added to version 6.0 too late to be mentioned in the book (although it does appear on the cover).

Specific changes and additions are grouped together by major topic, roughly corresponding to the chapters of Using C-Kermit.


0. INCOMPATIBILITIES WITH PREVIOUS RELEASES

  1. C-Kermit 7.0 uses FAST Kermit protocol settings by default. This includes "unprefixing" of certain control characters. Because of this, file transfers that worked with previous releases might not work in the new release (but it is more likely that they will work, and much faster). If a transfer fails, you'll get a context-sensitive hint suggesting possible causes and cures. Usually SET PREFIXING ALL does the trick.

  2. C-Kermit 7.0 transfers files in BINARY mode by default. To restore the previous behavior, put SET FILE TYPE TEXT in your C-Kermit initialization file.

  3. No matter whether FILE TYPE is BINARY or TEXT by default, C-Kermit 7.0 now switches between text and binary mode automatically on a per-file basis according to various criteria, including (a) which kind of platform is on the other end of the connection (if known), (b) the version of Kermit on the other end, and (c) the file's name (see Section 4, especially 4.3). To disable this automatic switching and restore the earlier behavior, put SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL in your C-Kermit initialization file. To disable automatic switching for a particular transfer, include a /TEXT or /BINARY switch with your SEND or GET command.

  4. The RESEND and REGET commands automatically switch to binary mode; previously if RESEND or REGET were attempted when FILE TYPE was TEXT, these commands would fail immediately, with a message telling you they work only when the FILE TYPE is BINARY. Now they simply do this for you. See Section 4.23 for additional (important) information.

  5. SET PREFIXING CAUTIOUS and MINIMAL now both prefix linefeed (10 and 138) in case rlogin, ssh, or cu are "in the middle", since otherwise <LF>~ might appear in Kermit packets, and this would cause rlogin, ssh, or cu to disconnect, suspend,escape back, or otherwise wreck the file transfer. Xon and Xoff are now always prefixed too, even when Xon/Xoff flow control is not in effect, since unprefixing them has proven dangerous on TCP/IP connections.

  6. In UNIX, VMS, Windows, and OS/2, the DIRECTORY command is built into C-Kermit itself rather than implemented by running an external command or program. The built-in command might not behave the way the platform-specific external one did, but many options are available for customization. Of course the underlying platform-specific command can still be accessed with "!", "@", or "RUN" wherever the installation does not forbid. In UNIX, the "ls" command can be accessed directly as "ls" in C-Kermit. See Section 4.5.1 for details.

  7. SEND ? prints a list of switches rather than a list of filenames. If you want to see a list of filenames, use a (system-dependent) construction such as SEND ./? (for UNIX, Windows, or OS/2), SEND []? (VMS), etc. See Sections 1.5 and 4.7.1.

  8. In UNIX, OS-9, and Kermit 95, the wildcard characters in previous versions were * and ?. In C-Kermit 7.0 they are *, ?, [, ], {, and }, with dash used inside []'s to denote ranges and comma used inside {} to separate list elements. If you need to include any of these characters literally in a filename, precede each one with backslash (\). See Section 4.9.

  9. SET QUIET { ON, OFF } is now on the command stack, just like SET INPUT CASE, SET COUNT, SET MACRO ERROR, etc, as described on p.458 of Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition. This allows any macro or command file to SET QUIET ON or OFF without worrying about saving and restoring the global QUIET value. For example, this lets you write a script that tries SET LINE on lots of devices until it finds one free without spewing out loads of error messages, and also without disturbing the global QUIET setting, whatever it was.

  10. Because of the new "." operator (which introduces assignments), macros whose names begin with "." can not be invoked "by name". However, they still can be invoked with DO.

  11. The syntax of the EVALUATE command has changed. See Section 7.9.2. To restore the previous syntax, use SET EVALUATE OLD.

  12. The \v(directory) variable now includes the trailing directory separator; in previous releases it did not. This is to allow constructions such as:

      cd \v(dir)data.tmp
    

    to work across platforms that might have different directory notation, such as UNIX, Windows, and VMS.

  13. Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the FLOW-CONTROL setting was global and sticky. In C-Kermit 7.0, there is an array of default flow-control values for each kind of connection, that are applied automatically at SET LINE/PORT/HOST time. Thus a SET FLOW command given before SET LINE/PORT/HOST is likely to be undone. Therefore SET FLOW can be guaranteed to have the desired effect only if given after the SET LINE/PORT/HOST command.

  14. Character-set translation works differently in the TRANSMIT command when (a) the file character-set is not the same as the local end of the terminal character-set, or (b) when the terminal character-set is TRANSPARENT.


1. PROGRAM AND FILE MANAGEMENT AND COMMANDS

1.0. Bug Fixes

The following patches were issued to correct bugs in C-Kermit 6.0. These are described in detail in the 6.0 PATCHES file. All of these fixes have been incorporated in C-Kermit 6.1 (never released except as K95 1.1.16-17) and 7.0.

 0001   All UNIX         C-Kermit mishandles timestamps on files before 1970
 0002	Solaris 2.5++    Compilation error on Solaris 2.5 with Pro C
 0003	All VMS          CKERMIT.INI Fix for VMS
 0004	VMS/VAX/UCX 2.0  C-Kermit 6.0 can't TELNET on VAX/VMS with UCX 2.0
 0005	All              C-Kermit Might Send Packets Outside Window
 0006	All              MOVE from SEND-LIST does not delete original files
 0007	Solaris 2.5++    Higher serial speeds on Solaris 2.5
 0008   All              C-Kermit application file name can't contain spaces
 0009   AT&T 7300 UNIXPC setuid and hardware flow-control problems
 0010   Linux on Alpha   Patch to make ckutio.c compile on Linux/Alpha
 0011   OS-9/68000 2.4   Patch to make ck9con.c compile on OS-9/68000 2.4
 0012   MW Coherent 4.2  Patches for successful build on Coherent 4.2
 0013   SINIX-Y 5.43     "delay" variable conflicts with <sys/clock.h>
 0014   VMS/VAX/CMU-IP   Subject: Patches for VAX/VMS 5.x + CMU-IP
 0015   All              XECHO doesn't flush its output
 0016   VMS              CD and other directory operations might not work
 0017   Linux 1.2.x++    Use standard POSIX interface for high serial speeds
 0018   UNIX             SET WILDCARD-EXPANSION SHELL dumps core
 0019   All              Hayes V.34 modem init string problem
 0020   All              READ command does not fail if file not open
 0021   All              Problems with long function arguments
 0022   All              Certain \function()s can misbehave
 0023   All              X MOD 0 crashes program
 0024   All              Internal bulletproofing for lower() function
 0025   OpenBSD          Real OpenBSD support for C-Kermit 6.0
 0026   All              Incorrect checks for macro/command-file nesting depth
 0027   All              ANSWER doesn't automatically CONNECT
 0028   All              Overzealous EXIT warning
 0029   All              OUTPUT doesn't echo when DUPLEX is HALF
 0030   All              Minor problems with REMOTE DIRECTORY/DELETE/etc
 0031   All              CHECK command broken
 0032   All              Problem with SET TRANSMIT ECHO
 0033   UNIX, VMS, etc   HELP SET SERVER says too much
 0034   All              READ and !READ too picky about line terminators
 0035   All              END from inside SWITCH doesn't work
 0036   All              Problem telnetting to multihomed hosts
 0037   All              Redirection failures in REMOTE xxx > file

REDIRECT was missing in many UNIX C-Kermit implementations; in version 7.0, it should be available in all of them.


1.1. Command Continuation

Comments that start with ";" or "#" can no longer be continued. In:

  ; this is a comment -
  echo blah

the ECHO command will execute, rather than being taken as a continuation of the preceding comment line. This allows easy "commenting out" of commands from macro definitions.

However, the text of the COMMENT command can still be continued onto subsequent lines:

  comment this is a comment -
  echo blah

As of version 6.0, backslash is no longer a valid continuation character. Only hyphen should be used for command continuation. This is to make it possible to issue commands like "cd a:\" on DOS-like systems.

As of version 7.0:


1.2. Editor Interface

SET EDITOR name [ options ]
Lets you specify a text-editing program. The name can be a fully specified pathname like /usr/local/bin/emacs19/emacs, or it can be the name of any program in your PATH, e.g. "set editor emacs". In VMS, it must be a DCL command like "edit", "edit/tpu", "emacs", etc. If an environment variable EDITOR is defined when Kermit starts, its value is the default editor. You can also specify options to be included on the editor command line. Returns to Kermit when the editor exits.

EDIT [ filename ]
If the EDIT command is given without a filename, then if a previous filename had been given to an EDIT command, it is used; if not, the editor is started without a file. If a filename is given, the editor is started on that file, and the filename is remembered for subsequent EDIT commands.

SHOW EDITOR
Displays the full pathname of your text editor, if any, along with any command line options, and the file most recently edited (and therefore the default filename for your next EDIT command).

Related variables: \v(editor), \v(editopts), \v(editfile).


1.3. Web Browser and FTP Interface

C-Kermit includes an FTP command, which simply runs the FTP program; C-Kermit does not include any built-in support for Internet File Transfer Protocol, nor any method for interacting directly with an FTP server. In version 7.0, however, C-Kermit lets you specify your FTP client:

SET FTP-CLIENT [ name [ options ] ]
The name is the name of the FTP executable. In UNIX, Windows, or OS/2, it can be the filename of any executable program in your PATH (e.g. "ftp.exe" in Windows, "ftp" in UNIX); elsewhere (or if you do not have a PATH definition), it must be the fully specified pathname of the FTP program. If the name contains any spaces, enclose it braces. Include any options after the filename; these depend the particular ftp client.

The Web browser interface is covered in the following subsections.


1.3.1. Invoking your Browser from C-Kermit

BROWSE [ url ]
Starts your preferred Web browser on the URL, if one is given, otherwise on the most recently given URL, if any. Returns to Kermit when the browser exits.

SET BROWSER [ name [ options ] ]
Use this command to specify the name of your Web browser program, for example: "set browser lynx". The name must be in your PATH, or else it must be a fully specified filename; in VMS it must be a DCL command.

SHOW BROWSER
Displays the current browser, options, and most recent URL.

Related variables: \v(browser), \v(browsopts), \v(browsurl).

Also see Section 2.15: Contacting Web Servers with the HTTP Command.


1.3.2. Invoking C-Kermit from your Browser

The method for doing this depends, of course, on your browser. Here are some examples:

Netscape on UNIX (X-based)
In the Options->Applications section, set your Telnet application to:

  xterm -e /usr/local/bin/kermit/kermit -J %h %p

(replace "/usr/local/bin/kermit/kermit" by C-Kermit's actual pathname). -J is C-Kermit's command-line option to "be like Telnet"; %h and %p are Netscape placeholders for hostname and port.

Lynx on UNIX
As far as we know, this can be done only at compile time. Add the following line to the Lynx userdefs.h file before building the Lynx binary:

  #define TELNET_COMMAND "/opt/bin/kermit -J"

And then add lines like the following to the Lynx.cfg file:

  DOWNLOADER:Kermit binary download:/opt/bin/kermit -i -V -s %s -a %s:TRUE
  DOWNLOADER:Kermit text download:/opt/bin/kermit -s %s -a %s:TRUE

  UPLOADER:Kermit binary upload:/opt/bin/kermit -i -r -a %s:TRUE
  UPLOADER:Kermit text upload:/opt/bin/kermit -r -a %s:TRUE
  UPLOADER:Kermit text get:/opt/bin/kermit -g %s:TRUE
  UPLOADER:Kermit binary get:/opt/bin/kermit -ig %s:TRUE
But none of the above is necessary if you make C-Kermit your default Telnet client, which you can do by making a symlink called 'telnet' to the C-Kermit 7.0 binary. See Section 9.1 for details.


1.4. Command Editing

Ctrl-W ("Word delete") was changed in 7.0 to delete back to the previous non-alphanumeric, rather than all the way back to the previous space.


1.5. Command Switches

As of version 7.0, C-Kermit's command parser supports a new type of field, called a "switch". This is an optional command modifier.

1.5.1. General Switch Syntax

A switch is a keyword beginning with a slash (/). If it takes a value, then the value is appended to it (with no intervening spaces), separated by a colon (:) or equal sign (=). Depending on the switch, the value may be a number, a keyword, a filename, a date/time, etc. Examples:

  send oofa.txt                              ; No switches
  send /binary oofa.zip                      ; A switch without a value
  send /protocol:zmodem oofa.zip             ; A switch with a value (:)
  send /protocol=zmodem oofa.zip             ; A switch with a value (=)
  send /text /delete /as-name:x.x oofa.txt   ; Several switches

Like other command fields, switches are separated from other fields, and from each other, by whitespace, as shown in the examples just above. You can not put them together like so:

  send/text/delete/as-name:x.x oofa.txt

(as you might do in VMS or DOS, or as we might once have done in TOPS-10 or TOPS0-20, or PIP). This is primarily due to ambiguity between "/" as switch introducer versus "/" as UNIX directory separator; e.g. in:

  send /delete/as-name:foo/text oofa.txt

Does "foo/text" mean the filename is "foo" and the transfer is to be in text mode, or does it mean the filename is "foo/text"? Therefore we require whitespace between switches to resolve the ambiguity. (That's only one of several possible ambiguities -- it is also conceivable that a file called "text" exists in the path "/delete/as-name:foo/").

In general, if a switch can take a value, but you omit it, then either a reasonable default value is supplied, or an error message is printed:

  send /print:-Plaserwriter oofa.txt         ; Value included = print options
  send /print oofa.txt                       ; Value omitted, OK
  send /mail:kermit@columbia.edu oofa.txt    ; Value included = address
  send /mail oofa.txt                        ; Not OK - address required
  ?Address required

Context-sensitive help (?) and completion (Esc or Tab) are available in the normal manner:

  C-Kermit> send /pr? Switch, one of the following:
    /print /protocol
  C-Kermit> send /pro<ESC>tocol:?  File-transfer protocol,
   one of the following:
    kermit   xmodem   ymodem   ymodem-g   zmodem
  C-Kermit> send /protocol:k<TAB>ermit

If a switch takes a value and you use completion on it, a colon (:) is printed at the end of its name to indicate this. If it does not take a value, a space is printed.

Also, if you type ? in a switch field, switches that take values are shown with a trailing colon; those that don't take values are shown without one.


1.5.2. Order and Effect of Switches

The order of switches should not matter, except that they are evaluated from left to right, so if you give two switches with opposite effects, the rightmost one is used:

  send /text /binary oofa.zip                ; Sends oofa.zip in binary mode.

Like other command fields, switches have no effect whatsoever until the command is entered (by pressing the Return or Enter key). Even then, switches affect only the command with which they are included; they do not have global effect or side effects.


1.5.3. Distinguishing Switches from Other Fields

All switches are optional. A command that uses switches lets you give any number of them, including none at all. Example:

  send /binary oofa.zip
  send /bin /delete oofa.zip
  send /bin /as-name:mupeen.zip oofa.zip
  send oofa.zip

But how does Kermit know when the first "non-switch" is given? It has been told to look for both a switch and for something else, the data type of the next field (filename, number, etc). In most cases, this works well. But conflicts are not impossible. Suppose, for example, in UNIX there was a file named "text" in the top-level directory. The command to send it would be:

  send /text

But C-Kermit would think this was the "/text" switch. To resolve the conflict, use braces:

  send {/text}

or other circumlocutions such as "send //text", "send /./text", etc.

The opposite problem can occur if you give an illegal switch that happens to match a directory name. For example:

  send /f oofa.txt

There is no "/f" switch (there are several switches that begin with "/f", so "/f" is ambiguous). Now suppose there is an "f" directory in the root directory; then this command would be interpreted as:

Send all the files in the "/f" directory, giving each one an as-name of "oofa.txt".

This could be a mistake, or it could be exactly what you intended; C-Kermit has no way of telling the difference. To avoid situations like this, spell switches out in full until you are comfortable enough with them to know the minimum abbreviation for each one. Hint: use ? and completion while typing switches to obtain the necessary feedback.


1.5.4. Standard File Selection Switches

The following switches are used on different file-oriented commands (such as SEND, DIRECTORY, DELETE, PURGE) to refine the selection of files that match the given specification.

/AFTER:date-time
Select only those files having a date-time later than the one given. See Section 1.6 for date-time formats. Synonym: /SINCE.

/NOT-AFTER:date-time
Select only those files having a date-time not later than (i.e. earlier or equal to) the one given. Synonym: /NOT-SINCE.

/BEFORE:date-time
Select only those files having a date-time earlier than the one given.

/NOT-BEFORE:date-time
Select only those files having a date-time not earlier than (i.e. later or equal to) the one given.

/DOTFILES
UNIX and OS-9 only: The filespec is allowed to match files whose names start with (dot) period. Normally these files are not shown.

/NODOTFILES
(UNIX and OS-9 only) Don't show files whose names start with dot (period). This is the opposite of /DOTFILES, and is the default. Note that when a directory name starts with a period, the directory and (in recursive operations) all its subdirectories are skipped.

/LARGER-THAN:number
Only select files larger than the given number of bytes.

/SMALLER-THAN:number
Only select files smaller than the given number of bytes.

/EXCEPT:pattern
Specifies that any files whose names match the pattern, which can be a regular filename, or may contain "*" and/or "?" metacharacters (wildcards), are not to be selected. Example:

  send /except:*.log *.*

sends all files in the current directory except those with a filetype of ".log". Another:

  send /except:*.~*~ *.*

sends all files except the ones that look like Kermit or EMACS backup files (such as "oofa.txt.~17~") (of course you can also use the /NOBACKUP switch for this).

The pattern matcher is the same one used by IF MATCH string pattern (Section 7.4), so you can test your patterns using IF MATCH. If you need to match a literal * or ? (etc), precede it by a backslash (\). If the pattern contains any spaces, it must be enclosed in braces:

  send /except:{Foo bar} *.*

The pattern can also be a list of up to 8 patterns. In this case, the entire pattern must be enclosed in braces, and each sub-pattern must also be enclosed in braces; this eliminates the need for designating a separator character, which is likely to also be a legal filename character on some platform or other, and therefore a source of confusion. You may include spaces between the subpatterns but they are not necessary. The following two commands are equivalent:

  send /except:{{ck*.o} {ck*.c}} ck*.?
  send /except:{{ck*.o}{ck*.c}} ck*.?

If a pattern is to include a literal brace character, precede it with "\". Also note the apparent conflict of this list format and the string-list format described in Section 4.9.1. In case you want to include a wildcard string-list with braces on its outer ends as an /EXCEPT: argument, do it like this:

  send /except:{{{ckuusr.c,ckuus2.c,ckuus6.c}}} ckuus*.c


1.5.5. Setting Preferences for Different Commands

Certain oft-used commands offer lots of switches because different people have different requirements or preferences. For example, some people want to be able to delete files without having to watch a list of the deleted files scroll past, while others want to be prompted for permission to delete each file. Different people prefer different directory-listing styles. And so on. Such commands can be tailored with the SET OPTIONS command:

SET OPTIONS command [ switch [ switch [ ... ] ] ]
Sets each switch as the default for the given command, replacing the "factory default". Of course you can also override any defaults established by the SET OPTIONS command by including the relevant switches in the affected command any time you issue it.

SHOW OPTIONS
Lists the commands that allows option-setting, and the options currently in effect, if any, for each. Switches that have synonyms are shown under their primary name; for example. /LOG and /VERBOSE are shown as /LIST.

Commands for which options may be set include DIRECTORY, DELETE, PURGE, and TYPE. Examples:

  SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY /PAGE /NOBACKUP /HEADING /SORT:DATE /REVERSE
  SET OPTIONS DELETE /LIST /NOHEADING /NOPAGE /NOASK /NODOTFILES
  SET OPTIONS TYPE /PAGE

Not necessarily all of a command's switches can be set as options. For example, file selection switches, since these would normally be different for each command.

Put the desired SET OPTIONS commands in your C-Kermit customization file for each command whose default switches you want to change every time you run C-Kermit.


1.6. Dates and Times

Some commands and switches take date-time values, such as:

  send /after:{8-Feb-2000 10:28:01}

Various date-time formats are acceptable. The rules for the date are:

If the date-time string contains any spaces, it must be enclosed in braces. Examples of legal dates:

                           Interpretation:
  2000-Feb-8                8 February 2000
  {2000 Feb 8}              8 February 2000
  2000/Feb/8                8 February 2000
  2000_Feb_8                8 February 2000
  2000-2-8                  8 February 2000
  2000-02-08                8 February 2000
  8-Feb-2000                8 February 2000
  08-Feb-2000               8 February 2000
  12/25/2000                25 December 2000
  25/12/2000                25 December 2000

The last two examples show that when the year comes last, and the month is given numerically, the order of the day and month doesn't matter as long as the day is 13 or greater (mm/dd/yyyy is commonly used in the USA, whereas dd/mm/yyyy is the norm in Europe). However:

  08/02/2000                Is ambiguous and therefore not accepted.

If a date is given, the time is optional and defaults to 00:00:00. If the time is given with a date, it must follow the date, separated by space, /, -, or underscore, and with hours, minutes, and seconds separated by colon (:). Example:

  2000-Feb-8 10:28:01       Represents 8 February 2000, 10:28:01am

If a date is not given, the current date is used and a time is required.

Time format is hh:mm:ss or hh:mm or hh in 24-hour format, or followed by "am" or "pm" (or "AM" or "PM") to indicate morning or afternoon. Examples of times that are acceptable:

                           Interpretation:
  3:23:56                    3:23:56am
  3:23:56am                  3:23:56am
  3:23:56pm                  3:23:56pm = 15:23:56
 15:23:56                    3:23:56pm = 15:23:56
  3:23pm                     3:23:00pm = 15:23:00
  3:23PM                     3:23:00pm = 15:23:00
  3pm                        3:00:00pm = 15:00:00

Examples of legal date-times:

  send /after:{8 Feb 2000 10:28:01}
  send /after:8_Feb_2000_10:28:01
  send /after:8-Feb-2000/10:28:01
  send /after:2000/02/08/10:28:01
  send /after:2000/02/08_10:28:01
  send /after:2000/02/08_10:28:01am
  send /after:2000/02/08_10:28:01pm
  send /after:2000/02/08_10:28pm
  send /after:2000/02/08_10pm
  send /after:10:00:00pm
  send /after:10:00pm
  send /after:10pm
  send /after:22

Finally, there is a special all-numeric format you can use:

  yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss

For example:

  20000208 10:28:01

This is Kermit's standard date-time format (based on ISO 8601), and is accepted (among other formats) by any command or switch that requires a date-time, and is output by any function whose result is a calendar date-time.

There are no optional parts to this format and it must be exactly 17 characters long, punctuated as shown (except you can substitute underscore for space in contexts where a single "word" is required). The time is in 24-hour format (23:00:00 is 11:00pm). This is the format returned by \fdate(filename), so you can also use constructions like this:

  send /after:\fdate(oofa.txt)

which means "all files newer than oofa.txt".

Besides explicit dates, you can also use the any of the following shortcuts:

TODAY
Stands for the current date at 00:00:00.

TODAY 12:34:56
Stands for the current date at the given time.

YESTERDAY
Stands for yesterday's date at 00:00:00. A time may also be given.

TOMORROW
Stands for tomorrow's date at 00:00:00. A time may also be given.

+ number { DAYS, WEEKS, MONTHS, YEARS } [ time ]
Is replaced by the future date indicated, relative to the current date. If the time is omitted, 00:00:00 is used. Examples: +3days, +2weeks, +1year, +37months.

- number { DAYS, WEEKS, MONTHS, YEARS } [ time ]

Is replaced by the past date indicated, relative to the current date. If the time is omitted, 00:00:00 is used.

The time can be separated from the date shortcut by any of the same separators that are allowed for explicit date-times: space, hyphen, slash, period, or underscore. In switches and other space-delimited fields, use non-spaces to separate date/time fields, or enclose the date-time in braces, e.g.:

  purge /before:-4days_12:00:00
  purge /before:{- 4 days 12:00:00}

Of course you can also use variables:

  define \%n 43
  purge /before:-\%ndays_12:00:00

Shortcut names can be abbreviated to any length that still distinguishes them from any other name that can appear in the same context, e.g. "TOD" for today, "Y" for yesterday. Also, the special abbreviation "wks" is accepted for WEEKS, and "yrs" for "YEARS".

(To see how to specify dates relative to a specific date, rather than the current one, see the \fmjd() function description below.)

You can check date formats with the DATE command. DATE by itself prints the current date and time in standard format: yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss. DATE followed by a date and/or time (including shortcuts) converts it to standard format if it can understand it, otherwise it prints an error message.

The following variables and functions deal with dates and times; any function argument designated as "date-time" can be in any of the formats described above.

\v(day)
The first three letters of the English word for the current day of the week, e.g. "Wed".

\fday(date-time)
The first three letters of the English word for day of the week of the given date. If a time is included, it is ignored. Example: \fday(8 Feb 1988) = "Mon".

\v(nday)
The numeric day of the week: 0 = Sunday, 1 = Monday, ..., 6 = Saturday.

\fnday(date-time)
The numeric day of the week for the given date. If a time is included, it is ignored. Example: \fnday(8 Feb 1988) = "1".

\v(date)
The current date as dd mmm yyyy, e.g. "08 Feb 2000" (as in this example, a leading zero is supplied for day-of-month less than 10).

\v(ndate)
The current date in numeric format: yyyymmdd, e.g. "20000208".

\v(time)
The current time as hh:mm:ss, e.g. "15:27:14".

\ftime(time)
The given free-format date and/or time (e.g. "3pm") returns the time (without the date) converted to hh:mm:ss 24-hour format, e.g. "15:00:00" (the date, if given, is ignored).

\v(ntime)
The current time as seconds since midnight, e.g. "55634".

\v(tftime)
The elapsed time of the most recent file-transfer operation in seconds.

\v(intime)
The elapsed time for the most recent INPUT command to complete, in milliseconds.

\fntime(time)
The given free-format date and/or time is converted to seconds since midnight (the date, if given, is ignored). This function replaces \ftod2secs(), which is now a synonym for \fntime(). Unlike \ftod2secs(), \fntime() allows a date to be included, and it allows the time to be in free format (like 3pm), and it allows the amount of time to be more than 24 hours. E.g. \fntime(48:00:00) = 172800. Example of use:
  set alarm \fntime(48:00:00) ; set alarm 48 hours from now.

\fn2time(seconds)
The given number of seconds is converted to hh:mm:ss format.

\fdate(filename)
Returns the modification date-time of the given file in standard format: yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss.

\fcvtdate(date-time)
Converts a free-format date and/or time to Kermit standard format: yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss. If no argument is given, returns the current date-time in standard format. If a date is given but no time, the converted date is returned without a time. If a time is given with no date, the current date is supplied. Examples:
  \fcvtdate(4 Jul 2000 2:21:17pm) = 20000704 14:21:17
  \fcvtdate() = 20000704 14:21:17 (on 4 Jul 2000 at 2:21:17pm).
  \fcvtd(4 Jul 2000) = 20000704
  \fcvtd(6pm) = 20000704 18:00:00 (on 4 Jul 2000 at 6:00pm).

\fdayofyear(date-time)
\fdoy(date-time)
Converts a free-format date and/or time to yyyyddd, where ddd is the 3-digit day of the year, and 1 January is Day 1. If a time is included with the date, it is returned in standard format. If a date is included but no time, the date is returned without a time. If a time is given with no date, the time is converted and the current date is supplied. If no argument is given, the current date-time is returned. Synonym: \fdoy(). Examples:

  \fddayofyear(4 Jul 2000 2:21:17pm) = 2000185 14:21:17
  \fdoy() = 2000185 14:21:17 (on 4 Jul 2000 at 2:21:17pm).
  \fdoy(4 Jul 2000) = 2000185
  \fdoy(6pm) = 2000185 18:00:00 (on 4 Jul 2000 at 6:00pm).

Note: The yyyyddd day-of-year format is often erroneously referred to as a Julian date. However, a true Julian date is a simple counting number, the number of days since a certain fixed day in the past. See \fmjd() below.

\fdoy2date(date-time)
Converts a date or date-time in day-of-year format to a standard format date. A yyyyddd-format date must be supplied; time is optional. The given date is converted to yyyymmdd format. If a time is given, it is converted to 24-hour format. Examples:

  \fdoy2date(2000185) = 20000704
  \fdoy2(2000185 3pm) = 20000704 15:00:00

\fmjd(date-time)
Converts free-format date and/or time to a Modified Julian Date (MJD), the number of days since 17 Nov 1858 00:00:00. If a time is given, it is ignored. Examples:

  \fmjd(4 Jul 2000) = 50998
  \fmjd(17 Nov 1858) = 0
  \fmjd(16 Nov 1858) = -1

\fmjd2date(mjd)
Converts an MJD (integer) to standard date format, yyyymmdd:

  \fmjd2(50998) = 4 Jul 1998
  \fmjd2(0) = 17 Nov 1858
  \fmjd2(-1) = 16 Nov 1858
  \fmjd2(-365) = 17 Nov 1857

MJDs are normal integers and, unlike DOYs, may be added, subtracted, etc, with each other or with other integers, to obtain meaningful results. For example, to find out the date 212 days ago:

  echo \fmjd2date(\fmjd()-212)

Constructions such as this can be used in any command where a date-time is required, e.g.:

  send /after:\fmjd2date(\fmjd()-212)

to send all files that are not older than 212 days (this is equivalent to "send /after:-212days").

MJDs also have other regularities not exhibited by other date formats. For example, \fmodulus(\fmjd(any-date),7) gives the day of the week for any date (where 4=Sun, 5=Mon, ..., 3=Sat). (However, it is easier to use \fnday() for this purpose, and it gives the more conventional result of 0=Sun, 1=Mon, ..., 6=Sat).

Note that if MJDs are to be compared, they must be compared numerically (IF <, =, >) and not lexically (IF LLT, EQUAL, LGT), whereas DOYs must be compared lexically if they include a time (which contains ":" characters); however, if DOYs do not include a time, they may also be compared numerically.

In any case, lexical comparison of DOYs always produces the appropriate result, as does numeric comparison of MJDs.

The same comments apply to sorting. Also note that DOYs are fixed length, but MJDs can vary in length. However, all MJDs between 3 April 1886 and 30 Aug 2132 are 5 decimal digits long. (MJDs become 6 digits long on 31 Aug 2132, and 7 digits long on 13 Oct 4596).


1.7. Partial Completion of Keywords

Partial completion of keywords was added in C-Kermit 7.0. In prior versions, if completion was attempted (by pressing the Esc or Tab key) on a string that matched different keywords, you'd just get a beep. Now Kermit completes up to the first character where the possibly matching keywords differ and then beeps. For example:

  C-Kermit> send /n<Tab>

which matches /NOT-BEFORE and /NOT-AFTER, now completes up to the dash:

  C-Kermit> send /n<Tab>ot-<Beep>

Partial completion works for filenames too (as it has for some years).


1.8. Command Recall

C-Kermit has had a command history buffer for some time, which could be scrolled interactively using control characters or (in Kermit 95 only) arrow keys. Version 7.0 adds a REDO command that allows the most recent command matching a given pattern to be re-executed:

{ REDO, RR, ^ } [ pattern ]
Search the command history list for the most recent command that matches the given pattern, and if one is found, execute it again.

The pattern can be a simple string (like "send"), in which case the last SEND command is re-executed. Or it can contain wildcard characters "*" and/or "?", which match any string and any single character, respectively (note that "?" must be preceded by backslash to override its normal function of giving help), and in most C-Kermit versions may also include [] character lists and {} string lists (see Section 4.9).

The match works by appending "*" to the end of the given pattern (if you didn't put one there yourself). Thus "redo *oofa" becomes "redo *oofa*" and therefore matches the most recent command that contains "oofa" anywhere within the command. If you want to inhibit the application of the trailing "*", e.g. to force matching a string at the end of a command, enclose the pattern in braces:

  redo {*oofa}

matches the most recent command that ends with "oofa".

REDO commands themselves are not entered into the command history list. If no pattern is given, the previous (non-REDO) command is re-executed. The REDOne command is reinserted at the end of the command history buffer, so the command scrollback character (Ctrl-P, Ctrl-B, or Uparrow) can retrieve it.

Examples:

  C-Kermit> echo foo
  foo
  C-Kermit> show alarm
  (no alarm set)
  C-Kermit> echo blah
  blah
  C-Kermit> redo          ; Most recent command
  blah
  C-Kermit> redo s        ; Most recent command starting with "s"
  (no alarm set)
  C-Kermit> redo echo f   ; Most recent command starting with "echo f"
  foo
  C-Kermit> redo *foo     ; Most recent command that has "foo" in it
  foo
  C-Kermit> <Ctrl-P>      ; Scroll back
  C-Kermit> echo foo      ; The REDOne command is there
  C-Kermit> redo {*foo}   ; Most recent command that ends with "foo"
  foo
  C-Kermit>

Since REDO, REDIAL, and REDIRECT all start the same way, and RED is the designated non-unique abbreviation for REDIAL, REDO must be spelled out in full. For convenience, RR is included as an invisible easy-to-type synonym for REDO. You can also use the "^" character for this:

  C-Kermit> ^             ; Most recent command
  C-Kermit> ^ s           ; Most recent command starting with "s"
  C-Kermit> ^s            ; Ditto (space not required after "^").
  C-Kermit> ^*foo         ; Most recent command that has "foo" in it.
  C-Kermit> ^{*foo}       ; Most recent command ends with "foo".

Unlike the manual command-history-scrolling keys, the REDO command can be used in a script, but it's not recommended (since the command to be REDOne might not be found, so if the REDO command fails, you can't tell whether it was because REDO failed to find the requested command, or because the command was found but it failed).


1.9. EXIT Messages

The EXIT and QUIT commands now accept an optional message to be printed. This makes the syntax of EXIT and QUIT just like END and STOP:

{ EXIT, QUIT, END, STOP } [ status-code [ message ] ]

where status-code is a number (0 indicating success, nonzero indicating failure). This is handy in scripts that are never supposed to enter interactive mode:

  dial 7654321
  if fail exit 1 Can't make connection - try again later.

Previously this could only be done in two steps:

  dial 7654321
  xif fail { echo Can't make connection - try again later, exit 1 }

A status code must be included in order to specify a message. In the case of EXIT and QUIT, the default status code is contained in the variable \v(exitstatus), and is set automatically by various events (file transfer failures, etc; it can also be set explicitly with the SET EXIT STATUS command). If you want to give an EXIT or QUIT command with a message, but without changing the exit status from what it normally would have been, use the \v(exitstatus) variable, e.g.:

   exit \v(existatus) Goodbye from \v(cmdfile).

The EXIT status is returned to the system shell or whatever other process invoked C-Kermit, e.g. in UNIX:

  C-Kermit> exit 97 bye bye
  bye bye
  $ echo $?
  97
  $


1.10. Managing Keyboard Interruptions

When C-Kermit is in command or file-transfer mode (as opposed to CONNECT mode), it can be interrupted with Ctrl-C. Version 7.0 adds the ability to disarm the Ctrl-C interrupt:

SET COMMAND INTERRUPT { ON, OFF }
COMMAND INTERRUPT is ON by default, meaning the Ctrl-C can be used to interrupt a command or a file transfer in progress. Use OFF to disable these interruptions, and use it with great caution for obvious reasons.

SET TRANSFER INTERRUPT { ON, OFF }
This can be used to disable keyboard interruption of file transfer when C-Kermit is in local mode, or to re-enable it after it has been disabled. This applies to the X, Z, E, and similar keys as well as to the system interrupt character, usually Ctrl-C. This is distinct from SET TRANSFER CANCELLATION, which tells whether packet mode can be exited by sending a special sequence of characters.

Several other commands can be interrupted by pressing any key while they are active. Version 7.0 adds the ability to disable this form of interruption also:

SET INPUT CANCELLATION { ON, OFF }
Whether an INPUT command in progress can be interrupted by pressing a key. Normally ON. Setting INPUT CANCELLATION OFF makes INPUT commands uninterruptible except by Ctrl-C (unless COMMAND INTERRUPTION is also OFF).

SET SLEEP CANCELLATION { ON, OFF }
Whether a SLEEP, PAUSE, or WAIT command in progress can be interrupted by pressing a key. Normally ON. Setting SLEEP CANCELLATION OFF makes these commands uninterruptible except by Ctrl-C (unless COMMAND INTERRUPTION is also OFF). Synonyms: SET PAUSE CANCELLATION, SET WAIT CANCELLATION.

So to make certain a script is not interruptible by the user, include these commands:

  SET TRANSFER INTERRUPT OFF
  SET SLEEP CANCELLATION OFF
  SET INPUT CANCELLATION OFF
  SET COMMAND INTERRUPTION OFF

Make sure to turn them back on afterwards if interruption is to be re-enabled.

When a PAUSE, SLEEP, WAIT, or INPUT command is interrupted from the keyboard, the new variable \v(kbchar) contains a copy of the (first) character that was typed and caused the interruption, provided it was not the command interrupt character (usually Ctrl-C). If these commands complete successfully or time out without a keyboard interruption, the \v(kbchar) variable is empty.

The \v(kbchar) variable (like any other variable) can be tested with:

  if defined \v(kbchar) command

The command is executed if the variable is not empty.

The \v(kbchar) variable can be reset with WAIT 0 (PAUSE 0, SLEEP 0, etc).


1.11. Taming The Wild Backslash -- Part Deux

Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition, contains a brief section, "Taming the Wild Backslash", on page 48, which subsequent experience has shown to be inadequate for Kermit users intent on writing scripts that deal with Windows, DOS, and OS/2 filenames, in which backslash (\) is used as the directory separator. This section fills in the blanks.

1.11.1. Background

The Kermit command language shares a certain unavoidable but annoying characteristic with most other command languages that are capable of string replacement, namely the necessity to "quote" certain characters when you want them to be taken literally. This is a consequence of the facts that:

  1. One or more characters must be set aside to denote replacement, rather than acting as literal text.
  2. We have only 96 printable characters to work with in ASCII, which is still the only universally portable character set.
  3. There is no single printable character that is unused everywhere.
  4. Variables are not restricted to certain contexts, as they are in formal programming languages like C and Fortran, but can appear anywhere at all within a command, and therefore require special syntax.

Thus there can be conflicts. To illustrate, the standard UNIX shell uses dollar sign ($) to introduce variables. So the shell command:

  echo $TERM

displays the value of the TERM variable, e.g. vt320. But suppose you want to display a real dollar sign:

  echo The price is $10.20

This causes the shell to evaluate the variable "$1", which might or might not exist, and substitute its value, e.g.:

  The price is 0.20

(in this case the $1 variable had no value.) This is probably not what you wanted. To force the dollar sign to be taken literally, you must apply a "quoting rule", such as "precede a character by backslash (\) to force the shell to take the character literally":

  echo The price is \$10.20
  The price is $10.20

But now suppose you want the backslash AND the dollar sign to be taken literally:

  echo The price is \\$10.20

This doesn't work, since the first backslash quotes the second one, thereby leaving the dollar sign unquoted again:

  The price is \0.20

Quoting the dollar sign requires addition of a third backslash:

  echo The price is \\\$10.20
  The price is \$10.20

The first backslash quotes the second one, and the third backslash quotes the dollar sign.

Every command language -- all UNIX shells, VMS DCL, DOS Batch, AOS/VS CLI, etc etc -- has similar rules. UNIX shell rules are probably the most complicated, since many printable characters -- not just one -- are special there: dollar sign, single quote, double quote, backslash, asterisk, accent grave, number sign, ampersand, question mark, parentheses, brackets, braces, etc -- practically every non-alphanumeric character needs some form of quoting if it is to be taken literally. And to add to the confusion, the UNIX shell offers many forms of quoting, and many alternative UNIX shells are available, each using slightly different syntax.


1.11.2. Kermit's Quoting Rules

Kermit's basic quoting rules are simple by comparison (there are, of course, additional syntax requirements for macro definitions, command blocks, function calls, etc, but they are not relevant here).

The following characters are special in Kermit commands:

Backslash (\)
Introduces a variable, or the numeric representation of a special character, or a function, or other item for substitution. If the backslash is followed by a digit or by any of the following characters:

  x, o, d, m, s, f, v, $, %, &, :, {

this indicates a special substitution item; otherwise the following character is to be taken literally (exceptions: \ at end of line is taken literally; \n, \b, and \n are special items in the OUTPUT command only).

Semicolon (;)
(Only when at the beginning of a line or preceded by at least one space or tab) Introduces a comment.

Number sign (#)
(Only when at the beginning of a line or preceded by at least one space or tab) Just like semicolon; introduces a comment.

Question mark (?)
(Only at the command prompt - not in command files or macros) Requests context-sensitive help.

To force Kermit to take any of these characters literally, simply precede it by a backslash (\).

Sounds easy! And it is, except when backslash also has a special meaning to the underlying operating system, as it does in DOS, Windows, and OS/2, where it serves as the directory separator in filenames such as:

  D:\K95\KEYMAPS\READ.ME

Using our rule, we would need to refer to this file in Kermit commands as follows:

  D:\\K95\\KEYMAPS\\READ.ME

But this would not be obvious to new users of Kermit software on DOS, Windows, or OS/2, and it would be annoying to seasoned ones. Thus MS-DOS Kermit and Kermit 95 go to rather extreme lengths to allow the more natural notation, as in:

  send d:\k95\keymaps\read.me

The reason this is tricky is that we also need to allow for variables and other expressions introduced by backslash in the same command. For example, suppose \%a is a variable whose value is "oofa" (without the quotes). What does the following command do?

  send d:\%a

Does it send the file named "oofa" in the current directory of the D: disk, or does it send a file named "%a" in the root directory of the D: disk? This is the kind of trouble we get into when we attempt to bend the rules in the interest of user friendliness. (The answer is: if the variable \%a has definition that is the name of an existing file, that file is sent; if a file d:\%a exists, it is sent; otherwise if both conditions are true, the variable takes precedence, and the literal filename can be forced by quoting: \\%a.)

In Kermit 95 (but not MS-DOS Kermit), we also bend the rules another way by allowing you to use forward slash (/) rather than backslash (\) as the directory separator:

  send d:/k95/keymaps/read.me

This looks more natural to UNIX users, and in fact is perfectly acceptable to the Windows 95/98/NT and OS/2 operating systems on the API level. BUT (there is always a "but") the Microsoft shell, COMMAND.COM, for Windows 95/98 and NT does not allow this notation, and therefore it can not be used in any Kermit command -- such as RUN -- that invokes the Windows command shell AND your command shell is COMMAND.COM or any other shell that does not allow forward slash as directory separator (some alternative shells do allow this).

NOTE: There exists a wide variety of alternative shells from third parties that do not have this restriction. If you are using a shell that accepts forward slash as a directory separator, you can stop reading right now -- UNLESS (there is always an "unless") you want your scripts to be portable to systems that have other shells. Also note that some Windows shells might actually REQUIRE forward slashes (instead of backslashes) as directory separators; we do not treat this situation below, but the treatment is obvious -- use slash rather backslash as the directory separator.


1.11.3. Passing DOS Filenames from Kermit to Shell Commands

The following Kermit commands invoke the system command shell:

  RUN (and its synonyms ! and @)
  REDIRECT
  PIPE

Each of these commands takes a shell command as an operand. These shell commands are not, and can not be, parsed by Kermit since Kermit does not know the syntax of shell commands, and so can't tell the difference between a keyword, a filename, a variable, a switch, or other item. Therefore the rules can not be bent since Kermit doesn't know where or how to bend them. To illustrate (using the regular Windows shell):

  run c:\\windows\\command\\chkdsk.exe

works OK, but:

  run c:/windows/command/chkdsk.exe

is not accepted by COMMAND.COM. But:

  run c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe

results in Kermit applying its quoting rules before sending the text to the shell. Since "w" and "c" are not in the list of backslash-item codes, the backslash means "take the following character literally". Thus, by the time this filename gets to the Windows shell, it has become:

  c:windowscommandchkdsk.exe

which is probably not what you wanted. (If "w" and "c" were in the list, the results could be even stranger.) Even more confusing is the case where a directory or filename starts with one or more digits:

  run c:\123\lotus.exe

in which "\123" is the Kermit notation for ASCII character 123, which happens to be left brace ({), resulting in "c:{lotus.exe".

So when passing filenames to a Windows shell, always use double backslashes as directory separators, to ensure that the shell gets single backslashes:

  run c:\\windows\\command\\chkdsk.exe
  run c:\\123\\lotus.exe

Similar problems might occur with the built-in EDIT, BROWSE, and FTP commands. These commands result in Kermit building a shell command internally to invoke the associated helper program; the form of this command might conflict with the form demanded by certain alternative shells.


1.11.4. Using Variables to Hold DOS Filenames

Now to the next level. Suppose you want to write a script in which filenames are parameters, and therefore are stored in variables. Example:

  define \%f c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe
  ...
  run \%f

Obviously this won't work for the reasons just noted; the RUN command requires directory separators be coded as double backslashes:

  define \%f c:\\windows\\command\\chkdsk.exe
  ...
  run \%f

This will work; no surprises here. However, if you had used ASSIGN rather than DEFINE, you might have been surprised after all; review pages 348-349 of Using C-Kermit (2nd Ed) for the difference between DEFINE and ASSIGN.

We have said that any Kermit 95 or MS-DOS Kermit command that parses filenames itself -- SEND, for example -- does not require double backslashes since it knows it is parsing a filename. So since the following works:

  send c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe

Should the following also work?

  define \%f c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe
  ...
  send \%f

Answer: No. Why? Because \%f is evaluated "recursively", to allow for the possibility that its definition contains further variable references. This is true of all "backslash-percent-letter" (or -digit) variables, and also for array references. So \%f becomes c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe, which becomes c:windowscommandchkdsk.exe.

The trick here is to use the "other" kind of variable, that is evaluated only "one level deep" rather than recursively:

  define filename c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe
  ...
  send \m(filename)

Similarly if you want to prompt the user for a filename:

  ask filename { Please type a filename: }
   Please type a filename: c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe
  send \m(filename)


1.11.5. Passing DOS Filenames as Parameters to Macros

Suppose you want to pass a DOS filename containing backslashes as a parameter to a Kermit macro. This raises two issues:

  1. Parameters to macros are "just text" and so are fully evaluated before they are passed to the macro.
  2. Once inside the macro, the formal parameters \%1, \%2, ... \%9 are the type of variable that is evaluated recursively.

Thus a DOS filename is ruined once in the act of parsing the macro invocation, and again when referring to it from within the macro. To illustrate, suppose "test" is a macro. Then in the invocation:

  test c:\mydir\blah.txt

"c:mydirblah.txt" is assigned to \%1. However, if we double the backslashes:

  test c:\\mydir\\blah.txt

"c:\mydir\blah.txt" is assigned to \%1. But then when you refer to \%1 in the macro, it is evaluated recursively, resulting in "c:mydirblah.txt". To illustrate:

  define test echo \%1
  test c:\mydir\blah.txt
  c:mydirblah.txt
  test c:\\mydir\\blah.txt
  c:mydirblah.txt
  test c:\\\\mydir\\\\blah.txt
  c:\mydir\blah.txt

Let's address each part of the problem separately. First, inside the macro. You can use the \fcontents() function to force a backslash-percent variable (such as a macro argument) to be evaluated one level deep instead of recursively, for example:

  define test echo { The filename is "\fcontents(\%1)"}

  test c:\mydir\blah.txt               ; We don't expect this to work
   The filename is "c:mydirblah.txt"   ; and it doesn't.
  test c:\\mydir\\blah.txt             ; But this does...
   The filename is "c:\mydir\blah.txt"

Thus if the filename arrives inside the macro with single backslashes, the backslashes are preserved if you always refer to the parameter through the \fcontents() function.

Now how to ensure that backslashes are not stripped or misinterpreted when passing a filename to a macro? This brings us back to what we learned in earlier sections:

  1. If it is a literal filename, either double the backslashes, or (if the filename is to be used only within Kermit itself and not passed to a DOS shell, or it is to be passed to an alternative shell that accepts forward slash as a directory separator), use forward slash instead of backslash as the directory separator.

  2. If it is a variable that contains a filename, make sure you use a macro-style variable name, rather than a backslash-percent-character name.

Examples:

  define test echo \fcontents(\%1)
  define filename c:\mydir\blah.txt

  test c:\\mydir\\blah.txt  ; Literal filename with double backslashes
  c:\mydir\blah.txt

  test c:/mydir/blah.txt    ; Literal filename with forward slashes
  c:/mydir/blah.txt

  test \m(filename)         ; Variable
  c:\mydir\blah.txt

But what if you don't like these rules and you still want to pass a literal filename containing single backslashes to a macro? This is possible too, but a bit tricky: turn command quoting off before invoking the macro, and then turn it back on inside the macro. Example:

  define test set command quoting on, echo \fcontents(\%1)

  set command quoting off
  test c:\mydir\blah.txt
  c:\mydir\blah.txt

Upon return from the macro, command quoting is back on (since the macro turned it on).

Obviously this trick can not be used if the filename is stored in a variable, since it prevents the variable from being evaluated.


1.11.6. Passing DOS File Names from Macro Parameters to the DOS Shell

Now suppose you need to pass a DOS filename to a macro, and the macro needs to pass it, in turn, to the Windows shell via (say) Kermit's RUN command. This works too:

  define xrun run \fcontents(\%1)
  xrun c:\\windows\\command\\chkdsk.exe

(or you can use the SET COMMAND QUOTING OFF / ON technique described above to avoid the double backslashes.) But..

  xrun c:/windows/command/chkdsk.exe

does not work if the Windows shell does not recognize "/" as a directory separator. If there is a chance that a filename might be passed to the macro in this form, the macro will need to convert it to a form acceptable to the shell:

  define xrun run \freplace(\fcontents(\%1),/,\\)

Here we replace all occurrences (if any) of "/" in the argument with "\" prior to issuing the RUN command. Of course, in order to specify "\" as a literal character in the \freplace() argument list, we have to double it.


1.11.7. Passing DOS Filenames to Kermit from the Shell

As noted in the manual, the \&@[] array contains Kermit's command-line arguments. Suppose one of these arguments, say \&@[3], is a DOS filename such as C:\FOO\BAR\BAZ\OOFA.TXT. (Note: In C-Kermit 7.0 and K95 1.1.18 and later, command-line arguments after "=" or "--" are also available in the top-level \%1..9 variables; see Section 7.5.)

Of course you can eliminate any problems by using forward slashes rather than backslashes in the filename, but sometimes this is not possible, as when the Kermit command line is being generated by another program than can only generate "native" format DOS filenames.

As noted in the manual, "\%x" variables and \&x[] arrays are always evaluated "all the way" (recursively). If the contents of one of these variables contains backslashes, this causes another level of evaluation.

There is another kind of variable, which is evaluated only "one level deep". You can use this to prevent interpretation of the backslashes in the filenames. Example:

  assign filename \fcontents(\&@[3])  ; Transfer contents
  ...
  send \m(filename)

Or, more simply:

  send \fcontents(\&@[3])


1.12. Debugging

The debug log is produced when you give a "log debug" command. This is normally done at the request of the Kermit help desk, for forwarding to the Kermit developers for analysis as a last resort in troubleshooting problems. (Last resort because it can grow quite huge in a very short time.) In cases where timing information is critical to understanding a problem, you can tell C-Kermit to put a timestamp on each debug log line by giving the command:

  SET DEBUG TIMESTAMP ON

At any time before or after activating the debug log (SET DEBUG TIMESTAMP OFF turns off timestamping). Timestamps can be turned off and on as desired while logging. Obviously, they increase the size and growth rate of the log significantly, and so should be used sparingly. Timestamps are of the form hh:mm:ss.xxx, where .xxx is thousands of a second (but is included only on platforms that include this feature).


1.13. Logs

In UNIX C-Kermit and in K-95, you can now direct any log to a pipe. This not only lets you send your logs to places other than disk files, but also lets you customize them to any desired degree.

LOG { DEBUG, PACKETS, SESSION, TRANSACTION, CONNECTION } { file, pipe } ...
A "pipe" is the name of a command, preceded by a vertical bar. If the pipe contains any spaces, it must be enclosed in braces.

Here are some examples for UNIX (always remember the importance of getting the UNIX shell quoting rules right):

LOG TRANSACTIONS |lpr
This sends the transaction log to the default UNIX printer, rather than to a file (use "lp" rather than "lpr" if necessary).

LOG TRANSACTIONS {| myfilter > t.log}
For those who don't like the format of the transaction log, or want to extract certain information from it; write your own output filter.

LOG SESSION {| lpr -Plaserwriter}
This sends the session log to a specific UNIX printer, rather than to a file. Note the braces around the pipeline. These are required because it contains spaces.

LOG DEBUG {| tail -100 > debug.log}
This causes the debug log file to contain only the final 100 lines. Suppose C-Kermit crashes under some unpredictable circumstances, and you need a debug log to catch it in the act. But the debug log can grow to huge proportions very quickly, possibly filling up the disk. Piping the debug log through "tail" results in keeping only the last 100 lines (or other number of your choice).

LOG DEBUG {| grep "^TELNET" > debug.log}
This one shows how to log only Telnet negotiations. Piping the debug log through grep or egrep lets you log only specific information, rather than everything. "man grep" for further info.

LOG DEBUG {| gzip -c > debug.log.gz}
Creates a full debug log, but compressed by gzip to save space.

LOG PACKETS {| tr "\\01" "X" | cut -c9- > packet.log}
This one writes the regular packet log, but translates the Ctrl-A that starts each packet to the letter "X" and removes the s-nn-nn- notation from the beginning of each line. Note the double backslash (normal Kermit quoting rules). "man tr" and "man cut" for further info.

See Section 2.12 for information about the new connection log.


1.14. Automatic File-Transfer Packet Recognition at the Command Prompt

Beginning in version 7.0, C-Kermit can recognize Kermit (and in some cases also Zmodem) file-transfer packets while at its command prompt. This is convenient (for example), if you escaped back from a remote Kermit program and told the local Kermit program to send a file, but forgot to tell the remote Kermit program to receive it (and the local Kermit did not have the "send a Kermit receive command" feature available). This feature is controlled by the following command:

SET COMMAND AUTODOWNLOAD { ON, OFF }
When ON, which is the default, the command parser recognizes Kermit packets when Kermit is in remote mode. An S packet makes it go into receive mode, an I packet makes it go into server mode. When OFF, packet recognition is disabled and the behavior when a packet is received at the command prompt is as it was in C-Kermit 6.1 and earlier (namely to print an error message).

COMMAND AUTODOWNLOAD is the command-mode equivalent of TERMINAL AUTODOWNLOAD, which is effective during CONNECT mode.


1.15. The TYPE Command

The TYPE command now accepts a selection of optional switches (Section 1.5), and also sets several variables.

Syntax: TYPE [ switches... ] filename

Variables:

\v(ty_ln)
Line number of current line (during TYPE command; see /PREFIX)

\v(ty_lc)
Line count of file most recently TYPEd.

\v(ty_mc)
Match count of file most recently TYPEd (see /MATCH).

Switches:

/PAGE
If /PAGE is included, Kermit pauses at the end of each screenful and issues a "more?" prompt. You may press the space bar to view the next page (screenful), or press "q" or "n" to return to the C-Kermit prompt. If this switch is given, it overrides the COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING setting for this command only. If it is not given, paging is according to COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING.

/NOPAGE
Do not pause at the end of each screenful; show the whole file (or all selected lines) at once. If this switch is given, it overrides the COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING setting for this command only. If it is not given, paging is according to COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING.

/HEAD[:n]
Only show the first n lines of the file (where n is a number). If n is omitted, 10 is used.

/TAIL[:n]
Only show the last n lines of the file (where n is a number). If nis omitted, 10 is used. Note: /HEAD and /TAIL can't be combined; if you give both switches, only the most recent one is used.

/MATCH:pattern
Only type lines from the file that match the given pattern (see Section 4.9.1 for pattern notation). UNIX users familiar with grep should note a significant difference: there is no implied "*" at the beginning and end of the pattern. Thus:

  TYPE /MATCH:foo    Lists lines whose entire contents are "foo".
  TYPE /MATCH:foo*   Lists lines that start with "foo".
  TYPE /MATCH:*foo   Lists lines that end with "foo".
  TYPE /MATCH:*foo*  Lists lines that have "foo" anywhere in them.

/HEAD and /TAIL apply after /MATCH, so "type /tail:20 /match:x*" shows the last 20 lines in the file that start with "x".

/PREFIX:string
Print the given string at the beginning of each line. The string may be a constant, a variable, or a quoted variable. If it's an unquoted variable, its value at the time the TYPE command was given is used as a constant. If it is a quoted variable, it is re-evaluated for each line; a useful variable for this context is \v(ty_ln) (the line number of the current line being typed). If the prefix is to include spaces, it must be enclosed in braces. Examples:

type /prefix:{oofa.txt: } /match:*thing* oofa.txt
Prints all lines in oofa.txt that contain "thing" with the filename itself as the prefix (similar to UNIX grep).

type /prefix:{\v(time). } oofa.txt
Prefixes each line of oofa.txt with the time at which the TYPE command was given (one backslash)

type /prefix:{\\v(time). } oofa.txt
Prefixes each line of oofa.txt with the time at which that line is being typed (two backslashes).

type /prefix:{\\v(ty_ln). } oofa.txt
Prefixes each line of oofa.txt with its line number.

type /prefix:{\\flpad(\\v(ty_ln),4). } oofa.txt
Same as the previous example, except the line number is right-adjusted in a 4-column field.

/WIDTH[:n]
Truncates each line at column n (which must be a number) prior to printing it. This option can be used for long lines when you don't want them to wrap. If nis omitted, your current screen width is used.

/COUNT
Counts lines and -- if /MATCH was included, matches -- but does not print any lines from the file. The line and match count is shown at the end, and the variables \v(ty_lc) and \v(ty_lm) are set accordingly.

SET OPTIONS TYPE { /PAGE, /NOPAGE, /WIDTH:n }
Sets the paging default for TYPE commands, which can be overridden in any particular TYPE command by including the desired switch.

If a TYPE command is given with no switch, and no SET OPTIONS TYPE selection is in effect, paging is according to your COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING setting (SHOW COMMAND).


1.16. The RESET Command

The RESET command, added in 7.0, closes all open files and logs, but does not affect the open connection (if any).


1.17. The COPY and RENAME Commands

As of C-Kermit 7.0, in the UNIX version only, the COPY and RENAME commands are built in and do not call the underlying platform's COPY or RENAME command. This allows them to work in "NOPUSH" versions and other circumstances where it can't access system commands, and it allows file copying and renaming to be done portably in scripts. The characteristics of the built-in COPY or RENAME include:

These commands now also accept the following switches:

  /LIST (/LOG, /VERBOSE)    = Print "file1 => file2 (OK)" (or error message).
  /NOLIST (/NOLOG, /QUIET)  = Don't print anything (except error messages).

/NOLIST is the default.

The same built-in code is used by the UNIX C-Kermit server to execute REMOTE COPY commands (except in this case no switches are available).

The COPY command also accepts the following additional switches. When any of these are given (and they can be used in any combination except /SWAP and /APPEND), some of the checks listed above are relaxed, and thus it might be possible to get into trouble in certain cases, e.g. when the source and target files are the same file:

  /APPEND                   = Append source file to destination file.
  /SWAP-BYTES               = Swap bytes (see Section 6.6.5).
  /FROMB64                  = Decode the source file from Base64 encoding.
  /TOB64                    = Encode the target file in Base64.

Base64 is the encoding commonly used for enclosures in Internet email.


1.18. The MANUAL Command

The MANUAL command can be used to access the appropriate Kermit manual or other manual. The general syntax is:

MANUAL [ string ]
If the string is omitted, C-Kermit asks the underlying system to access the C-Kermit manual using whatever method is appropriate for the system.

The specific action depends on the system. In UNIX, a "man" command is issued; "kermit" is the default argument but other manual topics may be specified. If the "man" command allows index or string searching, the appropriate syntax may be included.

In Kermit 95, the MANUAL command brings up the HTML online K95 manual.

In VMS and elsewhere, "man" is simply translated to "help", with a default argument of "kermit"; other and/or additional arguments may be included according to the definition of the system's "help" command.

Correct operation of the "man" command in C-Kermit depends on the appropriate man page or help topic having been installed in the right place with the right permissions and format.


1.19. String and Filename Matching Patterns

A pattern is a string that includes special notation for matching classes or sequences of characters. C-Kermit 7.0 / K95 1.1.19 supports patterns in several places:

Patterns are also called wildcards, especially when used for filename matching. C-Kermit's pattern syntax is explained in Section 4.9.1, and also by the HELP WILDCARDS command.


1.20. Multiple Commands on One Line

As of C-Kermit 7.0, commands can be grouped together on one line by separating the commands with commas and enclosing the list in braces. For example:

  C-Kermit> { echo One, echo Two, echo Three }
  C-Kermit> do { echo One, echo Two, echo Three }

Command lists can be nested:

  [ do ] { echo One, echo Two, if true { echo A, echo B}, echo Three }

and the END command works as it does in macros:

  [ do ] { echo One, echo Two, if true end, echo Three }

The "one line" stricture is, of course, pliant to line-continuation conventions, namely that lines ending in hyphen (-) or left brace ({) are to be continued. Thus the first example can also be rendered:

  [ do ] {
      echo One
      echo Two
      echo Three
  }

(the "do" is optional).


1.21. What Do I Have?

C-Kermit can be built for hundreds of different platforms with practically countless configuration options. Certain commands might not be available in certain configurations, etc. Even on the same platform, different builds are possible: "maximum functionality", "minimum size", "maximum performance", and so on. You can find out a lot about the configuration of your C-Kermit program with the SHOW FEATURES command. Of course, a lot of what it says, especially in the bottom part, might seem like gibberish, but can be deciphered with a Rosetta Stone (such as the C-Kermit source or the ckccfg.txt file). In any case, the output from SHOW FEATURES might easily explain why some expected feature is missing, or some buffer is smaller than expected. Here's a sample of the bottom section for the SunOS version:

C-Kermit 7.0.196, 1 Jan 2000

Major optional features included:
 Network support (type SHOW NET for further info)
 Telnet Kermit Option
 Hardware flow control
 External XYZMODEM protocol support
 Latin-1 (West European) character-set translation
 Latin-2 (East European) character-set translation
 Cyrillic (Russian, Ukrainian, etc) character-set translation
 Greek character-set translation
 Hebrew character-set translation
 Japanese character-set translation
 Unicode character-set translation
 Pseudoterminal control
 REDIRECT command
 RESEND command
 Fullscreen file transfer display
 Control-character unprefixing
 Streaming
 Autodownload

Major optional features not included:
 No Kerberos(TM) authentication
 No SRP(TM) (Secure Remote Password) protocol
 No Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) protocol
 No Transport Layer Security (TLS) protocol
 No encryption
 No X Windows forwarding

Host info:
 Machine:    sun4m
 Model:      (unknown)
 OS:         SunOS
 OS Release: 4.1.3_U1
 OS Version: 4

Target: sunos41gsc
GCC version: 2.7.2
Compiled Dec 31 1999 10:38:54, options:
 __GNUC__ __STDC__ _POSIX_JOB_CONTROL _SC_JOB_CONTROL ARRAYREFLEN=1024 BIGBUFOK
 BROWSER BSD4 CK_ANSIC CK_APC CK_AUTODL CK_CURSES CK_DNS_SRV CK_ENVIRONMENT
 CK_FAST CK_LOGIN CK_MKDIR CK_NAWS CK_PCT_BAR CK_PERMS CK_RECALL CK_RTSCTS
 CK_SPEED CK_TIMERS CK_TMPDIR CK_TTGWSIZ CK_TTYFD CK_WREFRESH CKEXEC
 CKFLOAT=double CKGHNLHOST ckmaxfiles=64 CKMAXOPEN=64 CKMAXPATH=1023 CKREALPATH
 CKREGEX CKSYSLOG CKTUNING CMDBL=32763 CMDDEP=64 CONGSPD DCMDBUF DIRENT DYNAMIC
 FNFLOAT FORDEPTH=32 GFTIMER HADDRLIST HDBUUCP IFDEBUG IKS_OPTION IKSDB
 IKSDCONF INBUFSIZE=32768 INPBUFSIZ=4096 MAC_MAX=16384 MACLEVEL=128 MAXDDIR=32
 MAXDNUMS=4095 MAXGETPATH=128 MAXTAKE=54 MAXWLD=102400 MSENDMAX=1024 NETCMD
 NETCONN NETPTY NOKVERBS NOSETBUF OBUFSIZE=32768 PARSENSE PATTERNS PIPESEND
 RENAME RLOGCODE SAVEDUID SELECT SIG_V SOL_SOCKET sparc STREAMING sun SUNOS4
 SYSTIMEH TCPSOCKET TIMEH TLOG TNCODE TTLEBUF TTSPDLIST UIDBUFLEN=256 UNIX
 UNPREFIXZERO USE_LSTAT USE_MEMCPY VNAML=4096 WHATAMI XFRCAN Z_MAXCHAN=46
 z_maxchan=46 ZXREWIND

 byte order: big endian

 sizeofs: int=4 long=4 short=2 char=1 char*=4 float=4 double=8

 floating-point: precision=16 rounding=1

Without going into detail about what all the notation means, notice a couple things:

See the ckccfg.txt file for details.


1.22. Generalized File Input and Output

C-Kermit 7.0 adds a new generalized I/O system for stream files, augmenting (and to some extent, overlapping with) the older OPEN, READ, WRITE, and CLOSE commands. In the new file i/o system, which can be used simultaneously with the old one, all commands are grouped together under the new FILE keyword, and some related functions and variables are added.

1.22.1. Why Another I/O System?

The well-known LOG, OPEN, READ, WRITE, and CLOSE commands have the following restrictions:

  1. Only one READ file and one WRITE file can be open at a time.
  2. The READ and WRITE commands are strictly line oriented.
  3. These commands can not be used with binary files.
  4. They do not support read/write access or random access.
  5. The syntax is a bit counterintuitive for programmers.

The new file i/o system allows multiple files to be open at once, in any desired combination of modes (read/write/append) supported by the operating system, for line, block (record), or character i/o, for sequential or random access, using consistent syntax and conventions.

The new system, however, does not replace the old one, since the old system still must be used for:

  1. The session, packet, debug, transaction, and connection logs.
  2. Reading and writing commands rather than files.
  3. Existing scripts.

The new system works only with regular files, not with commands or pipes or mailboxes or pseudoterminals. No special provisions are made in the FILE commands for handling devices or network connections, nor for preventing you from trying to open them; if the underlying operating system treats them like regular stream disk files, the FILE commands (except, of course SEEK, REWIND, and COUNT) might work with them. (In C programming terms, the FILE commands are, at present, nothing more than a front end to fopen() / fread() / fwrite() / fclose() and friends, which are a portable API to sequential files, but this might change in the future for platforms like VMS and VOS that have more complicated file systems.)

Definitions:

Channel
A number assigned to a file when it is opened, by which it must be referred to in all input/output operations.

Read/Write Pointer
The current position in an open file, expressed as the 0-based byte count from the beginning.


1.22.2. The FILE Command

FILE keyword [ switches ] channel [ data ]
The keyword specifies the function: FILE OPEN, FILE READ, FILE WRITE, FILE CLOSE, etc. For convenience (and for familiarity to C programmers), the two-word FILE commands can be shortened to the single words FOPEN, FREAD, FWRITE, FCLOSE, and so on. Switches are optional, and modify or amplify the requested file function.

As in C, Fortran, and other programming languages, open files are referred to by "channels", integers such as 0, 1, 2, 3, and so on. A channel number is assigned when you open a file. The number of available channels depends on the underlying operating system, and can be seen in the variable:

  \v(f_max)

or by giving the FILE LIST (FLIST) command. Channels are discussed in greater detail in Section 1.22.4.

FILE command errors can be caught with IF FAIL after the FILE command. In addition, the \v(f_error) variable is set to the completion code of the command: 0 if no error, or a negative number if there was an error. The error codes are listed in Section 1.22.5.

The command to open a file is:

FILE OPEN [ switches ] variable filename
Opens a file for the type of access specified by the switches, or for read-only access if no switches are given. Upon success, a channel number is assigned to this file and stored in the given variable so you can refer to the open file in subsequent i/o commands. If the file can not be opened, the FILE OPEN command fails. Synonym: FOPEN.

The FILE OPEN switches are:

/READ
Open the file for read access. If no switches are given, /READ is assumed. If the file does not exist or can't be opened for read access, the FILE OPEN command fails.

/WRITE
Allow writing. If a file of the same name already exists, it is overwritten unless /READ or /APPEND is also included. If a file of the given name does not exist, it is created.

/APPEND
Equivalent to /WRITE, except that if the file exists, it is not destroyed. The read/write pointer is set to the end of the file, so unless you change it with FILE SEEK or REWIND (see below), the first FILE WRITE command adds to the end of the file, preserving what was there already. If /WRITE is also given, it is ignored.

/BINARY
Open the file in "binary" mode, rather than text mode. This switch is meaningless (but still can be used) in UNIX. In VMS, Windows, and OS/2, it inhibits end-of-line processing and conversion, and so should be used for binary files and/or files that are to be accessed in record or character mode rather than line by line.

The variable for the channel number can be any kind of variable: the \%x kind, a macro name, or an array element. But it must be a variable, not a number -- C-Kermit assigns the channel number; you can't tell it what number to use.

Example:

  FILE OPEN \%c oofa.txt                  ; Open oofa.txt for reading.
  IF FAIL exit 1 Can't open oofa.txt      ; Always check to see if it worked.
  ECHO oofa.txt: channel = \%c

If the file oofa.txt is opened successfully, a channel number is assigned to the variable \%c. Here's another example using a macro name for the channel number:

  FILE OPEN channel oofa.txt              ; Open oofa.txt for reading.
  IF SUCCESS ECHO oofa.txt: channel = \m(channel)

Switches can be combined when it makes sense and the underlying operating system allows it. For example, to open a file in binary mode for reading and writing (sometimes called "update"):

  FILE OPEN /READ /WRITE /BINARY \%c budget.db

Some combinations might be allowed, others not. For example /READ /APPEND will usually not be allowed. /WRITE /APPEND is treated as /APPEND.

A major advantage of the new system over the older one is that you can have multiple files open at once. Suppose, for example, that you want to open all the files in a certain directory at once:

  .\%n := \ffiles(/usr/olga*,&f)          ; Get file list into array.
  if ( > \%n \v(f_max) ) {                ; Make sure there aren't too many.
      exit 1 {\v(dir): \%n = Too many files}
  }
  declare \&c[\%n]                        ; Make array for channel numbers.
  for \%i 1 \%n 1 {                       ; Loop to open every file...
      file open \&c[\%i] \&f[\%i]         ; Try to open this one
      if fail exit 1 Open error: \&f[\%i] ; Check for failure
  }

If this loop completes successfully, the \&c[] array will contain \%n channel numbers of open files in elements 1 through \%n.

Any file that you open with FILE OPEN stays open until Kermit exits, or you close it explicitly. The command to close a file is:

FILE CLOSE { ALL, channel }
If a channel number is given and the channel refers to an open file, the file is closed and the channel is freed for reuse; if the channel does not refer to an open file, an error message is printed and the command fails. If ALL is specified instead of a specific channel, all files opened with FILE OPEN are closed and if all open files were closed successfully (even if no files were open), the command succeeds; if any open file could not be closed, the command fails; however, all open files that could be closed are still closed. Synonym: FCLOSE.

FILE CLOSE might fail because, for example, the disk filled up or a quota was exceeded. Example:

  fopen /write \%c new.txt                ; Open new.txt for writing.
  if fail exit 1                          ; Check for error.
  fclose \%c                              ; Close the file we just opened.

This creates a 0-length file called new.txt.

Note that FILE OPEN /WRITE (without /READ or /APPEND) always creates a new file, and therefore destroys any file with the same name that might already exist (assuming you have permission to delete it). To avoid overwriting existing files, simply check first:

  if exist new.txt exit 1 {Fatal - new.txt already exists}
  fopen /write \%c new.txt
  if fail ...

The next two commands give information about open files:

FILE STATUS channel
Tells the name of the file, if any, open on the given channel and the switches it was opened with. The read/write pointer is also shown; this is where the next read or write will occur; "[EOF]" is shown if the current position in the open file is the end -- i.e. the next read will fail if the file was opened in /READ mode; the next write will add material to the end. The current line number (0-based) is also shown if known. The FILE STATUS command succeeds if the channel is open, and fails if there is no open file on the given channel, or if the channel number is invalid or out of range. Synonym: FSTATUS.

FILE LIST
Lists the channel number and name of each open file, along with its OPEN modes (R, W, A, B, RW, etc) and its current read/write pointer or "[EOF]" if it is at the end. Also tells the number of files currently opened with FILE OPEN, plus the maximum number of open files allowed by the system and the maximum number allowed for FILE OPEN. Synonym: FLIST.

Next come the commands for reading and writing files:

FILE READ [ switches ] channel [ variable ]
Reads data from the file on the given channel number into the variable, if one was given; if no variable was given, the result is printed on the screen. IMPORTANT: The variable should normally be a macro name rather than a \%x or \&x[] variable if you want backslash characters in the file to be taken literally (see pp.408-412 of Using C-Kermit for an explanation; you can also read into a \%x or \&x[] variable, but then you must remember to protect future references to by \fcontents() if you don't want C-Kermit to process any backslashes it might contain). The desired amount of data (according to the switches) is read from the file at the current read/write pointer, and upon completion the read/write position is updated to first byte after the data that was read, no matter what switches were given. Synonym: FREAD.

FILE WRITE [ switches ] channel text
Writes the given text to the file on the given channel number. The text, of course, can be literal text or a variable, or any combination. If the text might contain leading or trailing spaces, it must be enclosed in braces if you want to preserve them. Synonym: FWRITE.

Before proceeding, a caution about the NUL character. C-Kermit is so named because it is a Kermit program written in the C language. In C, character strings are represented as a sequence of non-NUL bytes terminated by a NUL byte (a byte in which all bits are 0). Thus a C string can not contain NUL bytes; it always ends with the first NUL byte. C-Kermit variables are implemented as C strings and therefore can't contain NUL bytes either, so the FILE READ and FILE WRITE commands do not handle files or strings that contain NUL bytes, except when the /CHARACTER switch is included with the FILE READ or WRITE command, or when /LPAD:0 or /RPAD:0 is given with the FILE WRITE command; these switches are explained below.

Also note that Kermit can not be used read or write binary numbers in the machine's internal format (integer or floating-point); in general, numbers can be processed only when represented as numeric or floating-point strings.

FILE READ switches are:

/LINE
Specifies that a line of text is to be read. A line is defined according to the underlying operating system's text-file format. For example, in UNIX a line is a sequence of characters up to and including a linefeed, or the end of the file, which ever comes first. The line terminator (if any) is removed before assigning the text to the variable. If no switches are included with the FILE READ command, /LINE is assumed. Normally this switch should not be used with files opened in /BINARY mode (but nothing prevents it either).

/SIZE:number
Specifies that the given number of bytes (characters) is to be read. The actual number of bytes returned will be less if the end of file is reached (or a NUL byte is encountered). For example, if a file is 514 bytes long, FILE READ /SIZE:512 returns 512 bytes the first time and 2 bytes the second time. FILE READ /SIZE provides a kind of "record i/o" for files that do not necessarily contain lines. The resulting block of characters is assigned to the variable without any editing. Synonym: /BLOCK.

/CHARACTER
Equivalent to /SIZE:1. If FILE READ /CHAR succeeds but the variable is empty, this indicates a NUL byte was read. Synonym: BYTE.

FILE WRITE switches are:

/LINE
Specifies that an appropriate line terminator is to be added to the end of the text. If no switches are included, /LINE is assumed.

/SIZE:number
Specifies that the given number of bytes (characters) is to be written. If the given text is longer than the requested size, it is truncated; if is shorter, it is padded according /LPAD and /RPAD switches. Synonym: /BLOCK.

/LPAD[:value]
If /SIZE was given, but the text is shorter than the requested size, the text is padded on the left with sufficient copies of the character whose ASCII value is given to write the given length. If no value is specified, 32 (the code for Space) is used. The value can also be 0 to write the indicated number of NUL bytes. If /SIZE was not given, this switch is ignored.

/RPAD[:value]
Like LPAD, but pads on the right.

/CHARACTER
Specifies that one character should be written. If the text is empty or not given, a NUL character is written; otherwise the first character of text is given. Synonym: /BYTE.

/STRING
Specifies that the text is to be written as-is, with no terminator added.

Here's an example in which we copy a text file line by line:

  file open /read \%c oofa.txt            ; Open input file
  if fail exit 1 Can't open input file    ; Check that it's open
  file open /write \%d new.txt            ; Open output file
  if fail exit 1 Can't open output file   ; Check
  while true {                            ; Loop to copy lines
      file read /line \%c line            ; Read a line
      if fail break                       ; Assume failure = end of file
      file write /line \%d {\m(line)}     ; Write the line to output file
      if fail exit 1 Write failure        ; Failure here is fatal
  }
  file close \%c                          ; Close the two files
  file close \%d

Note that since /LINE is the default for both FILE READ and FILE WRITE, it can be omitted as in the following example, where we also use the short names for the FILE commands.

  fopen /read \%c oofa.txt                ; Open input file
  if fail exit 1 Can't open input file    ; Check that it's open
  fopen /write \%d new.txt                ; Open output file
  if fail exit 1 Can't open output file   ; Check
  while true {                            ; Loop to copy lines
      fread \%c line                      ; Read a line
      if fail break                       ; Assume failure = end of file
      fwrite \%d {\m(line)}               ; Write the line to output file
      if fail exit 1 Write failure        ; Failure here is fatal
  }
  fclose \%c                              ; Close the two files
  fclose \%d

Here's the same example using "record i/o" (the open and close sequences are are omitted since they are the same as above). The result is the same, but execution is much faster:

  while true {                            ; Loop to copy blocks
      fread /size:512 \%c block           ; Read a block into \%a
      if fail break                       ; Assume failure = end of file
      fwrite /string \%d {\m(block)}      ; Write the block to output file
      if fail exit 1 Write failure        ; Failure here is fatal
  }

Although record i/o is faster, it should not be used in line-oriented applications, since it returns arbitrary chunks of the file to your script, rather than lines. In this example, FWRITE /STRING is used rather than FWRITE /SIZE:512 to avoid the last output block being padded beyond the original file's length.

A file can also be copied character by character, but this is much slower than line i/o and VERY much slower than block i/o:

  while true {                            ; Loop to copy blocks
      fread /char \%c c                   ; Read a character into c
      if fail break                       ; Assume failure = end of file
      fwrite /char \%d {\m(c)}            ; Write character to output file
      if fail exit 1 Write failure        ; Failure is fatal
  }

Although character i/o is slow, it is the only way to process files that contain NUL characters (i.e. bytes composed of only zero bits). In the example above, when "fread /char \%c c" returns a NUL, the c variable is empty. But since the FREAD /CHAR command did not fail, we know the result was really a NUL. FWRITE /CHAR, when given an empty variable (or no variable at all) writes a NUL. Thus the loop above will copy any file at all (very slowly). In non-copying applications, NULs are detected like this:

  fread /char \%c c
  if fail (do something)
  if not def c (a NUL byte was read)

Finally some advanced file operations:

FILE FLUSH channel
For output files only: commits all previous writes to disk, in case the computer was buffering them. Synonym: FFLUSH.

FILE COUNT [ { /BYTES, /LINES, /LIST, /NOLIST } ] channel
By default, or if the /BYTES switch is given, counts the bytes in the file, if any, open on the given channel. If the /LINES switch is given, counts lines in the file. If the /LIST switch is given, the result is printed. If the /NOLIST switch is given, the result is not printed. /QUIET is a synonym for /NOLIST. If neither /LIST nor /NOLIST is given, the result is printed if the command is given at top level, i.e. not from a command file or macro. In all cases, the result of the most recent FILE COUNT command is stored in the variable \v(f_count). Note that FILE COUNT /LINE works (and can only work) by reading the entire file; expect it to take some time if the file is large. Synonym: FCOUNT.

FILE REWIND channel
Moves the read/write pointer to the beginning of the file. Equivalent to FILE SEEK channel 0. Synonym: FREWIND.

FILE SEEK [ switches ] channel { [{+,-}]number, LAST, EOF }
Moves the read/write pointer for the file on this channel to the given position, which may be a byte (character) number or a line number, expressed in either absolute or relative terms. Switches:

/BYTE
The number given is a byte number. Synonym: /CHARACTER.
/LINE
The number given is a line number.
/ABSOLUTE
The number given is absolute.
/RELATIVE
The number given is relative to the current position.

By default, or if the /BYTE switch is given, the number is a byte number (0 = first byte). If /LINE is given, the number is a line number (0 = first line). EOF means to move to the end of the file. LAST means to move to the last line or character of the file, depending on whether it's a line or character seek.

If neither the /RELATIVE nor the /ABSOLUTE switch is given, then if a signed number is given, the motion is relative to the current position. An expression that evaluates to a negative number is not considered signed for this purpose; that is, a sign (+ or -) must be included as the first character of the number in the command itself to force a relative seek (in the absence of /RELATIVE or /ABSOLUTE).

If the number has no sign, or if the /ABSOLUTE switch is given, the number represents an absolute position (relative to the beginning of the file). Subsequent FILE READs or WRITEs will take place at the new position.

If the read/write pointer is placed after the end of the file, a subsequent FILE READ will fail, but a FILE WRITE will succeed (possibly creating a file with "holes"). If a FILE SEEK /BYTE command is given, the current line becomes unknown (unless the position is 0) and subsequent FILE SEEK /RELATIVE /LINE commands will fail until the next non-relative FILE SEEK /LINE command is given. Synonym: FSEEK.

An absolute FILE SEEK to a negative position fails silently, as does a relative seek to a position before the beginning of the file.

A caution about relative SEEKs: remember that the number is relative to the current position. Whenever you read or write, this changes the position. In each of the following examples, assume the file open on channel \%c is positioned at line n (the FREAD target variable is omitted for lack of space):

  { FREAD \%c, FSEEK /LINE \%c -1, FREAD \%c }  <-- Reads line n twice
  { FREAD \%c, FSEEK /LINE \%c +0, FREAD \%c }  <-- Reads lines n and n+1
  { FREAD \%c, FSEEK /LINE \%c +1, FREAD \%c }  <-- Reads lines n and n+2
  { FREAD \%c, FSEEK /LINE \%c -2, FREAD \%c }  <-- Reads lines n and n-1
  { FREAD \%c, FSEEK /LINE \%c -3, FREAD \%c }  <-- Reads lines n and n-2

Another caution: Using FSEEK and FREAD /SIZE to repeatedly read the same disk block (e.g. when sampling a database record that is frequently updated) might not give you updated disk blocks due to the internal buffering and caching of the C library (this probably varies from one platform/compiler combination to another). If necessary you can force a fresh disk read with a close/open sequence:

  FCLOS \%c
  FOPEN \%c samefilename
  FSEEK \%c samespot
  FREAD /SIZE:howmanybytes \%c variable


1.22.3. FILE Command Examples

To read the last 10 lines of a text file into an array:

  fopen /read \%c oofa.txt                ; Open the file
  if fail exit 1 Can't open oofa.txt      ; Always check for failure
  dcl \&a[10]                             ; Declare a 10-element array
  fcount /line \%c                        ; Count lines in the file
  fseek /line \%c \v(f_count)-10          ; Seek to 10 lines from the end
  if fail exit 1 Can't seek               ; Check for failure
  for \%i 1 10 1 { fread \%c \&a[\%i] }   ; Read the last 10 lines
  fclose \%c                              ; Close the file

Note that blank lines show up as empty (undefined) array elements, for example if you give a "show array a" command at this point. This is normal. You can still use these elements; e.g.:

  for \%i 1 10 1 { echo \%i. \&a[\%i] }   ; Display the 10 lines

Here is how to read the last line of a file (already open on channel \%c):

  fseek /line \%c last                    ; Seek directly to last line

Alternatively:

  fseek /line \%c eof                     ; Seek to end of file
  fseek /line \%c -1                      ; Seek to beginning of last line

Alternatively:

  fcount /line \%c                        ; Count the file's lines
  fseek /line \%c \v(f_count)-1           ; Seek to last line
  fread \%c                               ; Read it

To read every other line from the file (using relative SEEK), skipping the first line:

  fopen /read \%c oofa.txt                ; Open the file
  while ( success ) {                     ; Loop through lines
      fseek /line \%c +1                  ; Skip a line
      if success fread \%c                ; Read & display a line
  }
  fclose \%c                              ; Close the file

Here is how to read the lines of a file in reverse order:

  fopen /read \%c oofa.txt                ; Open
  if fail exit 1                          ; Check
  fseek /line \%c last                    ; Seek to last line
  while success {                         ; Loop
      fread \%c                           ; Read line
      fseek /line \%c -2                  ; Seek backwards two lines
  }
  fclose \%c                              ; Close the file

The loop works because a relative SEEK outside the file fails.

It is also possible to use block i/o to manage random-access files with fixed-length records (as long as they don't contain NUL characters). Suppose, for example, you have a file of "card image" records with fixed-field information about customers, such as:

  Name:     Columns  1-32  (column numbers are 1-based)
  Address:  Columns 33-72
  Balance:  Columns 73-80

The records are indexed by customer number, starting with 0. There are no line terminators separating them. Therefore the record for customer number n starts at position nx 80 (\%n*80).

Now suppose we received a payment from customer number 173 and want to update the balance:

  .\%n = 173                               ; Customer (record) number
  .\%a = 12.72                             ; Amount
  fopen /read /write \%c customer.db       ; Open the file
  if fail stop 1 OPEN FAILED: \f_errmsg()  ; Check
  fseek /byte \%c 80*\%n                   ; Seek to record
  fread /size:80 \%c r                     ; Read the record
  if fail stop 1 READ FAILED: \f_errmsg()  ; Check (IMPORTANT)
  .\%b := \fright(\m(r),8)                 ; Extract the balance
  .\%b := \ffpadd(\%b,\%a,2)               ; Add the new payment
  if fail stop 1 ARITHMETIC ERROR: \%b/\%a ; Catch bad records
  .r := {\fleft(\m(r),72)\flpad(\%b,8)}    ; Update the record
  fseek /byte \%c 80*\%n                   ; Reposition to same spot
  fwrite /size:80 \%c {\m(r)}              ; Replace the record
  if fail stop 1 WRITE FAILED: \f_errmsg() ; Check
  fclose \%c                               ; Close the file

REMEMBER: Using FILE SEEK to move beyond the end of file can result in a file with holes when writing; when reading, an end-of-file error will occur -- be sure to check for it.


1.22.4. Channel Numbers

C-Kermit's channel numbers are integers from 0 to some platform-dependent limit, such as 46 or 1985 (the value of \v(f_max)). This is the limit placed by the operating system on the number of files that may be opened by one process or user or job, minus the standard input, output, and error files, and minus the number of files reserved by C-Kermit for logs, OPEN READ and WRITE, and file transfer (and maybe some command files -- the \v(f_max) number can't be exact).

Although you must include a variable in the FILE OPEN command, to which the channel number is assigned, you don't have to use a variable in the other FILE commands if you know what the number is -- you can just put the number. This saves you a few keystrokes when typing commands at the prompt:

  fopen \%c oofa.txt
  flist
  0. /usr/olga.oofa.txt (R) 0

This tells the channel number is 0 (the number on the left is the channel file's channel number). Of course you can also find it by echoing the variable:

  echo \%c
  0

Or with "fstatus \%c". Now you can type commands like:

  fread 0

to read a line from the file. Obviously, however, using digits rather than a variable for the channel number would be poor practice in a script.

If in commands like:

  fread \%c \%a

you have trouble remembering which variable is which, note that the channel number is, indeed, a number. Anywhere C-Kermit accepts a number it can also accept an expression, so you can put parentheses around the channel number to remind you it's the channel number and not the variable into which data is to be read:

  fread (\%c) \%a

Normally channel numbers are assigned sequentially as 0, 1, 2, ... up to the limit. However, once you start closing files, there can be holes in the sequence. New channels are assigned to fill in the holes. Thus you can't depend on channel numbers being in any particular sequence.


1.22.5. FILE Command Errors

Each FILE command sets the variable \v(f_error) to one of the following values:

    0 = No error
   -1 = System error
   -2 = Attempt to read after end of file
   -3 = Channel not open
   -4 = Channel number out of range (negative or too large)
   -5 = Numeric argument (size, ...) out of range
   -6 = File not found
   -7 = Bad or missing filename
   -8 = Too many files are already open (FILE OPEN only)
   -9 = Forbidden operation (e.g. write to a read-only file)
  -10 = Access denied
  -11 = Illegal combination of OPEN modes (FILE OPEN only)
  -12 = Buffer overflow
  -13 = Current line number unknown (for relative line seeks)
  -14 through -98: Reserved.
  -99 = Requested operation not implemented in this version of C-Kermit
 -999 = Unknown error

When \v(f_error) is -1, this means the FILE command failed because because of a system error, in which case you can examine the following variables:

  \v(errno)     = System error number.
  \v(errstring) = Error message corresponding to \v(errno).

A special function is available for translating the \v(f_error) code to an error message string:

\f_errmsg([code])
  If the code is -1, returns error message of the most recent system
  error; otherwise if the code is a valid \v(f_error) value, the associated
  message is returned.  If the code is omitted, the status message
  corresponding to the current \v(f_error) value is returned.

A FILE command that fails prints the appropriate error message automatically, except when the command is READ or SEEK and the error is -2 (end of file); in that case, the command still fails, but does not print a message. This allows constructions such as:

  fopen \%c oofa.txt
  while success { fread \%c }
  fclose \%c

to work as expected, i.e. without an annoying message when the end of file is reached.


1.22.6. File I/O Variables

The variables associated with the file i/o package are:

\v(f_count)
Result of the most recent FILE COUNT (FCOUNT) command.

\v(f_error)
Numeric error code of most recent FILE command (0 = no error).

\v(f_max)
Maximum number of files open simultaneously.


1.22.7. File I/O Functions

Some of the FILE commands can also be issued as function calls, which makes script writing a bit more convenient, especially for C programmers. Also, several functions are provided that do not have command equivalents. Each of these functions takes a channel number as the first argument. These functions do not work for OPEN { READ, !READ, WRITE, !WRITE, and APPEND } files.

\f_status(channel)
Returns 0 if the channel is not open, otherwise a number between 1 and 15 which is the sum of the OPEN modes:

  1 = /READ
  2 = /WRITE
  4 = /APPEND
  8 = /BINARY

The remaining functions work only for open channels. Each of these functions can fail for the applicable reasons listed in Section 1.22.5. For instructions on handling function errors, see Section 7.12.

\f_pos(channel)
Returns the file's current read/write pointer (0-based). There is no FILE command equivalent.

\f_line(channel)
Returns the file's current line number (0-based), if known, otherwise -1. There is no FILE command equivalent. The line number is known as long as no character or block i/o has been done on the channel.

\f_handle(channel)
Returns the "file handle" of the file. That is, it translates the portable C-Kermit channel number into a system-specific file handle or number that can be passed to other programs on the same platform. In UNIX this is a file descriptor. There is no FILE command equivalent.

\f_eof(channel)
Returns 1 if the read/write pointer of the file on the given channel is at the end of the file, 0 otherwise. Convenient in WHILE statements, e.g.:

    while not \f_eof(\%c) { fread \%c }

\f_getchar(channel)
Equivalent to FREAD /CHAR. Returns the character actually read. If \f_getchar() does not fail but the return value is empty, this means a NULL character was read.

\f_getline(channel)
Equivalent to FREAD /LINE. Returns the line actually read, but with the line terminator stripped. If \f_getline() does not fail but the return value is empty, this normally means an empty line was read.

\f_getblock(channel,n)
Equivalent to FREAD /SIZE:n. Returns the block of characters actually read. If the returned block is smaller than n, it indicates either that the end of file was reached or a NUL character is in the block.

\f_putchar(channel,c)
Equivalent to FWRITE /CHARACTER. Writes the character c. If c contains more than one character, only the first is written. If c is empty a NUL is written. Returns the number of characters written on success, or a negative error code upon failure.

\f_putline(channel,string)
Equivalent to FWRITE /LINE. Writes the string and adds the appropriate line termination character or sequence. If the string is empty or omitted, an empty line is written. Returns the number of characters written on success, or a negative error code upon failure.

\f_putblock(channel,string)
Equivalent to FWRITE /STRING. Writes the string as given. If the string is empty or omitted, nothing is written. Returns the number of characters written on success, or a negative error code upon failure.


1.22.8. File I/O Function Examples

  fopen /read \%c oofa.txt            ; Open our favorite file for reading
  if failure exit 1                   ; Check that it's open
  while not \f_eof(\%c) {             ; Loop until EOF
      .line := \f_getline(\%c)        ; Get a line
      if success echo {\m(line)}      ; Echo it
  }
  if not \f_eof(\%c) {                ; Check reason for loop exit
      exit 1 File Error: \f_errmsg()  ; If not EOF say so.
  }

  frewind \%c                         ; Rewind the file
  while not \f_eof(\%c) {             ; Same thing but with block i/o
      .block := \f_getblock(\%c,256)  ; (much faster than line i/o)
      if success xecho {\m(block)}
  }

  frewind \%c                         ; Rewind again
  while not \f_eof(\%c) {             ; Same deal but with character i/o
      .c := \f_getchar(\%c)           ; (much slower than line i/o)
      if success xecho {\m(c)}
  }
  close \%c

To close all open files (equivalent to FCLOSE ALL):

  for \%i 0 \v(f_max)-1 1 {
      if \f_status(\%i) fclose \%i
  }


1.23. The EXEC Command

The EXEC command is available only in UNIX.

EXEC [ /REDIRECT ] command [ arg1 [ arg2 [ ... ] ]
Runs the given command with the arguments in such a way that the command replaces C-Kermit in memory, and C-Kermit ceases to execute. EXEC is like RUN, except instead of returning to C-Kermit when finished, the command returns to whatever process invoked Kermit.

In the normal case, no files are closed, so the EXEC'd command inherits the open files, read/write pointers, working directory, process ID, user ID (unless command is SUID), group ID (unless command is SGID), groups, etc. (In UNIX, the EXEC command is simply a front end for execvp().)

If the /REDIRECT switch is included, then if a connection is open (SET LINE or SET HOST), it becomes the standard input and output of the EXEC'd program. If no connection is open, the /REDIRECT switch has no effect. For example to use C-Kermit for PPP dialing in Linux:

  set modem type usr          ; Specify the kind of modem you have
  set line /dev/ttyS1         ; Specify the device it's connected to
  set speed 57600             ; and the speed
  set flow rts/cts            ; and flow control.
  set dial retries 100        ; Try the dial sequence up to 100 times.
  dial {{9-212-555-1212}{9-212-555-1213}{9-212-555-1214}{9-212-555-1215}}
  if fail exit 1
  for \%i 1 16 1 {            ; Try up to 16 times to get login prompt
      input 10 Login:         ; Wait 10 sec for it to appear
      if success break        ; Got it - proceed...
      output \13              ; Send a carriage return and try again
  }
  if ( > \%i 16 ) stop 1 NO LOGIN PROMPT
  lineout \(myuserid)         ; Send user ID
  input 30 assword:           ; Wait for Password prompt
  if fail stop 1 NO PASSWORD PROMPT
  lineout \m(mypassword)      ; Send the password.
  exec /redirect pppd         ; Replace ourselves with pppd.

In this example we assume that the script has already set up the myuserid and mypassword variables -- normally the password should be prompted for, rather than stored on disk. Notice the advantages over the well-known "chat script":

NOTE: PPP and SLIP dialing are not available in Windows 95/98/NT/2000, whose APIs do not provide a method for an application to hand over a connection to the PPP or SLIP driver.


1.24. Getting Keyword Lists with '?'

Suppose you type "te" at the C-Kermit> 6.0 prompt and then Esc or Tab to request keyword completion. Kermit beeps, indicating that more than one command starts with "te". But if you type '?' to see what they are, Kermit shows only "telnet". So why the beep? Because of invisible keywords like "telopt", "terminal", and "text". Lots of keywords are invisible because they are either synonyms for other keywords or else esoteric options to be used only in special circumstances, so we don't want them cluttering up the menus.

But then there is no way for you to discover them. So in C-Kermit 7.0, if you type '?' AFTER the beginning of a keyword field, then invisible keywords are shown too:

  C-Kermit> te<Esc><BEEP>
  C-Kermit> te? Command, one of the following:
   telnet    telopt    terminal  text
  C-Kermit>te

But if '?' is typed at the beginning of a field, only visible keywords are shown, as before (so, in this example, if '?' is typed at the C-Kermit> prompt, "telnet" is the only command shown that starts with "te").


2. MAKING AND USING CONNECTIONS

The SET LINE, SET HOST, and SET PORT (a synonym for SET LINE) commands have new synonyms, in which the word SET is replaced by the word OPEN: OPEN LINE, etc. There is no new functionality here, but OPEN is a better verb, since SET generally takes no action, whereas these commands actually try to open a connection. Furthermore, there is the symmetry with CLOSE.


2.0. SET LINE and SET HOST Command Switches

The SET LINE (SET PORT) and SET HOST commands now allow switches before the device or host name, in most cases, and under certain circumstances, also at the end. The new syntax is backwards compatible with the previous syntax; thus SET LINE, SET PORT, and SET HOST commands in command files written for C-Kermit 6.0 or earlier still work. The expanded syntax is:

{ OPEN, SET } { LINE, PORT, HOST } [ switches ] device-or-address [ switches ]

The first group of switches is:

/NETWORK-TYPE:{TCP/IP,X.25,PIPE,PTY...}
When more than one network type is available, this lets you specify the type of network to use for this connection without affecting your global SET NETWORK TYPE. See Section 2.7 about pipes and ptys.

/USERID:[string]
This switch is equivalent to SET LOGIN USERID. If a string is given, it sent to host during Telnet negotiations; if this switch is given but the string is omitted, no user ID is sent to the host. If this switch is not given, your current LOGIN USERID (\v(userid) value), if any, is sent. Unlike most other switches, this one is "sticky", since the value must persist throughout the session in case the server requests the ID string at a later time.

/CONNECT
Enter CONNECT mode immediately and automatically after the device or connection is open. On serial devices, however, when CARRIER-WATCH is not OFF, wait up to 1 second for the Carrier Detect signal to appear before trying to connect, to give the device time to react DTR, which might have been off prior to opening the device.

/SERVER
Enter server mode immediately and automatically after the device or connection is open. Treatment of carrier is the same as for /CONNECT.

/WAIT
/NOWAIT
For Telnet connections only: Like SET TELNET WAIT { ON, OFF }, but applies only to this connection, and in fact applies only when OPENing this connection (which is usually the only place it matters). Typically you would use TELNET /NOWAIT to make a connection to a misbehaving Telnet server that does not reply to negotiations as required by the Telnet protocol definition.

Note: /CONNECT and /SERVER switches are not available in the RLOGIN and TELNET commands, since these commands already include an implicit /CONNECT and preclude automatic entry into server mode.

The /CONNECT and /SERVER switches are especially useful with "set host *" connections. For example, suppose you want to start a Kermit server on socket 3000 of your TCP host. Normally you would have to give the command:

  set host * 3000

and then wait for a connection to come in, and only then could you give the SERVER command (or else define a macro to do this, and then execute the macro). Now you can do it in one step:

  set host /server * 3000

This tells C-Kermit to wait for the connection and then enter server mode once it comes in, no matter how long it takes. Similarly, "set host /conn *" can be used to wait for a "chat" connection to come in.

Another set of switches is available in VMS only, for use only with SET LINE:

/SHARE
Allows the SET LINE device to be opened in shared mode. Normally it makes no sense to open a serial device in shared mode, but it's necessary when C-Kermit is running in an environment such as DECIntact, that opens your job's controlling terminal in such a way that C-Kermit can't open it too, unless it enables SHARE privilege. Note: SHARE privilege is required.

/NOSHARE
Requires that the SET LINE device not be in use by any other process in order for it to be successfully opened by C-Kermit. If neither /SHARE nor /NOSHARE is specified, /NOSHARE is used.

The second group of switches is:

/NO-TELNET-INIT
Do not send initial Telnet negotiations even if this is a Telnet port.

/RAW-SOCKET
This is a connection to a raw TCP socket (Section 2.3.5).

/RLOGIN
Use Rlogin protocol even if this is not an Rlogin port.

/TELNET
Send initial Telnet negotiations even if this is not a Telnet port.

As of C-Kermit 7.0 and K95 1.1.19, the TELNET command includes an implicit /TELNET switch. So if you TELNET to a non-TELNET port, Kermit sends initial Telnet negotiations. This makes sense, since that's what "telnet" means.

If you want to make a connection to a non-Telnet port without sending initial Telnet negotiations, use:

  set host [ /connect ] name-or-address port

or:

  telnet name-or-address port /no-telnet-init

Additional switches might be added in the future; type "set host ?" or "set line ?" to see a current list.


2.1. Dialing

Automatic redialing is illegal or restricted in many countries, so until C-Kermit 7.0, it was disabled by default, i.e. until a SET DIAL RETRIES command was given. In C-Kermit 7.0, if no SET DIAL RETRIES command has been given, a default is picked dynamically at DIAL time based on the calling country code, if known. At this writing, the only country code known to have no restrictions on automatic redialing is 1. So in this case a limit of 10 is chosen; otherwise 1. If you have not given an explicit SET DIAL RETRIES command, SHOW DIAL shows the value as "(auto)", and then the value actually used is shown when you give the DIAL command.

As of C-Kermit 7.0, automatic redialing is automatically canceled if the call could not be placed because no dialtone was detected.


2.1.1. The Dial Result Message

If DIAL DISPLAY is not ON, the "Call complete" message now shows the modem's call result message, for example:

  Dialing: ...
  Call complete: "CONNECT 31200/ARQ/V32/LAPM/V42BIS"

The exact format and contents of this message, of course, depends on the make, model, and configuration of your modem, so use your modem manual to interpret it. The call result message is also available in C-Kermit's \v(dialresult) variable.

  C-Kermit> echo \v(dialresult)
  CONNECT 31200/ARQ/V32/LAPM/V42BIS
  C-Kermit> echo Speed = \fword(\v(dialresult),2)
  Speed = 31200
  C-Kermit>

Suppose your modem reports the modulation speed as shown above and you want to ensure your call is completed at (say) 24000 bps or more. You can use a little macro to do the job:

define HSDIAL {                ; High Speed DIAL
    local \%s
    if < \v(argc) 1 if not def \v(dialnumber) end 1 Usage: \%0 number
    set dial retries 100
    set dial interval 1
    while true {
	dial \%*
	if fail end 1 DIAL failed.
	asg \%s \fword(\v(dialresult),2)
	if def \%s if numeric \%s if not < \%s 24000 break
    }
}

(See Section 7.5 about the \%* variable.)


2.1.2. Long-Distance Dialing Changes

Due to the glut of cell phones, pagers, fax machines, ISPs, etc, area codes and dialing rules are changing all the time. In the North American Numbering Plan (NANP) countries (USA, Canada, etc), area codes are split or overlayed with increasing frequency, and 10- and 11-digit dialing is gradually becoming the norm for local calls. Changes are occurring In Europe, too, partly for these reasons and partly because of some new EC rules.

In France, effective 18 October 1996, all calls, even local ones, must be dialed with an area code. French area codes are presently 1-digit numbers, 1-6, and the long-distance dialing prefix is 0. All calls within France are considered long distance and begin with 01, 02, ..., 06.

Effective 1 May 1997, all calls within the US state of Maryland, even local ones, must be dialed with an area code but without the long-distance prefix -- this is the now widely-known North American phenomenon of "ten digit dialing". The same is happening elsewhere -- many cities in Florida adopted 10-digit dialing in 1998.

In Italy beginning 19 June 1998, all calls to fixed (as opposed to mobile) numbers must be prefixed by 0. When calling into Italy from outside, the 0 must follow the country code (39). Calls to cell phones, however, must be placed without the 0. Then on 29 December 2000, the 0 will become a 4 (for calling fixed numbers) and a prefix of 3 must used for calling mobile phones. More info at: http://www.telecomitalia.it/npnn/.

In Spain, effective 4 April 1998, with hard cutover on 18 July 1998, all calls within the country must be dialed with 9 digits, and all calls from outside Spain must also be dialed with 9 digits (after the country code, 34). The new 9-digit numbers all begin with "9". More info at: http://www.telefonica.es/cambiodenumeracion/

Several new dialing features and commands have been added in version 6.1 and 7.0 to address these changes.

C-Kermit 6.0 and Kermit 95 1.1.11 and earlier handle the French situation via a reasonable subterfuge (setting the local area code to a nonexistent one), but did not handle "ten-digit dialing" well at all; the recommended technique was to change the long-distance dialing prefix to nothing, but this defeated Kermit's "list numbers for one name" feature when the numbers were in different locations. For example:

  set dial ld-prefix
  dial onlineservice

where "onlineservice" is a dialing directory entry name corresponding to entries that are in (say) Maryland as well as other states, would not correctly dial the numbers not in Maryland.

A new command lets you specify a list of area codes to be considered local, except that the area code must be dialed:

SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES [ areacode [ areacode [ areacode [ ... ] ] ] ]
The list may include up to 32 area codes. If a number is called whose area code is in this list, it is dialed WITHOUT the long-distance prefix, but WITH the area code.

So in Maryland, which (last time we looked) has two area codes, 410 and 301, the setup would be:

  SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES 410 301

Example:

  SET DIAL LD-PREFIX 1
  SET DIAL AREA-CODE 301
  SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES 410 301 <-- Area codes in 10-digit dialing region
  DIAL +1 (301) 765-4321         <-- Dials 3017654321  (local with area code)
  DIAL +1 (410) 765-4321         <-- Dials 4107654321  (local with area code)
  DIAL +1 (212) 765-4321         <-- Dials 12127654321 (long distance)

The SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES command does not replace the SET DIAL AREA-CODE command. The latter specifies the area code you are dialing from. If the called number is in the same area code, then the area code is dialed if it is also in the LC-AREA-CODES list, and it is not dialed otherwise. So if "301" had not appeared in the LC-AREA-CODES list in the previous example:

  SET DIAL LD-PREFIX 1
  SET DIAL AREA-CODE 301
  SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES 410     <-- Area codes in 10-digit dialing region
  DIAL +1 (301) 765-4321         <-- Dials 7654321     (local)
  DIAL +1 (410) 765-4321         <-- Dials 4107654321  (local with area code)
  DIAL +1 (212) 765-4321         <-- Dials 12127654321 (long distance)

The new Kermit versions also add a Local Call Prefix and Local Call Suffix, in case you have any need for it. These are added to the beginning and of local phone numbers (i.e. numbers that are not long-distance or international). Examples:

  SET DIAL LD-PREFIX 1
  SET DIAL LC-PREFIX 9
  SET DIAL LC-SUFFIX *
  SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES 410     <-- Area codes in 10-digit dialing region
  SET DIAL AREA-CODE 301
  DIAL +1 (301) 765-4321         <-- Dials 97654321*     (local)
  DIAL +1 (410) 765-4321         <-- Dials 94107654321*  (local with area code)
  DIAL +1 (212) 765-4321         <-- Dials 12127654321   (long distance)


2.1.3. Forcing Long-Distance Dialing

Suppose a number is in your country and area, but for some reason you need to dial it long-distance anyway (as is always the case in France). There have always been various ways to handle this:

  1. Temporarily set your area code to a different (or nonexistent or impossible) one (but this required knowledge of which area codes were nonexistent or impossible in each country).

  2. Dial the number literally instead of using the portable format, but this defeats the purpose of the portable dialing directory.

Now there is also a new command that, very simply, can force long-distance dialing:

SET DIAL FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE { ON, OFF }
If a call is placed to a portable phone number within the same country code as the calling number, it is dialed with the long-distance prefix and the area code if FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE is ON. If OFF, the regular rules and procedures apply.

Example (France):

  SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 33
  SET DIAL AREA-CODE 6
  SET DIAL FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE ON

(In fact, SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 33 automatically sets DIAL FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE ON...)

Example (USA, for a certain type of reverse-charge calling in which the called number must always be fully specified):

  SET DIAL PREFIX 18002666328$     ; 1-800-COLLECT
  SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 1
  SET DIAL AREA-CODE 212
  SET DIAL FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE ON

Example (Toronto, where calls to exchange 976 within area code 416 must be dialed as long distance, even when you are dialing from area code 416):

  SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 1
  SET DIAL AREA-CODE 416
  SET DIAL FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE ON
  DIAL +1 (416) 976-xxxx

If dialing methods were consistent and sensible, of course it would be possible to always dial every domestic call as if it were long distance. But in many locations this doesn't work or if it does, it costs extra. The following macro can be used for dialing any given number with forced long-distance format:

  define LDIAL {
      local \%x
      set dial force-long-distance on
      dial \%*
      asg \%x \v(success)
      set dial force-long-distance off
      end \%x
  }

(See Section 7.5 about the \%* variable.)


2.1.4. Exchange-Specific Dialing Decisions

This applies mainly to the North American Numbering Plan (NANP). Refer to the section "Alternative notations" in Using C-Kermit 2nd Edition, pages 106-107, and the story about Toronto on page 110. Using the new LC-AREA-CODES list, we can address the problem by treating the exchange as part of the area code:

  SET DIAL LD-PREFIX 1
  SET DIAL AREA-CODE 416
  SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES 905276
  DIAL +1 416 765 4321               <-- 7654321      (local)
  DIAL +1 905 276 4321               <-- 9052764321   (local with area code)
  DIAL +1 905 528 4321               <-- 19055284321  (long distance)

The same technique can be used in Massachusetts (story at top of page 111) and in any other place where dialing to some exchanges within a particular area code is local, but to others in the same area code is long distance.


2.1.5. Cautions about Cheapest-First Dialing

Kermit does not maintain a knowledge base of telephony information; it only provides the tools to let you enter a phone number in a standard format and dial it correctly from any location in most cases.

In particular, Kermit does not differentiate the charging method from the dialing method. If a call that is DIALED as long-distance (e.g. from 212 to 718 in country code 1) is not CHARGED as long distance, we have no way of knowing that without keeping a matrix of charging information for every area-code combination within every country, and any such matrix would be obsolete five minutes after it was constructed. Thus, "cheapest-first" sorting is only as reliable as our assumption that the charging method follows the dialing method. A good illustration would be certain online services that have toll-free dialup numbers which they charge you a premium (in your online service bill) for using.


2.1.6. Blind Dialing (Dialing with No Dialtone)

C-Kermit's init string for Hayes-like modems generally includes an X4 command to enable as many result codes as possible, so that Kermit can react appropriately to different failure reasons. One of the result codes that X4 enables is "NO DIALTONE". A perhaps not obvious side effect of enabling this result code that the modem must hear dialtone before it will dial.

It is becoming increasingly necessary to force a modem to dial even though it does not hear a dialtone on the phone line; for example, with PBXs that have strange dialtones, or with phone systems in different countries, or with ISDN phones, etc. This is called "blind dialing".

C-Kermit 7.0 has two new commands to cope with this situation:

SET DIAL IGNORE-DIALTONE { ON, OFF }
OFF (the default) means to tell the modem to wait for dialtone before dialing. ON means to enable "blind dialing", i.e. tell the modem NOT to wait for dialtone before dialing. Generally this is accomplished by sending ATX3 to the modem just prior to dialing. SET MODEM TYPE xxx and then SHOW MODEM displays Kermit's built-in "ignore dialtone" command.

SET DIAL COMMAND IGNORE-DIALTONE text
This lets you change the built-in ignore-dialtone command (such as ATX3) to whatever you choose, in case the built-in one does not work, or another command works better.

Notes:

  1. The ignore-dialtone command is not sent unless SET DIAL IGNORE-DIALTONE is ON.

  2. The ATX3 command generally disables not only NO DIALTONE, but also BUSY. So this will prevent Kermit from detecting when the line is busy. This is a property of the modem, not of Kermit.


2.1.7. Trimming the Dialing Dialog

The command:

  SET MODEM COMMAND action [ command ]

is used to override Kermit's built-in modem commands for each action, for each kind of modem in its internal database. If you include a command, this is used instead of the built-in one. If you omit the command, this restores the original built-in command.

If you want to omit the command altogether, so Kermit doesn't send the command at all, or wait for a response, use:

  SET MODEM COMMAND action {}

That is, specify a pair of empty braces as the command, for example:

  SET MODEM COMMAND ERROR-CORRECTION ON {}


2.1.8. Controlling the Dialing Speed

The rate at which characters are sent to the modem during dialing is normally controlled by the built-in modem database. You might want to override this if Kermit seems to be dialing too slowly, or it is sending characters to the modem faster than the modem handle them. A new command was added for this in C-Kermit 7.0:

SET DIAL PACING number
Specifies the number of milliseconds (thousandths of seconds) to pause between each character when sending commands to the modem during DIAL or ANSWER command execution. 0 means no pause at all, -1 (the default) or any other negative number means to use the value from the database. Any number greater than 0 is the number of milliseconds to pause.

HINT: You might also need to control the rate at which the modem generates Touch Tones during dialing, for example when sending a numeric page. There are two ways to do this. One way is to insert pause characters into the dialing string. For modems that use the AT command set, the pause character is comma (,) and causes a 2-second pause. On most modems, you can use the S8 register to change the pause interval caused by comma in the dialing string. The other way is to set your modem's tone generation interval, if it has a command for that. Most AT-command-set modems use S11 for this; the value is in milliseconds. For example on USR modems:

  ATS11=200

selects an interval of 200 milliseconds to separate each dialing tone.

Hint: To add S-Register settings or other commands to your dialing procedure, use the new SET MODEM COMMAND PREDIAL-INIT command (Section 2.2.2).


2.1.9. Pretesting Phone Number Conversions

The LOOKUP command now accepts telephone numbers as well as directory-entry names, for example:

  LOOKUP +1 (212) 7654321

When given a phone number, LOOKUP prints the result of converting the phone number for dialing under the current dialing rules. For example, if my country code is 1 and my area code is 212, and I am dialing out from a PBX whose outside-line prefix is "93,":

  C-Kermit> lookup +1 (212) 7654321
  +1 (212) 7654321 => 93,7654321
  C-Kermit>

You can also use the \fdialconvert(phone-number) function (Section 2.1.11) to do this programmatically:

  C-Kermit> echo "\fdialconvert(+1 (212) 7654321)"
  "93,7654321"
  C-Kermit>

So the new LOOKUP behaves as follows:

LOOKUP portable-format-phone-number
Displays how the number would actually be dialed Sets FAILURE if there was a conversion error, otherwise SUCCESS.

LOOKUP literal-format-phone-number
Displays the same literal-format-phone-number Always sets SUCCESS.

LOOKUP dialing-directory-name
Displays all matching entries and converts portable phone numbers. Sets SUCCESS if at least one entry was found, otherwise FAILURE.

LOOKUP =anything
Displays "=anything" and sets SUCCESS.

There is, at present, no programmatic way to fetch numbers from the dialing directory. This will be considered for a future release.


2.1.10. Greater Control over Partial Dialing

The following rules now apply to partial dialing:

However, the suffix that *would* have been applied, based on the dialing rules that were invoked when processing the first PDIAL command, is stored in the variable:

  \v(dialsuffix)

which you can include in any subsequent PDIAL or DIAL commands.

Example:

  pdial {\m(my_long_distance_pager_number_part_1)}
  pdial {\m(my_long_distance_pager_number_part_2)}
  pdial {\v(dialsuffix)}
  pdial {\m(my_long_distance_pager_number_part_3)}
  pdial {@\m(numeric_pager_code)#}


2.1.11. New DIAL-related Variables and Functions

\fdialconvert(s)
s is a phone number in either literal or portable format (not a dialing directory entry name). The function returns the dial string that would actually be used by the DIAL command when dialing from the current location, after processing country code, area code, and other SET DIAL values, and should be the same as the result of LOOKUP when given a telephone number.

\v(dialsuffix)
Contains the suffix, if any, that was applied in the most recent DIAL command, or the suffix that would have been applied in the most recent PDIAL command. Use this variable to send the dial suffix at any desired point in a PDIAL sequence.

\v(dialtype)
A number indicating the type of call that was most recently placed. Can be used after a normal DIAL command, or after the first PDIAL command in a PDIAL sequence. Values are:

  -2: Unknown because TAPI handled the phone number translation.
  -1: Unknown because some kind of error occured.
   0: Internal within PBX.
   1: Toll-free.
   2: Local within calling area.
   3: Unknown (e.g. because a literal-format phone number was given).
   4: Long distance within country.
   5: International

\v(dialcount)
The current value of the DIAL retry counter, for use in a DIAL macro (Section 2.1.13).

\v(d$px)
PBX Exchange (see Section 2.1.12).

Other dial-related variables, already documented in Using C-Kermit (or other sections of this document, e.g. Section 2.1.1), include \v(dialnumber), \v(dialstatus), etc. A convenient way to display all of them is:

  show variable dial  ; hint: abbreviate "sho var dial"

This shows the values of all the variables whose names start with "dial". Also "show variable d$" (to show the \v(d$...) variables).


2.1.12. Increased Flexibility of PBX Dialing

Refer to Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition, pages 107-108. Recall that three commands are needed to configure C-Kermit for dialing from a PBX:

  SET DIAL PBX-EXCHANGE number
  SET DIAL PBX-INSIDE-PREFIX number
  SET DIAL PBX-OUTSIDE-PREFIX number

Unfortunately, this model does not accommodate PBXs that have more than one exchange. For example our PBX at Columbia University (which must handle more than 10,000 phones) has 853-xxxx and 854-xxxx exchanges.

Beginning in C-Kermit 7.0, the SET DIAL PBX-EXCHANGE command accepts a list of exchanges, e.g.:

  SET DIAL PBX-EXCHANGE 853 854

(multiple exchanges are separated by spaces, not commas).

So now when dialing a portable-format number that has the same country and area codes as those of your dialing location, C-Kermit compares the exchange of the dialed number with each number in the PBX Exchange list (rather than with a single PBX Exchange number, as it did formerly) to determine whether this is an internal PBX number or an external call. If it is an external call, then the PBX Outside Prefix is applied, and then the normal dialing rules for local or long-distance calls.

If it is an inside call, the exchange is replaced by the PBX Inside Prefix. But if the PBX has more than one exchange, a single fixed PBX Inside Prefix is probably not sufficient. For example, at Columbia University, we must dial 3-xxxx for an internal call to 853-xxxx, but 4-xxxx for a call to 854-xxxx. That is, the inside prefix is the final digit of the exchange we are dialing. For this reason, C-Kermit 7.0 provides a method to determine the inside prefix dynamically at dialing time, consisting of a new variable and new syntax for the SET DIAL PBX-INSIDE-PREFIX command:

\v(d$px)
This variable contains the exchange that was matched when a PBX internal call was detected. For example, if the PBX exchange list is "853 854" and a call is placed to +1 (212) 854-9999, \v(d$px) is set to 854.

SET DIAL PBX-INSIDE-PREFIX \fxxx(...)
If the PBX Inside Prefix is defined to be a function, its evaluation is deferred until dialing time. Normally, this would be a string function having \v(d$px) as an operand. Of course, you can still specify a constant string, as before.

So given the following setup:

  SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 1
  SET DIAL AREA-CODE 212
  SET DIAL PBX-OUTSIDE-PREFIX 93,
  SET DIAL PBX-EXCHANGE 853 854
  SET DIAL PBX-INSIDE-PREFIX \fright(\v(d$px),1)

The following numbers give the results indicated:

 Number                   Result
  +1 (212) 854-9876        4-9876
  +1 (212) 853-1234        3-1234
  +1 (212) 765-4321        93,765-4321
  +1 (333) 765-4321        93,1333765-4321

Furthermore, the K_PBX_XCH environment variable may now be set to a list of exchanges to automatically initialize C-Kermit's PBX exchange list, for example (in UNIX ksh or bash):

  export K_PBX_XCH="853 854"

(Quotes required because of the space.) Of course, this variable can also be set to a single exchange, as before:

  export K_PBX_XCH=853


2.1.13. The DIAL macro - Last-Minute Phone Number Conversions

After a DIAL or LOOKUP command is given, a list of phone numbers is assembled from the dialing directory (if any), with all location-dependent conversion rules applied as described in Chapter 5 of Using C-Kermit.

However, additional conversions might still be required at the last minute based on local or ephemeral conditions. So that you can have the final word on the exact format of the dial string, C-Kermit 7.0 lets you pass the converted string through a macro of your own design for final processing before dialing. The relevant command is:

SET DIAL MACRO [ name ]
Specifies the name of a macro to be run on each phone number after all built-in conversions have been applied, just before the number is dialed. If no name is given, no macro is run. The phone number, as it would have been dialed if there were no dial macro, is passed to the macro.

The dial macro can do anything at all (except start a file transfer). However, the normal use for the macro would be to modify the phone number. For this reason the phone number is passed to the macro as argument number 1 (\%1). To cause a modified number to be dialed, the macro should terminate with a RETURN statement specifying a return value. To leave the number alone, the macro should simply end. Example:

  define xxx return 10108889999$\%1
  set dial macro xxx
  dial xyzcorp

This defines a DIAL MACRO called xxx, which puts an access code on the front of the number. Another example might be:

  def xxx if equal "\v(modem)" "hayes-1200" return \freplace(\%1,$,{,,,,,})
  set dial macro xxx
  dial xyzcorp

which replaces any dollar-sign in the dial string by a series of five commas, e.g. because this particular modem does not support the "wait for bong" feature (remember that commas that are to be included literally in function arguments must be enclosed in braces to distinguish them from the commas that separate the arguments) and when the IF condition is not satisfied, the macro does not return a value, and so the number is not modified. Then when a DIAL command is given referencing a dialing directory entry, "xyzcorp". The macro is automatically applied to each matching number.

Numerous dial-, modem-, communications-, and time-related variables are available for decision making your dial macro. Type SHOW VARIABLES for a list. Of particular interest is the \v(dialcount) variable, which tells how many times the DIAL command gone through its retry loop: 1 on the first try, 2 on the second, 3 on the third, and so on, and the \v(dialresult) and \v(dialstatus) variables.

Here are some other applications for the DIAL MACRO (from users):

To illustrate the final item, suppose you have a choice among many phone service providers; the provider is chosen by dialing an access code before the number. Different providers might be better (e.g. cheaper) for certain times of day or days of the week, or for dialing certain locations; you can use the DIAL macro to add the access for the most desirable provider.

Similarly, when the same number might be reached through multiple providers, it's possible that one provider might not be able to complete the call, but another one can. In that case, you can use the DIAL macro to switch providers each time through the DIAL loop -- that's where the \v(dialcount) variable comes in handy.

The following command can be used to debug the DIAL macro:

SET DIAL TEST { ON, OFF }
Normally OFF, so the DIAL command actually dials. When ON, the DIAL command performs all lookups and number conversions, and then goes through the number list and retry loop, but instead of actually dialing, lists the numbers it would have called if none of the DIAL attempts succeeded (or more precisely, every number was always busy).


2.1.14. Automatic Tone/Pulse Dialing Selection

SET DIAL METHOD { AUTO, DEFAULT, PULSE, TONE }
Chooses the dialing method for subsequent calls.

Prior to version 7.0, C-Kermit's DIAL METHOD was DEFAULT by default, meaning it does not specify a dialing method to the modem, but relies on the modem to have an appropriate default dialing method set. So, for example, when using Hayes compatible modems, the dial string would be something like ATD7654321, rather than ATDT7654321 or ATDP7654321.

In C-Kermit 7.0 and K95 1.1.19, the dial method can be set from the environment variable:

  K_DIAL_METHOD

when Kermit starts. The values can be TONE, PULSE, or DEFAULT, e.g. (UNIX):

  set K_DIAL_METHOD=TONE; export K_DIAL_METHOD

In the absence of a K_DIAL_METHOD definition, the new default SET DIAL METHOD is AUTO rather than DEFAULT. When DIAL METHOD is AUTO and the local country code is known, then if tone dialing is universally available in the corresponding area, tone dialing is used; if dialing from a location where pulse dialing is mandatory, pulse dialing is used.

The "tone country" and "pulse country" lists are preloaded according to our knowledge at the time of release. You can see their contents in the SHOW DIAL listing. You can change the lists with:

SET DIAL TONE-COUNTRIES [ cc [ cc [ ... ] ] ]
Replaces the current TONE-COUNTRIES list with the one given. Each cc is a country code; separate them with spaces (not commas). Example:

  set dial tone-countries 1 358 44 46 49

If no country codes are given, the current list, if any, is removed, in which case SET DIAL METHOD AUTO is equivalent to SET DIAL METHOD DEFAULT.

SET DIAL PULSE-COUNTRIES [ cc [ cc [ ... ] ] ]
Replaces the current PULSE-COUNTRIES list with the one give. Syntax and operation is like SET DIAL TONE-COUNTRIES.

If the same country code appears in both lists, Pulse takes precedence.

The SET DIAL TONE- and PULSE-COUNTRIES commands perform no verification whatsoever on the cc's, since almost any syntax might be legal in some settings. Furthermore, there is no facility to edit the lists; you can only replace the whole list. However, since the only purpose of these lists is to establish a basis for picking tone or pulse dialing automatically, all you need to override the effect of the list is to set a specific dialing method with SET DIAL METHOD TONE or SET DIAL METHOD PULSE.


2.1.15. Dial-Modifier Variables

As of C-Kermit 7.0, dial modifiers are available in the following variables:

 \v(dm_lp) Long pause
 \v(dm_sp) Short pause
 \v(dm_pd) Pulse dial
 \v(dm_td) Tone dial
 \v(dm_wa) Wait for answer
 \v(dm_wd) Wait for dialtone
 \v(dm_rc) Return to command mode

You can use these in your dial strings in place of hardwired modifiers like "@", ",", etc, for increased portability of scripts. Example:

  C-Kermit>set modem type usrobotics
  C-Kermit>sho variables dm
   \v(dm_lp) = ,
   \v(dm_sp) = /
   \v(dm_pd) = P
   \v(dm_td) = T
   \v(dm_wa) = @
   \v(dm_wd) = W
   \v(dm_rc) = ;
  C-Kermit>exit


2.1.16. Giving Multiple Numbers to the DIAL Command

Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the only way to give a DIAL command a list of phone numbers to try until one answers was to create a dialing directory that had multiple entries under the same name, and then use that entry name in the DIAL command. Now a list of numbers can be given to the DIAL command directly in the following format:

  dial {{number1}{number2}{number3}...}

This is the same list format used by SEND /EXCEPT: and other commands that allow a list where normally a single item is given. Restrictions on this form of the DIAL command are:

In all other respects, the numbers are treated as if they had been fetched from the dialing directory; they can be in literal or portable format, etc. Example:

  dial {{7654321} {+1 (212) 5551212} { 1-212-5556789 }}

The list can be any length at all, within reason.

This feature is especially handy for use with the K95 Dialer, allowing a list of phone numbers to be specified in the Telephone Number box without having to set up or reference a separate dialing directory.

You can also use it to add commonly-dialed sequences as variables in your C-Kermit customization file, e.g.:

  define work {{7654321}{7654322}{7654323}}

and then:

  dial {\m(work)}

(the variable name must be enclosed in braces).

Or more simply:

  define work dial {{7654321}{7654322}{7654323}}

and then:

  work


2.2. Modems

2.2.1. New Modem Types

Since C-Kermit 6.0:

  atlas-newcom-33600ifxC Atlas/Newcom 33600
  att-keepintouch        AT&T KeepinTouch PCMCIA V.32bis Card Modem
  att-1900-stu-iii       AT&T Secure Data STU-III Model 1900
  att-1910-stu-iii       AT&T Secure Data STU-III Model 1910
  bestdata               Best Data
  cardinal               Cardinal V.34 MVP288X series.
  compaq                 Compaq Data+Fax (e.g. in Presario)
  fujitsu                Fujitsu Fax/Modem Adapter
  generic-high-speed     Any modern error-correcting data-compressing modem
  itu-t-v25ter/v250      ITU-T (CCITT) V.25ter (V.250) standard command set
  megahertz-att-v34      Megahertz AT&T V.34
  megahertz-xjack        Megahertz X-Jack
  motorola-codex         Motorola Codex 326X Series
  motorola-montana       Motorola Montana
  mt5634zpx              Multitech MT5634ZPX
  rockwell-v90           Rockwell V.90 56K
  rolm-244pc             Siemens/Rolm 244PC (AT command set)
  rolm-600-series        Siemens/Rolm 600 Series (AT command set)
  spirit-ii              QuickComm Spirit II
  suprasonic             SupraSonic V288+
  supra-express-v90      Supra Express V.90

One of the new types, "generic-high-speed" needs a bit of explanation. This type was added to easily handle other types that are not explicitly covered, without going through the bother of adding a complete user-defined modem type. This one works for modern modems that use the AT command set, on the assumption that all the default ("factory") settings of the modem (a) are appropriate for Kermit, (b) include error correction, data compression, and speed buffering; and (c) are recallable with the command AT&F.

If the command to recall your modem's profile is not AT&F, use the SET MODEM COMMAND INIT-STRING command to specify the appropriate modem command. The default init-string is AT&F\13 (that is, AT, ampersand, F, and then carriage return); a survey of about 20 modern modem types shows they all support this, but they might mean different things by it. For example, the USR Sportster or Courier needs AT&F1 (not AT&F, which is equivalent to AT&F0, which recalls an inappropriate profile), so for USR modems:

  set modem type generic-high-speed
  set modem command init AT&F1\13

Of course, USR modems already have their own built-in modem type. But if you use this one instead, it will dial faster because it has fewer commands to give to the modem; in that sense "&F1" is like a macro that bundles numerous commands into a single one. See your modem manual for details about factory profiles and commands to recall them.

WARNING: Do not use the generic-high-speed modem type in operating systems like VMS where hardware flow control is not available, at least not unless you change the init string from AT&F\13 to something else that enables local Xon/Xoff or other appropriate type of flow control.

Also see Section 2.1.7 for additional hints about making dialing go faster.


2.2.2. New Modem Controls

SET MODEM CAPABILITIES list
In C-Kermit 7.0, this command automatically turns MODEM SPEED-MATCHING OFF if SB (Speed Buffering) is in the list, and turns it ON if SB is absent.

SET MODEM COMMAND PREDIAL-INIT [ text ]
Commands to be sent to the modem just prior to dialing. Normally none.

SET MODEM SPEAKER { ON, OFF }
Determines whether modem speaker is on or off while call is being placed. ON by default. Note: This command does not provide fine-grained control over when the speaker is on or off. Normally, ON means while the call is being placed, until the point at which carrier is successfully established. If your modem has a different speaker option that you want to choose, then use the SET MODEM COMMAND SPEAKER ON text command to specify this option.

SET MODEM COMMAND SPEAKER { ON, OFF } [ text ]
Specify or override the commands to turn your modem's speaker on and off.

SET MODEM VOLUME { LOW, MEDIUM, HIGH }
When MODEM SPEAKER is on, select volume. Note: In some modems, especially internal ones, these commands have no effect; this is a limitation of the particular modem, not of Kermit.

SET MODEM COMMAND VOLUME { LOW, MEDIUM, HIGH } [ text ]
Specify or override the commands to set your modem's speaker volume.

SET MODEM COMMAND IGNORE-DIALTONE [ text ]
The command to enable blind dialing (Section 2.1.6).

SET MODEM ESCAPE-CHARACTER code
Has been augmented to allow codes of 0 or less: < 0 means the escape mechanism is disabled. = 0 means to use (restore) the default value from the modem database. > 0 and < 128 is a literal value to be used instead of the default one. > 127 means the escape mechanism is disabled. This affects "modem hangup". When the escape mechanism is disabled, but SET MODEM HANGUP-METHOD is MODEM-COMMAND, it sends the hangup command immediately, without the <pause>+++<pause> business first. This is useful (for example) when sending lots of numeric pages, a process in which never we go online, and so never need to escape back. Eliminating the unnecessary pauses and escape sequence allows a lot more pages to be sent per unit time.

Recall that C-Kermit can dial modems to which it is connected via TCP/IP (Telnet or Rlogin) as described on page 126 of Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed. In this case the MODEM HANGUP-METHOD should be MODEM-COMMAND, since RS-232 signals don't work over TCP/IP connections. As noted in the manual, such connections are set up by the following sequence:

  set host host [ port ]
  set modem type name
  dial number

But this can cause complications when you use Kermit to switch between serial and TCP/IP connections. In the following sequence:

  set host name
  set modem type name
  set port name

the first two commands obey the rules for dialing out over Telnet. However, the SET PORT command requires that Kermit close its current (Telnet) connection before it can open the serial port (since Kermit can only have one connection open at a time). But since a modem type was set after the "set host" command was given, Kermit assumes it is a Telnet dialout connection and so sends the modem's hangup sequence is sent to the Telnet host. To avoid this, close the network connection explicitly before opening the serial one:

  set host name
  close
  set modem type name
  set port name


2.3. TELNET and RLOGIN

For additional background, please also read the TELNET.TXT file, also available on the Web in HTML format.

Cautions:

New commands:

TELOPT { AO, AYT, BREAK, CANCEL, EC, EL, EOF, EOR, GA, IP, DMARK,
DO, DONT, NOP, SB, SE, SUSP, WILL, WONT
}
This command was available previously, but supported only DO, DONT, WILL, and WONT. Now it lets you send all the Telnet protocol commands. Note that certain commands do not require a response, and therefore can be used as nondestructive "probes" to see if the Telnet session is still open; e.g.:

  set host xyzcorp.com
  ...
  telopt nop
  if fail stop 1 Connection lost

SET TCP ADDRESS [ ip-address ]
Specifies the IP address of the computer that C-Kermit is running on. Normally this is not necessary. The exception would be if your machine has multiple network adapters (physical or virtual) with a different address for each adapter AND you want C-Kermit to use a specific address when making outgoing connections or accepting incoming connections.

SET TCP DNS-SERVICE-RECORDS { ON, OFF }
Tells C-Kermit whether to try to use DNS SRV records to determine the host and port number upon which to find an advertised service. For example, if a host wants regular Telnet connections redirected to some port other than 23, this feature allows C-Kermit to ask the host which port it should use. Since not all domain servers are set up to answer such requests, this feature is OFF by default.

SET TCP REVERSE-DNS-LOOKUP { ON, OFF, AUTO }
Tells Kermit whether to perform a reverse DNS lookup on TCP/IP connections. This allows Kermit to determine the actual hostname of the host it is connected to, which is useful for connections to host pools, and is required for Kerberos connections to host pools and for incoming connections. If the other host does not have a DNS entry, the reverse lookup could take a long time (minutes) to fail, but the connection will still be made. Turn this option OFF for speedier connections if you do not need to know exactly which host you are connected to and you are not using Kerberos. AUTO, the default, means the lookup is done on hostnames, but not on numeric IP addresses.

SET TELNET WAIT-FOR-NEGOTIATIONS { ON, OFF }
Each Telnet option must be fully negotiated either On or Off before the session can continue. This is especially true with options that require sub-negotiations such as Authentication, Encryption, and Kermit; for proper support of these options Kermit must wait for the negotiations to complete. Of course, Kermit has no way of knowing whether a reply is delayed or not coming at all, and so will wait a minute or more for required replies before continuing the session. If you know that Kermit's Telnet partner will not be sending the required replies, you can set this option of OFF to avoid the long timeouts. Or you can instruct Kermit to REFUSE specific options with the SET TELOPT command.

SET TELOPT [ { /CLIENT, /SERVER } ] option
{ ACCEPTED, REFUSED, REQUESTED, REQUIRED }
[ { ACCEPTED, REFUSED, REQUESTED, REQUIRED } ]
SET TELOPT lets you specify policy requirements for Kermit's handling of Telnet option negotiations. Setting an option is REQUIRED causes Kermit to offer the option to the peer and disconnect if the option is refused. REQUESTED causes Kermit to offer an option to the peer. ACCEPTED results in no offer but Kermit will attempt to negotiate the option if it is requested. REFUSED instructs Kermit to refuse the option if it is requested by the peer.

Some options are negotiated in two directions and accept separate policies for each direction; the first keyword applies to Kermit itself, the second applies to Kermit's Telnet partner; if the second keyword is omitted, an appropriate (option-specific) default is applied. You can also include a /CLIENT or /SERVER switch to indicate whether the given policies apply when Kermit is the Telnet client or the Telnet server; if no switch is given, the command applies to the client.

Note that some of Kermit's Telnet partners fail to refuse options that they do not recognize and instead do not respond at all. In this case it is possible to use SET TELOPT to instruct Kermit to REFUSE the option before connecting to the problem host, thus skipping the problematic negotiation.

Use SHOW TELOPT to view current Telnet Option negotiation settings. SHOW TELNET displays current Telnet settings.


2.3.0. Bug Fixes

If "set host nonexistent-host" was given (and it properly failed), followed by certain commands like SEND, the original line and modem type were not restored and C-Kermit thought that it still had a network hostname; fixed in 7.0.

2.3.1. Telnet Binary Mode Bug Adjustments

SET TELNET BUG BINARY-ME-MEANS-U-TOO { ON, OFF } was added to edit 192 after the book was printed. Also SET TELNET BUG BINARY-U-MEANS-ME-TOO. The default for both is OFF. ON should be used when communicating with a Telnet partner (client or server) that mistakenly believes that telling C-Kermit to enter Telnet binary mode also means that it, too, is in binary mode, contrary to the Telnet specification, which says that binary mode must be negotiated in each direction separately.

2.3.2. VMS UCX Telnet Port Bug Adjustment

A new command, SET TCP UCX-PORT-BUG, was added for VMS versions with UCX (DEC TCP/IP), applying only to early versions of UCX, like 2.2 or earlier. If you try to use VMS C-Kermit to make a Telnet connection using a port name (like "telnet", which is used by default), the underlying UCX getservbyname() function might return the service number with its bytes swapped and the connection will fail. If "telnet hostname 23" works, then your version of UCX has this bug and you can put "set tcp ucx-port-bug on" in your CKERMIT.INI file to get around it.

2.3.3. Telnet New Environment Option

The TELNET NEW-ENVIRONMENT option (RFC 1572) is supported as 7.0. This option allows the C-Kermit Telnet client to send certain well-known variables to the Telnet server, including USER, PRINTER, DISPLAY, and several others. This feature is enabled by default in Windows and OS/2, disabled by default elsewhere. The command to enable and disable it is:

  SET TELNET ENVIRONMENT { ON, OFF }

When ON, and you Telnet to another computer, you might (or might not) notice that the "login:" or "Username:" prompt does not appear -- that's because your username was sent ahead, in which case the remote system might prompt you only for your password (similar to Rlogin). Use "set telnet environment off" to defeat this feature, particularly in scripts where the dialog must be predictable. You can also use this command to specify or override specific well-known environment variable values:

 SET TELNET ENVIRONMENT { ACCT,DISPLAY,JOB,PRINTER,SYSTEMTYPE,USER } [ text ]

2.3.4. Telnet Location Option

The TELNET LOCATION option (RFC 779) is supported in 7.0. This option allows the C-Kermit Telnet client to send a location string to the server if the server indicates its willingness to accept one. If an environment variable named LOCATION exists at the time C-Kermit starts, its value is used as the location string. If you want to change it, use:

  SET TELNET LOCATION text

If you omit the text from this command, the Telnet location feature is disabled.

SET TELNET ENVIRONMENT DISPLAY is used to set the DISPLAY variable that is sent to the host, as well as the the XDISPLAY location.

2.3.5. Connecting to Raw TCP Sockets

The SET HOST and TELNET commands now accept an optional switch, /RAW-SOCKET, at the end, only if you first give a host and a port. Example:

  set host xyzcorp.com 23 /raw-socket
  set host 128.49.39.2:2000 /raw-socket
  telnet xyzcorp.com 3000 /raw

Without this switch, C-Kermit behaves as a Telnet client when (a) the port is 23 or 1649, or (b) the port is not 513 and the server sent what appeared to be Telnet negotiations -- that is, messages starting with 0xFF (IAC). With this switch, Kermit should treat all incoming bytes as raw data, and will not engage in any Telnet negotiations or NVT CRLF manipulations. This allows transparent operation through (e.g.) raw TCP ports on Cisco terminal servers, through the 'modemd' modem server, etc.

2.3.6. Incoming TCP Connections

Accomplished via SET HOST * port, were introduced in C-Kermit 6.0, but for UNIX only. In Version 7.0, they are also available for VMS.


2.4. The EIGHTBIT Command

EIGHTBIT is simply a shorthand for: SET PARITY NONE, SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE 8, SET COMMAND BYTESIZE 8; that is, a way to set up an 8-bit clean connection in a single command.


2.5. The Services Directory

Chapter 7 of Using C-Kermit does not mention the ULOGIN macro, which is used by our sample services directory, CKERMIT.KND. Unlike UNIXLOGIN, VMSLOGIN, etc, this one is for use with systems that require a user ID but no password. Therefore it doesn't prompt for a password or wait for a password prompt from the remote service.

In version 7.0, the CALL macro was changed to not execute a SET MODEM TYPE command if the given modem type was the same as the current one; otherwise the new SET MODEM TYPE command would overwrite any customizations that the user had made to the modem settings. Ditto for SET LINE / SET PORT and SET SPEED.


2.6. Closing Connections

Until version 7.0, there was never an obvious and general way to close a connection. If a serial connection was open, it could be closed by "set line" or "set port" (giving no device name); if a network connection was open, it could be closed by "set host" (no host name).

In version 7.0, a new command closes the connection in an obvious and straightforward way, no matter what the connection type:

  CLOSE [ CONNECTION ]

The CLOSE command was already present, and required an operand such as DEBUG-LOG, WRITE-FILE, etc, and so could never be given by itself. The new CONNECTION operand is now the default operand for CLOSE, so CLOSE by itself closes the connection, if one is open, just as you would expect, especially if you are a Telnet or Ftp user.

Also see the description of the new SET CLOSE-ON-DISCONNECT command in Section 2.10.


2.7. Using C-Kermit with External Communication Programs

C-Kermit 7.0 includes a new ability to create and conduct sessions through other communications programs. Two methods are available:

  1. Pty (pseudoterminal): The external program is run on a "pseudoterminal", which is controlled by Kermit. This method works with practically any external program, but it is not portable. At this writing, it works only on some (not all) UNIX versions, and not on any non-UNIX platforms.

  2. Pipe: The external program's standard input and output are redirected through a "pipe" controlled by Kermit. This method is relatively portable -- it should work across all UNIX versions, and it also works in Windows and OS/2 -- but it is effective only when the external program actually uses standard i/o (and many don't).

The two methods are started differently but are used the same way thereafter.

The purpose of this feature is to let you use C-Kermit services like file transfer, character-set translation, scripting, automatic dialing, etc, on connections that Kermit can't otherwise make itself.

This feature is the opposite of the REDIRECT feature, in which C-Kermit makes the connection, and redirects an external (local) command or program over this connection. In a pty or pipe connection, C-Kermit runs and controls a local command or program, which makes the connection. (The same method can be used to simply to control a local program without making a connection; see Section 2.8.)

To find out if your version of Kermit includes PTY support, type "show features" and look for NETPTY in the alphabetical list of options. For pipes, look for NETCMD.

The commands are:

SET NETWORK TYPE PTY or SET NETWORK TYPE PIPE
SET HOST command
where command is any interactive command. If the command does not use standard i/o, you must use SET NETWORK TYPE PTY.

Notes:

The SET NETWORK TYPE, SET HOST sequence sets the given network type for all subsequent SET HOST commands until another SET NETWORK TYPE command is given to change it.

You can also use the new /NETWORK-TYPE:PTY or /NETWORK-TYPE:PIPE (or simply /PIPE or /PTY) switches on the SET HOST command itself:

  SET HOST /NETWORK-TYPE:PIPE command  ; These two are the same
  SET HOST /PIPE command

  SET HOST /NETWORK-TYPE:PTY command   ; Ditto
  SET HOST /PTY command

These are like SET NETWORK TYPE followed by SET HOST, except they apply only to the connection being made and do not change the global network type setting (see Section 1.5 about the difference between switches and SET commands).

Include any command-line options with the command that might be needed, as in this example where C-Kermit uses another copy of itself as the communications program:

  SET HOST /PIPE /CONNECT kermit -YQJ xyzcorp.com

As usual, if you include the /CONNECT switch, SET HOST enters CONNECT mode immediately upon successful execution of the given command. Therefore new commands are available as a shorthand for SET HOST /CONNECT /PTY and /PIPE:

PTY [ command ]
PIPE [ command ]
The PTY and PIPE commands work like the TELNET and RLOGIN commands: they set up the connection (in this case, using the given command) and then enter CONNECT mode automatically (if the PIPE or PTY command is given without a command, it continues the current session if one is active; otherwise it gives an error message).

The PIPE command is named after the mechanism by which C-Kermit communicates with the command: UNIX pipes. C-Kermit's i/o is "piped" through the given command. Here is a typical example:

  PIPE rlogin -8 xyzcorp.com

This is equivalent to:

  SET HOST /PIPE rlogin -8 xyzcorp.com
  CONNECT

and to:

  SET HOST /PIPE /CONNECT rlogin -8 xyzcorp.com

IMPORTANT:
If you are writing a script, do not use the PIPE, PTY, TELNET, or RLOGIN command unless you really want C-Kermit to enter CONNECT mode at that point. Normally SET HOST is used in scripts to allow the login and other dialogs to be controlled by the script itself, rather than by an actively participating human at the keyboard.

Throughput of pty and pipe connections is limited by the performance of the chosen command or program and by the interprocess communication (IPC) method used and/or buffering capacity of the pipe or pty, which in turn depends on the underlying operating system.

In one trial (on SunOS 4.1.3), we observed file transfer rates over an rlogin connection proceeding at 200Kcps for downloads, but only 10Kcps for uploads on the same connection with the same settings (similar disparities were noted in HP-UX). Examination of the logs revealed that a write to the pipe could take as long as 5 seconds, whereas reads were practically instantaneous. On the other hand, using Telnet as the external program rather than rlogin, downloads and uploads were better matched at about 177K each.

Most external communication programs, like C-Kermit itself, have escape characters or sequences. Normally these begin with (or consist entirely of) a control character. You must be sure that this control character is not "unprefixed" when uploading files, otherwise the external program will "escape back" to its prompt, or close the connection, or take some other unwanted action. When in CONNECT mode, observe the program's normal interaction rules. Of course C-Kermit's own escape character (normally Ctrl-\) is active too, unless you have taken some action to disable it.

On PTY connections, the underlying PTY driver is not guaranteed to be transparent to control characters -- for example, it might expand tabs, translate carriage returns, generate signals if it sees an interrupt character, and so on. Similar things might happen on a PIPE connection. For this reason, if you plan to transfer files over a PTY or PIPE connection, tell the file sender to:

SET PREFIXING ALL
This causes all control characters to be prefixed and transmitted as printable ASCII characters.

If the external connection program is not 8-bit clean, you should also:

SET PARITY SPACE
This causes 8-bit data to be encoded in 7 bits using single and/or locking shifts.

And if it does not make a reliable connection (such as those made by Telnet, Rlogin, Ssh, etc), you should:

SET STREAMING OFF
This forces C-Kermit to treat the connection as unreliable and to engage in its normal ACK/NAK protocol for error detection and correction, rather than "streaming" its packets, as it normally does on a network connection (Section 4.20).

In some cases, buffer sizes might be restricted, so you might also need to reduce the Kermit packet length to fit; this is a trial-and-error affair. For example, if transfers always fail with 4000-byte packets, try 2000. If that fails too, try 1000, and so on. The commands are:

SET RECEIVE PACKET-LENGTH number
This tells the file receiver to tell the file sender the longest packet length it can accept.

SET SEND PACKET-LENGTH number
This tells the file sender not to send packets longer than the given length, even if the receiver says longer ones are OK. Of course, if the receiver's length is shorter, the shorter length is used.

If none of this seems to help, try falling back to the bare minimum, lowest-common-denominator protocol settings:

ROBUST
No sliding windows, no streaming, no control-character unprefixing, packet length 90.

And then work your way back up by trial and error to get greater throughput.

Note that when starting a PIPE connection, and the connection program (such as telnet or rlogin) prints some greeting or information messages before starting the connection, these are quite likely to be printed with a stairstep effect (linefeed without carriage return). This is because the program is not connected with the UNIX terminal driver; there's not much Kermit can do about it. Once the connection is made, everything should go back to normal. This shouldn't happen on a PTY connection because a PTY is, indeed, a terminal.

On a similar note, some connection programs (like Solaris 2.5 rlogin) might print lots of error messages like "ioctl TIOCGETP: invalid argument" when used through a pipe. They are annoying but usually harmless. If you want to avoid these messages, and your shell allows redirection of stderr, you can redirect stderr in your pipe command, as in this example where the user's shell is bash:

  PIPE rlogin xyzcorp.com 2> /dev/null

Or use PTY rather than PIPE, since PTY is available on Solaris.


2.7.0. C-Kermit over tn3270 and tn5250

Now you can make a connection from C-Kermit "directly" to an IBM mainframe and transfer files with it, assuming it has Kermit-370 installed. Because tn3270 is neither 8-bit clean nor transparent to control characters, you must give these commands:

  SET PREFIXING ALL   ; Prefix all control characters
  SET PARITY SPACE    ; Telnet connections are usually not 8-bit clean

and then:

  SET HOST /PTY /CONNECT tn3270 abccorp.com

or simply:

  pty tn3270 abccorp.com

SET HOST /PIPE does not work in this case, at least not for file transfer. File transfer does work, however, with SET HOST /PTY, provided you use the default packet length of 90 bytes; anything longer seems to kill the session.

You can also make connections to IBM AS/400 computers if you have a tn5250 program installed:

  pty tn5250 hostname

In this case, however, file transfer is probably not in the cards since nobody has ever succeeded in writing a Kermit program for the AS/400. Hint:

  define tn3270 {
      check pty
      if fail end 1 Sorry - no PTY support...
      pty tn3270 \%*
  }

Similarly for tn5250. Note that CHECK PTY and CHECK PIPE can be used in macros and scripts to test whether PTY or PIPE support is available.


2.7.1. C-Kermit over Telnet

Although C-Kermit includes its own Telnet implementation, you might need to use an external Telnet program to make certain connections; perhaps because it has access or security features not available in C-Kermit itself. As noted above, the only precautions necessary are usually:

  SET PREFIXING ALL   ; Prefix all control characters
  SET PARITY SPACE    ; Telnet connections might not be 8-bit clean

and then:

  SET HOST /PTY (or /PIPE) /CONNECT telnet abccorp.com

or, equivalently:

  PTY (or PIPE) telnet abccorp.com


2.7.2. C-Kermit over Rlogin

C-Kermit includes its own Rlogin client, but this can normally be used only if you are root, since the rlogin TCP port is privileged. But ptys and pipes let you make rlogin connections with C-Kermit through your computer's external rlogin program, which is normally installed as a privileged program:

  SET PREFIXING ALL

and then:

  SET HOST /PTY (or /PIPE) /CONNECT rlogin -8 abccorp.com

or, equivalently:

  PTY (or PIPE) rlogin -8 abccorp.com

The "-8" option to rlogin enables transmission of 8-bit data. If this is not available, then include SET PARITY SPACE if you intend to transfer files.

Note that the normal escape sequence for rlogin is Carriage Return followed by Tilde (~), but only when the tilde is followed by certain other characters; the exact behavior depends on your rlogin client, so read its documentation.


2.7.3. C-Kermit over Serial Communication Programs

Ptys and pipes also let you use programs that make serial connections, such as cu or tip. For example, C-Kermit can be used through cu to make connections that otherwise might not be allowed, e.g. because C-Kermit is not installed with the required write permissions to the dialout device and the UUCP lockfile directory.

Suppose your UUCP Devices file contains an entry for a serial device tty04 to be used for direct connections, but this device is protected against you (and Kermit when you run it). In this case you can:

  SET CONTROL PREFIX ALL
  PTY (or PIPE) cu -l tty04

(Similarly for dialout devices, except then you also need to include the phone number in the "cu" command.)

As with other communication programs, watch out for cu's escape sequence, which is the same as the rlogin program's: Carriage Return followed by Tilde (followed by another character to specify an action, like "." for closing the connection and exiting from cu).


2.7.4. C-Kermit over Secure Network Clients

DISCLAIMER: There are laws in the USA and other countries regarding use, import, and/or export of encryption and/or decryption or other forms of security software, algorithms, technology, and intellectual property. The Kermit Project attempts to follow all known statutes, and neither intends nor suggests that Kermit software can or should be used in any way, in any location, that circumvents any regulations, laws, treaties, covenants, or other legitimate canons or instruments of law, international relations, trade, ethics, or propriety.

For secure connections or connections through firewalls, C-Kermit 7.0 can be a Kerberos, SRP, and/or SOCKS client when built with the appropriate options and libraries. But other application-level security acronyms and methods -- SSH, SSL, SRP, TLS -- pop up at an alarming rate and are (a) impossible to keep up with, (b) usually mutually incompatible, and (c) have restrictions on export or redistribution and so cannot be included in C-Kermit itself.

However, if you have a secure text-based Telnet (or other) client that employs one of these security methods, you can use C-Kermit "through" it via a pty or pipe.


2.7.4.1. SSH

C-Kermit does not and can not incorporate SSH due to licensing, patent, and USA export law restrictions.

The UNIX SSH client does not use standard input/output, and therefore can be used only by Kermit's PTY interface, if one is present. The cautions about file transfer, etc, are the same as for Rlogin. Example:

  SET PREFIXING ALL
  PTY ssh XYZCORP.COM

Or, for a scripted session:

  SET PREFIXING ALL
  SET HOST /PTY ssh XYZCORP.COM

Hint:

  define ssh {
      check pty
      if fail end 1 Sorry - no PTY support...
      pty ssh \%*
  }


2.7.4.2. SSL

Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) is another TCP/IP security overlay, this one designed by and for Netscape. An SSL Telnet client is available for UNIX from the University of Queensland. More info at:

  http://www.psy.uq.oz.au/~ftp/Crypto/

Interoperability with C-Kermit is unknown. C-Kermit also includes its own built-in SSL/TLS support, but it is not exportable; CLICK HERE file for details.


2.7.4.3. SRP

SRP(TM) is Stanford University's Secure Remote Password protocol. An SRP Telnet client is available from Stanford:

  http://srp.stanford.edu/srp/

Stanford's SRP Telnet client for UNIX has been tested on SunOS and works fine with C-Kermit, as described in Section 2.7.1, e.g.

  SET PREFIX ALL
  PTY (or PIPE) srp-telnet xenon.stanford.edu

C-Kermit itself can be built as an SRP Telnet client on systems that have libsrp.a installed; the C-Kermit support code, however, may not be exported outside the USA or Canada.


2.7.4.4. SOCKS

C-Kermit can be built as a SOCKS-aware client on systems that have a SOCKS library. See section 8.1.1 of the ckccfg.txt file.

C-Kermit 7.0 can also be run over SOCKSified Telnet or rlogin clients with SET NETWORK TYPE COMMAND. Suppose the Telnet program on your system is SOCKS enabled but C-Kermit is not. Make Kermit connections like this:

  SET PREFIX ALL
  PTY (or PIPE) telnet zzz.com


2.7.4.5. Kerberos

UNIX C-Kermit can be built with MIT Kerberos IV or V authentication and encryption. Instructions are available in a separate document. Additional modules are required that can not be exported from the USA to any country except Canada, by US law.

If you have Kerberos installed but you don't have a Kerberized version of C-Kermit, you can use ktelnet as C-Kermit's external communications program to make secure connections without giving up C-Kermit's services:

  SET PREFIX ALL
  PTY (or PIPE) ktelnet cia.gov


2.8. Scripting Local Programs

If your version of Kermit has PTY support built in, then any text-based program can be invoked with SET HOST /PTY or equivalent command and controlled using the normal sequence of OUTPUT, INPUT, IF SUCCESS commands (this is the same service that is provided by the 'expect' program, but controlled by the Kermit script language rather than Tcl).

When PTY service is not available, then any program that uses standard input and output can be invoked with SET HOST /PIPE.

Here's an example in which we start an external Kermit program, wait for its prompt, give it a VERSION command, and then extract the numeric version number from its response:

  set host /pty kermit -Y
  if fail stop 1 {Can't start external command}
  input 10 C-Kermit>
  if fail stop 1 {No C-Kermit> prompt}
  output version\13
  input 10 {Numeric: }
  if fail stop 1 {No match for "Numeric:"}
  clear input
  input 10 \10
  echo VERSION = "\fsubstr(\v(input),1,6)"
  output exit\13

This technique could be used to control any other interactive program, even those that do screen formatting (like Emacs or Vi), if you can figure out the sequence of events. If your Kermit program doesn't have PTY support, then the commands are restricted to those using standard i/o, including certain shells, interactive text-mode "hardcopy" editors like ex, and so on.

If you are using the PTY interface, you should be aware that it runs the given program or command directly on the pty, without any intervening shell to interpret metacharacters, redirectors, etc. If you need this sort of thing, include the appropriate shell invocation as part of your command; for example:

  pty echo *

just echoes "*"; whereas:

  pty ksh -c "echo *"

echoes all the filenames that ksh finds matching "*".

Similarly for redirection:

  set host /pty ksh -c "cat > foo"  ; Note: use shell quoting rules here
  set transmit eof \4
  transmit bar

And for that matter, for built-in shell commands:

  set host /pty ksh -c "for i in *; do echo $i; done"

The PIPE interface, on the other hand, invokes the shell automatically, so:

  pipe echo *

prints filenames, not "*".


2.9. X.25 Networking

X.25 networking is documented in Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition. When the book was published, X.25 was available only in SunOS, Solaris, and Stratus VOS. Unlike TCP/IP, X.25 APIs are not standardized; each vendor's X.25 libraries and services (if they have them at all) are unique.

This section describes new additions.


2.9.1. IBM AIXLink/X.25 Network Provider Interface for AIX

Support for X.25 was added via IBM's Network Provider Interface (NPI), AIXLink/X.25 1.1, to the AIX 4.x version of C-Kermit 7.0. Unfortunately, AIXLink/X.25 is a rather bare-bones facility, lacking in particular any form of PAD support (X.3, X.28, X.29). Thus, the AIX version of C-Kermit, when built to include X.25 networking, has neither a PAD command, nor a SET PAD command. The same is true for the underlying AIX system: no PAD support. Thus it is not possible to have an interactive shell session over an X.25 connection into an AIX system (as far as we know), even from X.25-capable Kermit versions (such as Solaris or VOS) that do include PAD support.

Thus the X.25 capabilities in AIX C-Kermit are limited to peer-to-peer connections, e.g. from a C-Kermit client to a C-Kermit server. Unlike the Solaris, SunOS, and VOS versions, the AIX version can accept incoming X.25 connections:

  set network type x.25
  if fail stop 1 Sorry - no X.25 support
  ; Put any desired DISABLE or ENABLE or SET commands here.
  set host /server *
  if fail stop 1 X.25 "set host *" failed

And then access it from the client as follows:

  set network type x.25
  if fail stop 1 Sorry - no X.25 support
  set host xxxxxxx ; Specify the X.25/X.121 address
  if fail stop 1 Can't open connection

And at this point the client can use the full range of client commands: SEND, GET, REMOTE xxx, FINISH, BYE.

The AIX version also adds two new variables:

\v(x25local_nua)
The local X.25 address.

\v(x25remote_nua)
The X.25 address of the host on the other end of the connection.

C-Kermit's AIX X.25 client has not been tested against anything other than a C-Kermit X.25 server on AIX. It is not known if it will interoperate with C-Kermit servers on Solaris, SunOS, or VOS.

To make an X.25 connection from AIX C-Kermit, you must:

  set x25 call-user-data xxxx

where xxxx can be any even-length string of hexadecimal digits, e.g. 123ABC.


2.9.2. HP-UX X.25

Although C-Kermit presently does not include built-in support for HP-UX X.25, it can still be used to make X.25 connections as follows: start Kermit and tell it to:

  set prefixing all
  set parity space
  pty padem address

This should work in HP-UX 9.00 and later (see Section 2.7). If you have an earlier HP-UX version, or the PTY interface doesn't work or isn't available, try:

  set prefixing all
  set parity space
  pipe padem address

Failing that, use Kermit to telnet to localhost and then after logging back in, start padem as you would normally do to connect over X.25.


2.10. Additional Serial Port Controls

C-Kermit 7.0 adds the following commands for greater control over serial ports. These commands are available only in C-Kermit versions whose underlying operating systems provide the corresponding services (such as POSIX and UNIX System V), and even then their successful operation depends on the capabilities of the specific device and driver.

SET DISCONNECT { ON, OFF }
On a SET LINE or SET PORT connection with SET CARRIER ON or AUTO, if the carrier signal drops during the connection, indicating that the connection has been lost, and C-Kermit notices it, this setting governs what happens next. With SET DISCONNECT OFF, which is consistent with previous behavior, and therefore the default, C-Kermit continues to keep the device open and allocated. With SET DISCONNECT ON, C-Kermit automatically closes and releases the device when it senses a carrier on-to-off transition, thus allowing others to use it. However, it remains the default device for i/o (DIAL, REDIAL, INPUT, SEND, CONNECT, etc), so if a subsequent i/o command is given, the device is reopened if it is still available. When it has been automatically closed in this manner, SHOW COMMUNICATIONS puts "(closed)" after its name, and in UNIX, the lockfile disappears -- both from SHOW COMM and from the lockfile directory itself. Synonym: SET CLOSE-ON-DISCONNECT.

SET EXIT ON-DISCONNECT { ON, OFF }
Like DISCONNECT, but makes the program exit if a connection drops.

Note that SET CLOSE-ON-DISCONNECT and SET EXIT ON-DISCONNECT apply only to connections that drop; they do not apply to connections that can't be made in the first place. For example, they have no effect when a SET LINE, SET HOST, TELNET, or DIAL command fails.

HANGUP
If [CLOSE-ON-]DISCONNECT is ON, and the HANGUP command is given on a serial device, and the carrier signal is no longer present after the HANGUP command, the device is closed and released.

SET PARITY HARDWARE { EVEN, ODD }
Unlike SET PARITY { EVEN, ODD, MARK, SPACE }, which selects 7 data bits plus the indicated kind of parity (to be done in software by Kermit itself), SET PARITY HARDWARE selects 8 data bits plus even or odd parity, to be done by the underlying hardware, operating system, or device driver. This command is effective only with a SET LINE or SET PORT device. That is, it has no effect in remote mode, nor on network connections. There is presently no method for selecting 8 data bits plus mark or space parity. If hardware parity is in effect, the variable \v(hwparity) is set to "even" or "odd". Note: some platforms might also support settings of SPACE, MARK, or NONE.

SET STOP-BITS { 1, 2 }
This tells the number of 1-bits to insert after an outbound character's data and parity bits, to separate it from the next character. Normally 1. Choosing 2 stop bits should do no harm, but will slow down serial transmission by approximately 10 percent. Historically, 2 stop bits were used with Teletypes (at 110 bps or below) for print-head recovery time. There is presently no method for choosing any number of stop bits besides 1 and 2.

SET SERIAL [ dps ]
dps stands for Data-bits, Parity, Stop-bits. This is the notation familiar to many people for serial port configuration: 7E1, 8N1, 7O2, etc. The data bits number also becomes the TERMINAL BYTESIZE setting. The second character is E for Even, O for Odd, M for Mark, S for Space, or N for None. The list of available options depends on the capabilities of the specific platform. If dps is omitted, 8N1 is used. Type "set serial ?" for a list of available choices. Examples:

SET SERIAL 7E1
Equivalent to SET PARITY EVEN, SET STOP-BITS 1, SET TERM BYTE 7.

SET SERIAL 8N1
Equivalent to SET PARITY NONE, SET STOP-BITS 1, SET TERM BYTE 8.

SET SERIAL 7E2
Equivalent to SET PARITY EVEN and SET STOP-BITS 2, SET TERM BYTE 7.

SET SERIAL 8E2
Same as SET PARITY HARDWARE EVEN, SET STOP-BITS 2, SET TERM BYTE 8.

SET SERIAL
Same as SET PARITY NONE and SET STOP-BITS 1, SET TERM BYTE 8.

Notes:

SHOW COMMUNICATIONS displays the current settings. Stop bits and hardware parity are shown only for SET PORT / SET LINE (serial) devices, since they do not apply to network connections or to remote mode. STOP-BITS is shown as "(default)" if you have not given an explicit SET STOP-BITS or SET SERIAL command.

The \v(serial) variable shows the SET SERIAL setting (8N1, 7E1, etc).


2.11. Getting Access to the Dialout Device

This section is for UNIX only; note the special words about QNX at the end. Also see Section 2.0 for SET LINE switches, particularly the /SHARE switch for VMS only.

C-Kermit does its best to obey the UUCP lockfile conventions of each platform (machine, operating system, OS version) where it runs, if that platform uses UUCP.

But simply obeying the conventions is often not good enough, due to the increasing likelihood that a particular serial device might have more than one name (e.g. /dev/tty00 and /dev/term/00 are the same device in Unixware 7; /dev/cua and /dev/cufa are the same device in NeXTSTEP), plus the increasingly widespread use of symlinks for device names, such as /dev/modem.

C-Kermit 7.0 goes to greater lengths than previous versions to successfully interlock with other communications program (and other instances of Kermit itself); for example, by:

See the ckuins.txt and ckubwr.txt files for details.

QNX is almost unique among UNIX varieties in having no UUCP programs nor UUCP-oriented dialout-device locking conventions. QNX does, however, allow a program to get the device open count. This can not be a reliable form of locking unless all applications do it (and they don't), so by default, Kermit uses this information only for printing a warning message such as:

  C-Kermit>set line /dev/ser1
  WARNING - "/dev/ser1" looks busy...

However, if you want to use it as a lock, you can do so with:

  SET QNX-PORT-LOCK { ON, OFF }

QNX-PORT-LOCK is OFF by default; if you set in ON, C-Kermit fails to open any dialout device when its open count indicates that another process has it open. SHOW COMM (in QNX only) displays the setting, and if you have a port open, it also shows the current open count (with C-Kermit's own access always counting as 1).


2.12. The Connection Log

C-Kermit 7.0 adds the ability to log connections, so you can see where you've been and have a record of calls you've made. A connection is defined as any communications session that is begun by SET LINE, SET PORT, DIAL, SET HOST, TELNET, or RLOGIN. Connections are not logged unless you request it; the command is:

LOG CX [ filename [ { NEW, APPEND } ] ]
Enables logging of connections in the given file. If the trailing { NEW, APPEND } keyword is omitted, the file is opened for appending; i.e. new records are written to the end. If NEW is specified, a new file is created; if a file of the same name already existed, it is overwritten. If the filename is omitted, CX.LOG in your home (login) directory is used (note: uppercase). To accept all defaults, just use "log connections" (or "l c" for short). Synonym: LOG CONNECTIONS.

CLOSE CX-LOG
This closes the connection log if it was open. (Note, the CLOSE CONNECTION command closes the connection itself).

SHOW CX
This shows your current connection, if any, including the elapsed time (since you opened it). Synonym: SHOW CONNECTION.

\v(cx_time)
This variable shows the elapsed time of your current connection, or if there is no current connection, of your most recent connection, of if there have been no connections, 0.

The connection contains one line per connection, of the form:

  yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss username pid p=v [ p=v [ ... ] ]

where the timestamp (in columns 1-18) shows when the connection was made; username is the login identity of the person who made the connection; pid is Kermit's process ID when it made the connection. The p's are parameters that depend on the type of connection, and the v's are their values:

  T = Connection Type (TCP, SERIAL, DIAL, DECNET, etc).
  H = The name of the Host from which the connection was made.
  N = Destination phone Number or Network host name or address.
  D = Serial connections only: Device name.
  O = Dialed calls only: Originating country code & area code if known.
  E = Elapsed time in hh:mm:ss format (or hhh:mm:ss, etc).

If you always want to keep a connection log, simply add:

  log connections

to your C-Kermit customization file. Note, however, that if you make a lot of connections, your CX.LOG will grow and grow. You can handle this by adding a "logrotate" procedure like the following to your customization file, before the "log connections" command:

  define LOGROTATE {                    ; Define LOGROTATE macro
      local \%i \%m \%d \%n \%f MAX
      def MAX 4                         ; How many months to keep
      if not def \%1 -                  ; No argument given
	end 1 \%0: No filename given
      if not = 1 \ffiles(\%1) -         ; Exactly 1 file must match
	end 1 \%0: \%1 - File not found
      .\%d := \fsubstr(\fdate(\%1),1,6) ; Arg OK - get file year & month
      if = \%d -                        ; Compare file year & month
        \fsubstr(\v(ndate),1,6) -       ; with current year & month
	  end 0                         ; Same year & month - done
      rename \%1 \%1.\%d                ; Different - rename file
      .\%n := \ffiles(\%1.*)            ; How many old files
      if < \%n \m(MAX) end 0            ; Not enough to rotate
      .\%m := \%1.999999                ; Initial compare string
      for \%i 1 \%n 1 {                 ; Loop thru old logs
	 .\%f := \fnextfile()           ; Get next file name
	 if llt \%f \%m .\%m := \%f     ; If this one older remember it
      }
      delete \%m                        ; Delete the oldest one
  }
  log connections                       ; Now open the (possibly new) log
  logrotate \v(home)CX.LOG              ; Run the LOGROTATE macro

As you can see, this compares the yyyymm portion of the modification date (\fdate()) of the given file (\%1) with the current yyyymm. If they differ, the current file has the yyyymm suffix (from its most recent modification date) appended to its name. Then we search through all other such files, find the oldest one, and delete it. Thus the current log, plus the logs from the most recent four months, are kept. This is all done automatically every time you start C-Kermit.

On multiuser systems, it is possible to keep a single, shared, system-wide connection log, but this is not recommended since (a) it requires you keep a publicly write-accessible logfile (a glaring target for mischief), and (b) it would require each user to log to that file and not disable logging. A better method for logging connections, in UNIX at least, is syslogging (see ckuins.txt Section 15 and Section 4.2 of the IKSD Administration Guide for details).


2.13. Automatic Connection-Specific Flow Control Selection

Beginning in C-Kermit 7.0, the appropriate flow-control method for each connection type is kept in a table, for example:

  Remote:           NONE
  Modem:            RTS/CTS
  Direct-Serial:    NONE
  TCPIP:            NONE

The size of the table and values for each connection type can vary from platform to platform. Type "set flow ?" for a list of available flow-control types.

The table is used to automatically select the appropriate kind of flow control whenever you make a connection. You can display the table with:

  SHOW FLOW-CONTROL

The defaults are as follows:

Remote:
NONE or XON/XOFF. This is because C-Kermit is not allowed to find out what type of connection the incoming user has (*). No kind of flow control will work on every kind of connection, including (unexpectedly) KEEP, which we would have liked to use, but not turning off flow control at the remote end during file transfer on TCP/IP connections is fatal to the transfer (except in VMS and HP-UX, where it must be set to Xon/Xoff!) Therefore if you are dialing in to a serial port on a server (UNIX or VMS) where C-Kermit is running, you will need to tell C-Kermit to "set flow keep" before transferring files (assuming the modem and port are configured correctly by the system administrator; otherwise you'll need to give a specific kind of flow control, e.g. "set flow xon/xoff"), so in this case C-Kermit will not disable flow control, as it must do when you are coming via Telnet (directly or through a terminal server, except on VMS and HP-UX).

Modem:
This applies when you dial out with a modem. In this case, the MODEM FLOW-CONTROL setting takes affect after the SET FLOW setting, so it can pick the most appropriate flow control for the combination of the particular modem and the computer/port/driver that is dialing.

Direct-Serial:
The default here is NONE because C-Kermit has no way of knowing what kind of flow control, if any, is or can be done by the device at the other end of the connection. RTS/CTS would be a bad choice here, because if the CTS signal is not asserted, the connection will hang. And since direct connections are often made with 3-wire cables, there is a good chance the CTS signal will not be received.

TCPIP:
NONE, since TCP and IP provide their own flow control transparently to the application, except in VMS, where Xon/Xoff is the default due to the requirements of the VMS TCP/IP products.

Other networks:
NONE, since networks should provide their flow control transparently to the application.

(*) This is possibly the worst feature of UNIX, VMS, and other platforms where C-Kermit runs. If C-Kermit was able to ask the operating system what kind of connection it had to the user, it could set up many things for you automatically.

You can modify the default-flow-control table with:

  SET FLOW-CONTROL /xxx { NONE, KEEP, RTS/CTS, XON/XOFF, ... }

where "xxx" is the connection type, e.g.

  SET FLOW /REMOTE NONE
  SET FLOW /DIRECT RTS/CTS

If you leave out the switch, SET FLOW works as before, choosing the flow control method to be used on the current connection:

  SET FLOW XON/XOFF

Thus, whenever you make a connection with SET PORT, SET LINE, DIAL, SET HOST, TELNET, RLOGIN, etc, an appropriate form of flow control is selected automatically. You can override the automatic selection with a subsequent SET FLOW command, such as SET FLOW NONE (no switch included).

The flow control is changed automatically too when you give a SET MODEM TYPE command. For example, suppose your operating system (say Linux) supports hardware flow control (RTS/CTS). Now suppose you give the following commands:

  set line /dev/ttyS2    ; Automatically sets flow to NONE
  set modem type usr     ; Automatically sets flow to RTS/CTS
  set modem type rolm    ; Doesn't support RTS/CTS so now flow is XON/XOFF

IMPORTANT: This new feature tends to make the order of SET LINE/HOST and SET FLOW commands matter, where it didn't before. For example, in VMS:

  SET FLOW KEEP
  SET LINE TTA0:

the SET LINE undoes the SET FLOW KEEP command; the sequence now must be:

  SET FLOW /DIRECT KEEP
  SET LINE TTA0:

or:

  SET LINE TTA0:
  SET FLOW KEEP


2.14. Trapping Connection Establishment and Loss

If you define a macro called ON_OPEN, it is executed any time that a SET LINE, SET PORT, SET HOST, TELNET, RLOGIN or similar command succeeds in opening a connection. The argument is the host or device name (as shown by SHOW COMMUNICATIONS, and the same as \v(line)). This macro can be used for all sorts of things, like automatically setting connection- or host-specific parameters when the connection is opened. Example:

  def ON_OPEN {
      switch \%1 {
        :abccorp.com, set reliable off, break
        :xyzcorp.com, set receive packet-length 1000, break
        etc etc...
      }
  }

If you define a macro called ON_CLOSE, it will be executed any time that a SET LINE, SET PORT, SET HOST, TELNET, RLOGIN or any other kind of connection that C-Kermit has made is closed, either by the remote or by a local CLOSE, HANGUP, or EXIT command or other local action, such as when a new connection is opened before an old one was explicitly closed.

As soon as C-Kermit notices the connection has been closed, the ON_CLOSE macro is invoked at (a) the top of the command parsing loop, or (b) when a connection is closed implicitly by a command such as SET LINE that closes any open connection prior to making a new connection, or (c) when C-Kermit closes an open connection in the act of exiting.

The ON_CLOSE macro was inspired by the neverending quest to unite Kermit and SSH. In this case using the "tunnel" mechanism:

  def TUNNEL {                                ; \%1 = host to tunnel to
      local \%p
      if not def \%1 stop 1
      assign tunnelhost \%1                   ; Make global copy
      undef on_close
      set macro error off
      close connection                        ; Ignore any error
      open !read tunnel start \%1
      read \%p                                ; Get port number
      if fail stop 1 Tunnel failure: \%1
      close read
      if fail stop 1 Tunnel failure: \%1      ; See Section 4.2.8.1
      assign on_close {                       ; Set up close handler
          echo Closing tunnel: \m(tunnelhost)
          !tunnel stop \m(tunnelhost)
          undef on_close
      }
      set host localhost:\%p /telnet
      if success end 0
      undef on_close
      stop 1 Connection failure: \%1
  }

In this case, when the connection stops, we also need to shut down the tunnel, even if it is at a later time after TUNNEL has finished executing. This way we can escape back, reconnect, transfer files, and so on until the connection is broken by logging out from the remote, or by explicitly closing it, or by EXITing from C-Kermit, at which time the tunnel is shut down.

When the connection is closed, no matter how, the ON_CLOSE macro executes and then undefines (destroys) itself, since we don't want to be closing tunnels in the future when we close subsequent connections.

Other such tricks can be imagined, including ending ON_CLOSE with a STOP command to force the command stack to be peeled all the way back to the top, for example in a deeply nested script that depends on the connection being open:

  def on_close { stop 1 CONNECTION LOST }

When C-Kermit invokes the ON_CLOSE macro, it supplies one argument (\%1): the reason the connection was closed as a number, one of the following:

  2 - Fatal failure to negotiate a required item on a network connection.
  1 - Closed by C-Kermit command.
  0 - All others (normally closed by remote).

which may be used for any purpose; for example, to add a comment to the connection log:

  def on_close {
      local \%m
      if not open cx end 0
      switch \%1 {
        :0, .\%m = Closed by remote, break
        :1, .\%m = Closed by me, break
        :2, .\%m = Network protocol negotiation failure, break
      }
      if def \%m writeln cx {# \%m}
  }


2.15. Contacting Web Servers with the HTTP Command

C-Kermit 7.0 (at this writing, the UNIX version only) supports direct contact and interaction with Web servers via HTTP 1.0 protocol. To make a connection, use Kermit's normal method for making a TCP/IP connection, but specify the HTTP port:

  SET HOST host http [ switches ]

where host is the IP hostname or address, and http is the name of the TCP port for the Web server. Relevant switches include:

/RAW
Treat the connection as a transparent binary pipe. This switch may be required if a port other than 'http' is used.

/SSL
Make an secure private connection with SSL (only if SSL support is included in your version of Kermit). In this case the port name might need to be https rather than http, e.g. "set host secureserver.xyxcorp.com https /ssl".

/TLS
Make an secure private connection with TLS (only if TLS support is included in your version of Kermit). In this case the port name would be https rather than http.

Then you can issue an HTTP command. In most cases, the server closes the connection when the command is complete. Example:

  SET HOST www.columbia.edu http
  IF FAIL EXIT 1 Can't contact server
  HTTP GET kermit/index.html

At this point the connection is closed, since that's how HTTP 1.0 works. If you want to perform additional operations, you must establish a new connection with another SET HOST command.

The HTTP command acts as a client to the Web server, except instead of displaying the results like a Web browser would, it stores them. Any HTTP command can (but need not) include any or all of the following switches:

/AGENT:user-agent
Identifies the client to the server; "C-Kermit" or "Kermit-95" by default.

/HEADER:header-line
Used for specifying any optional headers. A list of headers is provided using braces for grouping:

  /HEADER:{{tag:value}{tag:value}...}

For a listing of valid tag value and value formats see RFC 1945: Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.0. A maximum of eight headers may be specified.

/USER:name
In case a page requires a username for access.

/PASSWORD:password
In case a page requires a password for access.

/ARRAY:arrayname
Tells Kermit to store the response headers in the given array, one line per element. The array need not be declared in advance. Example:

  C-Kermit? http /array:c get kermit/index.html
  C-Kermit? show array c
  Dimension = 9
  1. Date: Fri, 26 Nov 1999 23:12:22 GMT
  2. Server: Apache/1.3.4 (Unix)
  3. Last-Modified: Mon, 06 Sep 1999 22:35:58 GMT
  4. ETag: "bc049-f72-37d441ce"
  5. Accept-Ranges: bytes
  6. Content-Length: 3954
  7. Connection: close
  8. Content-Type: text/html

As you can see, the header lines are like MIME e-mail header lines: identifier, colon, value. The /ARRAY switch is the only method available to a script to process the server responses for a POST or PUT command.

The HTTP commands are:

HTTP [ switches ] GET remote-filename [ local-filename ]
Retrieves the named file. If a local-filename is given, the file is stored locally under that name; otherwise it is stored with its own name.

HTTP [ switches ] HEAD remote-filename local-filename
Like GET except without actually getting the file; instead it gets only the headers, storing them into the given file, whose name must be given, one line per header item, as shown above in the /ARRAY: switch description.

HTTP [ switches ] INDEX remote-directory [ local-filename ]
Retrieves the file listing for the given server directory. NOTE: This command is not supported by most Web servers.

HTTP [ switches ] POST [ /MIME-TYPE:type ] local-file remote-file
Used to send a response as if it were sent from a form. The data to be posted must be read from a file.

HTTP [ switches ] PUT [ /MIME-TYPE:type ] local-file remote-file
Uploads a local file to a server file.

HTTP [ switches ] DELETE remote-filename
Instructs the server to delete the specified filename.


3. TERMINAL CONNECTION

3.1. CONNECT Command Switches

The following switches (see Section 1.5) were added to the CONNECT command in 7.0:

/QUIETLY
Don't print the "Connecting to..." or "Back at..." messages. CQ is an invisible command synonym for CONNECT /QUIETLY.

/TRIGGER:string
Specify a trigger or triggers (Section 3.2) effective for this CONNECT command only, temporarily overriding any current SET TERMINAL TRIGGER values (Section 3.2).

Note: Other switches might also be available; type "connect ?" for a list, "help connect" for a description of each.


3.2. Triggers

Triggers were added for UNIX, VMS, AOS/VS, and K95 in C-Kermit 7.0.

SET TERMINAL TRIGGER string
Tells C-Kermit to look for the given string during all subsequent CONNECT sessions, and if seen, to return to command mode automatically, as if you had escaped back manually. If the string includes any spaces, you must enclose it in braces. Example:

  set terminal trigger {NO CARRIER}

Comparisons are made after character-set translation.

If a string is to include a literal brace character, precede it with a backslash:

  ; My modem always makes this noise when the connection is lost:
  set terminal trigger |||ppp\{\{\{\{UUUUUUU

If you want Kermit to look for more than one string simultaneously, use the following syntax:

  set terminal trigger {{string1}{string2}...{stringn}}

In this case, C-Kermit will return to command mode automatically if any of the given strings is encountered. Up to 8 strings may be specified.

If the most recent return to command mode was caused by a trigger, the new variable, \v(trigger), shows the trigger value; otherwise \v(trigger) is empty.

The SHOW TRIGGER command displays the SET TERMINAL TRIGGER values as well as the \v(trigger) value.


3.3. Transparent Printing

As noted in the manual, C-Kermit's CONNECT command on UNIX is not a terminal emulator, but rather a "semitransparent pipe" between the terminal or emulator you are using to access C-Kermit, and the remote host to which C-Kermit is connected. The "semitransparent" qualifier is because of character-set translation as well as several actions taken by the emulator in response to the characters or strings that pass through it, such as APCs, Kermit packets (autodownload), triggers, etc.

The UNIX version of C-Kermit 7.0 adds another such action: Transparent printing, also called Controller printing (as distinct from Autoprint or line or screen print). It is intended mainly for use on UNIX workstation consoles (as opposed to remote logins), but with some care can also be used when accessing C-Kermit remotely.

Transparent printing is related to APC by sharing C-Kermit's built-in ANSI escape-sequence parser to detect "printer on" and "printer off" sequences from the host. When the printer-on sequence is received, all subsequent arriving characters -- including NUL, control characters, and escape sequences -- are sent to the SET PRINTER device instead of to your screen until the printer-off sequence is received, or you escape back, whichever happens first. These bytes are not translated or modified or filtered in any way by Kermit (except for possibly stripping of the 8th bit, as noted below), but if filtering or translation is desired, this can be accomplished by your SET PRINTER selection (e.g. by choosing a pipeline of filters).

By default, your SET PRINTER device is your default UNIX printer, but it can also be a file, a command, or the null device (which causes all printer material to be discarded). See Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed., p.41 for details.

Transparent printing is controlled by the command:

SET TERMINAL PRINT { ON, OFF }
When ON, transparent-print sequences are obeyed, and printing occurs on the system where C-Kermit is running. When OFF, transparent print sequences are ignored and passed through to your actual terminal or emulator, along with the data they enclose. OFF is the default, for compatibility with earlier C-Kermit releases. As noted in the manual, when the current SET PRINTER device is a file, transparent-print material is appended to it; the file is not overwritten.

SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE { 7, 8 }
SET PARITY { EVEN, ODD, MARK, SPACE, NONE }
If the terminal bytesize is 7, or PARITY is not NONE, the 8th bit of each byte is stripped prior to printing.

The transparent-print escape sequences are:

<ESC>[5i
Printer On. Send all subsequent incoming bytes to the printer without any kind of filtering, translation, or alteration. Note: <ESC> stands for ASCII character number 27 (decimal), Escape.

<ESC>[4i
Printer Off. Resume displaying incoming bytes on the screen.

These are the same sequences used by DEC VT100 and higher terminals and other ANSI X3.64 and ISO 6429 compatible terminals. There is no provision for selecting other printer-control sequences.

Restrictions:

  1. You must SET TERM TRANSPARENT-PRINT ON before you can use this feature.

  2. Only the 7-bit forms of the escape sequences are supported. The 8-bit CSI C1 control is not recognized.

  3. Autoprint is not supported, since this requires a full-fledged terminal emulator with direct access to the screen.

  4. The start-print and stop-print sequences pass through to the screen (there is no way to avoid this without causing unacceptable delays or deadlocks in CONNECT mode). Thus if your terminal or emulator also supports transparent printing via these same sequences, an empty file will be sent to its printer. Normally this has no effect.

Point (4) is similar to the situation with autodownload and APC -- when you have several Kermit clients in a chain, you should take care that these features are enabled in only one of them.

Example 1:

  set printer {|lpr -Plaser}  ; Specify the printer (if not default).
  set term print on           ; Enable transparent printing.
  set term byte 8             ; Enable 8-bit characters.
  connect                     ; Enter CONNECT mode.

Example 2:

  set printer /home/users/olga/printer.log  ; Send printer material to a file.

Example 3:

  set printer {| grep -v ^Received | lpr}   ; Filter out some lines

Then use "pcprint" or "vtprint" commands on the host to initiate transparent print operations. See Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed., p.406 for details.

Here is a sample "pcprint" shell script for UNIX:

  #!/bin/sh
  echo -n '<ESC>[5i'
  if [ $# -eq 0 ]; then
    cat
  else
    cat $*
  fi
  echo -n '<FF><ESC>[4i'
  # (end)

(Replace "<ESC>" by the actual ASCII Escape character and "<FF>" by the ASCII Formfeed character).

If you always want transparent printing enabled, put "set term print on" in your C-Kermit customization file (~/.mykermrc in UNIX). The "set term bytesize" selection, however, is a property of each separate connection.


3.4. Binary and Text Session Logs

C-Kermit 7.0 corrects an oversight in earlier releases, in which binary session logs (SET SESSION-LOG BINARY) translated character sets and performed various formatting transformations (e.g. "newline mode") before writing characters to the session log. In C-Kermit 7.0, binary-mode session logging writes characters as they come in, before anything (other that parity-bit stripping) is done to them. Text-mode session logging records the characters after processing.


4. FILE TRANSFER

Every file is transferred either in text mode (which implies record-format and character-set translation) or binary mode (in which each byte is sent literally without any kind of conversion). The mode in which a file is transferred is controlled by (a) the default mode, in the absence of any other indications; (b) the SET FILE TYPE command; (c) various automatic mechanisms based on client/server negotiations, directory information or filename patterns, etc.

The default FILE TYPE was changed from TEXT to BINARY in C-Kermit 7.0 because:


4.0. BUG FIXES, MINOR CHANGES, AND CLARIFICATIONS

4.0.0. Filenames with Spaces

Filenames that contain spaces are a major nuisance to a program like Kermit, whose command language is line- and word-oriented, in which words are separated by spaces and a filename is assumed to be a "word". In general (unless noted otherwise in the description of a particular command), there is only one way to refer to such files in Kermit commands, and that is to enclose the name in braces:

  send {this file}

Tells Kermit to send the file whose name is "this file" (two words, no quotes). Of course, various circumlocutions are also possible, such as:

  define \%a this file
  send \%a

BUT, perhaps contrary to expectation, you can't use "\32" to represent the space:

  send this\32file

does not work. Why? Because the Kermit parser, which must work on many operating systems including Windows, has no way of knowing what you mean by "this\32file". Do you mean a file whose name is "this file" in the current directory? Or do you mean a file whose name is "32file" in the "this" subdirectory of the current directory? Guessing won't do here; Kermit must behave consistently and deterministically in all cases on all platforms.

Note that you can't use Esc or Tab within {...} for filename completion, or question mark to get a filename list. However, you can include wildcards; for example:

  send {* *}

sends all files whose name contains a space.

All things considered, it is best to avoid spaces in file and directory names if you can. Also see Section 5.4 on this topic.


4.0.1. Packet out of Window

C-Kermit 6.0 could send packets "out of window" if the window size was greater than 1 and ACKs had arrived out of order. Fixed in 6.1.


4.0.2. MOVE after ADD SEND-LIST

ADD SEND-LIST followed by MOVE did not delete original files; fixed in 6.1. Carrier loss was not detected during transfer; in 7.0 C-Kermit checks for this (but results can not be guaranteed). In any case, the protocol will eventually time out if the connection is lost.


4.0.3. GET and RECEIVE As-Names

In 5A(190) through 6.0.192, the GET and RECEIVE as-name did not properly override the RECEIVE PATHNAMES setting. In 7.0 it does.


4.0.4. New Brief Statistics Listing

Version 7.0 adds a /BRIEF switch to the STATISTICS command, to display a short file-transfer statistics report. /BRIEF is now the default. Use /VERBOSE to see the full display, which is about 25 lines long.


4.0.5. Improved FAST Command

The preinstalled definition of the FAST macro did not take enough factors into account. Now it sets packet lengths and window sizes appropriate to the configuration. Furthermore, in IRIX only, it might restrict the SEND packet length to 4000, to work around a bug in the IRIX Telnet server, depending on the IRIX version (see ckubwr.txt, IRIX section). To see the built-in definition of the FAST macro, type "show macro fast". To change it, simply define it to be whatever you want -- it's just a macro, like any other.


4.0.6. The SET SEND BACKUP Command

Version 7.0 adds SET SEND BACKUP { ON, OFF }. This tells whether backup files should be sent. Backup files are the ones created by Kermit (and EMACS, and possibly other applications) to preserve old copies of files when creating new ones with the same name. Kermit does this when receiving a file and its FILE COLLISION setting is BACKUP (or RENAME, in which case it the new file gets the backup name). On most platforms, the backup name is formed by adding:

  .~n~

to the end of the filename, where "n" is a number. For example, if the original file is oofa.txt, a backup file might be called:

  oofa.txt.~1~

(or oofa.txt.~2~, etc). If you SET SEND BACKUP OFF, this tells Kermit not to send files that have backup names. Normally, SET SEND BACKUP is ON (as shown by SHOW PROTOCOL), and backup files are sent if their names match the SEND file specification.

Also see PURGE, SET FILE COLLISION, SEND /NOBACKUP, DIRECTORY /[NO]BACKUP.


4.0.7. The SET { SEND, RECEIVE } VERSION-NUMBERS Command

VMS Only. Normally when sending files, VMS C-Kermit strips the version number. For example, if the file is FOO.BAR;34, the name is sent as FOO.BAR (without the ";34"). If you want to keep version numbers on when sending files, use SET SEND VERSION-NUMBERS ON. The effect depends on the receiver.

Normally when receiving files, and an incoming filename includes a VMS-style version number (such as FOO.BAR;34) VMS C-Kermit strips it before trying to create the new file; this way the new file receives the next highest version number in the customary manner for VMS. If you want version numbers on incoming filenames to be used in creating the new files, use SET RECEIVE VERSION-NUMBERS ON.

Normally these commands would be effective only when VMS C-Kermit is exchanging files with a non-VMS Kermit program, since VMS-to-VMS transfers use labeled mode unless you have gone out of your way to defeat it.

Example: You want to send all versions of all files in the current directory from a VMS C-Kermit client to a UNIX C-Kermit server. Use:

  set send version-numbers on
  send *.*;*

The resulting Unix files will have VMS-style version numbers as part of their name, for example "foo.bar;1", "foo.bar;2", etc.

Now suppose you want to send these files from Unix to another VMS system and preserve the version numbers. Again we have a Unix C-Kermit server and VMS C-Kermit client. Give these commands to the client:

  set receive version-numbers on
  get *


4.0.8. The SET { SEND, RECEIVE } { MOVE-TO, RENAME-TO } Commands

These commands are persistent global versions of the /MOVE-TO: and /RENAME-TO: switches of the SEND, GET, and RECEIVE commands. They should normally be used only when setting up a dedicated transaction-processing application, in which each file is to be moved or renamed immediately after, and only if, it is transferred successfully, so that (for example) an independent, concurrent process can notice when new files appear and process them immediately without having to guess whether they are complete.


4.0.9. SET FILE INCOMPLETE AUTO

SET FILE INCOMPLETE { KEEP, DISCARD }, which tells whether to keep or discard incompletely received files, has a new option, AUTO, which is also the default. It means KEEP the incomplete file if the transfer is in binary mode, otherwise DISCARD it. This reduces the chances that a subsequent recovery operation (RESEND, REGET, etc) could produce a corrupt file, since recovery works only for binary-mode transfers.


4.1. FILE-TRANSFER FILENAME TEMPLATES

File-transfer filename templates allow files to be renamed automatically by the file sender, the receiver, or both, during transfer of groups of files.

4.1.1. Templates in the As-Name

Prior to C-Kermit 6.1 and Kermit 95 1.1.12 the only options that could be used to affect the names of files being transferred were SET FILENAMES { LITERAL, CONVERTED } and SET { SEND, RECEIVE } PATHNAMES { ON, OFF }, plus the "as-name" feature of the SEND (MOVE, etc) and RECEIVE commands.

Previously, the as-name could be used only for a single file. For example:

  SEND FOO BAR

would send the file FOO under the name BAR, but:

  SEND *.TXT anything

was not allowed, since it would give the same name to each file that was sent. When receiving:

  RECEIVE FOO

would rename the first incoming file to FOO before storing it on the disk, but subsequent files would not be renamed to FOO, since this would result in overwriting the same file repeatedly. Instead, they were stored under the names they arrived with.

Beginning in C-Kermit 6.1 and Kermit 95 1.1.12, it is possible to specify as-names in SEND, RECEIVE, and related commands even for file groups. This is accomplished by using replacement variables in the as-name, along with optional material such character-string functions and/or constant strings. An as-name containing replacement variables is called a filename template.

The key to filename templates is the new variable:

  \v(filename)

During file transfer it is replaced by the name of each file currently being transferred (after transfer, it is the name of the last file transferred).

So, for example:

  send *.txt \v(filename).new

sends each file with its own name, but with ".new" appended to it. Of course if the name already contains periods, this could confuse the file receiver, so you can also achieve fancier effects with constructions like:

  send *.txt \freplace(\v(filename),.,_).new

which replaces all periods in the original filename by underscores, and then appends ".new" to the result. So, for example, oofa.txt would be sent as oofa_txt.new.

Another new variable that is useful in this regard is \v(filenumber), which is the ordinal number of the current file in the file group, so you can also:

  send *.txt FILE\flpad(\v(filenum),2,0)

resulting in a series of files called FILE00, FILE01, FILE02, etc. (At the end of the transfer, \v(filenum) tells the number of files that were transferred).

If you specify a constant as-name when sending a file group:

  send *.txt thisnameonly

Kermit complains and asks you to include replacement variables in the as-name. You should generally use \v(filename) or \v(filenumber) for this purpose, since other variables (with the possible exception of date/time related variables) do not change from one file to the next. But Kermit accepts any as-name at all that contains any kind of variables for file group, even if the variable will not change. So:

  send *.txt \%a

is accepted, but all files are sent with the same name (the value of \%a, if it has one and it is constant). If the variable has no value at all, the files are sent under their own names.

Of course, the value of \%a in the previous example need not be constant:

  define \%a FILE\flpad(\v(filenum),2,0)_at_\v(time)
  send *.txt \%a

The RECEIVE command, when given without an as-name, behaves as always, storing all incoming files under the names they arrive with, subject to SET FILE NAME and SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES modifications (Section 4.10).

However, when an as-name is given in the RECEIVE command, it is applied to all incoming files rather than to just the first. If it does not contain replacement variables, then the current FILE COLLISION setting governs the result. For example:

  receive foo

will result in incoming files named foo, foo.~1~, foo.~2~, and so on, with the default FILE COLLISION setting of BACKUP. If it does contain replacement variables, of course they are used.

When receiving files, the \v(filename) variable refers to the name that was received in the incoming file-header packet, BEFORE any processing by SET FILE NAMES or SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES. Since the filenames in file-header packets are usually in uppercase, you would need to convert them explicitly if you want them in lowercase, e.g.:

  receive \flower(\v(filename)).new


4.1.2. Templates on the Command Line

On the command-line, use templates as shown above as the -a option argument, bearing in mind the propensity of UNIX and perhaps other shells to treat backslash as a shell escape character. So in UNIX (for example):

  kermit -s oofa.* -a x.\\v(filenum)

By the way, this represents a change from 6.0 and earlier releases in which the as-name (-a argument or otherwise) was not evaluated by the command parser. Thus, for example, in VMS (where the shell does not care about backslashes), it was possible to:

  kermit -s oofa.txt -a c:\tmp\oofa.txt

Now backslashes in the as-name must be quoted not only for the shell (if necessary) but also for Kermit itself:

  kermit -s oofa.txt -a c:\\tmp\\oofa.txt      ; Kermit only
  kermit -s oofa.txt -a c:\\\\tmp\\\\oofa.txt  ; Shell and Kermit

You can also use the \fliteral() function for this:

  kermit -s oofa.txt -a \fliteral(c:\tmp\oofa.txt)      ; Kermit only
  kermit -s oofa.txt -a \\fliteral(c:\\tmp\\oofa.txt)   ; Shell and Kermit


4.1.3. Post-Transfer Renaming

Filename templates are now also useful in SET { SEND, RECEIVE } RENAME-TO and in the /RENAME-TO: switch, that can be given to the SEND, GET, or RECEIVE commands; this is similar to an as-name, but is effective on a per-file basis if and only if the file was transferred successfully.

MOVE-TO and RENAME-TO address a requirement commonly stated for transaction processing and similar systems. Suppose, for example, a central system "X" accepts connections from multiple clients simultaneously; a process on X waits for a file to appear and then processes the file. This process must have a way of knowing when the file has been completely and successfully transferred before it starts to process it. This can be accomplished easily using C-Kermit's SET { SEND, RECEIVE } { MOVE-TO, RENAME-TO } command or /MOVE-TO: or /RENAME-TO: switches, described in Sections 4.7.1 through 4.7.3.

Here's an example for the client side, in which files to be sent are placed in a certain directory (/usr/olga/tosend in this example) by another process when they are ready to go. This might be in a hospital or big doctor's office, where medical insurance claims are entered at a number of workstations, and then deposited in the "tosend" directory, from which they are sent to a claims clearinghouse. We assume the connection is already made and a Kermit server is on the other end.

  local srcdir findir              ; Declare local (automatic) variables
  assign srcdir /usr/olga/tosend   ; Local source directory (files to send)
  assign findir /usr/olga/sent     ; Where to move files after they are sent
  log transactions                 ; Keep a log of transfers
  cd \m(srcdir)                    ; Change to the source directory
  while true {                     ; Loop forever...
      send /move-to:\m(findir) *   ; Send all files
      sleep 60                     ; Sleep a minute
  }                                ; Go back and do it again

Note how simple this is. Once each file is sent, it is moved so it won't be sent again (you could also use SEND /RENAME-TO: or even SEND /DELETE). If a transfer fails, the file is not moved and so we try again to send it next time around. If there are no files to send, the SEND command does nothing but a message is printed; you can avoid the message by checking first to see if any files are in the directory:

  while true {                     ; Loop forever...
      if > \ffiles(*) 0 -          ; If there are any files
        send /move-to:\m(findir) * ; send them.
      sleep 60                     ; Sleep a minute.
  }                                ; Go back and do it again.

It's even simpler on the server side (here again we assume the connection is already in place):

  local rcvdir findir              ; Declare local (automatic) variables
  assign rcvdir /usr/ivan/tmp      ; Temporary receiving directory
  assign findir /usr/ivan/new      ; Where to move files after reception
  log transactions                 ; Keep a log of transfers
  cd \m(rcvdir)                    ; Change to the source directory
  set receive move-to \m(findir)   ; Declare move-to directory.
  server                           ; Enter server mode.

A separate process (e.g. the medical claim-form decoder) can look for files appearing in the /usr/ivan/new directory and process them with every confidence that they have been completely received.

Note that the use of MOVE-TO can result in moved files overwriting one another (the application would normally avoid this by assigning each transaction a unique, e.g. based on customer number and claim number). But if filename collisions are a possibility in your application, RENAME-TO might be a better choice; you can use any variables you like in the template to ensure uniqueness of the RENAME-TO filename; for example:

  SET RECEIVE RENAME-TO \v(filename)_\v(ndate)_\v(ntime)_\v(userid)_\v(pid)


4.2. FILE-TRANSFER PIPES AND FILTERS

4.2.1. INTRODUCTION

Beginning in C-Kermit 6.1 and Kermit 95 1.1.12, it is possible to send from a command, or "pipe", as well as from a file, and to receive to a pipe or command. In a typical example, we might want to transfer an entire directory tree from one UNIX system to another (but without using the methods described in Sections 4.3 , 4.10, 4.11, and 4.15). We could do this in multiple steps as follows:

  1. Create a tar archive of the desired directory tree
  2. Compress the tar archive
  3. Transfer it in binary mode to the other computer
  4. Decompress it
  5. Extract the directory tree from the tar archive

But this is inconvenient and it requires a temporary file, which might be larger than we have room for.

The new pipe-transfer feature lets you do such things in a single step, and without intermediate files.

Additional new features, also discussed here, let you specify pre- and post- processing filters for outbound and incoming files, and give you a way to insert the output from shell or system commands into C-Kermit commands.

The file-transfer related features are available only with Kermit protocol, not with any external protocols, nor with K95's built-in XYZMODEM protocols (because XYZMODEM recovers from transmission errors by rewinding the source file, and you can't rewind a pipe).

This section begins by discussing the simple and straightforward use of these features in UNIX, in which pipes and input/output redirection are a fundamental component and therefore "just work", and then goes on to discuss their operation in Windows and OS/2, where matters are much more complicated.


4.2.1.1. TERMINOLOGY

Standard Input
This is a precise technical term denoting the normal source of input for a command or program, which is the keyboard of your terminal by default, but which can be redirected to a file or pipe.

Stdin
Abbreviation for Standard Input.

Standard Output
A precise technical term denoting the normal destination for output from a command or program, which is your terminal screen by default, but which can be redirected to a file.

Stdout
Abbreviation for Standard Output.

Stdio
Abbreviation for Standard Input / Standard Output.

I/O
Abbreviation for Input / Output.

Shell
Text-based system command processor, such as the UNIX shell, DOS COMMAND.COM, etc.

Pipe
A mechanism by which the standard output of one program is sent to the standard input of another.

Pipeline
A series of programs connected by pipes.


4.2.1.2. NOTATION

In command descriptions, "command" is replaced by a shell or system command or pipeline. The command names specified in these commands are interpreted by your shell, just as if you were typing them at the shell prompt, and so if they are in your PATH, they will be found in the expected manner. Therefore you don't have to specify complete pathnames for commands that are programs (but it shouldn't hurt if you do).

The normal notation for I/O redirection is as follows:

  <  Read Stdin from the given file.
  >  Send Stdout to the given file.
  |  Send Stdout from the command on the left to the command on the right.

Examples:

sort < foo > bar
Sorts the lines in file "foo" and writes the results to file "bar"

grep -c "some text" *.txt | grep -v ":0" | sort | pr -3 | lpr
This is a command pipeline composed of 5 commands:

grep -c "some text" *.txt
Looks in all files whose names end with ".txt" for the string "some text" and writes to Stdout the names of each file followed by a colon and the number of occurrences in each.

grep -v ":0"
Prints to Stdout the lines from Stdin that do NOT contain the string ":0", in this case, it removes the names of files that do not contain "some text".

sort
Sorts the lines from Stdin alphabetically to Stdout.

pr -3
Arranges the lines from Stdin in three columns.

lpr
Prints its Stdin on the default printer.

Note that the Kermit features described here work only with commands that use Stdio. If you attempt to use them with commands whose input and output can not be redirected, Kermit will most likely get stuck. Kermit has no way of telling how an external command works, nor what the syntax of the shell is, so it's up to you to make sure you use these features only with redirectable commands.

The quoting rules of your shell apply to the command. Thus in UNIX, where C-Kermit tries to use your preferred shell for running commands, shell "metacharacters" within commands must be escaped if they are to be taken literally, using the methods normal for your shell. For example, the UNIX tr (translate) command must have its arguments in quotes:

  tr "[a-z]" "[A-Z]"

otherwise the shell is likely to replace them by all filenames that match, which is probably not what you want. This is also true when using your shell directly, and has nothing to do with Kermit.


4.2.1.3. SECURITY

Some sites might not wish to allow access to system commands or external programs from within Kermit. Such access, including all the features described here, can be disabled in various ways:

  1. When building from source code, include -DNOPUSH among the CFLAGS.
  2. At runtime, give the NOPUSH command.
  3. For server mode, give the DISABLE HOST command.
  4. Implicit use of pipes can be disabled as described in Section 4.2.4.

Note: 3 and 4 are not necessary if you have done 1 or 2.


4.2.2. Commands for Transferring from and to Pipes

SEND /COMMAND sends data from a command or command pipeline, and RECEIVE /COMMENT writes data to a command or pipeline. The GET /COMMAND command asks a server to send material, and then writes the incoming material to a command or pipeline. These features, along with switches (like "/COMMAND", described in Section 4.7) are new to C-Kermit 6.1. The following synonyms are also provided:

  CSEND    = SEND /COMMAND
  CRECEIVE = RECEIVE /COMMAND
  CGET     = GET /COMMAND

None of these commands can be used if a SEND or RECEIVE FILTER (respectively, Section 4.2.3) is in effect, or if a NOPUSH command (Section 4.2.1.3) has been given, or if the current protocol is not Kermit.


4.2.2.1. Sending from a Command

SEND /COMMAND command [ as-name ]
SEND /AS-NAME:as-name /COMMAND command
CSEND command [ as-name ]
These three forms are the same. They work like the SEND command, but instead of sending a file, it sends the standard output of the given command, either under the command's own name, or else with the given as-name. If the command contains spaces, it must be enclosed in braces. Braces should also be used for the as-name if it contains spaces. If braces are included around either the command or the as-name, they are removed after parsing but before use. As with SEND, the transfer is in text or binary mode according the current FILE TYPE setting, unless you override the global transfer mode by including a /TEXT or /BINARY switch. The command must require no input.

When sending from a command or pipeline, C-Kermit has no way of knowing in advance how much data will be sent, and so it can not send the size to the other Kermit in the Attribute packet, and so the receiving Kermit has no way of displaying "percent done" or a progress bar (thermometer).

Examples that make sense in text mode (illustrated by common UNIX commands):

SEND /COMMAND finger
CSEND finger
sends the current "finger" listing (who's logged in) under the name "finger". The two forms "send /command" and "csend" are equivalent; we won't bother showing them both in the rest of the examples.

SEND /COMMAND:{finger}
CSEND {finger}
Same as previous example (braces are removed from "{finger}").

SEND /COMMAND:{ finger }
CSEND { finger }
Same as previous example, but note that the spaces are kept. This does not prevent the shell from running the "finger" program, but its output is sent under the name " finger " (with a leading and trailing space).

SEND /COMMAND:finger /AS-NAME:userlist
CSEND finger userlist
sends the current finger listing under the name "userlist".

SEND /COMMAND:{finger | sort -r} /AS-NAME:userlist
CSEND {finger | sort -r} userlist
sends the current finger listing, sorted in reverse order, under the name "userlist". The braces are needed to distinguish the command from the as-name.

SEND /COMMAND:{finger | sort -r} /AS-NAME:{userlist}
CSEND {finger | sort -r} {userlist}
Same as previous example (braces are removed from "{userlist}").

SEND /COMMAND:{finger | sort -r} /AS-NAME:{\freplace(\v(filename),\32,_)}
CSEND {finger | sort -r} {\freplace(\v(filename),\32,_)}
Like the previous example, but sends the output of the command under the name of the command, but with all spaces (\32) replaced by underscores, so the as-name is "finger_|_sort_-r".

Examples that make sense in binary mode (three equivalent forms are shown):

SEND /COMMAND /BINARY {tar cf - . | gzip -c} mydir.tar.gz
SEND /COMMAND /BINARY /AS-NAME:mydir.tar.gz {tar cf - . | gzip -c}
CSEND /BINARY {tar cf - . | gzip -c} mydir.tar.gz
Makes a tar archive of the current directory, compresses it with the GNU gzip program, and sends it as "mydir.tar.gz". The other Kermit can, of course, just store it as a file, or it can use CRECEIVE to uncompress and dearchive it as part of the transfer process.

When using a "pipeline" of commands in the command field, obviously, the first command must not require any input, and the last command should produce some output, and all intermediate commands should get some input and produce some output.


4.2.2.2. Receiving to a Command

RECEIVE /COMMAND command
CRECEIVE command
This is like RECEIVE, except incoming material is written to the standard input of the given command, in text or binary mode according to the normal rules for file reception. Be sure to include a redirector to a file (if the command normally writes to standard output), or the output of the command won't go anywhere. The command may contain spaces; braces are not needed, but they are removed if used.

WARNING: C-Kermit has no way of knowing anything about the command, or even whether it is a command. Thus this command will always cause C-Kermit to enter protocol mode, as long as some text is specified in the command field. However, if the text does not correspond to a command, the transfer will eventually fail with a message such as "Error writing data" or "Failure to close file".

Examples for text mode (in UNIX):

RECEIVE /COMMAND sort -r > reverse.txt
CRECEIVE sort -r > reverse.txt
The text that is received is sorted in reverse order and stored in the file "reverse.txt". The two forms shown are equivalent.

RECEIVE /COMMAND {sort -r > reverse.txt}
CRECEIVE {sort -r > reverse.txt}
The same as the previous example; if braces are included, they are simply removed.

RECEIVE /COMMAND {sort -r > \flower(\v(filename)).reverse}
CRECEIVE {sort -r > \flower(\v(filename)).reverse}
Same but stores result under the incoming filename, lowercased, and with ".reverse" appended to it.

RECEIVE /COMMAND sort
CRECEIVE sort
Does nothing useful, since the output of sort has nowhere to go.

RECEIVE /COMMAND sort -r | pr -3 | lpr -Plaserjet
CRECEIVE sort -r | pr -3 | lpr -Plaserjet
The text that is received is sorted in reverse order, arranged into three columns, and sent to the "laserjet" printer.

Examples for binary mode:

RECEIVE /COMMAND:{gunzip -c | tar xf -}
CRECEIVE {gunzip -c | tar xf -}
Assuming the data that is received is a compressed tar archive, uncompresses the archive and passes it to tar for extraction. In this case the braces are needed because otherwise the final "-" would be taken as a command continuation character (see Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition, p.33).

GET /COMMAND remote-file command
GET /COMMAND /AS-NAME:command remote-file
CGET remote-file command
This command tells the Kermit client to send a GET request for the given remote file to a Kermit server. Unlike GET, however, the incoming material is written to a command, rather than to a file. If the remote-file or the command contain spaces, they must be enclosed in braces. The same cautions about the command apply as for CRECEIVE.

Examples (for UNIX):

GET /COMMAND oofa.txt sort -r > oofa.new
GET /COMMAND {oofa.txt} {sort -r > oofa.new}
CGET oofa.txt sort -r > oofa.new
CGET {oofa.txt} {sort -r > oofa.new}
These four are equivalent. Each of them requests the server to send its "oofa.txt" file, and as it arrives, it is sorted in reverse order and written to "oofa.new".

GET /COMMAND {profile exec a} lpr
GET /COMMAND {profile exec a} {lpr}
GET /COMMAND /AS-NAME:lpr {profile exec a}
GET /COMMAND /AS-NAME:{lpr} {profile exec a}
GET /COMMAND /AS:lpr {profile exec a}
CGET {profile exec a} lpr
CGET {profile exec a} {lpr}
Here the remote filename contains spaces so it MUST be enclosed in braces. As it arrives it is sent to the lpr program for printing. Braces are optional around "lpr" since it contains no spaces.

GET /COMMAND *.txt {cat >> new.txt}
GET /AS-NAME:{cat >> new.txt} /COMMAND *.txt
CGET *.txt {cat >> new.txt}
This gets all the ".txt" files from the server and concatenates them all into a single "new.txt" file on the client.

GET /COMMAND *.txt {echo \v(filename)>>new.txt;cat>>new.txt}
CGET *.txt {echo \v(filename)>>new.txt;cat>>new.txt}
As above, but inserts each file's name before its contents.


4.2.3. Using File-Transfer Filters

The commands described in Section 4.2.2 let you send the output of a command, or receive data into a command. But what if you want to specify preprocessing for files that you send, or postprocessing of files that you receive, even when multiple files are involved? For this you need a way to specify send and receive filters. The commands are SET SEND FILTER and SET RECEIVE FILTER; SHOW PROTOCOL displays the current settings.

4.2.3.1. The SEND Filter

SET SEND FILTER [ command ]
This command specifies a command to be run on any file that you SEND (or MOVE, MSEND, etc). It also applies to files sent when in server mode, in response to GET commands, but not to the results of REMOTE commands like REMOTE DIRECTORY, REMOTE TYPE, REMOTE HOST, etc. The command may be, but need not be, enclosed in braces; if it is, the braces are stripped before use. The output of this command is sent, rather than the file itself. The current FILE TYPE setting (TEXT or BINARY) applies to the output of the command. The command must contain at least one instance of \v(filename), for which the name of the actual file is substituted. If the command is omitted, the send filter is removed and files are sent in the normal manner.

The SET SEND FILTER sets up a "global" filter -- that is, one that applies to all subsequent file-sending commands until you change or remove it. You can also specify a "local" filter to be used in a specific file-sending command by using the /FILTER switch (see Section 1.5); for example:

  SEND /FILTER:command [ other-switches ] filename

Besides \v(filename), you can include any other script programming notation in the send filter: variable names, array references, calls to built-in string or other functions, and so on. These are evaluated during file transfer, NOT during parsing, and they are evaluated separately for each file.

When the SEND or MOVE (SEND /DELETE) command is used with a send filter, the output from the filter is sent under the file's original name unless you specify an "as-name" or template. The Attribute packet (if any) contains the original file's attributes (size, creation date, etc). So (for example) if the filter changes the file's size, the progress thermometer might be wrong. (We can't send the size of the output from the filter, because it is not known until the transfer is finished.) If you prefer that the size not be sent, use "set attributes size off".

You can not use send filters with RESEND (SEND /RECOVER) or PSEND (SEND /START).

Examples for text mode:

SET SEND FILTER sort -r \v(filename) ; Braces may be omitted
SET SEND FILTER {sort -r \v(filename)} ; Braces may be included
SEND *.txt
This sends every file in the current directory whose name ends with ".txt" under its own name, but with its lines sorted in reverse order.

SEND /FILTER:{sort -r \v(filename)} *.txt
Same as above, but the filter applies only to this SEND command. Braces are required in this case.

SET SEND FILTER {sort -r \v(filename)}
SEND oofa.txt reverse.txt
Sends the oofa.txt file with its lines sorted in reverse order under the name "reverse.txt".

SET SEND FILTER {sort -r \v(filename)}
SEND oofa.* \v(filename).reverse
Sends all the oofa.* files with their lines sorted in reverse order; each file is sent under its own name but with ".reverse" appended to it.

SET SEND FILTER {tr "[a-z]" "[A-Z]" < \v(filename)}
SEND *.txt
Sends all ".txt" files under their own names, but uppercasing their contents.

Note that the SEND FILTER applies not only to files that are sent with SEND, MOVE, MSEND, etc, but also to files sent by the C-Kermit server in response to GET requests.

Examples for binary mode:

SET SEND FILTER {gzip -c \v(filename)}
SEND /BINARY oofa.txt oofa.txt.gz
Sends the oofa.txt file, compressed by gzip, as oofa.txt.gz.

SEND /BINARY /FILTER:{gzip -c \v(filename)} oofa.txt oofa.txt.gz
As above, but the filter applies only to this SEND command.

SET SEND FILTER {gzip -c \v(filename)}
SEND /BINARY oofa.* \fupper(\replace(\v(filename),.,_)).GZ
Sends all the oofa.* files, compressed by gzip, each under its own name, but with the name uppercased, all periods within the name converted to underscores, and ".GZ" appended to it. So, for example, "oofa.txt" is sent as "OOFA_TXT.GZ".

In the gzip examples, note that the amount of data that is sent is normally less than the original file size because gzip compresses the file. But Kermit sends the original file size ahead in the attribute packet anyway (unless you tell it not too). Thus the transfer will probably appear to terminate early, e.g. when the receiver's file-transfer display thermometer is only at 40%. If this annoys you, tell Kermit to "set attribute length off". On the other hand, you can use the final position of the thermometer as a measure of the effectiveness of compression.


4.2.3.2. The RECEIVE Filter

SET RECEIVE FILTER [ command ]
This command specifies that the given command will be run on any file that is received before it is written to disk. The command may be, but need not be, enclosed in braces; if it is the braces are stripped before use. The following two commands are equivalent:

  SET RECEIVE FILTER sort -r > \v(filename)
  SET RECEIVE FILTER {sort -r > \v(filename)}

The RECEIVE filter command may contain a "\v(filename)" sequence to be replaced by the incoming filename from the file header packet, but it is not required. However you must use it whenever your filter would normally write to Stdout, otherwise its output will be lost.

The RECEIVE filter command may contain one or more "\v(filename)" sequence to be replaced by the incoming filename from the file header packet, but it is not required. However you must use it whenever your filter would normally write to Stdout, otherwise its output will be lost.

RECEIVE /FILTER:command and GET /FILTER:command can also be used to specify a filter to be used for only one file-transfer operation.

UNIX examples for text mode:

SET RECEIVE FILTER lpr
RECEIVE
All the files that are received are sent to the default UNIX print spooler.

RECEIVE /FILTER:lpr
Same as above, except the lpr filter is used only with this RECEIVE command.

RECEIVE lpr
This is probably not what you want; it creates a file called lpr.

SET RECEIVE FILTER {sort -r > \v(filename)}
RECEIVE
Stores each incoming file with its lines sorted in reverse order, under its own name.

RECEIVE /FILTER:{sort -r > \v(filename)}
As above, but the filter is used only for this RECEIVE command.

SET RECEIVE FILTER sort -r > \v(filename)
RECEIVE reverse.txt
Stores each incoming file with its lines sorted in reverse order, under the name "reverse.txt". The actual result depends on the FILE COLLISION setting. If it is OVERWRITE and multiple files arrive, then each incoming file destroys the previous one. If it is BACKUP (the default), filename conflicts are resolve by adding "version numbers" to the filenames: reverse.txt, reverse.txt.~1~, reverse.txt.~2~, etc.

SET RECEIVE FILTER sort -r > \v(filename)
RECEIVE \v(filename).reverse
Stores each incoming file with its lines sorted in reverse order, under the name it arrived with, but with ".reverse" appended to it.

SET RECEIVE FILTER sort -r > \v(filename)
RECEIVE \flower(\v(filename)).reverse
Like the previous example, but ensures that the filename is lowercase.

Examples for binary mode:

SET RECEIVE FILTER gunzip -c > \v(filename)
RECEIVE
This receives one or more presumably compressed file and uncompresses each one into a file having the same name it was sent with. For example, if the file is sent with the name OOFA.TXT.GZ, it is stored with that name, even after decompression.

SET RECEIVE FILTER gunzip -c > \v(filename)
RECEIVE \flower(\fsubstring(\v(filename),1,\flength(\v(filename))-3))
Like the previous example, but the resulting filename has its rightmost three characters removed from it and the remainder is lowercased. So if the incoming filename is OOFA.TXT.GZ, it is stored as oofa.txt after decompression.

Of course you don't want to type such long hideous commands, so we have also introduced several new functions:

\fstripx(string[,character])
This function removes the rightmost segment of the string that starts with the given character. If no character is given, period (.) is used. Thus it is most conveniently used for stripping the extension from a filename (or the decimal portion from a floating-point number written in US/UK style). Examples:

   \fstripx(OOFA.TXT.GZ)             => OOFA.TXT
   \fstripx(OOFA.TXT.GZ,.)           => OOFA.TXT
   \fstripx(OOFA.TXT.GZ,X)           => OOFA.T
   \fstripx(\fstripx(OOFA.TXT.GZ))   => OOFA
   \fstripx($100.00)                 => $100

\fstripn(string,number)
Removes the rightmost number characters from the string. Examples:

   \fstripn(OOFA.TXT.GZ)             => OOFA.TXT.GZ
   \fstripn(OOFA.TXT.GZ,3)           => OOFA.TXT
   \fstripn(OOFA.TXT.GZ,7)           => OOFA

\fstripb(string[,c1[,c2]])
Strips enclosing matching braces, brackets, parentheses, or quotes from the string. The second argument, c1, specifies which kind of enclosure to look for; if not specified, any enclosing (), [], <>, {}, "", '', or `' are removed. If c1 is specified and c2 is not, then if c1 is an opening brace, bracket, or parenthesis, the matching closing one is supplied automatically as c2. If both c1 and c2 are specified, then to be stripped the string must begin with c1 and end with c2. If the string is not enclosed in the indicated manner, the result is the original string. Examples:

   \fstripb("abc")                   => abc
   \fstripb([abc])                   => abc
   \fstripb([abc)                    => [abc
   \fstripb(<abc>)                   => abc
   \fstripb(<abc>,[)                 => <abc>
   \fstripb((abc))                   => abc
   \fstripb((abc),[)                 => (abc)
   \fstripb((abc),{(})               => abc
   \fstripb(+abc+)                   => +abc+
   \fstripb(+abc+,+)                 => abc
   \fstripb(+abc+,+,^)               => +abc+
   \fstripb(+abc^,+,^)               => abc
   \fstripb('abc')                   => abc
   \fstripb(`abc')                   => abc
   \fstripb(``abc'')                 => `abc'
   \fstripb(\fstripb(``abc''))       => abc

Notice the special syntax required for including a literal parenthesis in the argument list. As the last two examples illustrate, \fstripb() strips only one level at at a time; nesting can be used to strip a small fixed number of levels; loops can be used to strip larger or indeterminate numbers of levels.

\flop(string[,char])
Removes the leftmost segment of the string that ends with the given character. If no character is given, period (.) is used. Examples:

  \flop(OOFA.TXT.GZ)               => TXT.GZ
  \flop(OOFA.TXT.GZ,.)             => TXT.GZ
  \flop(OOFA.TXT.GZ,X)             => T.GZ

To remove the leftmost number characters, just use \fsubstring(s,number+1). To return the rightmost number characters, use \fright(s,number).

So the hideous example:

  receive \flower(\fsubstring(\v(filename),1,\flength(\v(filename))-3))

can now be written as:

  receive \flower(\fstripx(\v(filename)))

That is, the filename stripped of its extension and then lowercased. This is not only shorter and less hideous, but also does not depend on the length of the extension being 3.

Note that when a receive filter is in effect, this overrides your FILE COLLISION setting, since Kermit has no way of knowing what the final destination filename will be (because it does not know, and can not be expected to know, the syntax of every version of every command shell on every platform on the planet).


4.2.4. Implicit Use of Pipes

If you wish, C-Kermit can also examine incoming filenames to see if they start with "!", and if so, the subsequent text is treated as a command to read from or write to. For example, if a Kermit client is given the following command:

  get {!finger | sort}

the server on the other end, if it supports this feature, will run the "finger" program, pipe its standard output to the "sort" program, and send sort's standard output back to you. Similarly, if you:

  send oofa.txt !sort -r > oofa.new

or, equivalently:

  send oofa.txt {!sort -r > oofa.new}

or:

  send /as-name:{!sort -r > oofa.new} oofa.txt

this has the receiver send the contents of the incoming oofa.txt file to the sort program, which sorts the text in reverse order and stores the result in oofa.new.

This use of the exclamation mark should be familiar to UNIX users as the "bang" feature that lets you run an external application or command from within another application.

Kermit's "bang" feature is disabled by default, since it is not unheard for filenames to actually begin with "!". So if you want to use this feature, you must enable it with the following command:

SET TRANSFER PIPES { ON, OFF }
ON enables the recognition of "!" notation in incoming filenames during file transfer as an indicator that the remaining text is the name of a command. OFF, the default, disables this feature and uses the text as a filename in the normal fashion. This command does NOT affect SEND /COMMAND, GET /COMMAND, CSEND, etc.

So using a combination of CSEND (SEND /COMMAND) and the "bang" feature, you can transfer a directory tree all in one command (assuming the remote Kermit supports pipe transfers and has them enabled):

  CSEND {tar cf - . | gzip -c} {!gunzip -c | tar xf -}

or:

  SEND /COMMAND:{tar cf - . | gzip -c} /as:{!gunzip -c | tar xf -}

Pay close attention to the syntax. Braces are needed around the command because it contains spaces; braces are needed around the as-name because it ends with "-". The as-name must begin with "!" or receiving Kermit will not recognize it as a command. The CSEND command must NOT begin with "!" unless you are running a command whose name really does start that character.

Similarly, you have a Kermit server send a directory tree to be unpacked on the client end:

  CGET {!tar cf - . | gzip -c} {gunzip -c | tar xf -}

or:

  GET /COMMAND {!tar cf - . | gzip -c} /as:{gunzip -c | tar xf -}

Notice how, in this case, the bang is required in the remote command, to distinguish it from a filename, but not in the local command, since by definition of CGET (or GET /COMMAND), it is known to be a command.

SEND and RECEIVE FILTERs supersede the bang feature. For example, if a file arrives under the name "!gunzip -c | tar xf -", but the receiving Kermit also has been given a command like:

  set receive filter sort -r > \v(filename)

then the incoming data will be sorted rather than gunzipped.

Finally, if SET TRANSFER PIPES is ON (and in this case, this must be done in your C-Kermit initialization file), you can send from a pipe on the C-Kermit command line:

  kermit -s "!finger | sort -r" -a userlist

In this case the "filename" contains spaces and so must be quoting using your shell's quoting rules.


4.2.5. Success and Failure of Piped Commands

Commands or programs started by Kermit as a result of CSEND or CRECEIVE commands, CGET, SEND /COMMAND, REDIRECT commands (see Section 4.2.8.2), implicit use of pipes, RUN commands, and so forth, should return their exit status codes to the Kermit command that caused them to be run, and therefore IF SUCCESS and IF FAILURE tests after these commands should work as expected. For example:

  CSEND blah < filename

should fail if there is no command called "blah" or if there is no file called "filename". However, this is not foolproof and sometimes C-Kermit might think a command succeeded when it failed, or vice versa. This is most likely to happen when the highly system-dependent methods that Kermit must use to determine a command's exit status code do not supply the right information.

It can also happen because some commands might define success and failure differently from what you expect, or because you are using a pipeline composed of many commands, and one of them fails to pass failing exit status codes up the chain. The most likely culprit is the shell itself, which in most cases must be interposed between Kermit and any external program to be run.

In any case, you can examine the following variable to find out the exit status code returned to Kermit by the process most recently run by any command that runs external commands or programs, including CSEND, CRECEIVE, REDIRECT, RUN, etc:

  \v(pexitstat)

In UNIX, Windows and OS/2, the value should be -2 if no command has been run yet, 0 if the most recent command succeeded, -1, -3, or -4 if there was an internal error, and a positive number returned by the command itself if the command failed. If the number is in the range 1-127, this is the program's exit status code. If it is 128 or greater, this is supposed to indicate that the command or program was interrupted or terminated from outside itself.

In Windows 95 and 98, the return values of the default shell are unreliable; various third-party shells can be used to work around this deficiency.

In VMS, it is the actual exit status code of the command that was run. This is an odd number if the command succeeded, and an even number if it failed. You can see the associated message as follows:

  run write sys$output f$message(\v(pexitstat))

Or, more conveniently, use the new Kermit function:

  echo \ferrstring(\v(pexitstat))

which converts a system error code (number) to the corresponding message.


4.2.6. Cautions about Using Pipes to Transfer Directory Trees

Although utilities such as tar and zip/unzip might be available on different platforms (such as UNIX and Windows), this does not necessarily mean you can use them successfully to transfer directory trees between unlike platforms. For example:

  CSEND {tar cf - . | gzip -c} {!gunzip -c | tar xf -}

when used from UNIX to Windows will have satisfactory results for binary files, but not for text files. UNIX text files have lines ending with Linefeed (LF) only, whereas Windows text files have lines ending in Carriage Return and Linefeed (CRLF). Thus any text files that were in the archive formed by the first tar command will be unpacked by the second tar command in their original form, and will display and print incorrectly in Windows (except in applications that have been explicitly coded to handle UNIX-format text files). On the other hand if you told gzip to use "text mode" to do record format conversion (assuming there was a way to tell it, as there is with most "zip" programs), this would destroy any binary files in the archive.

Furthermore, if the archive contains text files that are written in languages other than English, the "special" (accented and/or non-Roman) characters are NOT translated, and are therefore likely show up as gibberish on the target system. For example, West European languages are usually encoded in ISO Latin Alphabet 1 in UNIX, but in PC code page 850 on the PC. Capital A with acute accent is code point 193 (decimal) Latin-1, but 181 in CP850. So A-acute in the UNIX file becomes Middle Box Bottom on the PC, and similarly for all the other special characters, and for all other languages -- Greek, Russian, Hebrew, Japanese, etc.

So when transferring text files between unlike platforms, you should use direct Kermit file transfers so Kermit can apply the needed record-format and character-set transformations. Use pipelines containing archivers like tar or zip only if all the files are binary or the two systems use the same record format and character set for text files.

Also see Sections 4.3, 4.10, 4.11, and 4.15 for how to transfer directory trees between both like and unlike systems directly with Kermit.


4.2.7. Pipes and Encryption

Of course pipelines could be used for encrypted file transfers, assuming proper precautions could be taken concerning the transmission of the key. But there is rarely a good way to do this. To illustrate using UNIX crypt:

  csend {crypt key < filename} {!crypt key > filename}

Or, more ambitiously:

  csend {tar cf - . | gzip -c | crypt key} {!crypt key | gunzip -c | tar xf -}

transmits the key in the file header packet as part of the (clear-text) remote command, defeating the entire purpose of encrypting the file data.

But if you are connected in terminal mode to the remote computer and type:

  creceive {crypt key > filename}

at the remote Kermit prompt, you have also transmitted the key in clear text over the communications link.

At present, the only secure way to use CSEND and CRECEIVE with an encryption filter is to have a human operator at both ends, so the key does not have to be transmitted.

Theoretically it would be possible to use PGP software (Pretty Good Privacy, by Phil Zimmerman, Phil's Pretty Good Software) to avoid key transmission (since PGP uses separate public and private key and "lets you communicate securely with people you've never met, with no secure channels needed for prior exchange of keys"), but the specific method has yet to be worked out.

HINT: See the PGP User's Guide, e.g. at:
http://www.telstra.com.au/docs/PGP/
Especially the topic "Using PGP as a UNIX-Style Filter":
http://www.telstra.com.au/docs/PGP/pgpdoc2/pgpdoc2_17.html

In any case, better and more convenient security options are now available: Kerberos authentication and encryption (CLICK HERE for details) and the new ability to run C-Kermit "though" other communication programs, described in Section 2.7.


4.2.8. Commands and Functions Related to Pipes

4.2.8.1. The OPEN !READ and OPEN !WRITE Commands

These are described in Using C-Kermit, and are generally useful with reading output from commands that produce more than one line on their standard output, or writing multiple lines into commands that accept them on their standard input.

In C-Kermit 7.0 CLOSE !READ is accepted as a synonym for CLOSE READ, and CLOSE !WRITE for CLOSE WRITE.

Testing the success and failure of these commands, however, can be a bit tricky. Consider:

  open !read lalaskjfsldkfjsldkfj

(where "lalaskjfsldkfjsldkfj" is neither a valid command nor the name of a program or script that can be run). OPEN !READ, in UNIX at least, translates this into execl(shellpath,shellname,"-c",command). This means it starts your preferred shell (e.g. from the SHELL environment variable) and asks it to execute the given command. It must be this way, because your command can be a either an internal shell command (which only your shell can execute) or an external command, which only your shell knows how to find (it knows your PATH and interprets, etc). Therefore unless OPEN !READ can't start your shell, it always succeeds.

Continuing with the nonexistent-command example:

  C-Kermit> open !read lalaskjfsldkfjsldkfj
  C-Kermit> status
   SUCCESS
  C-Kermit> read line
  C-Kermit> status
   SUCCESS
  C-Kermit> echo "\m(line)"
  "bash: lalaskjfsldkfjsldkfj: command not found"
  C-Kermit> close read
  C-Kermit> status
   FAILURE
  C-Kermit>

In other words, the failure can not be detected on OPEN, since the OPEN command succeeds if it can start your shell. It can't be detected on READ, since all this does is read output from the shell, which in this case happens to be an error message. However, failure IS detected upon close, since this is the occasion upon which the shell gives Kermit its exit status code.

For an illustration of this situation, see Section 2.14.


4.2.8.2. The REDIRECT Command

A second method of I/O redirection is offered by the REDIRECT command. This is a rather advanced and tricky feature that is presently supported only in UNIX C-Kermit, in OS-9 C-Kermit, and in Kermit 95. Syntax:

REDIRECT command
Runs the given command, sending its standard output to the current communications channel (SET LINE, SET PORT, or SET HOST connection), and reading its standard input from the same connection. Works only in local mode -- i.e. a connection is required -- and then only if the given command uses Standard I/O.

Example:

  redirect finger

runs the local "finger" command and sends its output over the connection as plain text, where presumably there is a process set up to read it. Another example:

  redirect finger | sort -r

shows the use of a pipeline.

Note: REDIRECT differs from CSEND/CRECEIVE in two important ways: (1) it does not use the Kermit protocol, and (2) it uses a bidirectional pipe rather than a one-way pipe.

The primary use of the REDIRECT command is to run external protocols, such as sz/rz in UNIX for ZMODEM, when they work over Standard I/O(*). Example:

  set host xyzcorp.com
  (login, etc)
  redirect sz oofa.zip

lets you make a Telnet connection with C-Kermit and then do a ZMODEM transfer over it. ZMODEM protocol messages go both ways over the same connection simultaneously.

It is possible to use C-Kermit on UNIX as your PPP dialer and then to REDIRECT the connection to the PPP software, but C-Kermit 7.0 offers a better approach to PPP dialing in its new EXEC command (Section 1.23).

In theory, you can also redirect an interactive process. For example, suppose you tell Kermit 95 to wait for an incoming TCP/IP connection:

  set host * 3000

and then tell C-Kermit on UNIX to:

  set host kermit95hostname 3000
  redirect ksh

and then tell Kermit 95 to CONNECT: now you are talking to the UNIX K-shell; you can give commands (pwd, ls, etc) and see the results. In practice, the K-shell's terminal modes are messed up because (a) it is not going through the Unix terminal driver, and (b) it is "smart" and knows it is being redirected, and so acts in a decidedly inhospitable manner (other applications like EMACS, vi, etc, simply refuse to run if their standard i/o has been redirected).

(*) The publicly-distributed sz/rz programs do not work as clients. However, Omen Technology does offer an up-to-date redirectable client XYZMODEM program called crzsz.


4.2.8.3. Receiving Mail and Print Jobs

As of 7.0, and in UNIX only, files that are sent to C-Kermit as mail (when the other Kermit uses a MAIL or SEND /MAIL command) or to be printed (via REMOTE PRINT or SEND /PRINT) are now piped directly to the mail or print program, rather than written to temporary files and then mailed or printed and then deleted. This has the advantages of (a) not requiring a temporary file, and (b) allowing mail to have a proper subject in place of the filename. Temporary files were bad not only because they required (a) space, and (b) writeability of the current directory, but also because using them could result in wiping out an existing file. See Section 4.7 for more about SEND /MAIL and SEND /PRINT.


4.2.8.4. Pipe-Related Functions

The \fcommand(command) function runs the given shell or system command and returns the command's standard output as its value (with any newline characters stripped from the end), unless the result is too long, in which case it returns the empty string. The maximum length for the result is at least 1022 bytes, and it might be longer on some platforms. Examples (UNIX):

  C-Kermit> echo "\fcommand(date)"
  "Fri Apr 18 13:31:42 1997"
  C-Kermit> echo "\fcommand(finger | wc -l)" ; how many users logged in?
  "      83"
  C-Kermit> evaluate \fcommand(finger | wc -l) * 2
  166
  C-Kermit> echo Welcome to \fcommand(tty) on \fcommand(date)
  Welcome to /dev/ttyre on Fri Apr 18 13:31:42 1997
  C-Kermit> echo "\fcommand(ls oofa.*)"
  "oofa.c
  oofa.h
  oofa.o"
  C-Kermit> cd /directory-with-thousands-of-files
  C-Kermit> echo "\fcommand(ls -l)" ; This would be too long
  ""
  C-Kermit>

If a command's output would be too long, you can use the other, more laborious method of reading from a command: OPEN !READ command, READ each line, CLOSE !READ.

The \frawcommand(command) function is identical to \fcommand(command), except it does not remove trailing newline characters:

  C-Kermit> echo "\frawcommand(date)"
  "Fri Apr 18 13:31:42 1997
  "
  C-Kermit> echo "\frawcommand(ls oofa.*)"
  "oofa.c
  oofa.h
  oofa.o
  "
  C-Kermit>

Use \frawcommand() if you want to retain the final line terminators, or if the command's output is "binary". But remember that if the result of this (or any other) function contains any NUL (ASCII code 0) characters, the first NUL will terminate the result string because this is how C strings work (it's "C-Kermit", remember?).

These functions are useful not only locally, but also in the client/server arena. If you need to get the results from a system command on the server end into a variable on the client end, just do:

  [ remote ] query kermit command(date)

The result is in the local \v(query) variable; see Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed., pp.359-360 for details.


4.3. Automatic Per-File Text/Binary Mode Switching

When transferring files between like systems (e.g. UNIX-to-UNIX), binary mode can be used for all files unless character-set translation is needed, and in fact Kermit programs of recent vintage recognize each others' platforms and switch to binary mode automatically when it is appropriate (e.g. DOS to OS/2, or UNIX to UNIX). (Exception: LABELED mode is chosen for VMS-to-VMS and OS/2-to-OS/2 transfers so complex file formats can be preserved.)

On a client/server connection between like systems, the transfer mode is currently determined by the file sender, rather than always by the client. If the client is sending, it controls the transfer mode. If a GET command is sent to the server, the server sends all files in binary mode if its TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET is TRANSPARENT; otherwise it uses text mode for text files (according to its text-pattern list) and binary mode for binary files. Of course, the client can control the server's transfer character-set with the REMOTE SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET command.

When transferring files between unlike systems, however, (e.g. UNIX-to-DOS), some files (such as executable program images) must be transferred in binary mode but others (such as plain-text files) must be transferred in text mode so their record format and character sets can be appropriately converted. If a binary file is transferred in text mode, it is ruined. If a text file is transferred in binary mode, then at the very least, its format can be incorrect; at worst it is also corrupted because its character set was not converted (in extreme cases the corruption is total, e.g. because one system is ASCII-based and the other EBCDIC).


4.3.1. Exceptions

VMS C-Kermit, when sending files to a non-VMS system, switches to text or binary mode automatically for each file, based on the record format in the file's directory entry; thus the mechanisms described in this section do not apply to VMS C-Kermit, yet the effect is the same: automatic text/binary mode switching when VMS C-Kermit is sending files. See the VMS Appendix of Using C-Kermit for details.

Kermit versions that support LABELED or IMAGE transfer mode are likewise not affected by this feature when one of those modes is selected (normally used only when transferring between like systems).

Kermit versions that support file-transfer pipes and filters are not affected by this feature when pipes or filters are used, since the output of a pipe or filter (such as gzip) is likely to require transfer in a different mode than the original file.

Finally, SEND /TEXT or SEND /BINARY will force files to be sent in the indicated mode, overriding all automatic transfer-mode-choosing mechanisms.


4.3.2. Overview

Suppose you give C-Kermit a command like:

  SEND *.*

And suppose the pattern *.* matches a mixture of text files (such as program source code) and binary files (such os object modules or executable programs).

C-Kermit 6.0 and earlier (except on VMS) send all files in the same mode: whatever you said in your most recent SET FILE TYPE command, or else whatever mode was chosen automatically according to the rules on page 236 of Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed.

But when text and binary files are mixed in the same group, and the files are being transferred to an unlike system (e.g. UNIX to IBM Mainframe), this results in corruption of either all the text files or all the binary files.

Stream-oriented file systems such as in UNIX and DOS do not record any information about the file to tell us whether the file should be transferred in binary or text mode, making it impossible to select the transfer mode for each file in a group automatically with any certainty.

However, we can use some fairly-well established file naming conventions for this purpose. C-Kermit 7.0 lets you provide lists of filename patterns that are used to separately determine the file type for each individual file being transfered. A pattern is a string, possibly containing the special characters "*" (asterisk, which matches any string of zero of more characters) and/or "?" (question mark, which matches any single character). For example "a*b" matches all files whose names start with "a" and end with "b", such as "ab", "arb", "ababababab", etc, but not "abba". And "a?b" matches any file whose name starts with "a", ends with "b", and is exactly 3 characters long.

NOTE: When typing commands at the C-Kermit prompt, you must prefix "?" with \ to override its normal function of giving help.

(Also see Section 4.9 for additional pattern-matching notations that might be available in your version of C-Kermit.)

When you have specified filename recognition patterns, C-Kermit can transfer the ones whose names match any of the binary-mode patterns in binary mode, and those with names that match any of the text-mode patterns in text mode, and those whose names match neither in the prevailing mode you have chosen, or that was chosen automatically via peer recognition.


4.3.3. Commands

SET FILE PATTERNS { ON, OFF, AUTO }
This tells Kermit whether to do per-file filename pattern-matching to determine text or binary mode. The normal and default setting is AUTO, which means to use pattern lists to switch transfer mode only when it is certain that the other Kermit program supports automatic notification of transfer mode (via Attribute packets) on a per-file basis (this information is obtained automatically during protocol startup negotiation). ON means to always determine the transfer mode from the filename and pattern list when sending files. Use OFF to disable this feature (without resetting your pattern lists). Also note that if you have selected LABELED file transfer (SET FILE TYPE LABELED), this takes precedence over filename-matching patterns and all files are sent in labeled mode.

SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL
Disables the use of filename patterns, no matter what the FILE PATTERNS setting.

REMOTE SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL
Client command to disable automatic transfer mode, and therefore also filename patterns, in the server. Synonym: REMOTE SET XFER MODE MANUAL.

{ GET, SEND, etc } { /BINARY, /TEXT }
Including a /BINARY or /TEXT (or, where supported, /IMAGE or /LABELED) switch with a file-transfer command changes the transfer mode to manual for that command only, and therefore disables patterns that that command.

SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
A list of zero or more patterns, separated by spaces (not commas). Letters in a pattern are case-sensitive if the underlying filenames are case sensitive (as in UNIX), and case-insensitive otherwise (as in Windows). If a file's name is matched by any pattern in the list and SET FILE PATTERNS is ON, the file is sent in binary mode. Examples:

  SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS *.gz *.Z *.tar *.zip *.o *.so *.a *.out ; UNIX
  SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS *.EXE *.ZIP *.OBJ *.COM ; DOS or OS/2 or Windows

If a pattern contains spaces, enclose it in braces.

SET FILE TEXT-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
Like SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS, but the patterns choose text files rather than binary ones. Examples:

  SET FILE TEXT-PATTERNS *.TXT *.KSC *.HTM* *.BAT ; DOS, Windows, OS/2

ADD BINARY-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
Adds one or more patterns to the BINARY-PATTERN list.

ADD TEXT-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
Adds one or more patterns to the TEXT-PATTERN list.

REMOVE BINARY-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
Removes one or more patterns from the BINARY-PATTERN list. The given patterns are matched with the ones in the BINARY-PATTERNS list with case sensitivity if the underlying file system has case-sensitive names (as do UNIX and OS-9), otherwise with case independence.

REMOVE TEXT-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
Removes one or more patterns from the TEXT-PATTERN list.

SHOW PATTERNS
Displays the current pattern selections.

Whenever you give a SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS or SET FILE TEXT-PATTERNS command, the previous list is replaced. If you give one of these commands without a pattern list, the previous list is removed.

When patterns are active and files are being sent, text patterns (if any) are applied first (but only if not RESENDing and not sending in LABELED mode), then binary patterns, so if the same pattern appears in both lists, binary mode is chosen.


4.3.4. Examples

Here's an example that might be used when sending files from UNIX:

  set file type binary
  set file text-patterns *.c *.h *.w *.txt makefile
  set file binary-patterns *.o
  msend makefile wermit wart ck*.[cwho] ck*.txt

Note that "wermit" and "wart" do not match any patterns so they are sent in the prevailing mode, which is binary. Also note the use of "makefile" as a pattern that does not contain any wildcard characters (there is no other convention to distinguish among "wermit" and "wart", which are binary executables, and "makefile", which is a text file, purely by their names).

Most C-Kermit implementations have a default pattern list built in, which includes patterns that are almost certain to succeed in picking the right transfer mode. Others are omitted due to ambiguity. For example ".hlp", and ".ini" are generally binary types in Windows but text types everywhere else.

NOTE: ".doc", used for decades to denote plain-text documentation files, now more often than not denotes a Microsoft Word Document, so ".doc" is now considered a binary type since it does less harm to transfer a plain-text document in binary mode than it does to transfer an MS Word file in text mode (except when IBM mainframes are involved!)

ANOTHER NOTE: ".com" files are binary in DOS-like operating systems, but they are text (DCL command procedures) in VMS. VMS C-Kermit sends .COM files in text mode; K95 sends them in binary mode. If you download a .COM file from VMS to DOS or Windows, and then upload it to another VMS system, be sure to use SEND /TEXT to preserve its textness.

You can see the default pattern list by starting C-Kermit without its initialization file (e.g. "kermit -Y") and using the SHOW PATTERNS command. If you will be depending on this feature, be sure to examine the list carefully in conjunction with the applications that you use.

The default pattern list does not take "backup files" into account because (a) people usually don't want to transfer them; and (b) it would make the pattern lists more than twice as long. For example, we would need to include both *.txt and *.txt.~[0-9]*~ for ".txt" files, and similarly for all the others. Instead, you can use SEND /NOBACKUP (or SET SEND BACKUP OFF) to skip over all backup files.

Put your most commonly-used safe pattern declarations in your C-Kermit customization file (ckermod.ini, .mykermrc, k95custom.ini, etc).

As noted, SET FILE PATTERNS is ON by default. Sometimes, however, it is desirable, or necessary, to force files to be sent in a particular mode, and often this must be done from the command line (e.g. when using Kermit as a download helper in a Web browser like Lynx). The -V command-line options is equivalent to SET FILE PATTERNS OFF and SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL. Example:

  kermit -Vis oofa.txt

forces oofa.txt to be sent in binary mode, even though ".txt" might match a text pattern.


4.4. File Permissions

"Permissions" refers to a code associated with a file that specifies who is allowed to access it, and in what manner. For example, the owner, the members of one or more groups, the system administrator, and everybody else, might be allowed various combinations of Read, Write, Append, Execute, or Listing access.

The permission code goes by different names on different platforms. In UNIX, it might be called the filemode. In VMS, it is called the file protection (or protection mask).

The comments in this section presently apply only to the UNIX and VMS versions of C-Kermit, to which these features were added in version 7.0; the DOS, Windows, and OS/2 file systems embody no notions of protection, and so MS-DOS Kermit and Kermit 95 do not send file permissions, and ignore them when received.

The permissions for a received file are determined by a combination of the file transfer mode (VMS-to-VMS transfers only), whether a file of the same name exists already, whether permissions of the file are received in the file attribute packet, and the setting of ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION.

The default for ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION is ON. If no attributes are received, the effect is the same as if attributes PROTECTION were OFF.

For VMS-to-VMS transfers, the default LABELED mode simply copies the protection code from source to destination.


4.4.1. When ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION is OFF

If no file of the same name exists, system defaults determine the permissions of the new file. Otherwise, the actions taken depend on the current FILE COLLISION setting: BACKUP, OVERWRITE, RENAME, etc, as documented in Using C-Kermit. But now the new file (if it is created at all) automatically inherits the permissions (mode bits) of the existing file in a way that is appropriate for the platform.

4.4.1.1. Unix

All mode bits are inherited except the directory bit, since the incoming file can not possibly be a directory. (In any case, it is not possible to receive a file that has the same name as an existing directory unless FILE COLLISION is set to RENAME).

4.4.1.2. VMS

Files with the same name as an existing file, transferred in modes other than LABELED between VMS systems, inherit the protection of the prior version.


4.4.2 When ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION is ON

File permissions can be conveyed as part of the file transfer process, in accordance with the Kermit protocol definition. If the file sender puts system-dependent and/or system-independent versions of the file protection (permissions) into the Attribute (A) packet, the file receiver can set the new file's permissions from them. Otherwise, the permissions are set the same as for ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION OFF.

When the incoming A packet contains system-dependent permissions, the file receiver checks to see if the sender has the same system ID (e.g. both the sending and receiving systems are UNIX, or both are VMS); if so, it decodes and uses the system-dependent permissions; otherwise it uses the generic ones (if any) and applies them to the owner field, setting the other fields appropriately as described in the following sections.

Setting the incoming file's protection from the A packet is controlled by SET ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION (or PERMISSION), which is ON by default, and its status is displayed by SHOW ATTRIBUTES.

The main benefit of this feature is to not have to "chmod +x" an executable file after transfer from UNIX to UNIX. Its cross-platform benefits are less evident, perhaps to retain the status of the Unix 'x' bit on a VMS system, for subsequent transfer back to a Unix system.


4.4.2.1. System-Specific Permissions

System-specific file permissions are used when the two Kermit programs recognize each other as running on the same type of system. For example, both are running under some form of UNIX (it doesn't matter which UNIX variation -- HP-UX, Solaris, AIX, etc -- all use the same scheme for file permissions); or both are running under VMS (even if one is on an Alpha and the other on a VAX, and/or one is old and the other is new).

4.4.2.1.1. UNIX

UNIX supports three categories of users, File Owner, Group, and World, and three types of file access permission: Read, Write, and Execute. Thus, a UNIX file's permissions are expressed in 9 bits.

The system-dependent permission string for UNIX is a 3-digit octal string, the low-order 9 bits of the st_mode member of the stat struct; we deliberately chop off the "file format" bits because they are not permissions, nor do we convey the setuid/setgid bits, lock bit, sticky bit, etc.

4.4.2.1.2. VMS

VMS supports four categories of users, System, File Owner, Group, and World, and four types of file access permission: Read, Write, Execute, and Delete. Thus, a VMS file's permissions are expressed in 16 bits.

The system-dependent protection string for VMS is a 4-digit hexadecimal string, corresponding to the internal-format protection word of the file (RWED for each of World,Group,Owner,System). A new file normally gets all 16 protection bits from the original file of the same name.

Note: VMS-to-VMS transfers take place in LABELED mode when the two C-Kermits recognize each other's platform as VMS (unless you have disabled LABELED-mode transfers). In this case, all of a file's attributes are preserved in the transfer and the protection mask (and other information) is taken from the file's internal information, and this takes precedence over any information in the Attribute packets. You can defeat the automatic switching into LABELED mode (if you want to) with SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL.


4.4.2.2. System-Independent Permissions

The system-independent ("generic") protection is used when the system IDs of the two Kermit programs do not agree (e.g. one is UNIX, the other is VMS). The generic protection attribute includes the following permissions (not all are applicable to every file system): Read, Write, Append, Execute, Delete, Search. The generic permissions are derived from the owner permissions of the source file, thus, a Unix 'w' permission becomes VMS Write,Delete.

The Owner field of the new file's permissions is set from the incoming generic protection attribute.

In UNIX, the Group and World permissions are set according to your umask, except that execute permission is NOT set in these fields if it was not also set in the generic protection (and consequently, is set in the Owner field).

In VMS, the System, Group, and World permissions are set according to the process default file permission (as shown in VMS by SHOW PROTECTION), except that no permissions are allowed in these fields that are not included in the generic permissions.

Note that the VMS and UNIX interpretations of Execute permission are not identical. In UNIX, a file (binary executable, shell script, etc) may not be executed unless it has Execute permission, and normally files that are not intended for execution do not have Execute permission. In VMS, Read permission implicitly supplies Execute capability. Generally files that have Read permission also have explicit Execute permission, but files (binary executables, DCL command procedures) that have Read permission and not Execute permission can still be executed.


4.5. File Management Commands

4.5.1. The DIRECTORY Command

Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the DIRECTORY command always ran an external system command (such as "ls" on UNIX) or program to product the directory listing. This had certain advantages, mostly that you could include system-dependent options for customized listings, e.g. on UNIX:

  dir -lt c* | more

or in VMS:

  directory /size/date/protection/except=*.obj oofa.*;0

This approach, however, carries some disadvantages: C-Kermit can't return SUCCESS or FAILURE status for (e.g.) "dir foo" according to whether the file "foo" exists; and it runs an inferior process, which might be a problem in some environments for resource and/or security reasons, and won't work at all in a "nopush" environment (e.g. one in which C-Kermit is configured to forbid access to exterior commands and programs, e.g. in a VMS "captive account").

In C-Kermit 7.0 on VMS and UNIX, and in K95 1.1.19 and later, the DIRECTORY command is internal to Kermit. It can be run in a "nopush" environment and returns SUCCESS or FAILURE status appropriately. In UNIX it prints all dates and times in a consistent way (unlike ls). In VMS it prints precise file sizes, rather than "blocks". It offers several formatting and other options, but it is not necessarily more flexible than the corresponding external commands or programs (the UNIX "ls" program, the VMS "directory" command). The syntax is:

DIRECTORY [ switch [ switch [ ... ] ] ] [ filespec ]

If no filespec is given, all files in the current directory are listed.

Optional switches include all the standard file-selection switches presented in Section 1.5.4, plus:

/ALL
Show both regular files and directories; this is the default.

/ARRAY:x
Instead of displaying a directory listing, put the files that would have been shown (based on the filespec and other selection switches) in the given array. The array need not (and should not) be predeclared; if the array already exists, it is destroyed and reused. The array name can be a single letter, like "a", or any fuller form, such as "&a", "\&a", "\&a[]", etc. If the /ARRAY switch is included, the following other switches are ignored: /BRIEF, /VERBOSE, /HEADING, /PAGE, /ENGLISHDATE, /ISODATE, /XFERMODE, /MESSAGE, /SORT, /REVERSE, /ASCENDING. In other words, only file selection switches are meaningful with /ARRAY: /FILES, /DIRECTORIES, /ALL, /DOTFILES, /NOBACKUP, /RECURSIVE, /SMALLER, /LARGER, /AFTER, /BEFORE, /EXCEPT, etc. The resulting array has the number of files (n) as its 0th element, and the filenames in elements 1 through n Example:

  dir /array:&a /files /nobackup /after:19990101 /larger:10000 [ab]*
  show array &a

/FILES
Only show regular files.

/DIRECTORIES
Only show directories.

/BACKUP
In UNIX, OS-9, K-95, and other versions that support SET FILE COLLISION BACKUP and create backup files by appending .~n~ to the filename (where "n" is a number), /BACKUP means to include these files in directory listings. This is the default.

/NOBACKUP
This is the opposite of /BACKUP: that is, do not include backup files in the listing.

/BRIEF
List filenames only; use a compact format, as many filenames as will fit across the screen (based on the longest name). A brief listing is always sorted alphabetically.

/VERBOSE
List one file per line, and include date, size, and (in UNIX only) permissions of each file. This is the opposite of /BRIEF, and is the default.

/PAGE
Pause at the end of each screenful and give a "more?" prompt, even if SET COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING is OFF.

/NOPAGE
Don't pause at the end of each screenful and give a "more?" prompt, even if SET COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING is ON. If neither /PAGE or /NOPAGE is given, paging is according to the prevailing COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING setting (which can be displayed with SHOW COMMAND).

/ENGLISHDATE
Show dates in dd-mmm-yyyy format; mmm is the first three letters of the English month name.

/ISODATE
Show dates in yyyy-mm-dd format; mm is the month number, 1-12. This is the opposite of /ENGLISHDATE, and is the default.

/HEADINGS
Print a heading before the listing and a summary at the end.

/NOHEADINGS
Don't print a heading before the listing or a summary at the end. This is the opposite of /HEADINGS, and is the default.

/XFERMODE
Only in Kermit programs that support SET FILE PATTERNS. If this switch is included, and the filename matches any FILE BINARY-PATTERN (Section 4.3), "(B)" is printed after the filename; otherwise, if it matches a FILE TEXT-PATTERN, "(T)" is printed.

/NOXFERMODE
Don't display transfer-mode indicators. This is the opposite of /XFERMODE and is the default.

/RECURSIVE
Show files not only in the given directory, but also in its subdirectories (if any), their subdirectories, etc.

/NORECURSIVE
Don't show files in subdirectories. This is the opposite of /RECURSIVE, and is the default.

/MESSAGE:text
This lets you specify a short text string to be appended to the end of each directory listing line (a space is supplied automatically). If the text contains any spaces, enclose it in braces, e.g. /MESSAGE:{two words}.

/NOMESSAGE
Don't append any message to the end of each directory listing line (default).

/SORT:[{NAME,SIZE,DATE}]
Sort the listing by name, size, or date. If the /SORT switch is given but the "sort-by" keyword is omitted, the listing is sorted by name. /SORT:NAME /ASCENDING (alphabetic sort by name) is the default.

/NOSORT
Don't sort the listing. Files are listed in whatever order they are supplied by the operating system, e.g. inode order in UNIX.

/REVERSE
If the /SORT switch is given, reverse the order of the sort. Synonym: /DESCENDING.

/ASCENDING
If the /SORT switch is given, sort the listing in normal order. This is the opposite of /REVERSE and is the default.

Note that most of the DIRECTORY-specific switches come in pairs, in which one member of a pair (e.g. /NOHEADINGS) is the opposite of the other (e.g. /HEADINGS).

If you always want to use certain options, you can set them with the SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY command (Section 1.5.5). Use SHOW OPTIONS to list the options currently in effect. To make the desired options apply every time you run C-Kermit, put a SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY command in your C-Kermit customization file, specifying the desired options. Options set in this manner apply to every subsequent DIRECTORY command. Of course, if you include switches in a DIRECTORY command, these override any defaults, built-in or custom. Example:

  DIRECTORY            ; Use "factory defaults"
  SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY /SORT:SIZE /REVERSE /HEADINGS  ; Customize defaults
  DIRECTORY            ; Use customized defaults
  DIR /SORT:NAME       ; Override customized default SORT key
  SET OPT DIR /RECURS  ; Add /RECURSIVE to customized defaults
  DIR /ASCEND          ; Override customized default SORT order

Notes:

Hint: How to find the biggest files in a directory tree:

  cd xxx ; (root of tree)
  directory /sort:size /recursive /reverse /dotfiles /page

Another hint: If you often use several different directory-listing formats, define macro shortcuts for them:

  DEFINE WD DIRECTORY /SORT:DATE /REVERSE \%*  ; Reverse chronological order
  DEFINE SD DIRECTORY /SORT:SIZE /REVERSE \%*  ; Reverse order of size
  DEFINE ND DIRECTORY /SORT:NAME /ASCEND \%*   ; Alphabetical by name
  DEFINE DL DIR /DIR /SORT:NAME /ASCEND \%*    ; Alphabetical directory list

Put these definitions in your C-Kermit customization file. Note that "\%*" (Section 7.5) in these definitions lets you include other switches in your macro invocations, e.g.:

  wd /headings *.txt

Of course you can still access your external directory listing program by using RUN or "!", e.g. in VMS:

  run directory /size/date/protection/except=*.obj oofa.*;0

or:

  !dir /size/date/prot/exc=*.obj oofa.*;0

In UNIX, use "!ls" or just "ls" (which is a special synonym for "!ls").


4.5.2. The CD and BACK Commands

In C-Kermit 7.0, the CD command has a new friend, the BACK command. BACK means "CD to my previous current directory". A second BACK brings you back to where you were before the first one; thus successive BACK commands switch back and forth between two directories.

4.5.2.1. Parsing Improvements

The CD command, as well as other commands that parse a directory name, were changed in 7.0 to provide all the expected functions: completion on Tab or Esc, directory-name lists on ?, etc. Other affected commands include SET SERVER GET-PATH, SET TEMP-DIRECTORY, SET FILE DOWNLOAD-DIRECTORY, and SPACE. CD and REMOTE CD also now work with logical names.

In VMS, the situation is a bit complicated since a directory name can look like "DEV:", "[FOO.BAR]", "DEV:[FOO.BAR]", "[FOO]BAR.DIR;1", etc. Completion and ?-help might not always work, but they do in many cases. Examples:

  cd ?           Lists all subdirectories of the current directory
  cd []?         Ditto
  cd k?          Ditto, but only those starting with K
  cd [foo]?      Lists all subdirectories of the [FOO] directory
  cd [-]?        Lists all subdirectories of the superior directory
  cd [--]?       Lists all subdirectories of the directory 2 levels up
  cd [...]?      Lists all directories below the current one
  cd [foo.?      Does not work.

C-Kermit allows all of the following in VMS:

  cd bar         CD to subdirectory BAR of the current directory
  cd .bar        Ditto
  cd [.bar]      Ditto
  cd bar.dir     etc...
  cd bar.dir;
  cd bar.dir;1
  cd [foo.bar]
  cd bar.baz     This can go more than 1 level deep...
  cd dir:        (where logical name DIR is defined as [FOO.BAR])

As well as the following:

  cd ..          Go up one level as in UNIX
  cd .           The current directory
  cd             My login directory

Note that "cd -" (go up one level) does not work as expected, because "-" is Kermit's command continuation character. However, "cd [-]", and "cd {-}" have the desired effect (and so does "cd ..", which is easier to type).


4.5.2.2. The CDPATH

The CD command in the UNIX, Windows, OS/2, and VMS versions of C-Kermit, as of version 6.1 / 1.1.12, searches the CDPATH for the given directory, if it is not absolute and if a CDPATH environment variable is defined. Example (in UNIX ksh or bash):

  $ export CDPATH=$HOME:$HOME/kermit:/tmp

Now if you give a "cd xxx" command, no matter what your current directory is, if the "xxx" directory is not a subdirectory of your current directory, then the xxx subdirectory of your home directory is used or if that does not exist, then the xxx subdirectory of the kermit subdirectory of your home directory is used or if that does not exist, then /tmp/xxx is used. This is how the ksh "cd" command works, and now the C-Kermit CD command works the same way.

In VMS, you can define CDPATH to be a list of directories that contain actual directory delimiters, and/or logical names representing directories, using commas to separate them, e.g.:

  $ define cdpath [HOME],[SOMEOTHERDIR],[HOME.MISC]
  $ define cdpath SYS$LOGIN:,DISK1:[HOME],DISK2:[SCRATCH.IVAN]

Example:

  $ define cdpath SYS$LOGIN:,[IVAN],[OLAF],[OLGA.MISC]
  $ kermit
  DISK1:[OLGA] C-Kermit> cd blah

tries the BLAH subdirectory of the user's login directory, then [OLGA.BLAH], [IVAN.BLAH], [OLAF.BLAH], and [OLGA.MISC.BLAH], in that order, using the first one it finds, failing if it finds none.

In C-Kermit 7.0, you may also set the CDPATH from the Kermit prompt:

SET CD PATH path
Allows the CD PATH to be set from within C-Kermit.

SHOW CD shows the CD path and all other information relevant to the CD command.


4.5.2.3. CD Messages

Whenever you change directory, you can have C-Kermit display a "Read Me" file from the new directory automatically. The commands are:

SET CD MESSAGE { ON, OFF, FILE list }
ON enables this feature; OFF (the default) disables it. File lets you specify the name of the "Read Me" file. A list of names to look for can be given in the following format:

  {{name1}{name2}{name3}{...}}

e.g.:

  SET SERVER CD-MESSAGE FILE {{./.readme}{README.TXT}{READ.ME}}

The default list of CD-message files is system dependent.

SHOW CD shows your current directory, previous directory, CD path, and CD message info.


4.5.3. Creating and Removing Directories

The MKDIR command now allows you to create multiple directories at once:

  C-Kermit> mkdir a/b/c/d

creates the directory a in the current directory (if it doesn't exist already), and then creates subdirectory b in the a directory (if it didn't exist already), and so on.

If you use MKDIR to try to create a directory that already exists, C-Kermit will print a warning ("?Directory already exists"), but the MKDIR command will still succeed. If you want to avoid the warning message, use IF DIRECTORY first to check if the directory already exists.

The RMDIR command, however, will not remove more than one directory, nor will it remove a directory that contains any files. (There is, as yet, no RMDIR /RECURSIVE command, although one might be added later.)

In VMS, these commands (like CD) are more forgiving of your syntax than is the DCL command shell; "mkdir oofa" is equivalent to "mkdir [.oofa]" and so on. Also in VMS, you'll find that C-Kermit's RMDIR command is easier than deleting a directory in DCL, since it automatically first gives it owner delete permission if you are the owner.


4.5.4. The DELETE and PURGE Commands

The DELETE command now offers a selection of switches, and has a new companion, the PURGE command. First, DELETE:

DELETE [ switches... ] filespec
Deletes the file or files that match the filespec, which may contain wildcards (Section 4.9).

Optional switches include the standard file-selection switches presented in Section 1.5.4, plus:

/ASK
Before deleting each file, ask permission interactively. Answers are Yes or OK (delete the file), No (don't delete it), or Quit (stop executing the DELETE command).

/NOASK
Don't ask permission to delete each file.

/LIST
List each file and show whether it was deleted. Synonyms: /LOG, /VERBOSE.

/NOLIST
Don't list files while deleting them. Synonyms: /NOLOG, /QUIET.

/HEADING
Print a heading and summary line.

/NOHEADING
Don't print a heading and summary line.

/PAGE
When listing, pause at the end of each screenful and give the "More?" prompt. If you reply "n" (no), the DELETE command terminates.

/SIMULATE
Do everything implied by the given switches and filespec, except do not actually delete any files. This lets you preview which files would be deleted; implies /LIST.

Now the PURGE command:

PURGE [ switches... ] [ filespec ]
(VMS only) Runs the DCL PURGE command. Switches and filespec, if any, are passed directly to DCL without parsing or verification. Deletes excess versions of the given (or all) files. The rest of this section does not apply to VMS.

PURGE [ switches... ] [ filespec ]
(UNIX only) Deletes "backup files" that match the filespec, which may contain wildcards (Section 4.9). If no filespec is given, all backup files in the current directory are selected (subject to modification by any switches). Do not include backup notation in the filespec.

Explanation:

To avoid destroying preexisting files when a new file arrives that has the same name, C-Kermit backs up the old file by appending a "backup number" to its name. In UNIX, the backup suffix consists of a period, a tilde, a number, and another tilde. For example, if a file called oofa.txt exists and a new oofa.txt file arrives, the original is renamed to oofa.txt.~1~. If another oofa.txt file arrives, the existing one is renamed to oofa.txt.~2~. And so on. This system is compatible with the one used by EMACS. Thus over time, if you receive a lot of files with C-Kermit or edit them with EMACS, backup files can build up. The new PURGE command lets you clean out accumulated backup files:

Optional switches include the standard file-selection switches presented in Section 1.5.4, plus all the switches listed above for the DELETE command, plus:

/KEEP:n
Retains the n most recent (highest-numbered) backup files for each file. For example, if oofa.txt, oofa.txt.~1~, oofa.txt.~2~, oofa.txt.~10~, oofa.txt.~12~, and oofa.txt.~100~ exist, "purge /keep:2 oofa.txt" deletes oofa.txt.~1~, oofa.txt.~2~, and oofa.txt.~10~, and keeps oofa.txt, oofa.txt.~12~, and oofa.txt.~100~. If /KEEP is given without a number, one (the highest numbered) backup file is kept.

CAUTION: The PURGE command should be used only when *.~*~ files truly are backup files. This is the case for EMACS, and it is the DEFAULT for C-Kermit. However, if C-Kermit's FILE COLLISION has been set to RENAME, newly received files will look like backup files. In that case, don't use the PURGE command or you'll be removing new files rather than old ones. (Use SHOW FILE to find the FILE COLLISION setting.)

The PURGE command is presently available only in UNIX. The command succeeds if it deleted any files, or if it deleted no files but there were no errors. It fails if it deleted no files and there were errors (i.e. deletion was attempted but failed). In VMS, backup file versions are handled automatically by the OS, and a PURGE command can be used at the VMS prompt to clean them up.

If you want certain switches to be supplied automatically with each DELETE or PURGE command, you can set them with SET OPTIONS (Section 1.5.5) and you can display any such settings with SHOW OPTIONS. Of course you can override them on a per-command basis by including switches in your PURGE or DELETE command.

Also see SET FILE COLLISION, SHOW FILE, SEND /NOBACKUP, SET SEND BACKUP, and DIRECTORY /[NO]BACKUP.


4.6. Starting the Remote Kermit Server Automatically

As noted on pages 275-276 of Using C-Kermit 2nd edition, you can have Kermit send "kermit receive" commands automatically when it is in local mode and you give a SEND or similar command, to start the remote Kermit receiver in case it is not already started. The "kermit receive" commands are specified by:

  SET PROTOCOL KERMIT binary-receive-command text-receive-command

As of version 7.0, a Kermit protocol option has been added to send a string to the host in advance of any Kermit packets when you give a GET-class or REMOTE command. This will switch the remote C-Kermit into the appropriate mode or, if the remote system is at a system command (shell) prompt, execute the string on the remote system. The new syntax of the SET PROTOCOL KERMIT command is:

  SET PROTOCOL KERMIT [ s1 [ s2 [ s3 ] ] ]

where:

       Default         Meaning
  s1  {kermit -ir}     Remote "kermit receive in binary mode" command.
  s2  {kermit -r}      Remote "kermit receive in text mode" command.
  s3  {kermit -x}      Remote "start kermit server" command.

NOTE: If the remote Kermit is 6.0, the following are recommended for fast startup and high-performance file transfer (see Appendix I in Using C-Kermit, second Edition, for command-line options):

  s1   kermit -YQir   (Kermit receive binary, skip init file, fast.)
  s2   kermit -YQTr   (Kermit receive text, skip init file, fast.)
  s3   kermit -YQx    (Kermit server, skip init file, fast.)

If the remote is C-Kermit 7.0 or later, change the -x option (enter server mode) to -O (uppercase letter O), which means "enter server mode for One transaction only); this way, it is not stuck in server after the transfer. Also note that the Q is redundant in version 7.0, since fast Kermit protocol settings are now the default.

Note that in case the C-Kermit executable is called "wermit" or "ckermit" you can change "kermit" in the strings above to "wermit" or "ckermit" and C-Kermit 7.0 or later will recognize these as synonyms for "kermit", in case it is at its command prompt when one of these strings is sent to it.


4.7. File-Transfer Command Switches

Over the years, various new methods of transferring a file have accumulated, until we had, in addition to the SEND command, also MOVE (send and then delete), MAIL (send as email), REMOTE PRINT (send to be printed), CSEND (send the output of a command), PSEND (send a part of a file), BSEND (send in binary mode), RESEND (resume an interrupted SEND), etc etc. Similarly: GET, REGET, CGET, RETRIEVE, and so on.

Not only is it confusing to have different names for these commands, many of which are not real words, but this also does not allow all combinations, like "send a file as mail, then delete it".

In C-Kermit 7.0, the SEND, GET, and RECEIVE commands were restructured to accept modifier switches (switches are explained in Section 1.5).


4.7.1. SEND Command Switches

Without switches, the SEND command still works exactly as before:

  send oofa.txt      ; send a single file
  send oofa.*        ; send multiple files
  send oofa.txt x.x  ; send oofa.txt as x.x (tell receiver its name is x.x)
  send               ; send from SEND-LIST

But now the following modifier switches may be included between "send" and the filename. Zero, one, two, or more switches may be included in any combination that makes sense. Switch names (such as /BINARY) can be abbreviated, just like any other keywords. Most of these switches work only when using Kermit protocol (/TEXT and /BINARY are the exceptions).

/AFTER:date-time
Specifies that only those files modified (or, in VMS, created) after the given date-time (see Section 1.6) are to be sent. Examples:

  send /text /after:{2-Feb-1997 10:28:30} *.txt
  send /text /after:\fdate(oofa.txt) *.txt

Synonym: /SINCE.

/ARRAY:arrayname
Specifies that instead of sending a file, C-Kermit is to send the contents of the given array. Since an array does not have a filename, you should include an /AS-NAME switch to specify the name under which the array is to be sent (if you do not, the name "_array_x_" is used, where 'x' is replaced by the array designator). See section 7.10 for array-name syntax. As noted in that section, you can also include a range to have a segment of the array sent, rather than the whole thing; for example: "send /array:&a[100:199]". It is strongly recommended that you accompany the /ARRAY switch with a /TEXT or /BINARY switch to force the desired transfer mode, since otherwise the various automatic mechanisms might switch to binary mode when you really wanted text, or vice versa. In text mode a line terminator is added to the end of each array element, but not in binary mode. For details and examples see Section 7.10.11.

/AS-NAME:text
Specifies "text" as the name to send the file under. You can also still specify the as-name as the second filename on the SEND command line. The following two commands are equivalent:

  send oofa.txt oofa.new
  send /as:oofa.new oofa.txt

/BEFORE:date-time
Specifies that only those files modified (or, in VMS, created) before the given date-time (Section 1.6) are to be sent.

/BINARY
Performs this transfer in binary mode without affecting the global transfer mode, overriding not only the FILE TYPE and TRANSFER MODE settings, but also the FILE PATTERN setting, but for this SEND command only. In other words, SEND /BINARY means what it says: send the file in binary mode, regardless of any other settings. Example:

  set file type text      ; Set global transfer mode to text
  send /binary oofa.zip   ; Send a file in binary
  send oofa.txt           ; This one is sent in text mode

/COMMAND
SEND /COMMAND is equivalent to CSEND (Section 4.2.2) -- it says to send the output from a command, rather than the contents of a file. The first "filename" on the SEND command line is interpreted as the name of a command; the second (if any) is the as-name. Examples:

  send /command {grep Sunday oofa.txt} sunday.txt
  send /as-name:sunday.txt /command {grep Sunday oofa.txt}
  send /bin /command {tar cf - . | gzip -c} {!gunzip -c | tar xf -}

/DELETE
Deletes the file (or each file in the group) after it has been sent successfully (but does not delete it if it was not sent successfully). SEND /DELETE is equivalent to MOVE. Has no effect when used with /COMMAND. Example:

  send /delete *.log

/DOTFILES
(UNIX and OS-9 only) Normally files whose names begin with "." are skipped when matching wildcards that do not also beging with ".". Include /DOTFILES to force these files to be included too.

/RECURSIVE
Descend the through the directory tree when locating files to send. Automatically sets /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE. Explained in Section 4.11 .

/EXCEPT:pattern
See Section 1.5.4.

/NOBACKUP
This means to skip backup files when sending, even if they match the SEND file specification. This is equivalent to using SEND /EXCEPT and including *.~[0-9]*~ in the exception list (or *.~*~ if Kermit was built without pattern-matching support; see Section 4.9.1). Including this switch is equivalent to giving SET SEND BACKUP OFF (Section 4.0.6) prior to SEND, except its effect is local to the SEND command with which it was given.

/NODOTFILES
The opposite of /DOTFILES (q.v.)

/FILENAMES:{CONVERTED,LITERAL}
Use this switch to override the current global SET FILE NAMES setting for this transfer only.

/FILTER:command
This specifies a filter to pass the file through before sending it. See the section on file-transfer pipes and filters. The /FILTER switch applies only to the file-transfer command it is given with; it does not affect the global SEND FILTER setting, if any.

/IMAGE
VMS: Sends in image mode. Non-VMS: same as /BINARY.

/LABELED
VMS and OS/2 only: Sends in labeled mode.

/LARGER-THAN:number
Specifies that only those files that are longer than the given number of bytes are to be sent.

/LISTFILE:filename
Specifies that the files to be sent are listed in a file with the given filename. The file contains one filename per line. These filenames are not checked in any way; each filename is taken and does not use or depend on any Kermit-specific syntax. In particular, backslashes are not treated specially, leading and trailing spaces are not stripped, etc. However, if a filename contains wildcards, they are expanded. Example: If a file named files.txt contains the following lines:

  blah.txt
  oofa*
  x.x

(but without leading or trailing spaces), then the C-Kermit command "send /listfile:files.txt" will send the files blah.txt, x.x, and all files whose names start with "oofa", assuming the files exist and are readable. The /LISTFILE switch, can, of course, be used with other switches when it makes sense, for example, /EXCEPT, /BINARY, /AFTER, /SMALLER, /MOVE-TO, /DELETE, /AS-NAME with a template, etc.

/MAIL:address
Sends the file as e-mail to the given address or addresses. "send /mail:address filename" is equivalent to "mail filename address". You can include multiple addresses separated by commas. Examples:

  send /mail:kermit-support@columbia.edu packet.log
  send /mail:cmg,fdc,jrd oofa.txt

As with any switch argument, if the address or address list contains any spaces, you must enclose it in braces. The format of the addresses must agree with that understood by the mail-sending program on the receiver's computer.

/MOVE-TO:directory-name
Specifies that after each (or the only) source file is sent successfully, and ONLY if it is sent successfully, it should be moved to the named directory. If the directory name contains spaces, enclose it in braces. If the directory does not exist, it is created if possible; if it can't be created, the command fails and an error message is printed. Example:

  send /text /move-to:/users/olga/backup/ *.txt

/NOT-AFTER:date-time
Specifies that only those files modified at or before the given date and time are to be sent.

/NOT-BEFORE:date-time
Specifies that only those files modified at or after the given date and time are to be sent.

/PATHNAMES:{OFF,ABSOLUTE,RELATIVE}
Use this switch to override the current global SET SEND PATHNAMES setting for this transfer only. /PATHNAMES:ABSOLUTE or RELATIVE also sets /FILENAMES:LITERAL (also for this transfer only) since pathnames are not sent otherwise.

/RENAME-TO:text
Specifies that after the (or each) source file is sent successfully, and ONLY if it is sent successfully, it should be renamed to the name given. If the name contains spaces, enclose it in braces. If a file group is being sent, then the "text" must contain a variable reference such as \v(filename) (see Section 4.1). Example:

  send /rename-to:ok_\v(filename) *.*

This sends each file in the current directory and if it was sent successfully, changes its name to begin with "ok_".

/SMALLER-THAN:number
Specifies that only those files that are smaller than the given number of bytes are to be sent.

/SUBJECT:text
Subject for email. Actually, this is just a synonym for /AS-NAME. If the text includes spaces, you must enclose it in braces. If you don't specify a subject (or as-name), the name of the file is used as the subject. Example:

  send /mail:kermit-support@columbia.edu /subj:{As requested} packet.log

/PRINT:options
Sends the file to be printed, optionally specifying options for the printer. Equivalent to REMOTE PRINT filename options. Examples:

  send /print oofa.txt              ; No options.
  send /print:/copies=3 oofa.txt    ; "/copies=3" is a VMS PRINT switch.
  send /print:-#3 oofa.txt          ; "-#3" is a UNIX lpr switch.

/PROTOCOL:name
Uses the given protocol to send the file (Kermit, Zmodem, etc) for this transfer without changing global protocol. Only available in Kermit 95, UNIX, and OS-9. Example:

  set protocol kermit               ; Set global protocol
  send /proto:zmodem /bin oofa.zip  ; Send just this file with Zmodem
  send oofa.txt                     ; This file is sent with Kermit

/QUIET
When sending in local mode, this suppresses the file-transfer display.

/RECOVER
Used to recover from a previously interrupted transfer; SEND /RECOVER is equivalent to RESEND. Recovery only works in binary mode; SEND /RECOVER and RESEND include an implied /BINARY switch. Even then, recovery will successful only if (a) the original (interrupted) transfer was also in binary mode, or (b) if it was in text mode, the two Kermit programs run on platforms where text-mode transfers are not length-changing.

/STARTING:number
Starts sending the file from the given byte position. SEND /STARTING:n filename is equivalent to PSEND filename n.

/TEXT
Performs this transfer in text mode without affecting the global transfer mode, overriding not only the FILE TYPE and TRANSFER MODE settings, but also the FILE PATTERN setting, for this SEND command only. In other words, SEND /TEXT really send the file in text mode, regardless of any other settings or negotiations.

About mail... Refer to Section 4.7.1. The same rules apply as for file transfer. If you are mailing multiple files, you can't use an as-name (in this case, a subject) unless it contains replacement variables like \v(filenum). For example, if you:

  send /mail:somebody@xyz.com *.txt

Then each file will arrive as a separate email message with its name as the subject. But if you:

  send /mail:somebody@xyz.com /subject:{Here is a file} *.txt

Then each file message will have the same subject, which is probably not what you want. You can get around this with constructions like:

  send /mail:somebody@xyz.com /subject:{Here is \v(filename)} *.txt

which embed the filename in the subject.

The MOVE, CSEND, MAIL, and RESEND commands now also accept the same switches. And the switches are also operative when sending from a SEND-LIST (see Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed, pp.191-192), so, for example, it is now possible to SEND /PRINT or SEND /MAIL from a SEND-LIST.

The MSEND and MMOVE commands also take switches, but not all of them. With these commands, which take an arbitrary list of filespecs, you can use /BINARY, /DELETE, /MAIL, /PRINT, /PROTOCOL, /QUIET, /RECOVER, and /TEXT (and /IMAGE or /LABELED, depending on the platform). MMOVE is equivalent to MSEND /DELETE. (If you want to send a group of files, but in mixed transfer modes with per-file as-names, use ADD SEND-LIST and then SEND.)

The MSEND/MMOVE switches come before the filenames, and apply to all of them:

  msend /print /text *.log oofa.txt /etc/motd

If you type any of these commands (SEND, CSEND, MSEND, etc) followed by a question mark (?), you will see a list of the switches you can use. If you want to see a list of filenames, you'll need to type something like "send ./?" (UNIX, OS/2, Windows, etc), or "send []?" (VMS), etc. Of course, you can also type pieces of a filename (anything that does not start with "/") and then "?" to get a list of filenames that start that way; e.g. "send x.?" still works as before.

In UNIX, where "/" is also the directory separator, there is usually no ambiguity between a fully-specified pathname and a switch, except when a file in the root directory has the same name as a switch (as noted in Section 1.5):

  send /etc/motd                        ; Works as expected
  send /command                         ; ???

The second example interprets "/command" as a switch, not a filename. To send a file actually called "command" in the root directory, use:

  send {/command}

or other system-dependent forms such as //command, /./command, c:/command, etc, or cd to / and then "send command".


4.7.2. GET Command Switches

Without switches, the GET command still works about the same as before:

  get oofa.txt                          ; GET a single file
  get oofa.*                            ; GET multiple files

However, the mechanism for including an "as-name" has changed. Previously, in order to include an as-name, you were required to use the "multiline" form of GET:

  get
  remote-filespec
  local-name

This was because the remote filespec might contain spaces, and so there would be no good way of telling where it ended and where the local name began, e.g:

  get profile exec a foo

But now since we can use {braces} for grouping, we don't need the multiline GET form any more, and in fact, support for it has been removed. If you give a GET command by itself on a line, it fails and an error message is printed. The new form is:

GET [ switches... ] remote-name [ local-name ]
Ask the server to send the file whose name is remote-name. If the optional local-name is given, store it locally under this name. If the remote-name or local-name contains spaces, they must be enclosed in braces:

  get {profile exec a} foo
  get oofa.txt {~/My Files/Oofa text}

If you want to give a list of remote file specifications, use the MGET command:

MGET [ switches... ] remote-name [ remote-name [ remote-name ... ] ]
Ask the server to send the files whose names are given.

Now you can also include modifier switches between GET or MGET and the remote-name; most of the same switches as SEND:

/AS-NAME:text
Specifies "text" as the name to store the incoming file under. (This switch is not available for MGET.) You can also still specify the as-name as the second filename on the GET command line. The following two commands are equivalent:

  get oofa.txt oofa.new
  get /as:oofa.new oofa.txt

/BINARY
Tells the server to send the given file(s) in binary mode without affecting the global transfer mode. Example:

  set file type text      ; Set global transfer mode to text
  get /binary oofa.zip    ; get a file in binary mode
  get oofa.txt            ; This one is transferred in text mode

Or, perhaps more to the point:

  get /binary foo.txt     ; where "*.txt" is a text-pattern

This has the expected effect only if the server is C-Kermit 7.0 or later or K95 1.1.19 or later.

/COMMAND
GET /COMMAND is equivalent to CGET (Section 4.2.2) -- it says to receive the file into the standard input of a command, rather than saving it on disk. The /AS-NAME or the second "filename" on the GET command line is interpreted as the name of a command. Examples:

  get /command sunday.txt {grep Sunday oofa.txt}
  get /command /as-name:{grep Sunday oofa.txt} sunday.txt
  get /bin /command {!gunzip -c | tar xf -} {tar cf - . | gzip -c}

/DELETE
Asks the Kermit server to delete the file (or each file in the group) after it has been transferred successfully (but not to delete it if it was not sent successfully). GET /DELETE is equivalent to RETRIEVE. Example:

  get /delete *.log

/EXCEPT:pattern
Specifies that any files whose names match the pattern, which can be a regular filename, or may contain "*" and/or "?" metacharacters, are to be refused upon arrival. To specify multiple patterns (up to 8), use outer braces around the group, and inner braces around each pattern:

  /EXCEPT:{{pattern1}{pattern2}...}

See the description of SEND /EXCEPT in Section 4.7.1 for examples, etc. Refusal is accomplished using the Attribute Rejection mechanism (reason "name"), which works only when Attribute packets have been successfully negotiated.

/FILENAMES:{CONVERTED,LITERAL}
Use this switch to override the current global SET FILE NAMES setting for this transfer only.

/FILTER:command
This specifies a filter to pass the incoming file through before writing to disk. See the section on file-transfer pipes and filters. The /FILTER switch applies only to the file-transfer command it is given with; it does not affect the global RECEIVE FILTER setting, if any.

/IMAGE
VMS: Transfer in image mode. Non-VMS: same as /BINARY.

/LABELED
VMS and OS/2 only: Specifies labeled transfer mode.

/MOVE-TO:directory
This tells C-Kermit to move each file that is successfully received to the given directory. Files that are not successfully received are not moved. By default, files are not moved.

/PATHNAMES:{OFF,ABSOLUTE,RELATIVE,AUTO}
Use this switch to override the current global SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES setting for this transfer only. /PATHNAMES:ABSOLUTE or RELATIVE also sets /FILENAMES:LITERAL (also for this transfer only) since incoming pathnames would not be treated as pathnames otherwise. See Section 4.10.

/QUIET
When sending in local mode, this suppresses the file-transfer display.

/RECOVER
Used to recover from a previously interrupted transfer; GET /RECOVER is equivalent to REGET. Recovery only works in binary mode; SEND /RECOVER and RESEND include an implied /BINARY switch. Even then, recovery will successful only if (a) the original (interrupted) transfer was also in binary mode, or (b) if it was in text mode, the two Kermit programs run on platforms where text-mode transfers are not length-changing.

/RECURSIVE
Tells the server that the GET file specification applies recursively. This switch also automatically sets /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE in both the server AND the client. When used in conjunction with /DELETE, this "moves" a directory tree from the server's computer to the client's computer (except that only regular files are deleted from the server's computer, not directories; thus the original directories will be left, but will contain no files). Note that all servers that support /RECURSIVE do not necessarily do so in combination with other switches, such as /RECOVER. (Servers that do include C-Kermit 7.0 and later, K95 1.1.19 and later.)

/RENAME-TO:string
This tells C-Kermit to rename each file that is successfully received to the given string. Files that are not successfully received are not renamed. By default, files are not renamed. The string can be a literal string, which is appropriate when only one file is being received, or it can contain one or more variables that are to be evaluated at the time each file is received, such as \v(filename), \v(filenumber), \v(ntime), \v(pid), \v(user), etc. WARNING: if you give a literal string and more than one file arrives, each incoming file will be given the same name (but SET FILE COLLISION BACKUP or RENAME can be used to keep the incoming files from overwriting each other).

/TEXT
Tells the server to perform this transfer in text mode without affecting its global transfer mode. See /BINARY for additional info.

The /MAIL and /PRINT options are not available (as they are for SEND), but you can use /COMMAND to achieve the same effect, as in these UNIX examples:

  get /command oofa.txt {mail kermit@columbia.edu}
  get /command oofa.txt lpr

In OS/2 or Windows, you can GET and print like this:

  get oofa.txt prn

The CGET, REGET, RETRIEVE commands also accept the same switches as GET. CGET automatically sets /COMMAND; REGET automatically sets /RECOVER and /BINARY, and RETRIEVE automatically sets /DELETE.


4.7.3. RECEIVE Command Switches

Without switches, the RECEIVE command still works as before:

  receive            ; Receives files under their own names
  receive /tmp       ; Ditto, but into the /tmp directory
  r                  ; Same as "receive"
  receive foo.txt    ; Receives a file and renames to foo.txt

Now you can also include modifier switches may be included between "receive" and the as-name; most of the same switches as GET:

/AS-NAME:text
Specifies "text" as the name to store the incoming file under. You can also still specify the as-name as a filename on the command line. The following two commands are equivalent:

  r oofa.new
  r /as:oofa.new

/BINARY
Performs this transfer in binary mode without affecting the global transfer mode. NOTE: This does not override the incoming filetype (as it does with GET), so this switch is useful only if ATTRIBUTE TYPE is OFF, or if the other Kermit does not send a TYPE (text or binary) attribute. In any case, it has no affect whatsoever on the file sender.

/COMMAND
RECEIVE /COMMAND is equivalent to CRECEIVE (Section 4.2.2) -- it says to receive the file into the standard input of a command, rather than saving it on disk. The /AS-NAME or the "filename" on the RECEIVE command line is interpreted as the name of a command.

  r /command {grep Sunday oofa.txt}
  r /command /as-name:{grep Sunday oofa.txt}
  r /bin /command {tar cf - . | gzip -c}

/EXCEPT:pattern
Specifies that any files whose names match the pattern, which can be a regular filename, or may contain "*" and/or "?" metacharacters, are to be refused upon arrival. To specify multiple patterns (up to 8), use outer braces around the group, and inner braces around each pattern:

  /EXCEPT:{{pattern1}{pattern2}...}

See the description of SEND /EXCEPT in Section 4.7.1 for examples, etc. Refusal is accomplished using the Attribute Rejection mechanism (reason "name"), which works only when Attribute packets have been successfully negotiated.

/FILENAMES:{CONVERTED,LITERAL}
Use this switch to override the current global SET FILE NAMES setting for this transfer only.

/FILTER:command
This specifies a filter to pass the incoming file through before writing to disk. See the section on file-transfer pipes and filters. The /FILTER switch applies only to the file-transfer command it is given with; it does not affect the global RECEIVE FILTER setting, if any.

/IMAGE
VMS: Transfer in image mode. Non-VMS: same as /BINARY. See comments under RECEIVE /BINARY.

/LABELED
VMS and OS/2 only: Specifies labeled transfer mode. See comments under RECEIVE /BINARY.

/MOVE-TO:directory
This tells C-Kermit to move each file that is successfully received to the given directory. Files that are not successfully received are not moved. By default, files are not moved.

/PATHNAMES:{ABSOLUTE,RELATIVE,OFF,AUTO}
Use this switch to override the current global SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES setting for this transfer only. See Section 4.10.

/RECURSIVE
When used with the RECEIVE command, /RECURSIVE is simply a synonym for /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE.

/RENAME-TO:string
This tells C-Kermit to rename each file that is successfully received to the given string. Files that are not successfully received are not renamed. By default, files are not renamed. The string can be a literal string, which is appropriate when only one file is being received, or it can contain one or more variables that are to be evaluated at the time each file is received, such as \v(filename), \v(filenumber), \v(ntime), \v(pid), \v(user), etc. WARNING: if you give a literal string and more than one file arrives, each incoming file will be given the same name (but SET FILE COLLISION BACKUP or RENAME can be used to keep the incoming files from overwriting each other).

/QUIET
When receiving in local mode, this suppresses the file-transfer display.

/TEXT
Receives in text mode without affecting the global transfer mode. See comments under RECEIVE /BINARY.

The /MAIL and /PRINT options are not available, but you can use /COMMAND to achieve the same effect, as in these UNIX examples:

  r /command {mail kermit@columbia.edu}
  r /command lpr

In OS/2 or Windows, you can RECEIVE and print like this:

  receive prn

The CRECEIVE command now also accepts the same switches.


4.8. Minor Kermit Protocol Improvements

4.8.1. Multiple Attribute Packets

C-Kermit 7.0 now sends more than one Attribute packet if a file's attributes do not fit into a single packet of the negotiated length. If a particular attribute (such as file creation date-time) does not fit within the negotiated length (which will only happen when the negotiated length is around 20 or less), that attribute is not sent at all.

4.8.2. Very Short Packets

There are certain situations where extremely short packets must be used; 20 or 30 bytes at most. This can happen when one or more devices along the communication path have very small buffers and lack an effective means of flow control. Examples are sometimes cited involving radio modems.

When the maximum packet length is shorter than certain packets that would be sent, those packets are either truncated or else broken up into multiple packets. Specifically:

  1. Parameter negotiation packets (I, S, and their ACKs) are truncated to the negotiated length. Any parameters that do not fit are reset to their default values. There is no provision in the Kermit protocol for fragmentation and reassembly of parameter strings.

  2. File header packets (containing the filename) are simply truncated. There is no provision in the Kermit protocol for fragmentation and reassembly of filenames.

  3. Attribute packets are fragmented and reassembled as described in 4.8.1 without loss of data, except in case a field will not fit at all in the negotiated length (the longest attribute is usually the date and time of file creation/modification) because of the rule that attributes may not be broken across packets.

  4. Data packets and other packets are unaffected -- they can be as short as they need to be, within reason.


4.9. Wildcard / File Group Expansion

"Wildcard" refers to the notation used in filenames to specify a group of files by pattern matching.

4.9.1. In UNIX C-Kermit

Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, C-Kermit was capable of expanding wildcard strings containing only the "metacharacters" '*' and '?':

*
Matches any sequence of zero or more characters. For example: "ck*.c" matches all files whose names start with "ck" and end with ".c", including "ck.c".

?
Matches any single character. For example, "ck?.c" matches all files whose names are exactly 5 characters long and start with "ck" and end with ".c". When typing commands at the prompt, you must precede any question mark to be used for matching by a backslash (\) to override the normal function of question mark, which is providing menus and file lists.

C-Kermit 7.0 adds the additional features that users of ksh, csh, and bash are accustomed to:

[abc]
Square brackets enclosing a list of characters matches any single character in the list. Example: ckuusr.[ch] matches ckuusr.c and ckuusr.h.

[a-z]
Square brackets enclosing a range of characters; the hyphen separates the low and high elements of the range. For example, [a-z] matches any character from a to z.

[acdm-z]
Lists and ranges may be combined. This example matches a, c, d, or m through z.

{string1,string2,...}
Braces enclose a list of strings to be matched. For example: ck{ufio,vcon,cmai}.c matches ckufio.c, ckvcon.c, or ckcmai.c. The strings may themselves contain metacharacters, bracket lists, or indeed, other lists of strings, but (when matching filenames) they may not contain directory separators.

Thus, the metacharacters in filenames (and in any other field that can be a pattern, such as the IF MATCH pattern, SEND or GET exception lists, etc) are:

 * ? [ {

And within braces only, comma (,) is a metacharacter.

To include a metacharacter in a pattern literally, precede it with a backslash '\' (or two if you are passing the pattern to a macro). Examples:

  send a*b      ; Send all files whose names start with 'a' and end with 'b'.
  send a?b      ; Ditto, but the name must be exactly three characters long.
  send a[a-z]b  ; Ditto, but the second character must be a lowercase letter.
  send a[x\-z]b ; Ditto, except the second character must be 'x', '-', or 'y'.
  send a[ghi]b  ; Ditto, except the second character must be 'g', 'h', or 'i'.
  send a[?*]b   ; Ditto, except the second character must be '?' or '*'.
  send a[\?\*]b ; Same as previous.
  send *?[a-z]* ; All files with names containing at least one character
                ; that is followed by a lowercase letter.

Or, more practically:

  send ck[cuw]*.[cwh]  ; Send the UNIX C-Kermit source files.

To refer to the C-Kermit sources files and makefile all in one filespec:

  {{makefile,ck[cuw]*.[cwh]}}

(NOTE: if the entire pattern is a {stringlist}, you must enclose it it TWO pairs of braces, since the SEND command strips the outer brace pair, because of the "enclose in braces if the filename contains spaces" rule).

If the makefile is called ckuker.mak:

  ck[cuw]*.{[cwh],mak}

(NOTE: double braces are not needed here since the pattern does not both begin and end with a brace.)

To add in all the C-Kermit text files:

  ck[cuw]*.{[cwh],mak,txt}

All of these features can be used anywhere you would type a filename that is allowed to contain wildcards.

When you are typing at the command prompt, an extra level of quoting is required for the '?' character to defeat its regular function of producing a list of files that match what you have typed so far, for example:

  send ck[cu]?

lists all the files whose names start with ckc and cku. If you quote the question mark, it is used as a pattern-matching character, for example:

  send ck\?[ft]io.c

sends all the file and communications i/o modules for all the platforms: ckufio.c, ckutio.c, ckvfio.c, ckvtio.c, etc.

If, however, a filename actually contains a question mark and you need to refer to it on the command line, you must use three (3) backslashes. For example, if the file is actually called ck?fio.c, you would use:

  send ck\\\?fio.c

Further notes on quoting:

C-Kermit's new pattern matching capabilities are also used when C-Kermit is in server mode, so now you can send requests such as:

  get ck[cuw]*.[cwh]

to a C-Kermit server without having to tell it to SET WILD SHELL first. Previously this would have required:

  mget ckc*.c ckc*.w ckc*.h cku*.c cku*.w cku*.h ckw*.c ckw*.w ckw*.h

The new pattern matching features make SET WILD SHELL redundant, and barring any objections, it will eventually be phased out. (One possible reason for retaining it would be as an escape mechanism when Kermit does not understand the underlying file system.)

By the way, patterns such as these are sometimes referred to as "regular expressions", but they are not quite the same. In a true regular expression (for example), "*" means "zero or more repetitions of the previous item", so (for example), "([0-9]*)" would match zero or more digits in parentheses. In Kermit (and in most shells), this matches one digit followed by zero or more characters, within parentheses. Here are some hints:

In other wildcarding news...

When building file lists in UNIX, C-Kermit follows symbolic links. Because of this, you might encounter any or all of the following phenomena:

The size of the file list that Kermit can build is limited in most C-Kermit implementations. The limit, if any, depends on the implementation. Use the SHOW FEATURES command and look in the alphabetized options list for MAXWLD to see the value.

4.9.2. In Kermit 95

Kermit 95 1.1.19 and later uses the same pattern matching syntax as in UNIX, but (as always) you will encounter numerous difficulties if you use backslash (\) as the directory separator. In any command where K95 parses filenames itself (that is, practically any file-oriented command except RUN), you can use forward slash (/) as the directory separator to avoid all the nasty conflicts.

4.9.3. In VMS, AOS/VS, OS-9, VOS, etc.

Platforms other than UNIX, Windows 95/98/NT, and OS/2 have their own filename matching capabilities that are, in general, different from Kermit's built-in ones and in any case might conflict with them. For example, [] encloses directory names in VMS.

Nevertheless you can still use all the pattern-matching capabilities described in Section 4.9.1 by loading a file list into an array (e.g. with \ffiles(*,&a), see Section 4.11.3) and then using IF MATCH on the members.


4.10. Additional Pathname Controls

In version 6.0 and earlier, C-Kermit's SET { SEND, RECEIVE } PATHNAMES command had only ON and OFF as options. In version 7.0, there are more choices:

SET SEND PATHNAMES OFF
When sending a file, strip all disk/directory information from the name. Example: "send /usr/olga/letters/oofa.txt" sends the file as "oofa.txt". This applies to actual filenames, not to any as-name you might specify.

SET SEND PATHNAMES RELATIVE
When sending a file, leave the pathname on as given. For example, if your current directory is /usr/olga, "send letters/oofa.txt" sends the file as "letters/oofa.txt", not "/usr/olga/letters/oofa.txt" or "letters.txt".

SET SEND PATHNAMES ABSOLUTE
When sending a file, convert its name to the full, absolute local pathname. For example, if your current directory is /usr/olga, "send letters/oofa.txt" sends the file as "/usr/olga/letters/oofa.txt". NOTE: Even with this setting, device and/or node names are not included. For example, in VMS, any node or device name is stripped; in Windows or OS/2, any disk letter is stripped.

SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES OFF
When receiving a file, strip all disk/directory information from the name before attempting to store it. This applies to incoming filename, not to any as-name you might specify. Example: If a file arrives under the name "/usr/olga/letters/oofa.txt" it is stored simply as "oofa.txt" in your download directory or, if no download directory has been specified, in your current directory.

SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES RELATIVE
When receiving a file, leave the pathname on as it appears in the incoming name, but if the incoming name appears to be absolute, make it relative to your current or download directory. Examples:

SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES ABSOLUTE
The incoming filename is used as given. Thus it cannot be stored unless the given path (if any) already exists or can be created. In this case, node, device, or disk designations are NOT stripped, since they most likely were given explicitly by the user as an as-name, meant to be used as given.

SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES AUTO
This is the default, and means RELATIVE if the sender tells me it is a recursive transfer, OFF otherwise.

Set FILE NAMES CONVERTED now also affects pathnames too. When PATHNAMES are RELATIVE or ABSOLUTE and FILE NAMES are CONVERTED, the file sender converts its native directory-name format to UNIX format, and the file receiver converts from UNIX format to its native one; thus UNIX format is the common intermediate representation for directory hierarchies, as it is in the ZIP/UNZIP programs (which is why ZIP archives are transportable among, UNIX, DOS, and VMS).

Here's an example in which a file is sent from Windows to UNIX with relative pathnames and FILE NAMES CONVERTED:

  Source name                Intermediate name      Destination Name
  C:\K95\TMP\OOFA.TXT        K95/TMP/OOFA.TXT       k95/tmp/oofa.txt

In a more complicated example, we send the same file from Windows to VMS:

  Source name                Intermediate name      Destination Name
  C:\K95\TMP\OOFA.TXT        K95/TMP/OOFA.TXT       [.K95.TMP]OOFA.TXT

(Note that disk letters and device designations are always stripped when pathnames are relative).

As you can imagine, as more and more directory formats are considered, this approach keeps matters simple: on each platform, Kermit must know only its own local format and the common intermediate one. In most cases, the receiver can detect which format is used automatically.


4.11. Recursive SEND and GET: Transferring Directory Trees

C-Kermit 7.0 in selected versions (UNIX, VMS, VOS, AOS/VS, Windows, and OS/2 at this writing) now permits the SEND command to traverse directories "recursively" if you ask it to; that is, to send files from the current or specified directory and all of its subdirectories too, and their subdirectories, etc. (Some other commands can do this too, including DIRECTORY.)

This feature is new to UNIX, Windows, VOS, and OS/2. VMS and AOS/VS have always included "wildcard" or "template" characters that allow this, and in this case, recursive directory traversal could happen behind Kermit's back, i.e. Kermit does not have to do it itself (in VMS, the notation is "[...]" or "[directory...]"; in AOS/VS is "#"). In C-Kermit 7.0, however, SEND /RECURSIVE is supported by C-Kermit itself for VMS.


4.11.1. Command-Line Options

To descend a directory tree when sending files, use the -L command-line option to indicate that the send operation is to be recursive, and include a name or pattern to be sent. When giving a pattern, you should enclose it in quotes to prevent the shell from expanding it. Examples:

  $ kermit -Ls "/usr/olga/*" # send all of Olga's files in all her directories
  $ kermit -Ls foo.txt       # send all foo.txt files in this directory tree
  $ kermit -Ls "*.txt"       # send all .txt files in this directory tree
  $ kermit -Ls "letters/*"   # send all files in the letters directory tree
  $ kermit -Ls letters       # send all files in the letters directory tree
  $ kermit -Ls "*"           # send all files in this directory tree
  $ kermit -Ls .             # UNIX only: send all files in this directory tree
  $ kermit -s .              # UNIX only: a filename of . implies -L

If you let the shell expand wildcards, Kermit only sends files whose names match files in the current or given directory, because the shell replaces an unquoted wildcard expression with the list of matching files -- and the shell does not build recursive lists. Note that the "." notation for the tree rooted at the current directory is allowed only in UNIX, since in Windows and OS/2, it means "*.*" (nonrecursive).


4.11.2. The SEND /RECURSIVE Command

If you include the /RECURSIVE switch in a SEND (or MOVE, or similar) command, it means to descend the current or specified directory tree searching for files whose names match the given name or pattern. Since this is not terribly useful unless you also include pathnames with the outbound files, the /RECURSIVE switch also includes an implicit /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE switch (which you can undo by including an explicit /PATHNAMES switch after the /RECURSIVE switch).

Examples:

SEND /RECURSIVE *
Sends all of the files in the current directory and all the files in all of its subdirectories, and all of their subdirectories, etc, including their relative pathnames. Empty directories are not sent.

SEND /RECURSIVE /PATHNAMES:ABSOLUTE *
Sends all of the files in the current directory and all the files in all of its subdirectories, and all of their subdirectories, etc, including their absolute pathnames.

SEND /RECURSIVE /PATHNAMES:OFF *
Sends all of the files in the current directory and all the files in all of its subdirectories, and all of their subdirectories, etc, without pathnames.

SEND /RECURSIVE /usr/olga/*
Sends all of the files in the /usr/olga directory and all the files in all of its subdirectories, and all of their subdirectories, etc.

SEND /RECURSIVE /usr/olga (or /usr/olga/)
Same as above. If the name is a directory name (with or without a trailing slash), its files are sent, and those of its subdirectories, and their subdirectories, etc (see Section 4.9).

SEND /RECURSIVE /TEXT /usr/olga/*.txt
As above, but only files whose names end with ".txt" are sent, and they are sent in text mode (as they would be by default anyway if SET FILE PATTERNS is ON or AUTO).

SEND .
UNIX only: Send all the files in the current directory.

SEND /RECURSIVE .
UNIX only: Sends all of the files in the current directory and all of its subdirectories, etc (Section 4.9).

The /RECURSIVE switch is different from most other switches in that its effect is immediate (but still local to the command in which it is given), because it determines how filenames are to be parsed. For example, "send *.txt" fails with a parse error ("No files match") if there are no *.txt files in the current directory, but "send /recursive *.txt" succeeds if there are ".txt" files anywhere in the tree rooted at the current directory.

The /RECURSIVE switch also affects the file lists displayed if you type "?" in a filename field. "send ./?" lists the regular files in the current directory, but "send /recursive ./?" lists the entire directory tree rooted at the current directory.


4.11.3. The GET /RECURSIVE Command

In a client/server setting, the client can also request a recursive transfer with:

GET /RECURSIVE [ other switches ] remote-filespec [ local-spec ]

In which remote file specification can be a directory name, a filename, a wildcard, or any combination. If the local-spec is not given (and PATHNAMES are RELATIVE), incoming files and directories go into the current local directory. If local-spec is given and is a directory, it becomes the root of the tree into which the incoming files and directories are placed. If local-spec has the syntax of a directory name (e.g. in UNIX it ends with /), C-Kermit creates the directory and then places the incoming files into it. If local-spec is a filename (not recommended), then all incoming files are stored with that name with collisions handled according to the FILE COLLISION setting.

Again, the normal method for transferring directory trees uses relative pathnames, and this is the default when the sender has been given the /RECURSIVE switch. The action at the receiver depends on its RECEIVE PATHNAMES setting. The default is AUTO, meaning that if the sender tells it to expect a recursive transfer, then it should automatically switch to relative pathnames for this transfer only; otherwise it obeys the RECEIVE PATHNAMES setting of OFF, ABSOLUTE, or RELATIVE.

What happens if a file arrives that has an absolute pathname, when the receiver has been told to use only relative pathnames? As a security precaution, in this case the receiver treats the name as if it was relative. For example, if a file arrives as:

  /usr/olga/oofa.txt

The receiver creates a "usr" subdirectory in its current directory, and then an "olga" subdirectory under the "usr" subdirectory in which to store the incoming file.

Suppose, however there is a sequence of directories:

  /usr/olga/a/b/c/d/

in which "a" contains nothing but a subdirectory "b", which in turn contains nothing but a subdirectory "c", which in turn contains nothing but a subdirectory "d", which contains nothing at all. Thus there are no files in the "/usr/olga/a/" tree, and so it is not sent, and therefore it is not reproduced on the target computer.


4.11.4. New and Changed File Functions

C-Kermit 7.0 adds the following functions:

\ffiles(pattern[,&a])
This function has been changed to match only regular files in the current or given directory, and to take an optional array name as a second argument (explained below).

\fdirectories(pattern[,&a])
Returns the number of directories that match the given pattern. If the pattern does not include a directory, then the search is performed in the current directory.

\frfiles(pattern[,&a])
Returns the number of files in the current or given directory and all of its subdirectories, and their subdirectories, etc, that match the given pattern. Warning -- this one can take quite some time if performed at the root of a large directory tree.

\frdirectories(pattern[,&a])
Returns the number of directories in the current or given directory and all of its subdirectories, and their subdirectories, etc, that match the given pattern.

Each of these functions builds up a list of files to be returned by the \fnextfile() function, just as \ffiles() always has done. (This can also be done with the /ARRAY switch of the DIRECTORY command; see Sections 4.5.1 and 7.10).

Each of these functions can be given an array name as an optional second argument. If an array name is supplied, the array will contain the number of files as its 0th element, and the filenames in elements 1 through last. If the array already existed, its previous contents are lost. For example, if the current directory contains two files, oofa.txt and foo.bar, then "\ffiles(*,&a)" creates an array \&a[] with a dimension of 2, containing the following elements:

 \&a[0] = 2
 \&a[1] = oofa.txt
 \&a[2] = foo.bar

If no files match the specification given in the first argument, the array gets a dimension of 0, which is the same as undeclaring the array.

Note that the order in which the array is filled (and in which \fnextfile() returns filenames) is indeterminate (but see Section 7.10.5).

Here's an example that builds and prints a list of all the file whose names end in .txt in the current directory and all its descendents:

  asg \%n \frfiles(*.txt)
  declare \&a[\%n]
  for \%i 1 \%n 1 {
      asg \&a[\%i] \fnextfile()
      echo \flpad(\%i,4). "\&a[\%i]"
  }

Alternatively, using the array method, and then printing the filenames in alphabetic order (see Section 7.10.3 and 7.10.5):

  asg \%n \frfiles(*.txt,&a)
  sort &a
  for \%i 1 \%n 1 {
      echo \flpad(\%i,4). "\&a[\%i]"
  }

Or even more simply:

  asg \%n \frfiles(*.txt,&a)
  sort &a
  show array &a

As noted elsewhere, the file lists built by \ffiles(), \frfiles(), etc, are now "safe" in the sense that SEND and other file-related commands can reference \fnextfile() without resetting the list:

  set send pathnames relative
  for \%i 1 \frfiles(*.txt) 1 {
      asg \%a \fnextfile()
      echo Sending \%a...
      send \%a
      if fail break
  }

Copying to an array (as shown on p.398 of Using C-Kermit 2nd Ed) is no longer necessary.


4.11.5. Moving Directory Trees Between Like Systems

4.11.5.1. UNIX to UNIX

Transferring a directory tree from one computer to another replicates the file sender's arrangement of files and directories on the file receiver's computer. Normally this is done using relative pathnames, since the user IDs might not be identical on the two computers. Let's say both computers are UNIX based, running C-Kermit 7.0 or later. On the sending computer (leaving out the connection details, etc):

  C-Kermit> cd /usr/olga
  C-Kermit> send /recursive .

The /RECURSIVE switch tells C-Kermit to descend through the directory tree and to include relative pathnames on outbound filenames.

On the receiving computer:

  C-Kermit> mkdir olgas-files           ; Make a new directory.
  C-Kermit> cd olgas-files              ; CD to it.
  C-Kermit> receive /recursive          ; = /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE

Each Kermit program recognizes that the other is running under UNIX and switches to binary mode and literal filenames automatically. Directories are automatically created on the receiving system as needed. File dates and permissions are automatically reproduced from source to destination.

4.11.5.2. VMS to VMS

To send recursively from VMS, simply include the /RECURSIVE switch, for example at the sender:

  $ kermit
  C-Kermit> cd [olga]
  C-Kermit> send /recursive *.*;0

And at the receiver:

  C-Kermit> cd [.olga]
  C-Kermit> receive /recursive

The notation "..." within directory brackets in VMS means "this directory and all directories below it"; the /RECURSIVE switch, when given to the sender, implies the use of "..." in the file specification so you don't have to include "..."; but it makes no difference if you do:

  $ kermit
  C-Kermit> send /recursive [olga...]*.*;0

And at the receiver:

  C-Kermit> cd [.olga]
  C-Kermit> receive /recursive

In either case, since both systems recognize each other as VMS, they switch into LABELED transfer mode automatically.


4.11.6. Moving Directory Trees Between Unlike Systems

There are several difficulties with recursive transfers between unlike systems:

So now, for the first time, it is possible to send directory trees among any combination of UNIX, DOS, Windows, OS/2, VMS, AOS/VS, etc. Here's an example sending files from an HP-UX system (where text files are encoded in the HP Roman8 character set) to a PC with K95 (where text files are encoded in CP850):

 Sender:
  cd xxx                           ; CD to root of source tree
  set file type binary             ; Default transfer mode
  set file character-set hp-roman8 ; Local character set for text files
  set xfer character-set latin1    ; Transfer character set
  set file patterns on             ; Enable automatic file-type switching...
  set file binary-patterns *.Z *.gz *.o  ; based on these patterns...
  set file text-patterns *.txt *.c *.h   ; for binary and text files.
  send /recursive *                ; Send all the file in this directory tree

 Receiver:
  cd yyy                           ; CD to root of destination tree
  set file character-set cp850     ; Local character set for text files
  receive /pathnames:relative      ; Receive with pathnames

Notes:

If you are refreshing an existing directory on the destination computer, use "set file collision update" or other appropriate file collision option to handle filename collisions.


4.12. Where Did My File Go?

Now that Kermit can be started by clicking on desktop icons (thus obscuring the concept of "current directory"), and can have a download directory, and can create directories for incoming files on the fly, etc, sometimes it is easy to lose a file after transfer. Of course, if you keep a transaction log:

  LOG TRANSACTIONS

it will record the fate and final resting place of each file. But in case you did not keep a log, the new command:

  WHERE

added in C-Kermit 7.0, gives you as much information as it has about the location of the last files transferred, including the pathname reported by the receiving Kermit, if any, when C-Kermit is the sender. This information was also added to SHOW FILE in somewhat less detail.


4.13. File Output Buffer Control

(UNIX only). The new command SET FILE OUTPUT lets you control how incoming files are written to disk:

SET FILE OUTPUT BUFFERED [ size ]
Chooses buffered file output; this is the default. UNIX does its normal sort of disk buffering. The optional size specifies Kermit's own file output buffer size, and therefore the frequency of disk accesses (write() system calls) -- the bigger the size, the fewer the disk accesses.

SET FILE OUTPUT UNBUFFERED [ size ]
This forces each file output write() call to actually commit the data to disk immediately. Choosing this option will usually slow file reception down.

SET FILE OUTPUT BLOCKING
Write() calls should not return until they are complete. This is the normal setting, and it lets Kermit detect disk-write errors immediately.

SET FILE OUTPUT NONBLOCKING
Write() calls should return immediately. This can speed up file reception, but also delay the detection of disk-write errors.

Experimentation with these parameters should be harmless, and might (or might not) have a perceptible, even dramatic, effect on performance.


4.14. Improved Responsiveness

In version 7.0, C-Kermit's file-transfer protocol engine has been tuned for additional speed and responsiveness.


4.15. Doubling and Ignoring Characters for Transparency

The following commands were added in 7.0, primarily to allow successful file transfer through ARPAnet TACs and with Honeywell DPS6 systems, but can be used in any setting where they might be needed:

SET SEND DOUBLE-CHAR { [ char [ char [ ... ] ] ], NONE }
Tells C-Kermit to double the specified characters (use decimal notation) in packets that it sends. For example, if you are sending files through a device that uses @ as an escape character, but allows you to send a single copy of @ through by doubling it, use "set send double 64".

SET RECEIVE IGNORE-CHAR [ char [ char [ ... ] ] ]
Tells C-Kermit to ignore the specified character(s) in incoming packets. Use this, for example, when something between the sender and receiver is inserting linefeeds for wrapping, NULs for padding, etc.


4.16. New File-Transfer Display Formats

SET TRANSFER DISPLAY { BRIEF, CRT, FULLSCREEN, NONE, SERIAL }
Selects the file-transfer display format.

BRIEF is the new one. This writes one line to the screen per file, showing the file's name, transfer mode, size, the status of the transfer, and when the transfer is successful, the effective data rate in characters per second (CPS). Example:

  SEND ckcfn3.o (binary) (59216 bytes): OK (0.104 sec, 570206 cps)
  SEND ckcfns.o (binary) (114436 bytes): OK (0.148 sec, 772006 cps)
  SEND ckcmai.c (text) (79147 bytes): OK (0.180 sec, 438543 cps)
  SEND ckcmai.o (binary) (35396 bytes): OK (0.060 sec, 587494 cps)
  SEND ckcnet.o (binary) (62772 bytes): REFUSED
  SEND ckcpro.o (binary) (121448 bytes): OK (0.173 sec, 703928 cps)
  SEND ckcpro.w (text) (63687 bytes): OK (0.141 sec, 453059 cps)
  SEND makefile (text) (186636 bytes): OK (0.444 sec, 420471 cps)
  SEND wermit (binary) (1064960 bytes): OK (2.207 sec, 482477 cps)

Note that transfer times are now obtained in fractional seconds, rather than whole seconds, so the CPS figures are more accurate (the display shows 3 decimal places, but internally the figure is generally precise to the microsecond).


4.17. New Transaction Log Formats

The new command:

  SET TRANSACTION-LOG { VERBOSE, FTP, BRIEF [ separator ] }

lets you choose the format of the transaction log. VERBOSE (the default) indicates the traditional format described in the book. BRIEF and FTP are new. This command must be given prior to the LOG TRANSACTION command if a non-VERBOSE type is desired.

4.17.1. The BRIEF Format

BRIEF chooses a one-line per file format suitable for direct importation into databases like Informix, Oracle, or Sybase, in which:

The fields are:

  1. Date in yyyymmdd format
  2. Time in hh:mm:ss format
  3. Action: SEND or RECV
  4. The local filename
  5. The size of the file
  6. The transfer mode (text, binary, image, labeled)
  7. The status of the transfer: OK or FAILED
  8. Additional status-dependent info, in doublequotes.

Examples:

  20000208,12:08:52,RECV,/u/olga/oofa.txt,5246,text,OK,"0.284sec 18443cps"
  20000208,12:09:31,SEND,/u/olga/oofa.exe,32768,binary,OK,"1.243sec 26362cps"
  20000208,12:10:02,SEND,"/u/olga/a,b",10130,text,FAILED,"Refused: date"

Note how the filename is enclosed in doublequotes in the final example, because it contains a comma.

To obtain BRIEF format, you must give the SET TRANSACTION-LOG BRIEF command before the LOG TRANSACTIONS command. (If you give them in the opposite order, a heading is written to the log by the LOG command.)


4.17.2. The FTP Format

SET TRANSACTION-LOG FTP (available only in UNIX) chooses a format that is compatible with the WU-FTPD (Washington University FTP daemon) log, and so can be processed by any software that processes the WU-FTPD log. It logs only transfers in and out, both successful and failed (but success or failure is not indicated, due to lack of a field in the WU-FTPD log format for this purpose). Non-transfer events are not recorded.

Unlike other logs, the FTP-format transaction log is opened in append mode by default. This allows you to easily keep a record of all your kermit transfers, and it also allows the same log to be shared by multiple simultaneous Kermit processes or (permissions permitting) users. You can, of course, force creation of a new logfile by specifying the NEW keyword after the filename, e.g.

  log transactions oofa.log new

All records in the FTP-style log are in a consistent format. The first field is fixed-length and contains spaces; subsequent fields are variable length, contain no spaces, and are separated by one or more spaces. The fields are:

Timestamp
This is an asctime-style timestamp, example: "Wed Sep 16 20:19:05 1999" It is always exactly 24 characters long, and the subfields are always in fixed positions.

Elapsed time
The whole number of seconds required to transfer the file, as a string of decimal digits, e.g. "24".

Connection
The name of the network host to which C-Kermit is connected, or the name of the serial device through which it has dialed (or has a direct connection), or "/dev/tty" for transfers in remote mode.

Bytes transferred
The number of bytes transferred, decimal digits, e.g. "1537904".

Filename
The name of the file that was transferred, e.g. "/pub/ftp/kermit/a/README.TXT". If the filename contains any spaces or control characters, each such character is replaced by an underscore ('_') character.

Mode
The letter 'b' if the file was transferred in binary mode, or 'a' if it was transferred in text (ASCII) mode.

Options
This field always contains an underscore ('_') character.

Direction
The letter 'o' if the file was transferred Out, and 'i' if the file was transferred In.

User class
The letter 'r' indicates the file was transferred by a Real user.

User identification
The ID of the user who transferred the file.

Server identification
The string "kermit". This distinguishes a Kermit transfer log record from a WU-FTPD record, which contains "ftp" in this field.

Authentication class
The digit '1' if we know the user's ID on the client system, otherwise '0'. Currently, always '0'.

Authenticated user
If the authentication class is '1', this is the user's ID on the client system. Otherwise it is an asterisk ('*'). Currently it is always an asterisk.

Examples:

  Thu Oct 22 17:42:48 1998 0 * 94 /usr/olga/new.x a _ i r olga kermit 0 *
  Thu Oct 22 17:51:29 1998 1 * 147899 /usr/olga/test.c a _ o r olga kermit 0 *
  Thu Oct 22 17:51:44 1998 1 * 235 /usr/olga/test.o b _ i r olga kermit 0 *
  Fri Oct 23 12:10:25 1998 0 * 235 /usr/olga/x.ksc a _ o r olga kermit 0 *

Note that an ftp-format transaction log can also be selected on the Kermit command line as follows:

  kermit --xferfile:filespec

This is equivalent to:

  SET TRANSACTION-LOG FTP
  LOG TRANSACTIONS filespec APPEND

Conceivably it could be possible to have a system-wide shared Kermit log, except that UNIX lacks any notion of an append-only file; thus any user who could append to the log could also delete it (or alter it). This problem could be worked around using setuid/setgid tricks, but these would most likely interfere with the other setuid/setgid tricks C-Kermit must use for getting at dialout devices and UUCP logfiles.


4.18. Unprefixing NUL

As of 6.1.193 Alpha.10, C-Kermit can finally send and receive file-transfer packets in which NUL (ASCII 0) is unprefixed (no more NUL-terminated packets!). NUL is, of course, extremely prevalent in binary files such as executables, and this has been a significant source of packet overhead. For example, when transferring itself (the SunOS C-Kermit executable) with minimal prefixing and 9000-byte packets, we see:

  File size:                       1064960
  Packet chars with 0 prefixed:    1199629  overhead = 12.65%
  Packet chars with 0 unprefixed:  1062393  overhead = -0.03%

Transfer rates go up accordingly, not only because of the reduced amount of i/o, but also because less computation is required on each end.


4.19. Clear-Channel Protocol

Now that C-Kermit itself is capable of sending and receiving any byte at all on a clear channel (Section 4.18), it is, for the first time, in a position to negotiate a clear channel with the other Kermit, giving it permission (but not requiring it) to unprefix any and all characters that it knows are safe. In general this means all but the Kermit start-of-packet character (normally Ctrl-A), Carriage Return (not only Kermit's end-of-packet character, but also treated specially on Telnet NVT links), and IAC (255, also special to Telnet).

By default, C-Kermit will say it has a clear channel only if it has opened a TCP socket. Since the Kermit program on the far end of a TCP/IP connection generally does not know it has a TCP/IP connection, it will not announce a clear channel unless it has been told to do so. The command is:

SET CLEAR-CHANNEL { ON, OFF, AUTO }

AUTO is the default, meaning that the clear-channel status is determined automatically from the type of connection. ON means to announce a clear channel, OFF means not to announce it. Use SHOW STREAMING (Section 4.20) to see the current CLEAR-CHANNEL status. Synonym: SET CLEARCHANNEL.

CLEAR-CHANNEL is also set if you start C-Kermit with the -I switch (see Section 4.20).

Whenever a clear channel is negotiated, the resulting control-character unprefixing is "sticky"; that is, it remains in effect after the transfer so you can use SHOW CONTROL to see what was negotiated.

You can also see whether a clear channel was negotiated in the STATISTICS /VERBOSE Display.

The advantage of the clear channel feature is that it can make file transfers go faster automatically. The disadvantage would be file-transfer failures if the channel is not truly clear, for example if C-Kermit made a Telnet connection to a terminal server, and then dialed out from there; or if C-Kermit made an Rlogin connection to host and then made a Telnet connection from there to another host. If a file transfer fails on a TCP/IP connection, use SHOW CONTROL to check whether control characters became unprefixed as a result of protocol negotiations, and/or SHOW STREAMING (Section 4.20) to see if "clear-channel" was negotiated. If this happened, use SET CLEAR-CHANNEL OFF and SET PREFIXING CAUTIOUS (or whatever) to prevent it from happening again.


4.20. Streaming Protocol

A new Kermit protocol option called "streaming" was added in C-Kermit 7.0. The idea is that if the two Kermit partners have a reliable transport (such as TCP/IP or X.25) between them, then there is no need to send ACKs for Data packets, or NAKs, since a reliable transport will, by definition, deliver all packets in order and undamaged. On such a connection, streaming cuts down not only on Kermit program overhead (switching back and forth between reading and sending packets), but also tends to make the underlying transport use itself more efficiently (e.g. by defeating the Nagle algorithm and/or Delayed ACK stratagem of the TCP layer). Furthermore, it allows transfers to work smoothly on extremely slow network congestions that would otherwise cause timeouts and retransmissions, and even failure when the retry limit was exceeded.

The trick is knowing when we can stream:

  1. If C-Kermit has opened a TCP socket or X.25 connection, it offers stream.

  2. If C-Kermit has been started with the -I (uppercase) option, or if it has been told to SET RELIABLE ON, it offers to stream.

  3. If C-Kermit is in remote mode, and has been told to SET RELIABLE AUTO (or ON), it always offers to stream, and also always agrees to stream, if the other Kermit offers. Unless you take explicit actions to override the defaults, this allows the local Kermit (the one that made the connection, and so knows whether it's reliable) to control streaming.

(Note that an offer to stream also results in a Clear-Channel announcement if CLEAR-CHANNEL is set to AUTO; see Section 4.19.)

When BOTH Kermits offer to stream, then they stream; otherwise they don't. Thus streaming-capable Kermit programs interoperate automatically and transparently with nonstreaming ones. If the two Kermits do agree to stream, you'll see the word "STREAMING" on the fullscreen file-transfer display in the Window Slots field. You can also find out afterwards with the STATISTICS or SHOW STREAMING commands.

WARNING: Automatic choice of streaming is based on the assumption of a "direct" end-to-end network connection; for example, a Telnet or Rlogin connection from host A to host B, and transferring files between A and B. However, if your connection has additional components -- something "in the middle" (B) that you have made a network connection to, which makes a separate connection to the destination host (C), then you don't really have a reliable connection, but C-Kermit has no way of knowing this; transferring files between A and C will probably fail. In such cases, you'll need to tell the *local* C-Kermit to "set reliable off" before transferring files (it does no good to give this command to the remote Kermit since the local one controls the RELIABLE setting).

Streaming is like using an infinite window size, with no timeouts and no tolerance for transmission errors (since there shouldn't be any). It relies on the underlying transport for flow control, error correction, timeouts, and retransmission. Thus it is very suitable for use on TCP/IP connections, especially slow or bursty ones, since Kermit's packet timeouts won't interfere with the transfer -- each packet takes as long to reach its destination as it takes TCP to deliver it. If TCP can't deliver the packet within its own timeout period (over which Kermit has no control), it signals a fatal error. Just like FTP.

Streaming goes much faster than non-streaming when a relatively small packet length is used, and it tends to go faster than non-streaming with even the longest packet lengths. The Kermit window size is irrelevant to streaming protocol, but still might affect performance in small ways since it can result in different paths through the code.

The definition of "reliable transport" does not necessarily demand 8-bit and control-character transparency. Streaming can work with parity and/or control-character prefixing just as well (but not as fast) as without them; in such cases you can leave RELIABLE set to ON, but set CLEARCHANNEL and/or PARITY appropriately.

Maximum performance -- comparable to and often exceeding FTP -- is achieved on socket-to-socket connections (in which the considerable overhead of the terminal driver and Telnet or Rlogin server is eliminated) with long packets and the new "brief" file-transfer display (Section 4.16).


4.20.1. Commands for Streaming

SET RELIABLE { ON, OFF, AUTO }
SET RELIABLE ON tells Kermit that it has a reliable transport.
SET RELIABLE OFF tells Kermit the transport is not reliable.
SET RELIABLE AUTO tells Kermit that it should SET RELIABLE ON whenever it makes a reliable connection (e.g. TELNET or SET HOST on a TCP/IP or X.25 network), and when in remote mode it should believe the transport is reliable if the other Kermit says it is during Kermit protocol negotiation.

AUTO is the default; the Kermit program that makes the connection knows whether it is reliable, and tells the remote Kermit.

The RELIABLE setting has several effects, including:

If you TELNET or SET HOST somewhere, this includes an implicit SET RELIABLE ON command. The -I command-line option is equivalent to SET RELIABLE ON.

Since SET RELIABLE ON (and -I) also implies SET CLEAR CHANNEL ON, you might find that in certain cases you need to tell Kermit that even though the connection is reliable, it doesn't have a clear channel after all:

  SET CLEAR-CHANNEL OFF
  SET PREFIXING CAUTIOUS ; or whatever...

You can control streaming without affecting the other items with:

  SET STREAMING { ON, OFF, AUTO }

AUTO is the default, meaning streaming will occur if Kermit has made a TCP/IP connection or if RELIABLE is ON (or it was started with the -I command line option). OFF means don't stream; ON means offer to stream no matter what.


4.20.2. Examples of Streaming

Here we look at the use and behavior of streaming on several different kinds of connections, and compare its performance with non-streaming transfers.

4.20.2.1. Streaming on Socket-to-Socket Connections

Here we get streaming automatically when both Kermit programs are capable of it, since they both make socket connections. For example, on the far end:

  C-Kermit> set host * 3000
  C-Kermit> server

and on the near end:

  C-Kermit> set host foo.bar.xyz.com 3000
  (now give SEND and GET command)

All subsequent file transfers use streaming automatically.

Here are the results from 84 trials, run on a production network, disk-to-disk, in which a 1-MB binary file (the SunOS C-Kermit Sparc executable) was sent from a Sun Sparc-10 with SunOS 4.1.3 to an IBM Power Server 850 with AIX 4.1, socket-to-socket, over a 10Mbps 10BaseT Ethernet, using minimal control-character unprefixing, window sizes from 10 to 32, and packet sizes from 1450 to 9010:

                Streaming    Nonstreaming
  Max CPS         748955        683354
  Min CPS         221522        172491
  Mean CPS        646134        558680
  Median CPS      678043        595874
  Std Dev         101424        111493

Correlations:

  CPS and window size:   -0.036
  CPS and packet length:  0.254
  CPS and streaming:      0.382

Note that the relationship between streaming and throughput is significantly stronger than that between CPS and window size or packet length.

Also note that this and all other performance measurements in this section are snapshots in time; the results could be much different at other times when the load on the systems and/or the network is higher or lower.

In a similar socket-to-socket trial, but this time over a wide-area TCP/IP connection (from New York City to Logan, Utah, about 2000 miles), the following results were obtained:

                Streaming    Nonstreaming
  Max CPS         338226        318203
  Min CPS         191659        132314
  Mean CPS        293744        259240
  Median CPS      300845        273271
  Std Dev          41914         52351

Correlations:

  CPS and window size:    0.164
  CPS and packet length:  0.123
  CPS and streaming:      0.346


4.20.2.2. Streaming on Telnet Connections

In this case the local copy of Kermit is told to TELNET or SET HOST, and so it knows it has a reliable connection and -- unless it has been told not to -- will offer to stream, and the other Kermit program, since it has STREAMING set to AUTO, agrees.

Since we have a reliable connection, we'll also get control-character unprefixing automatically because of the new clear-channel protocol (Section 4.19).

Any errors that occur during streaming are fatal to the transfer. The message is "Transmission error on reliable link". Should this happen:

  1. Check the remote Kermit's flow control setting (SHOW COMMUNICATIONS). If it is NONE, change it to XON/XOFF, or vice versa. If it is XON/XOFF (or you just changed it to XOFF/XOFF), make sure the file sender is prefixing the XON and XOFF characters. In the most drastic case, use "set prefix all" to force prefixing of all control characters.

  2. The remote Telnet server might chop off the 8th bit. In that case, tell C-Kermit to "set parity space". Or, you might be able to force the Telnet to allow eight-bit data by telling C-Kermit to "set telopt binary request accept" -- that is, request the Telnet server to enter binary mode, and accept binary-mode bids from the server.

  3. The remote Telnet server might have a buffering limitation. If a and b don't cure the problem, tell the file receiver to "set receive packet-length 1000" (or other number -- use the largest one that works). This too, is no different from the non-streaming case (more about this in Section 4.20.2.3).

And remember you can continue interrupted binary-mode transfers where they left off with the RESEND (= SEND /RECOVER) command.

Here are the figures for the same 84 trials between the same Sun and IBM hosts as in 4.20.2.1, on the same network, but over a Telnet connection rather than socket-to-socket:

                  Streaming    Nonstreaming
  Max CPS         350088        322523
  Min CPS          95547        173152
  Mean CPS        321372        281830
  Median CPS      342604        291469
  Std Dev          40503         29948

Correlations:

  CPS and window size:    0.001
  CPS and packet length:  0.152
  CPS and streaming:      0.128

Here the effect is not as emphatic as in the socket-to-socket case, yet on the whole streaming tends to be beneficial.

Additional measurements on HP-UX using C-Kermit 7.0 Beta.06:

                  Windowing     Streaming
  HP-UX 8->8      not tested       14Kcps
  HP-UX 8->9      not tested       76Kcps
  HP-UX 8->10      36Kcps          66Kcps
  HP-UX 9->9      not tested      190Kcps
  HP-UX 9->10     160Kcps         378Kcps


4.20.2.3. Streaming with Limited Packet Length

The IRIX telnet server (at least the ones observed in IRIX 5.3 and 6.2) does not allow Kermit to send packets longer than 4096 bytes. Thus when sending from IRIX C-Kermit when it is on the remote end of a Telnet connection, the packet length must be 4K or less. Trials in this case (in which packet lengths range from 1450 to 4000) show a strong advantage for streaming, which would be evident in any other case where the packet length is restricted, and stronger the shorter the maximum packet length.

                  Streaming    Nonstreaming
  Max CPS         426187        366870
  Min CPS         407500        276517
  Mean CPS        415226        339168
  Median CPS      414139        343803
  Std Dev           6094         25851

Correlations:

  CPS and window size:    0.116
  CPS and packet length:  0.241
  CPS and streaming:      0.901


4.20.2.4. Streaming on Dialup Connections

Here "dialup" refers to a "direct" dialup connection, not a SLIP or PPP connection, which is only a particular kind of TCP/IP connection.

Attempt this at your own risk, and then only if (a) you have error-correcting modems, and (b) the connections between the modems and computers are also error-free, perfectly flow-controlled, and free of interrupt conflicts. Streaming can be used effectively and to fairly good advantage on such connections, but remember that the transfer is fatal if even one error is detected (also remember that should a binary-mode transfer fail, it can be recovered from the point of failure with RESEND).

To use streaming on an unreliable connection, you must tell both Kermits that the connection is reliable:

  kermit -I

or:

  C-Kermit> set reliable on

In this case, it will probably be necessary to prefix some control characters, for example if your connection is through a terminal server that has an escape character. Most Cisco terminal servers, for example, require Ctrl-^ (30, as well as its high-bit equivalent, 158) to be prefixed. To unprefix these, you'll need to defeat the "clear channel" feature:

  C-Kermit> set reliable on
  C-Kermit> set clear-channel off
  C-Kermit> set prefixing none
  C-Kermit> set control prefix 1 13 30 158 ; and whatever else is necessary

Dialup trials were done using fixed large window and packet sizes. They compare uploading and downloading of two common types of files, with and without streaming. Configuration:

HP-9000/715/33 -- 57600bps, RTS/CTS -- USR Courier V.34 -- V.34+V.42, 31200bps -- USR V.34+ Rackmount -- 57600bps, RTS/CTS -- Cisco terminal server -- Solaris 2.5.1. Packet size = 8000, Window Size = 30, Control Character Unprefixing Minimal (but including the Cisco escape character).

Since this is not a truly reliable connection, a few trials failed when a bad packet was received (most likely due to UART overruns); the failure was graceful and immediate, and the message was informative. The results of ten successful trials uploading and downloading the two files with and without streaming are:

	    Streaming..
            Off    On
   Upload   5194   5565   txt (= C source code, 78K)
            3135   3406   gz  (= gzip file, compressed, 85K)
 Download   5194   5565   txt
            3041   3406   gz

Each CPS figure is the mean of 10 results.

A brief test was also performed on a LAT-based dialout connection from a VAX 3100 with VMS 5.5 to a USR Courier V.34 connected to a DECserver 700 at 19200 bps. The 1-MB Sparc executable downloaded from a Sun to the VAX at 1100cps without streaming and 1900cps with streaming, using 8000-byte packets, 30 window slots, and minimal prefixing in both cases.


4.20.2.5. Streaming on X.25 Connections

We have only limited access to X.25 networks. One trial was performed in which the 1MB Solaris 2.4 Sparc executable was transferred over a SunLink X.25 connection; nothing is known about the actual physical connection. With a packet length of 8000 and a window size of 30, the file transferred at 6400 cps (using a maximum of 6 window slots). With the same packet length, but with streaming, it transferred without mishap at 6710 cps, about 5% faster.


4.20.3. Streaming - Preliminary Conclusions

The results vary with the particular connection, but are good overall. Although numerous lower-level tricks can be used to improve performance on specific platforms or connection methods, streaming occurs at a high, system-independent level of the Kermit protocol and therefore can apply to all types of platforms and (reliable) connections transparently.


4.21. The TRANSMIT Command

Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the TRANSMIT command transmitted in text or binary mode according to SET FILE TYPE { TEXT, BINARY }. But now that binary mode is likely to be the default for protocol transfers, it is evident that this not also an appropriate default for TRANSMIT, since binary-mode TRANSMIT is a rather specialized and tricky operation. Therefore, TRANSMIT defaults to text mode always, regardless of the FILE TYPE setting.

C-Kermit 7.0 expands the capabilities of the TRANSMIT command by adding the following switches (see Section 1.5). The new syntax is:

  TRANSMIT [ switches... ] filename

Zero or more switches may be included:

/PIPE
When /PIPE is included, "filename" is interpreted as a system command or program whose output is to be sent. Synonym: /COMMAND. Example:

  transmit /pipe finger

You may enclose the command in braces, but you don't have to:

  xmit /pipe {ls -l | sort -r +0.22 -0.32 | head}

/BINARY
Transmits the file (or pipe output) in binary mode.

/TEXT
Transmits the file (or pipe output) in line-oriented text mode. Current FILE CHARACTER-SET and TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET selections govern translation. Default.

/TRANSPARENT
Specifies text mode without character-set translation, no matter what the FILE and TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET selections are.

/NOWAIT
This is equivalent to SET TRANSMIT PROMPT 0, but for this TRANSMIT command only. Applies only to text mode; it means to not wait for any kind of echo or turnaround character after sending a line before sending the next line. (Normally Kermit waits for a linefeed.)

When TRANSMIT ECHO is ON, C-Kermit tries to read back the echo of each character that is sent. Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, 1 second was allowed for each echo to appear; if it didn't show up in a second, the TRANSMIT command would fail. Similarly for the TRANSMIT PROMPT character. However, with today's congested Internet connections, etc, more time is often needed:

SET TRANSMIT TIMEOUT number
Specifies the number of seconds to wait for an echo or the prompt character when TRANSMIT PROMPT is nonzero; the default wait is 1 second. If you specify 0, the wait is indefinite. When a timeout interval of 0 is specified, and a desired echo or prompt does not show up, the TRANSMIT command will not terminate until or unless you interrupt it with Ctrl-C; use SET TRANSMIT TIMEOUT 0 with caution.

Note: to blast a file out the communications connection without any kind of synchronization or timeouts or other manner of checking, use:

  SET TRANSMIT ECHO OFF
  SET TRANSMIT PROMPT 0 (or include the /NOWAIT switch)
  SET TRANSMIT PAUSE 0
  TRANSMIT [ switches ] filename

In this case, text-file transmission is not-line oriented and large blocks can be sent, resulting in a significant performance improvement over line-at-at-time transmission. Successful operation depends (even more than usual for the TRANSMIT command!) on a clean connection with effective flow control.

For details on TRANSMIT and character sets, see Section 6.6.5.4.


4.22. Coping with Faulty Kermit Implementations

Kermit protocol has been implemented in quite a few third-party commercial, shareware, and freeware software packages, with varying degrees of success. In most cases operation is satisfactory but slow -- only the bare minimum subset of the protocol is available -- short packets, no sliding windows, no attributes, etc. In other cases, the implementation is incorrect, resulting in failures at the initial negotiation stage or corrupted files.

C-Kermit 7.0 and Kermit 95 1.1.19 include some new defense mechanisms to help cope with the most common situations. However, bear in mind there is only so much we can do in such cases -- the responsibility for fixing the problem lies with the maker of the faulty software.


4.22.1. Failure to Accept Modern Negotiation Strings

The published Kermit protocol specification states that new fields can be added to the parameter negotiation string. These are to be ignored by any Kermit implementation that does not understand them; this is what makes the Kermit protocol extensible. Unfortunately, some Kermit implementations become confused (or worse) when receiving a negotiation string longer than the one they expect. You can try working around such problems by telling Kermit to shorten its negotiation string (and thus disable the corresponding new features):

  SET SEND NEGOTIATION-STRING-MAX-LENGTH number

Try a number like 10. If that doesn't work, try 9, 8, 7, 6, and so on.


4.22.2. Failure to Negotiate 8th-bit Prefixing

The published Kermit protocol specification states that 8th-bit prefixing (which allows transfer of 8-bit data over a 7-bit connection) occurs if the file sender puts a valid prefix character (normally "&") in the 8th-bit-prefix field of the negotiation string, and the receiver puts either a letter "Y" or the same prefix character. At least one faulty Kermit implementation exists that does not accept the letter "Y". To force C-Kermit / K-95 to reply with the other Kermit's prefix character rather than a "Y", give the following (invisible) command:

  SET Q8FLAG ON

Use SET Q8FLAG OFF to restore the normal behavior.


4.22.3. Corrupt Files

Refer to Section 4.22.2. Some Kermit implementations mistakenly interpret the "Y" as a prefix character. Then, whenever a letter Y appears in the data, the Y and the character that follows it are replaced by a garbage character. At this writing, we are not sure if there is any solution, but try "set send negotiation-string-max-length 6" and/or "set q8flag on".

File corruption can also occur when control characters within the file data are sent without prefixing, as at least some are by default in C-Kermit 7.0 and K-95. Some Kermit implementations do not handle incoming "bare" control characters. To work around, "set prefixing all".


4.22.4. Spurious Cancellations

The Kermit protocol specification states that if an ACK to a Data packet contains X in its data field, the transfer of the current file is canceled, and if it contains a Z, the entire transfer is canceled. At least one overzealous Kermit implementation applies this rule to non-Data packets as well, the typical symptom being that any attempt to transfer a file whose name begins with X or Z results in cancellation. This is because the file receiver typically sends back the name under which it stored the file (which might not be the same as the name it was sent with) in the ACK to the File Header packet. This is information only and should not cause cancellation. To work around the problem, use:

  SET F-ACK-BUG { ON, OFF }

ON tells Kermit not to send back the filename in the ACK to the file header packet as it normally would do (OFF puts Kermit back to normal after using ON).

A variation on the this bug occurs in an obscure Kermit program for MUMPS: When this Kermit program sends a file called (say) FOO.BAR, it requires that the ACK to its F packet contain exactly the same name, FOO.BAR. However, C-Kermit likes to send back the full pathname, causing the MUMPS Kermit to fail. SET F-ACK-BUG ON doesn't help here. So a separate command has been added to handle this situation:

  SET F-ACK-PATH { ON, OFF }

Normally it is ON (regardless of the SET SEND PATHNAMES setting). Use SET F-ACK-PATH OFF to instruct Kermit to send back only the filename without the path in the ACK to the F packet.


4.22.5. Spurious Refusals

Some Kermit implementations, notably PDP-11 Kermit 3.60 and earlier, have bugs in their handling of Attribute packets that can cause unwarranted refusal of incoming files, e.g. based on date or size. This can be worked around by telling one or both of the Kermit partners to:

  SET ATTRIBUTES OFF


4.22.6. Failures during the Data Transfer Phase

This can be caused by control-character unprefixing (Section 4.22.3 ), and fixed by:

  SET PREFIXING ALL

It can also have numerous other causes, explained in Chapter 10 of Using C-Kermit: the connection is not 8-bit transparent (so use "set parity space" or somesuch), inadequate flow control, etc. Consult the manual.


4.22.7. Fractured Filenames

At least one well-known PC-based communications package negotiates data compression, which (according to the protocol specification) applies to both the filename and the file data, but then fails to decompress the filename. Example: C-Kermit sends a file called R000101.DAT (where 000101 might be non-Y2K-wise YYMMDD notation), and the package in question stores the files as R~#0101.DAT. Workaround: Tell C-Kermit to SET REPEAT COUNTS OFF.


4.22.8. Bad File Dates

At least one well-known PC-based communications package negotiates the passing of file timestamps from sender to receiver, but when it is sending files, it always gives them a timestamp of 1 February 1970. Workaround: tell C-Kermit to SET ATTRIBUTE DATE OFF. You don't get the file's real date, but you also don't get 1 Feb 1970; instead the file gets the current date and time.


4.23. File Transfer Recovery

Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, RESEND (SEND /RECOVER) and REGET (GET /RECOVER) refused to work if FILE TYPE was not BINARY or the /BINARY switch was not included. Now these commands include an implied /BINARY switch, meaning they set the file type to binary for the duration of the command automatically.

In the client/server arrangement, this also forces the server into binary mode (if it is C-Kermit 7.0 or greater, or K95 1.1.19 or greater) so the recovery operation proceeds, just as you asked and expected.

BUT... Just as before, the results are correct only under the following conditions:

Note that these circumstances are more likely to obtain in C-Kermit 7.0, in which:

But also note that the automatic client/server transfer-mode adjustments do not work with versions of C-Kermit prior to 7.0 or K95 prior to 1.1.16.

If the prior transfer was in text mode:

But in C-Kermit 7.0 and K95 1.1.19 and later, incompletely transferred text files are not kept unless you change the default. But if you have done this, and you have an incompletely transferred text file, you'll need to:

Kermit has no way of knowing whether the previous transfer was in text or binary mode so it is your responsibility to choose the appropriate recovery method.

If you use C-Kermit to maintain parallel directories on different computers, using SET FILE COLLISION to transfer only those files that changed since last time, and the files are big enough (or the connection slow enough) to require SEND /RECOVER to resume interrupted transfers, you should remember that SEND /RECOVER (RESEND) overrides all FILE COLLISION settings. Therefore you should use SEND /RECOVER (RESEND) only on the file that was interrupted, not the file group. For example, if the original transfer was initiated with:

  SEND *

and was interrupted, then after reestablishing your connection and starting the Kermit receiver with SET FILE COLLISION UPDATE on the remote end, use the following sequence at the sender to resume the transfer:

  SEND /RECOVER name-of-interrupted-file

and then:

  SEND *

(In C-Kermit 7.0 and later, \v(filename) contains the name of the file most recently transferred, as long you have not EXITed from Kermit or changed directory, etc.


4.24. FILE COLLISION UPDATE Clarification

In UNIX, file modification dates are used when comparing the file date with the date in the attribute packet. In VMS, however, the file creation date is used. These two policies reflect the preferences of the two user communities.

Also, remember that the file date/time given in the attribute packet is the local time at the file sender. At present, no timezone conversions are defined in or performed by the Kermit protocol. This is primarily because this feature was designed at a time when many of the systems where Kermit runs had no concept of timezone, and therefore would be unable to convert (say, to/from GMT or UTC or Zulu time).

As a consequence, some unexpected results might occur when transferring files across timezones; e.g. commands on the target system that are sensitive to file dates might work (UNIX "make", backups, etc).

Timezone handling is deferred for a future release.


4.25. Autodownload Improvements

Refer to pages 164-165 of Using C-Kermit about the hazards of autodownload when C-Kermit is "in the middle". As of C-Kermit 7.0, no more hazards. If C-Kermit has TERMINAL AUTODOWNLOAD ON and it detects a packet of the current protocol type (Kermit or Zmodem), it "erases" the visual aspect of the packet that would be seen by the terminal (or, more to the point, the emulator, such as K95). This way, only C-Kermit goes into RECEIVE mode, and not also the terminal emulator through which C-Kermit is accessed. And therefore, it is no longer necessary to SET TERMINAL AUTODOWNLOAD OFF to prevent multiple Kermits from going into receive mode at once, but of course it is still necessary to ensure that, when you have multiple Kermits in a chain, that the desired one receives the autodownload.

The defaults have not been changed; Kermit 95 still has autodownload ON by default, and C-Kermit has it OFF by default.


5. CLIENT/SERVER

5.0. Hints

If you use SET SERVER GET-PATH to set up your server, and the GET-PATH does not include the server's current directory, clients can become quite confused. For example, "remote dir oofa.txt" shows a file named oofa.txt, but "get oofa.txt" fails. In this situation, you should either DISABLE DIR or make your GET-PATH include the current directory.


5.1. New Command-Line Options

The -G command-line option is like -g (GET), except the incoming file is sent to standard output rather than written to disk.

The -I option ("Internet") is used to tell a remote C-Kermit program that you are coming in via Internet Telnet or Rlogin and therefore have a reliable connection. The -I option is equivalent to SET RELIABLE ON and SET FLOW NONE.

The -O option ("Only One") tells C-Kermit to enter server mode but then exit after the first client operation.

See Section 9.3 for details.


5.2. New Client Commands

BYE and FINISH no longer try to do anything if a connection is not active. Thus a sequence like "hangup" followed by "bye" or "finish" will no longer get stuck in a long timeout-and-retransmission cycle, nor will it try to open a new connection.

REMOTE EXIT
Similar to FINISH, except it ensures that the Kermit server program exits back to the operating system or shell prompt. (FINISH would return it to its interactive prompt if it was started in interactive mode, and would cause it to exit if it entered server mode via command-line option.) When C-Kermit is to be the server, you can use { ENABLE, DISABLE } EXIT to control the client's access to this feature.

REMOTE MKDIR directory-name
Tells the client to ask the server to create a directory with the given name, which can be absolute or relative. The syntax of the directory name depends on the Kermit server (see next section); in all cases, it can be in the syntax of the system where the server is running (UNIX, VMS, DOS, etc) but newer servers also accept UNIX syntax, no matter what the underlying platform. The server will not execute this command if (a) it does not understand it, (b) a DISABLE MKDIR command has been given, or (c) a DISABLE CWD command has been given; otherwise, the command is executed, but will fail if the directory can not be created, in which cases most servers will attempt to return a message giving the reason for failure. The REMOTE MKDIR command succeeds if the remote directory is created, or if it already exists and therefore does not need to be created, and fails otherwise.

REMOTE RMDIR directory-name
Tells the client to ask the server to remove (delete) a directory with the given name. The same considerations apply as for REMOTE MKDIR.

REMOTE SET FILE INCOMPLETE { DISCARD, KEEP, AUTO }
Previously this was only available in its earlier form, REMOTE SET INCOMPLETE (no FILE). The earlier form is still available, but invisible. Also, AUTO was added, meaning KEEP if in binary mode, DISCARD otherwise.

REMOTE SET TRANSFER MODE { AUTOMATIC, MANUAL }
Tells the client to ask the server to set the given file-transfer mode. Automatic means (roughly): if the client and the server are running on the same kind of computer (e.g. both are on UNIX), then use binary mode automatically; if the system types are different, use some other method to automatically determine text or binary mode, such as filename pattern matching. MANUAL means, in this context, obey the client's FILE TYPE setting (TEXT or BINARY). Synonym: REMOTE SET XFER MODE.

[ REMOTE ] QUERY KERMIT function(args...)
Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the arguments were not evaluated locally. Thus it was not possible to have the server run the function with client-side variables as arguments. Now:

  define \%a oofa.*
  remote query kermit files(\%a)    ; Client's \%a
  remote query kermit files(\\%a)   ; Server's \%a

[ REMOTE ] LOGIN [ user [ password ] ]
LOGIN is now a synonym for REMOTE LOGIN.

LOGOUT
This command, when given in local mode, is equivalent to REMOTE LOGOUT. When given at the IKSD prompt, it logs out the IKSD. When given at the C-Kermit prompt when it has no connection, it does nothing.

Note that in C-Kermit 7.0, the REMOTE (or R) prefix is not required for QUERY, since there is no local QUERY command. The new top-level QUERY command does exactly what REMOTE QUERY (RQUERY) does.

All REMOTE commands now have single-word shortcuts:

 Shortcut   Full Form
  RASG       REMOTE ASSIGN
  RCD        REMOTE CD
  RCOPY      REMOTE COPY
  RDEL       REMOTE DELETE
  RDIR       REMOTE DIRECTORY
  REXIT      REMOTE EXIT
  RHELP      REMOTE HELP
  RHOST      REMOTE HOST
  RPWD       REMOTE PWD
  RSET       REMOTE SET
  etc.

The R prefix is not applied to LOGIN because there is already an RLOGIN command with a different meaning. It is not applied to LOGOUT either, since LOGOUT knows what to do in each case, and for symmetry with LOGIN.


5.2.1. Remote Procedure Definitions and Calls

This is nothing new, but it might not be obvious... REMOTE ASSIGN and REMOTE QUERY may be used to achieve remote procedure execution. The remote procedure can be defined locally or remotely.

A remote procedure call is accomplished as noted in the previous section:

  [ remote ] query kermit function-name(args...)

This invokes any function that is built in to the Kermit server, e.g.:

  [ remote ] query kermit size(foo.bar)

returns the size of the remote file, foo.bar.

Now note that C-Kermit includes an \fexecute() function, allowing it to execute any macro as if it were a built-in function. So suppose MYMACRO is the name of a macro defined in the server. You can execute it from the client as follows (the redundant "remote" prefix is omitted in the remaining examples):

  query kermit execute(mymacro arg1 arg2...)

The return value, if any, is the value of the RETURN command that terminated execution of the macro, for example:

  define addtwonumbers return \feval(\%1+\%2)

The client invocation would be:

  query kermit execute(addtwonumbers 3 4)
  7

The result ("7" in this case) is also assigned to the client's \v(query) variable.

To execute a remote system command or command procedure (shell script, etc) use:

  query kermit command(name args...)

Finally, suppose you want the client to send a macro to the server to be executed on the server end. This is done as follows:

  remote assign macroname definition
  query kermit execute(macroname arg1 arg2...)

Quoting is required if the definition contains formal parameters.


5.3. New Server Capabilities

5.3.1. Creating and Removing Directories

The C-Kermit 7.0 server responds to REMOTE MKDIR and REMOTE RMDIR commands. The directory name may be in either the native format of the server's computer, or in UNIX format. For example, a server running on VMS with a current directory of [IVAN] can accept commands from the client like:

  remote mkdir olga         ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (nonspecific format)
  remote mkdir .olga        ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (VMS format without brackets)
  remote mkdir olga/        ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (UNIX relative format)
  remote mkdir /ivan/olga   ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (UNIX absolute format)
  remote mkdir [ivan.olga]  ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (VMS absolute format)
  remote mkdir [.olga]      ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (VMS relative format)

5.3.1.1. Creating Directories

If a directory name is given that contains more than one segment that does not exist, the server attempts to create all the segments. For example, if the client says:

  REMOTE MKDIR letters/angry

a "letters" subdirectory is created in the server's current directory if it does not already exist, and then an "angry" subdirectory is created beneath it, if it does not already have one. This can repeated to any reasonable depth:

  REMOTE MKDIR a/b/c/d/e/f/g/h/i/j/k/l/m/n/o/p/q/r/s/t/u/v/w/z/y/z

5.3.1.2. Removing Directories

When attempting to execute a REMOTE RMDIR, the server can remove only a single directory, not an entire sequence or tree. The system service that is called to remove the directory generally requires not only that the server process has write delete access, but also that the directory contain no files.

In the future, a REMOTE RMDIR /RECURSIVE command (and the accompanying protocol) might be added. For now, use the equivalent REMOTE HOST command(s), if any.


5.3.2. Directory Listings

Directory listings are generated by C-Kermit itself, rather than by running the underlying system's directory command. Some control over the listing format can be obtained with the SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY command (Section 4.5.1). The following options affect listings sent by the server: /[NO]HEADING, /[NO]DOTFILES, and /[NO]BACKUP. In UNIX and VMS, the listing is always sorted by filename. There is, at present, no protocol defined for the client to request listing options of the server; this might be added in the future.

The server's directory listings are in the following format:

Protection or permissions:
In UNIX and OS-9, this is a 10-character field, left adjusted. In VMS it is a 22-character field, left-adjusted. In each case, the protection / permission codes are shown in the server platform's native format. In other operating systems, this field is not shown.

Size in bytes:
This is always a 10-character field. The file's size is shown as a decimal number, right adjusted in the field. If the file is a directory and its size can not be obtained, the size is shown as "<DIR>". Two blanks follow this field.

Date:
Always in yyyy-mm-dd hh:mm:ss numeric format, and therefore 19 characters long. If the file's date/time can't be obtained, zeros (0) are shown for all the digits. This field is followed by two blanks.

Filename:
This field extends to the end of the line. Filenames are shown relative to the server's current directory. In UNIX, symbolic links are shown as they are in an "ls -l" listing as "linkname -> filename".

In UNIX and VMS, listings are returned by the server in alphabetical order of filename. There are presently no other sort or selection options.

However, since these are fixed-field listings, all fields can be used as sort keys by external sort programs. Note, in particular, that the format used for the date allows a normal lexical on that field to achieve the date ordering. For example, let's assume we have a UNIX client and a UNIX server. In this case, the server's listing has the date in columns 22-40, and thus could be sorted by the UNIX sort program using "sort +0.22 -0.40" or in reverse order by "sort +0.22 -0.40r".

Since the UNIX client can pipe responses to REMOTE commands through filters, any desired sorting can be accomplished this way, for example:

C-Kermit> remote directory | sort +0.22 -0.40

You can also sort by size:

  C-Kermit> remote directory | sort +0.11 -0.19

You can use sort options to select reverse or ascending order. "man sort" (in UNIX) for more information. And of course, you can pipe these listings through any other filter of your choice, such as grep to skip unwanted lines.


5.4. Syntax for Remote Filenames with Embedded Spaces

C-Kermit and K95, when in server mode, assume that any spaces in the file specification in an incoming GET command are filename separators. Thus if the client gives a command like:

  get {oofa.txt oofa.bin}

or, equivalently:

  mget oofa.txt oofa.bin

the server tries to send the two files, oofa.txt and oofa.bin. But what if you want the server to send you a file named, say:

  D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL

How does the server know this is supposed to be one file and not seven? In this case, you need to the send file name to the server enclosed in either curly braces:

  {D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL}

or ASCII doublequotes:

  "D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL"

The method for doing this depends on your client. If your client is C-Kermit 7.0, any recent version of Kermit 95, or MS-DOS Kermit 3.16, then you have to enclose the name in braces just so the client can parse it, so to send braces or doublequotes to the server, you must put them inside the first, outside pair of braces. And you also need to double the backslashes to prevent them from being interpreted:

  get {{D:\\HP OfficeJet 500\\Images\\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL}}
  get {"D:\\HP OfficeJet 500\\Images\\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL"}

To get around the requirement to double backslashes in literal filenames, of course you can also use:

  set command quoting off
  get {{D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL}}
  get {"D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL"}
  set command quoting on

If you are giving a "kermit" command to the UNIX shell, you have to observe the shell's quoting rules, something like this:

  kermit -ig "{D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL}"

Here, the quotes go on the outside so UNIX will pass the entire filename, spaces, braces, and all, as a single argument to Kermit, and the backslashes are not doubled because (a) the UNIX shell ignores them since they are in a quoted string, and (b) Kermit ignores them since the interactive command parser is not activated in this case.


5.5. Automatic Orientation Messages upon Directory Change

C-Kermit 7.0, when acting as a server, can send an orientation message to the client whenever the server directory changes. For example, when the client gives a REMOTE CD command, the server sends the contents of the new directory's "Read Me" file to the client's screen. The following commands govern this feature:

SET SERVER CD-MESSAGE FILE name
Given to the servr, allows the message-file name to be specified at runtime. A list of names to look for can be given in the following format:

  {{name1}{name2}{name3}{...}}

e.g. SET SERVER CD-MESSAGE FILE {{./.readme}{README.TXT}{READ.ME}}

REMOTE SET SERVER CD-MESSAGE { ON, OFF }
Given to the client, lets the client control whether the server sends automatic CD messages.

SHOW SERVER
Given to server, includes CD-Message status.

The default CD message file name is system dependent. SHOW CD or SHOW SERVER displays the list. Also see Section 4.5.2.


5.6. New Server Controls

DISABLE ENABLE
Allows the server to configured such that DISABLEd features can not be re-enabled by any means -- e.g. if the client is somehow able to get the server into command mode. Once DISABLEd, ENABLE can not be re-ENABLEd.

SET SERVER IDLE-TIMEOUT seconds
This was available previously in Kermit 95 only. Now it can be used in C-Kermit also to specify a maximum number of seconds the server is allowed to be idle before exiting server mode. 0 seconds means no idle timeout. In C-Kermit (but not K-95), SET SERVER TIMEOUT and SET SERVER IDLE-TIMEOUT are mutually exclusive -- you can have one or the other (or neither), but not both. (Server timeouts are for the benefit of primitive Kermit clients that are not capable of timing out on their own; to our knowledge, no such clients are still in circulation.)

SET SERVER KEEPALIVE { ON, OFF }
(See next section).


5.7. Timeouts during REMOTE HOST Command Execution

Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the C-Kermit server would block waiting for output from a system command invoked via REMOTE HOST from the client. If the system command took a long time to execute, the client would time out and send NAK packets. If the command took too long, the client would reach its retry limit and give up. Even if it didn't, the NAKs would cause unnecessary retransmissions.

In version 7.0, the C-Kermit server (VMS and select()-capable UNIX versions only), sends "keepalive packets" (empty data packets) once per second while waiting for the system command to complete. This procedure should be entirely transparent to the Kermit client, and should prevent the unwanted timeouts and NAKs. When C-Kermit 7.0 itself (or K95 1.1.19) is the client, it prints dots to show the keepalive packets.

The keepalive feature can be turned off and on with:

  SET SERVER KEEPALIVE { ON, OFF }

Normally it should be on. Turn it off it if causes trouble with the client, or if it seems to slow down the server (as it might on some platforms under certain circumstances).


6. INTERNATIONAL CHARACTER SETS

Support for several new single-byte character sets was added in C-Kermit 7.0. Unicode / ISO 10646 is not yet supported, but is a high priority for forthcoming releases.

6.0. ISO 8859-15 Latin Alphabet 9

To accommodate the Euro currency symbol, and to correct several other longstanding problems with ISO Latin Alphabet 1, ISO 8859-15 Latin Alphabet 9 was issued in May 1998. It is supported by C-Kermit 7.0 as a transfer character set, a file character set, and a terminal character set. Translations that preserve the new characters are available between Latin-9 and several other sets including:

  PC Code Page 858         (Western European languages, similar to CP850)
  Windows Code Page 1252   (Western European languages, similar to Latin-1)
  Windows Code Page 1250   (Eastern European languages, similar to Latin-2)

The Latin-9 transfer character set also allows for the OE digraph character, used primarily in French, to be preserved in transfers involving the DEC MCS or NeXT character sets.

The Euro character is also present in the Universal Character Set, described in Section 6.6.

6.1. The HP-Roman8 Character Set

The HP-Roman8 character set is supported in C-Kermit 6.0 and later but was omitted from Table VII-4 in the 2nd Edition of Using C-Kermit due to lack of space. It is listed in Appendix III.

6.2. Greek Character Sets

Greek character sets were added in 6.1:

  SET FILE CHARACTER-SET { CP869, ELOT927, GREEK-ISO }
  SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET { GREEK-ISO }

GREEK-ISO is ISO 8859-7, which the same as ELOT 928.

The new Greek character sets are listed in Appendix III.

6.3. Additional Latin-2 Character Sets

The following have been added as FILE and TERMINAL CHARACTER-SETs:

MAZOVIA-PC
A PC code page used in Poland, equivalent to CP437, but with 18 substitutions needed for Polish.

CP1250
The Windows Latin 2 Code Page. Equivalent to ISO 8859-2, but with different encoding.

6.4. Additional Cyrillic Character Sets

The following have been added as FILE and TERMINAL CHARACTER-SETs:

BULGARIA-PC
This is the Cyrillic PC code page used in Bulgaria, where it is called Code Page 856. It is attributed to a company called DATEC, Inc, but CP856 is not a proper designation, since it refers to a Hebrew Code Page (see the IBM Registry).

CP855
This PC Code Page contains all the Cyrillic letters that are also in ISO 8859-5, and is therefore useful for non-Russian Cyrillic text (Ukrainian, Belorussian, etc), unlike CP866, which has a smaller repertoire of Cyrillic letters.

CP1251
The Windows Cyrillic Code Page. Equivalent to CP855, but with different encoding.

KOI8R
An extension to "Old KOI-8" that adds upper and lower case Cyrillic letter Io (looks like Roman E with diaeresis) plus a selection of box-drawing characters to columns 8 through 11, which are vacant in original Old KOI-8. KOI8-R is used for the Russian language. It is specified in RFC 1489.

KOI8U
A similar extension of Old KOI-8, but for Ukrainian. It is specified in RFC 2319.


6.5. Automatic Character-Set Switching

Prior to version 7.0, C-Kermit's file character-set always had to be set explicitly. In 7.0 and later, it is set automatically when:

  1. This feature is enabled (as it is unless you disable it).

  2. An incoming text-mode transfer includes a transfer-character-set announcer and you have not previously given a SET FILE CHARACTER-SET command. In this case, C-Kermit switches to an appropriate file character set. For example, on an HP-UX workstation, an incoming Latin-1 file automatically selects HP-Roman8 for the local copy of the file; in Data General AOS/VS, it would select DG International.

  3. You give a SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET command without having previously specified a FILE CHARACTER-SET. An appropriate file character-set is chosen automatically.

In addition, when you give a SET FILE CHARACTER-SET command, the appropriate transfer character-set is automatically chosen, to be used when you are sending files (but this does not override the one announced by the sender when you are receiving files).

You might not agree about what is "appropriate", so of course you can disable or change all of the above actions.

You can disable (or re-enable) the new automatic character-set switching feature in each direction separately:

SET RECEIVE CHARACTER-SET-SELECTION { AUTOMATIC, MANUAL }
AUTOMATIC is the default, causing the behavior described above when an incoming file arrives. Choose MANUAL to defeat this behavior and force your current FILE CHARACTER-SET setting to be used, no matter what it is. Note that SET RECEIVE CHARACTER-SET MANUAL does not disable recognition of the incoming transfer character-set announcer, and translation from the corresponding character-set to your current file character-set. To disable that, use SET ATTRIBUTE CHARACTER-SET OFF.

SET SEND CHARACTER-SET-SELECTION { AUTOMATIC, MANUAL }
Again AUTOMATIC is the default, causing the behavior described above when you give a SET { FILE, TRANSFER } CHARACTER-SET command. Use MANUAL to allow you to specify the transfer and file character-sets independently.

SHOW CHARACTER-SETS
Tells settings of { SEND, RECEIVE } CHARACTER-SET-SELECTION.

Normally, however, it is more convenient to leave automatic switching active, and change any associations that are not appropriate for your application, area, or country. The commands are:

SHOW ASSOCIATIONS
This command lists all the associations in each direction: for each possible transfer character-set, it lists the associated file character-set, and vice versa. These are two separate and independent lists.

ASSOCIATE TRANSFER-CHARACTER-SET name1 [ name2 ]
Changes the association for the transfer character-set name1 to be the file character-set name2. If name2 is omitted, automatic switching is disabled for this transfer character-set only.

ASSOCIATE FILE-CHARACTER-SET name1 [ name2 ]
Changes the association for the file character-set name1 to be the transfer character-set name2. If name2 is omitted, automatic switching is disabled for this file character-set only.


6.6. UNICODE

C-Kermit 7.0 adds support for Unicode, the Universal Character Set, for:

C-Kermit is not, however, a "Unicode application" in the sense that its commands, messages, or user interface are Unicode. Rather, it is "Unicode aware" in its ability to handle and convert Unicode text in the course of file transfer and terminal connection, and you can also use Kermit to convert local files between Unicode and other character sets. TLA's:

  BMP - Base Multilingual Plane
  BOM - Byte Order Mark
  CJK - Chinese, Japanese, and Korean
  ISO - International Standards Organization
  TLA - Three-Letter Acronym
  UCS - Universal Character Set
  UTF - UCS Transformation Format

Unicode and ISO 10646 are the coordinated and compatible corporate and international standards for the Universal Character Set (UCS). Unlike single-byte and even most multibyte character sets, the UCS can represent all characters in every existing writing system. A flat plain-text file encoded in some form of UCS can contain any mixture of English, Spanish, Italian, German, Hebrew, Arabic, Greek, Russian, Armenian, Georgian, Japanese, Chinese, Korean, Vietnamese, Tibetan, Hindi, Bengali, Tamil, Thai, Ethiopic, and so on, plus scientific and mathematical notation, as well as texts in Runes, Ogham, Glagolitic, and other historic scripts.

The UCS already covers these scripts and many more, but it's an evolving standard with efforts underway to accommodate even more languages and writing systems. Support is growing for native UCS use on many platforms and in many applications. The goal of the framers of the UCS is for it to replace ASCII, the ISO Latin Alphabets, ISCII, VISCII, the Chinese, Japanese, and Korean (CJK) multibyte sets, etc, as well as the many private character sets in use today, in other words to become *the* Universal Character Set.

Until that time, however, conversions between existing sets and the UCS will be necessary when moving text between platforms and applications. Now Kermit can help.


6.6.1. Overview of Unicode

For a more complete picture, please visit:

  http://www.unicode.org/

and access the various online introductions, FAQs, technical reports, and other information. For greater depth, order the latest version of the published Unicode Standard. The following overview contains a great many oversimplifications and perhaps an opinion or two.

At present, the UCS is a 16-bit (2-byte) character set, but with provisions to grow to a 4-byte set. UCS-2 refers to the two-byte set, also called the Base Multilingual Plane (BMP), in which each character has 16 bits, and therefore there are 2^16 = 65536 possible characters. The first 128 characters are the same as US ASCII (C0 control characters and DEL included), the next 32 are the C1 control characters of ISO 6429, and the next 96 are the Right Half of ISO 8859-1 Latin Alphabet 1. The remaining tens of thousands of characters are arranged newly for the UCS, usually (but not always) in sections corresponding to existing standards, such as ISO Latin/Cyrillic, often plus additional characters not appearing in the existing standards due to lack of space (or other reasons).

ISO 10646 allows for additional planes, e.g. for Egyptian hieroglyphics or ancient (or other esoteric) CJK characters, but these planes are not yet defined and so we will say nothing more about them here, except that their use will require the 4-byte form of UCS, called UCS-4, in some form (more about "forms" in Section 6.6.2).

Unicode and ISO 10646 are constantly under revision, mainly to add new characters. The Unicode revision is denoted by a version number, such as 1.0, 1.1, 2.0, 3.0. The ISO 10646 standard revision is identified by Edition (such as ISO 10646-1 1993), plus reference to any amendments. The first versions of these standards included encodings for Korean Hangul syllables (Jamos); these encodings were changed in version 1.1 of Unicode and by Amendment 5 to ISO 10646-1. The Unicode Technical Committee and the ISO acknowledge that this was a bad thing to do, and promise never change encodings or character names again, since this poses serious problems for conformance and data interchange.

A UCS-2 value is customarily written like this:

  U+xxxx

where "xxxx" represents four hexadecimal digits, 0-9 and A-F. For example, U+0041 is "A", U+00C1 is A-acute, U+042F is uppercase Cyrillic "Ya", U+FB4F is Hebrew Ligature Alef Lamed, and U+FFFD is the special character that means "not a character".

Most characters from widely-used alphabetic writing systems such as the West European ones, Cyrillic, Greek, Hebrew, Vietnamese, etc, are available in "precomposed" form; for example Uppercase Latin Letter A with Acute Accent is a single character (as it is in Latin-1). However, the UCS also permits composition of a base character with one or more nonspacing diacritics. This means the same character can be represented in more than one way, which can present problems in many application areas, including transfer and character-set conversion of text.

Conversion from ASCII or Latin-1 to UCS-2 text is "trivial": simply insert a NUL (0) byte before each ASCII or Latin-1 byte. Converting in the reverse direction (provided the UCS-2 file contains only U+0000 to U+00FF) is equally simple (if we ignore the issue of composition): remove every second (NUL) byte. Conversion of other character sets to and from UCS, however, requires tables or algorithms specific to each set. Nevertheless, the relatively transparent upwards compatibility from ASCII and Latin-1, in which a very large share of the world's textual data is encoded, gives the UCS an entree onto existing platforms.

But the 2-byte format and the preponderance of NUL and other control bytes in UCS-2 text pose problems for current applications and transmission methods. And to make matters worse, different hardware platforms store UCS-2 characters in different byte order. Thus a UCS-2 file transferred by FTP (or accessed via NFS, etc) between two computers with different architecture might have its bytes in the wrong order (or worse; see Section 6.6.5.1 ).


6.6.2. UCS Byte Order

Consider the number 1. In an 8-bit byte, this would be represented by the following series of 0- and 1-bits:

  +-----------------+
  | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 |
  +-----------------+

Therefore in a 16-bit "word" the representation might be:

  +-----------------+-----------------+
  | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 |
  +-----------------+-----------------+

Now consider the number 256, which is 2 to the 8th power. The binary representation is 100000000 (1 followed by 8 zeros). 256 would go into a 16-bit word like this:

  +-----------------+-----------------+
  | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 |
  +-----------------+-----------------+

When a computer works this way, it is said to be Big Endian, meaning it puts the most significant (biggest) byte first (on the "left") in a 16-bit word, and the least significant byte second (on the right).

However, some other computers have the opposite arrangement, called Little Endian, in which 1 is:

  +-----------------+-----------------+
  | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 |
  +-----------------+-----------------+

and 256 is:

  +-----------------+-----------------+
  | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 |
  +-----------------+-----------------+

Computers such as Sparc, MIPS, PA-RISC, and PowerPC are Big Endian, whereas the PC and the Alpha are Little Endian. Endianness has never been an issue with 7- or 8-bit characters, but it is with UCS characters. It can be a tricky business to share or transfer a UCS-2 file between two different kinds of computers.

To alleviate (but not entirely solve) the problem, UCS-2 files are supposed to begin with the Unicode character U+FEFF, Zero-Width No-Break Space (ZWNBS). This is a kind of "no-op" (note: any such assertion must normally be qualified with many "but ifs" and "excepts" which are omitted here in the interest of brevity). If the bytes are reversed the ZWNBS becomes U+FFFE, which is not (and never will be) a defined UCS character. U+FEFF at the beginning of a UCS file is therefore called a Byte Order Mark, or BOM.

Any application that creates a UCS-2 (or UTF-16, or UCS-4) file should include a BOM, and any application that reads one should test for a BOM, and if one is found, infer the byte order from it. This is a convention, however -- not a standard or a requirement -- and applications vary in their ability to handle BOMs and "backwards" UCS-2 files.

Note that a BOM is useful only at the beginning of a file. If you append one UCS-2 file to another, and both have BOMs, the internal BOM is no longer a BOM. And if the byte orders of the two files differ, then either the first part or the second will be backwards. (Various other undesirable effects might also occur, not discussed here.)


6.6.2. UCS Transformation Formats

UCS textual data can be modified in various ways for transmission or storage. Any officially sanctioned method of doing this is called a UCS Transformation Format, or UTF. One such method, called UTF-16, is essentially identical with UCS-2 except that it designates certain code values as "escape sequences" (called surrogate pairs) to access characters in other planes without having to use full UCS-4. We won't discuss UTF-16 further here, since at the moment there are no other planes. Several other UTF's (such as UTF-1, UTF-2, and UTF-7) have fallen into disuse and are not discussed here. The most important transformation format today is UTF-8.

UTF-8, so called because it "serializes" UCS-2 data into a stream of 8-bit bytes, is designed to allow the UCS to work with present-day communications gear, computers, and software. The most important properties of UTF-8 are that byte order is constant (no byte swapping) and all (7-bit) ASCII characters represent themselves. Therefore conversion between ASCII and UTF-8 is no conversion at all, and applications or platforms (such as Plan 9 from Bell Labs) that use UTF-8 "for everything" can still run traditional ASCII-only applications and be accessed from them. In particular, unlike UCS-2, ASCII characters are not padded with NUL bytes. But also unlike UCS-2, there is no transparency for Latin-1 or any other non-ASCII character set. Every non-ASCII UCS-2 character is represented by a sequence of 2 or 3 UTF-8 bytes. Thus UTF-8 is more compact than UCS-2 for text containing a preponderance of ABC's (or other ASCII characters), about the same as UCS-2 for other alphabetic scripts (Cyrillic, Roman, Greek, etc), and larger than UCS-2 for Chinese, Japanese, and Korean.

The UTF-8 uncoding of the UCS has been adopted by the Internet as the preferred character set for new applications, and is gradually being retrofitted into traditional applications like FTP (RFC 2640).


6.6.3. Conformance Levels

Although the Unicode and ISO 10646 standards both describe the same character set, these standards differ in many ways, including their stated requirements for conformance and their classification of conformance levels.

Kermit has always abided by ISO character-set standards, including ISO character-set designation and invocation methods. In adapting Unicode, therefore, we had to choose from among the available ISO designations which, in turn, correspond with ISO 10646 conformance levels. At present, Kermit claims the lowest conformance level, 1, meaning (roughly) that it does not handle combining forms and it does not handle Korean Hangul Jamos (just as, at present, it does not handle Korean in general). Note that ISO 10646 Conformance Levels 1 and 2 sidestep the issue of the code changes for Korean Hangul by announcing non-support for Hangul regardless of encoding.

ISO 10646 Conformance Level 1 is approximately equivalent to Unicode Normalization Form C (described in Unicode Technical Report 15, incorporated into Unicode 3.0).

As noted in Section 6.6.2, Kermit does not claim to support UTF-16 at the present time, hence the UCS-2 nomenclature. Kermit treats surrogates just as if they were any other UCS-2 characters, rather than as escapes to other planes, which means that (except when converting between UCS-2 and UTF-8) they are translated to "error" characters, since (a) no other planes are defined yet (and if they were, no other character sets supported by Kermit would encode their characters), and (b) no valid surrogate character corresponds to any other UCS-2 character.

A minor yet significant aspect of Unicode 3.0 and some recent perturbation of ISO 10646-1 (probably Amendment 18, "Symbols and Other Characters") is the addition of the Euro Sign at U+20AC. As noted in Section 6.0, Kermit's "Euro compliance" includes conversion between Latin Alphabet 9 and various PC code pages. Text can also be converted between UCS-2 or UTF-8 and any other Euro-compliant character set (Latin-9, CP858, CP1250, CP1252) without loss of the Euro Sign.


6.6.4. Relationship of Unicode with Kermit's Other Character Sets

Kermit's character sets are divided into two groups: single-byte sets (such as Roman, Hebrew, Cyrillic, Greek) and multibyte (various Japanese sets). The two groups are distinct since one normally would not expect to convert Kanji ideograms to Roman (or other) letters, or vice versa.

Unicode character-set conversion works with both groups, but obviously the result depends on the repertoires of the source and destination character-sets both including the characters in the file. For example, you can translate a Hungarian text file between Latin-2 and Unicode, but not between (say) Unicode and Latin/Greek. By the same token you can convert Japanese text from Shift-JIS or EUC or JIS-7 to Unicode and back, but you can't convert the same file to (say) Latin-1 if it contains Japanese characters.

JIS-7 is equivalent to DEC Kanji and ISO-2022-JP except that the latter two do not support halfwidth Katakana. Kermit treats all three of these sets the same way, i.e. as JIS-7.

As noted, Kermit presently does not handle combining diacritics, and so will not correctly convert UCS files that use them into a single-byte character set. For example, if a UCS file contains Latin Capital Letter A (U+0041) followed by Combining Acute Accent (U+0301), the result will be a two-character sequence, A followed by another character. This is what is meant by Conformance Level 1. (The situation grows worse with multiple diacritics, since they can occur in any order.)

A higher level of conformance is possible, in which "canonical equivalences" are handled via algorithms and databases, at some (perhaps considerable) cost in performance, since a fair amount of additional code must be executed for every character during data transfer (database lookup, sorting of combining sequences into canonical order, etc). This can be added in future releases if there is a need (but in many cases, pre- and postpostprocessing might be a better option).

Within these constraints, Kermit converts between the UCS and its other character sets. For example, a mixture of Russian and English (and/or Dutch, or Latin) text can bet converted between the UCS and ISO Latin/Cyrillic or KOI-8. But since Kermit does not presently support Arabic character-set conversion, the new availability of UCS conversion does not mean that Kermit can convert from Arabic UCS text to some other character set, because Kermit does not support any other character set that includes Arabic. Ditto for Thai, Armenian, Georgian, Tibetan, Chinese, Korean, etc. However, Kermit CAN convert Arabic (or any other script) between UCS-2 and UTF-8.

Considering Cyrillic more carefully, note that the UCS also contains numerous Cyrillic characters not found in any of the Cyrillic sets (ISO Latin/Cyrillic, KOI8, CP866, etc) that Kermit supports; characters needed for Abkhasian, Yakut, Tatar, Bashkir, Altaic, Old Church Slavonic, etc; UCS text containing any of these historic or "extended" Cyrillic characters can not be converted to any of Kermit's current single-byte Cyrillic sets without loss. The situation is similar for Greek, Hebrew, etc, and even worse for Japanese since Unicode contains thousands of Kanjis that are lacking from the Japanese character sets based on JIS X 0208, such as EUC-JP, JIS-7, and Shift-JIS.

In general, when converting from UCS to a single-byte set, there is always the possibility of data loss, just as there is when converting from any larger set to a smaller one. For example, if a UCS file contains Devanagari characters, these characters will be lost when converting to (say) Latin-1, just as Roman vowels with acute accents are lost when converting from Latin-1 (an 8-bit set) to German ISO 646 (a 7-bit set).


6.6.5. Kermit's Unicode Features

C-Kermit can convert between UCS-2 or UTF-8 and any of its other character sets, and also between UCS-2 and UTF-8. When converting between UCS-2 or UTF-8 and a non-Unicode character set (such as Latin-1), the UCS Line Separator (LS, U+2028) and Paragraph Separator (PS, U+2029) characters are converted to the appropriate line terminator (CR, LF, or CRLF). When converting from a non-Unicode set to UCS-2 or UTF-8, however, line terminators are not converted to LS or PS. This is in accordance with the recommendations of Unicode Technical Report #13.

When C-Kermit starts, it tests the native byte order of the computer. You can see the result in the SHOW FEATURES or SHOW FILE display. It's also available in the variable \v(byteorder): 0 means Big Endian, 1 means Little Endian.

When UCS-2 is involved in file transfer or translation, the following commands tell C-Kermit what to do about byte order:

SET FILE UCS BYTE-ORDER { BIG-ENDIAN, LITTLE-ENDIAN }
This is for reading UCS-2 files that don't have a BOM, and also for writing UCS-2 files. If this command is not given, the machine's native byte order is used when writing UCS-2 files, and also when reading UCS-2 files that don't have a BOM.

SET FILE UCS BOM { ON, OFF }
This setting is used when creating UCS-2 files. A BOM is added at the beginning by default. Use OFF to not add the BOM. This command has no affect when writing files.

COPY /SWAP-BYTES sourcefile destinationfile
Use this for fixing a UCS-2 file whose bytes are in the wrong order.

Use SHOW FILE to display the FILE UCS settings.

Please note, again, that C-Kermit's user interface, including its script language, is not internationalized in any way. String comparisons, case conversion, and so on, work only for US ASCII (comparisons for equality work with other sets, but not lexically-greater-or-less-than or caseless comparisons; even comparisons for equality can fail when composed characters or byte order are involved). String functions such as \findex() and \fsubstring() that reference byte positions do just that; they won't work with UTF-8 text that contains any non-ASCII characters, and they will not work with UCS-2 text at all since they use C strings internally, which are NUL-terminated. These are just a few examples to illustrate that neither Unicode nor any other character-set beyond ASCII is supported at the user-interface, command, or scripting level in this version of C-Kermit.


6.6.5.1. File Transfer

Kermit supports both UCS-2 and UTF-8 as file and transfer character sets in text-mode file transfer.

To select UCS-2 or UTF-8 as a file character-set, use:

  SET FILE CHARACTER-SET { UCS2, UTF8 }

If you want to send a UCS-2 text file (or save an incoming file in UCS-2 format), tell Kermit to:

  SET FILE CHARACTER-SET UCS2

and if you want to send a UTF-8 text file (or store an incoming file in UTF-8 format), tell Kermit to:

  SET FILE CHARACTER-SET UTF8

When sending UCS-2 files, Kermit determines the byte order from the BOM, if there is one (and if there is a BOM, it is stripped, i.e. not sent). If there is no BOM, the byte order is the one specified in the most recent SET FILE UCS BYTE-ORDER command, if any, otherwise the computer's native byte order is assumed. When storing incoming files as UCS-2, the byte order is according SET FILE UCS BYTE-ORDER, if given, otherwise the native one; a BOM is written according to SET FILE UCS BOM.

A transfer character-set should be chosen that includes all of the characters in the source file. So, for example, if you are sending a UCS-2 file containing only German-language text, your transfer character-set can be Latin-1, Latin-2, Latin-9, UCS-2, or UTF-8. But if you are sending a file that contains a combination of Hebrew and Greek, your transfer character-set must be UCS-2 or UTF-8 if you don't want to lose one script or the other. Furthermore, the transfer character-set must be one that is supported by the receiving Kermit program. Since UCS support is new, it is possible that the other Kermit program (if it supports character sets at all) does not support it, but does support single-byte sets such as Latin-1, Latin/Cyrillic, etc.

To select UCS-2 or UTF-8 as a transfer character-set, use:

  SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET { UCS2, UTF8 }

It is up to the receiving Kermit program to convert the transfer format to its own local format, if necessary. If it does not understand the UTF-8 or UCS-2 transfer character-set, and your file can not be adequately represented by any single-byte transfer character-set (such as Latin-1 or Latin/Cyrillic) then, if UTF-8 format is acceptable on the receiving computer, use UTF-8 as the transfer character-set, with the receiver told to "set unknown-char keep", or with the sender told to "set attribute char off". If you want the file to be stored in UCS-2 format at the receiver, send it it binary mode if the source file is also UCS-2, or else use the TRANSLATE command (next section) to convert it to UCS-2 first, then send it in binary mode. You should not use UCS-2 as a transfer character-set in text-mode transfers to Kermit programs that don't support it, because they are likely to corrupt the result the same way FTP would (see the final paragraph of this section).

When UCS-2 is the transfer character set, it always goes into Kermit packets in Big Endian format, with no BOM. As always, the transfer character-set is announced by the sender to the receiver. The announcement for UCS-2 is "I162" (ISO Registration 162 = UCS-2 Level 1) and by definition it is Big Endian (the standards say that when UCS-2 is serialized into bytes, the order must be Big Endian). The announcement for UTF-8 is "I190" (UTF-8 Level 1).

When receiving a file whose transfer character-set is UCS-2 or UTF-8, you must choose the appropriate file character set for the result. There is no way Kermit can do this for you automatically, since UCS data can be in any script at all, or any combination.

In general, UTF-8 or UCS-2 should be chosen as a transfer character-set if the source file is also encoded in some form of UCS and it contains more than one script. But there are other situations where where UTF-8 or UCS-2 offer advantages. For example, suppose the source file is on a NeXTstation and the destination file is on VMS. Both the NeXT and the DEC Multinational character sets include the French OE digraph, but Latin-1 does not. Therefore French words containing this character might not arrive intact when Latin-1 is the transfer character-set, but will with UTF-8 or UCS-2, since the UCS includes the OE digraph (but so does Latin-9).

UCS-2 should be chosen as a transfer character-set only for Japanese text files that contain a large preponderance of Kanji, since in this case (and only this case) UCS-2 (two bytes per Kanji) is more efficient than UTF-8 (three bytes per Kanji). The same will be true for Chinese and Korean when they are supported by Kermit. UCS-2 should never be used as a transfer character-set with a transfer partner that does not support UCS-2 since this can cause file corruption (see last paragraph in this section).

Note that Kermit's repeat-count compression is 100% ineffective for UCS-2, and is also ineffective for multibyte characters in UTF-8 and EUC-JP; this is because repeat-compression is a transport-level mechanism that operates on a per-byte basis; it has no knowledge of the distinction between a byte and a character.

When C-Kermit starts, it sets up associations (Section 6.5) for incoming files whose transfer character sets are UCS-2 or UTF-8 appropriately for the platform so that the file character-set for the incoming file is UCS-2 in Windows and UTF-8 elsewhere. Otherwise, C-Kermit does not make any default associations for UCS-2 or UTF-8, but of course you may add or change associations to suit your needs and preferences by including the appropriate ASSOCIATE commands in your Kermit startup file. For example, if you are a PC user and deal only with text written in Greek and English, you can:

  ASSOCIATE TRANSFER-CHARACTER-SET UTF8 CP869
  ASSOCIATE TRANSFER-CHARACTER-SET UCS2 CP869
  ASSOCIATE FILE-CHARACTER-SET CP869 UTF8

Note that when file transfer involves conversion between a single-byte character set and UCS-2 or UTF-8, the file-transfer thermometer and estimated time left might be inaccurate, since they are based on the source file size, not the transfer encoding. This is purely a cosmetic issue and does not effect the final result. (And is not, strictly speaking, a bug; Kermit protocol presently includes no method for the sender to furnish an "estimated transfer size" to the receiver, and in any case any such guess could be as far off as the file size, given the many other factors that come into play, such as compression and prefixing).

A caution about FTP and UCS-2. As noted previously, if you transfer a UCS-2 file with FTP in binary mode between two computers with opposite Endianness, the result will have its bytes in the wrong order. However, if you use FTP to transfer a UCS-2 file in "ascii" (text) mode to ANY computer, even if it is identical to yours, the result will be corrupted because FTP's line-terminator conversions do not account for UCS-2. The same holds when sending from a UCS-aware Kermit program to an older Kermit program in text mode with a transfer character-set of UCS-2. So use UCS-2 as a transfer character-set ONLY with a UCS-2-aware Kermit partner.


6.6.5.2. The TRANSLATE Command

In Kermit versions that have Unicode support included, TRANSLATE now always goes through Unicode; that is, the source set is converted to UCS-2 and thence to the target set. This is a major improvement, since in prior releases, C-Kermit had to pick the "most appropriate" transfer character-set as the intermediate set, and this would result in the loss of any characters that the source and target sets had in common but were lacking from the intermediate set (for example the OE digraph when translating from NeXT to DEC MCS through Latin-1). This never happens when Unicode is the intermediate set because Unicode is a superset of all other character sets supported by Kermit. A more dramatic example would be translation between Cyrillic PC code page 866 and KOI8-R (Section 6.4); formerly all the line- and box-drawing characters would be lost (since ISO 8859-5 does not have any); now the ones that these two sets have in common are preserved.

UCS-2 and UTF-8 are now both supported as source-file and destination-file character sets by C-Kermit's TRANSLATE command, for example:

  translate oofa.txt ucs2 latin1 oofa-l1.txt

translates oofa.txt from UCS-2 to Latin-1, storing the result as oofa-l1.txt. Similarly:

  translate oofa.txt utf8 latin1 oofa-l1.txt
  translate oofa.txt latin1 ucs2 oofa-ucs2.txt
  translate oofa.txt latin1 utf8 oofa-utf8.txt
  translate oofa.txt ucs2 utf8 oofa-utf8.txt
  translate oofa.txt utf8 ucs2 oofa-ucs2.txt

Treatment of the UCS-2 BOM is exactly the same as for file transfer. Note that if a UCS-2 source file is in the "wrong" byte order and lacks a BOM, and you don't tell Kermit about it with SET FILE UCS BYTE-ORDER, the result of the translation is total gibberish. Recall that you can use COPY /SWAP-BYTES to switch the byte order of an errant UCS-2 file (or any other file for that matter, if you can think of a reason to). Also note that:

  translate oofa.txt ucs2 ucs2 new.txt

Produces a result in the native (or SET FILE UCS) byte-order as long as oofa.txt has a BOM.

As a side benefit of the Unicode work, the TRANSLATE command now works for the first time also for all Japanese character sets that Kermit supports. In other words, if you have a Japanese text file in any of the following encodings:

  EUC-JP
  Shift-JIS
  JIS-7
  UCS-2
  UTF-8

You can use the TRANSLATE command to convert to any other encoding from the same list.


6.6.5.3. Terminal Connection

The CONNECT command now allows UTF-8 as a local or remote terminal character-set:

  SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 } { ..., UTF8 }
  SET TERMINAL REMOTE-CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 }
  SET TERMINAL LOCAL-CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 }

(Recall that Kermit's terminal character-set has two "ends" -- the set used on the host to which Kermit is connected, and the set used on the local keyboard and screen.)

UCS-2 is not supported as a terminal character-set (either end) since (a) it is not used that way anywhere to our knowledge, and (b) the problems of Endianness and the high likelihood of loss of synchronization make it impractical. (Telecommunications is byte-oriented; if one byte, or any odd number of bytes, is lost because of buffer overruns, circuit resets, etc (or likewise if a burst of noise appears that takes the guise of an odd number of bytes), the byte order of the subsequent data stream will be backwards; unlike UTF-8 and traditional byte-based character sets, UCS-2 is not "self synchronizing".)

UTF-8 does not have byte-order or synchronization problems and is growing in popularity as a terminal character set as well as in other application areas. It allows a single terminal session to use multiple scripts (Roman, Cyrillic, Greek, etc) without ISO 2022 character-set switching (which terminal emulators like Kermit 95 can handle but few host applications understand or use), and meshes nicely with the Unicode screen fonts that are beginning to appear.

UTF-8 was first used in Plan 9 and soon will be available in Linux. It will probably spread from there (Unicode in some form is, of course, also used in Windows NT, but only internally -- not for access from outside).

To use UTF-8 or any other character set that uses 8-bit bytes in your terminal session, be sure to tell C-Kermit to:

  SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE 8
  SET COMMAND BYTESIZE 8
  SET PARITY NONE

(or use the shortcut command, EIGHTBIT, which does all three at once).

In a setup where your local Kermit program uses a single-byte character set such as PC Code Page 850 and the remote host uses UTF-8:

  SET TERM CHAR UTF8 CP850

or:

  SET TERM REMOTE CHAR UTF8
  SET TERM LOCAL CHAR CP850

all works as expected. UTF-8 text on the remote displays correctly on your screen, and when you type CP850 characters, they are translated to UTF-8 sequences for transmission, and the echo from the host is translated from UTF-8 back to CP850. Telnet negotiations and autodownload take place before any character-set translation and work as before. The session log (if text mode was selected for it) contains only the local terminal character-set. And so on.

Kermit merely supplies translations from UTF-8 to your local terminal character-set (this includes treating UTF-8 Line Separator and Paragraph separator as CRLF). However, Kermit does does not, at present, perform "canonicalization" of composed sequences, nor does it automatically execute bidirectionality algorithms for display of mixed-direction text (e.g. Hebrew and English). Such presentation issues, like all others in the terminal-host regime, are left to the host.

By the way, C-Kermit also allows UTF-8 to be the local end of the terminal character-set, but so far this code is not tested, since we don't have a UTF-8 console or terminal to work with. However, it can be stated without doubt that C-Kermit's key mapping will not work for UTF-8 values, since (a) the key map is indexed by 8-bit byte values and (b) C-Kermit reads keystrokes a byte at a time (these comments do not apply to K95, which has direct access to the keyboard and can read "wide" keycodes and uses them to index a "wide" keymap).

Restrictions: As noted, the CONNECT command does not support UCS-2 as a REMOTE TERMINAL character-set. Neither does it support the Japanese sets EUC-JP, JIS-7, and Shift-JIS. Support for the Japanese sets (and possibly Chinese and Korean too) might be added in a future release. Since the TRANSMIT command (next section) uses the same REMOTE TERMINAL character-sets as the CONNECT command, it has the same restrictions.


6.6.5.4. The TRANSMIT Command

As described in Chapter 15 of Using C-Kermit and Section 4.21 of this document, the TRANSMIT command can be used to upload a file without protocol, more or less as if you were typing it on your keyboard while connected to the host. When TRANSMITting in text mode, the file's character set is converted to the host's unless you have SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET TRANSPARENT, or you include the new TRANSMIT switch, /TRANSPARENT.

Before C-Kermit 7.0, the file character-set was assumed to be the same as the local end of the terminal character-set, and the TRANSMIT command used the same translations as the CONNECT command, ignoring the file character-set.

In C-Kermit 7.0, that assumption (a poor one to begin with) can no longer be made, since UCS-2 can be a file character-set but not a terminal character-set. So now the file's character-set is given by your most recent SET FILE CHARACTER-SET command. The host's character set is the remote end of your most recent SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET command:

  SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET remote-set [ local-set ]

or:

  SET TERMINAL REMOTE-CHARACTER-SET remote-set

The TRANSMIT command converts each source-file character from the FILE character-set to the REMOTE TERMINAL character-set, and then transmits the translated characters according to your SET TRANSMIT preferences (Chapter 15).

If you have SET TRANSMIT ECHO ON, and the host is echoing the transmitted characters, the echos are converted from the remote terminal character-set to the local terminal character-set.

  [ A picture would help... ]

Confused? Let's work through an example. Suppose your local computer is a NeXTstation, on which text files are encoded in the NeXT character set, and that the remote computer is a Data General AViiON, which uses the Data General International character set. Further suppose that you are logged in to the NeXT from a VT220 terminal which uses the DEC Multinational character set.

You need to convert the file from NeXT encoding to DG encoding and convert the echoes from DG encoding to DEC encoding. So on the NeXT, tell C-Kermit to:

  eightbit
  set file character-set next
  set term character-set dg-international dec-mcs
  transmit /text nextdata.txt

(This assumes you have some sort of collection process already set up on the Data General, such as a text editor or the venerable "cat > foo". The EIGHTBIT command is equivalent to SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE 8, SET COMMAND BYTESIZE 8, SET PARITY NONE.)

To further complicate matters, suppose your local terminal character set is the same as the remote one, so you don't need terminal character-set translation, but you need to TRANSMIT a file that is in a different character set and you want it translated to the host set. In this case, use SET TERM CHARACTER-SET to actually specify the character set used on each end, rather than specifying TRANSPARENT:

  eightbit
  set file character-set ucs2
  set term character-set latin1 latin1
  transmit /text ucs2data.txt

The distinction between:

  SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET xxx yyy

(where xxx and yyy are the same set) and:

  SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET TRANSPARENT

is new to C-Kermit 7.0, but affects only the TRANSMIT command.

The TRANSMIT command currently does nothing special with UCS-2/UTF-8 Line and Paragraph Separator characters; more experience is required to find out how these behave in a genuine Unicode terminal-host setting.

Restrictions: As noted, the TRANSMIT command translates from the FILE character-set to the REMOTE TERMINAL character-set. This rules out translations to any character set that is not supported as a REMOTE TERMINAL character-set, such as UCS-2, EUC-JP, JIS-7, and Shift-JIS.


6.6.5.5. Summary of Kermit Unicode Commands

Specifying file character-set and byte order:
SET FILE CHARACTER-SET { ..., UCS2, UTF8 }
REMOTE SET FILE CHARACTER-SET { ..., UCS2, UTF8 } (See next section)
SET FILE UCS BOM { ON, OFF }
SET FILE UCS BYTE-ORDER { BIG-ENDIAN, LITTLE-ENDIAN }

Specifying the transfer character-set:
SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET { ..., UCS-2, UTF-8 }
REMOTE SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET { ..., UCS-2, UTF-8 }

Specifying the terminal character-set:
SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 } { ..., UTF8 }
SET TERMINAL REMOTE-CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 }
SET TERMINAL LOCAL-CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 }

Displaying settings:
SHOW FILE
SHOW TRANSFER
SHOW TERMINAL
SHOW CHARACTER-SETS

Commands that use these settings include:
SEND, RECEIVE, GET, etc.
CONNECT
TRANSMIT
LOG SESSION

Converting files:
TRANSLATE infile { ..., UCS-2, UTF-8 } { ..., UCS-2, UTF-8 } outfile
COPY /SWAP-BYTES infile outfile


6.7. Client/Server Character-Set Switching

A simple mechanism has been added to allow the client to change the server's FILE CHARACTER-SET:

REMOTE SET FILE CHARACTER-SET name
The client asks the server to change its file character-set to the one given. The name must match one of the server's file character-set names. For convenience, C-Kermit uses its own file character-set keyword list for parsing this command so you can use ? for help and Tab or Esc for completion. However, since the server might have a different repertoire (or even use different names for the same sets), C-Kermit accepts any string you supply and sends it to the server. The server, if it supports this command (C-Kermit 7.0 and K95 1.1.19 do), sets its file character-set as requested, and also disables automatic character-set switching (Section 6.5). If the server does not support this command or if it does not support the given character set, the REMOTE SET FILE CHARACTER-SET command fails.

Here's an example that sends a Japanese text file encoded in Shift-JIS to a server using every combination of Kermit's Japanese-capable file and transfer character sets:

  dcl \&x[] = euc ucs2 utf8             ; transfer character-sets
  dcl \&y[] = eu uc ut                  ; 2-letter abbreviations for them
  dcl \&f[] = shift euc jis7 ucs2 utf8  ; file character-sets
  dcl \&g[] = sj eu j7 uc ut            ; 2-letter abbreviations

  set file char shift-jis               ; local file character-set is Shift-JIS
  for \%i 1 \fdim(&x) 1 {               ; for each transfer character-set...
      set xfer char \&x[\%i]            ; set it
      for \%j 1 \fdim(&f) 1 {           ; for each remote file character-set...
	  remote set file char \&f[\%j] ; set it
	  if fail exit 1 SERVER REJECTED CHARSET
	  send /text meibo-sj.html meibo-sj-\&y[\%i]-\&g[\%j].txt ; send the file
	  if fail exit 1 TRANSFER FAILED
      }
  }

The Kermit-370 server does not support REMOTE SET FILE CHARACTER-SET, but since it supports REMOTE KERMIT commands, you can get the same effect with REMOTE KERMIT SET FILE CHARACTER-SET name.


7. SCRIPT PROGRAMMING

(Also see Section 2.8, Scripting Local Programs.)

7.0. Bug Fixes

The following script programming bugs were fixed in C-Kermit 7.0:


7.1. The INPUT Command

7.1.1. INPUT Timeouts

The description of the INPUT command on page 422 fails to mention the following two points about the timeout (which apply to C-Kermit 6.0 and later):

  1. "INPUT -1 text" (or "INPUT \%x text", where \%x is any variable whose value is -1 or less) means "wait forever". This form of the INPUT command fails only if it is interrupted, since it will never time out.

  2. INPUT 0 performs a nonblocking read of material that has already arrived but has not yet been read, and succeeds immediately if the target string is found, or fails immediately if it is not found.

The same points apply to MINPUT. REINPUT ignores its timeout parameter.


7.1.2. New INPUT Controls

The following new INPUT controls were added in version 7.0:

SET INPUT AUTODOWNLOAD { ON, OFF }
Explained in Section 7.7.

SET INPUT CANCELLATION { ON, OFF }
This governs whether an INPUT command can be canceled by "pressing any key" on the keyboard. Normally it can be, in which case the INPUT command fails immediately and \v(instatus) is set to 2, indicating interruption. SET INPUT CANCELLATION OFF disables keyboard cancellations; thus if the search text is not encountered, the INPUT command will run for its entire timeout interval. SET INPUT CANCELLATION OFF does not disable interruption by Ctrl-C, however; every command needs an emergency exit. (If you really want to disable interruption by Ctrl-C, use SET COMMAND INTERRUPTION OFF.)

Also see Section 7.2 for any new variables related to INPUT.


7.1.3. INPUT with Pattern Matching

C-Kermit 7.0 allows INPUT, MINPUT, and REINPUT targets to be a pattern (explained in Sections 1.19 and 4.9). This solves a long-standing problem illustrated by the following scenario: a certain company has a bank of TCP/IP modem servers, with hostnames server1, server2, server3, and so on. Each server's prompt is its name, followed by a colon (:), for example "Server72:". Without INPUT patterns, it would be rather difficult to wait for the prompt. The brute force approach:

  minput 20 Server1: Server2: Server3: ... (enumerating each one)

is subject to failure whenever a new server is added. A more subtle approach:

  input 20 Server
  if fail ...
  input 2 :

is liable to false positives, e.g. "Welcome to the XYZ Corp Modem Server. Please read the following message:"...

With patterns, you can match the prompt with "Server*:" (which doesn't solve the "false positives" problem, but certainly is more compact than the brute force method), or with more specific patterns such as "Server[1-9]:" and "Server[1-9][0-9]:", or equivalently:

  Server{[1-9],[1-9][0-9]}:

meaning the word "Server" followed by a single digit (1-9) or by two digits representing a number from 1 to 99, followed by a colon.

INPUT pattern matching has been added in a way that does not interfere with existing scripts. No new commands or switches are used. The simple rule is: if an INPUT search target is the argument of the (new) \fpattern() function, it is a pattern. Otherwise it is taken literally, as before. For example:

  input 5 a*b

searches for an 'a' followed by an asterisk ('*'), followed by a 'b'. But:

  input 5 \fpattern(a*b)

searches for an 'a' followed by anything at all up to and including the first 'b'. This means that any search target to INPUT, MINPUT, or REINPUT can be a pattern or a literal string, and in particular that MINPUT can accommodate any mixture of patterns and literal strings.

In selecting patterns, note that:

A syntax note: If your pattern is a selection list, meaning a list of alternatives separated by commas and enclosed in braces, then the outer braces will be stripped by various levels of parsers, so you must include three of each:

  input 10 \fpattern({{{abc,mno,xyz}}})

Note that this is equivalent to:

  minput 10 abc mno xyz

except for the setting of the \v(minput) variable.

And a caution: INPUT pattern matching has a limitation that you probably never noticed with literal-string matching, namely that there is a limit on the size of the match. For example, if the pattern is "a*b", the match will succeed if the 'a' and 'b' are not separated by more than (say) 8K bytes, but will fail if they are farther apart than that. In such cases, it better to use two INPUTs (e.g. "input 10 a" and then "input 100 b").


7.1.4. The INPUT Match Result

The result of any INPUT, MINPUT, or REINPUT command, no matter whether the search targets are patterns or literal strings, is available in the new \v(inmatch) variable. For example:

  minput 10 cat \fpattern([dh]og)
  if success echo MINPUT matched "\v(inmatch)"

This is especially useful when a pattern was matched, since it makes the string that matched the pattern available to Kermit; there would be no way to get it otherwise.

After an INPUT command, you can view all the INPUT-related variables by typing "show variables in" (abbreviate as "sho var in"), which shows the values of all built-in variables whose names start with "in".


7.2. New or Improved Built-In Variables

\v(blockcheck)
Current BLOCK-CHECK setting, 1, 2, 3, or 4. 4 is the code for BLANK-FREE-2.

\v(byteorder)
The machine's byte order: 0 = Big Endian, 1 = Little Endian.

\v(cmdbufsize)
The length of the command buffer, which is the maximum size for a macro, a command, a variable, or anything else in C-Kermit's script language.

\v(ctty)
The device name of C-Kermit's controlling (login) terminal.

\v(filename)
Described in Sections 4.1 and 4.2.

\v(filenumber)
Described in Sections 4.1 and 4.2.

\v(filespec)
As of C-Kermit 7.0, contains fully qualified filenames rather than (usually) relative ones.

\v(return)
Now holds the END n value of the macro that most recently returned, in case END was used rather than RETURN.

\v(editor)
Pathname of preferred text editor
\v(editopts)
Command-line options for editor
\v(editfile)
File most recently edited

\v(browser)
Pathname of preferred Web browser
\v(browsopts)
Command-line options for Web browser
\v(browsurl)
URL most recently given to Web browser

\v(dialtype)
Type of call most recently placed (see Section 2.1.11).

\v(kbchar)
The character, if any, that was typed at the keyboard to to interrupt the most recent PAUSE, SLEEP, WAIT, MSLEEP, or INPUT command; empty if the most recent such command was not interrupted from the keyboard.

\v(lockdir)
UNIX only - The name of the UUCP lockfile directory, if known, otherwise "(unknown)".

\v(lockpid)
UNIX only - PID of process that owns the communication port that you tried to open with a SET LINE command that failed because the port was in use, otherwise empty. This variable is set with every SET LINE command.

\v(cx_time)
If no connection (SET HOST, SET LINE, DIAL, TELNET, etc) is active, this is 0. If a connection is active, this is the number of seconds since the connection was made.

\v(hwparity)
If hardware parity is in effect, this variable gives its value, such as "even" or "odd" (in which case, the \v(parity) variable will be "none"). Otherwise this variable is empty.

\v(serial)
Current serial port settings in 8N1 format (Section 2.10).

\v(errno)
In UNIX, the current value of the C runtime errno variable, which is quite volatile (meaning that often an "interesting" error code can be overwritten by some other library call or system service that sets errno before you have a chance to look at it). In VMS, the error code returned by the system or library call that most recently failed (success codes are not saved). Not available in other operating systems.

\v(errstring)
The UNIX or VMS system error message that corresponds to \v(errno). Not available in all OS's. Also see \ferrstring().

\v(setlinemsg)
The error message, if any, from the most recent SET LINE, SET PORT, SET HOST, TELNET, or other connection-making command. This is not necessarily the same as \v(errstring) since these commands might fail without generating a system error code, for example (in UNIX) because a lockfile existed indicating the device was assigned by another user.

\v(exitstatus)
The exit status C-Kermit would return if it exited now.

\v(pexitstat)
The exit status of the inferior process most recently invoked by C-Kermit (by RUN, !, REDIRECT, SEND /COMMAND, etc). In VMS, this code can be given to \ferrstring() to get the corresponding error message (in UNIX, program/command return codes are not the same as system error codes). Not available in operating systems other than UNIX and VMS. See Section 4.2.5 for details.

\v(inmatch)
The incoming string of characters, if any, that matched the most recent INPUT, REINPUT, or MINPUT command.

\v(intime)
The number of milliseconds (thousandths of seconds) it took for the most recent INPUT command to find its match, or -1 if no INPUT command has been given yet. If the INPUT command timed out, the value is approximately equal to 1000 times the INPUT timeout. If INPUT failed for some other reason, the value is undefined (\v(instatus) gives INPUT completion status). If your version of C-Kermit is built without high-precision floating-point timers, this number will always be a multiple of 1000.

\v(inwait)
The number of seconds specified as the timeout in the most recent INPUT command.

\v(dialsuffix)
Dialing suffix for use during PDIAL sequence; see Section 2.1.10.

\v(pid)
UNIX, VMS, and K95 only. C-Kermit's primary process ID, numeric, decimal. If you want to show it in hex, use \fn2hex(\v(pid)) If you want to show it in octal, use \fn2octal(\v(pid)).

\v(printer)
Current printer name or SET PRINTER value.

\v(p_ctl)
Control prefix char \v(p_8bit) 8-bit prefix char (if parity not none)
\v(p_rpt)
Repeat prefix char (if repeat compression enabled)

\v(herald)
Kermit's version herald

\v(test)
Kermit's test version, if any, or 0 if this is not a test version. Typical values for test versions are "Alpha.03" or "Beta.14".

\v(sendlist)
The number of entries in the SEND-LIST, 0 if none. Note: entries do not necessarily correspond to files, since an entry might contain wildcards. Also note that the value does not go back to 0 after the files in the list are sent. To reset this variable, use CLEAR SEND-LIST. The purpose of this variable is to determine if a SEND command, when given without any filenames, will be legal. Example:

  xif \v(sendlist) { send } else { send oofa.txt }

\v(trigger)
If the most recent CONNECT session was terminated automatically by a trigger, this variable contains the trigger value.

\v(ty_ln)
TYPE line number (during TYPE)
\v(ty_lc)
TYPE line count (after TYPE)
\v(ty_mc)
TYPE match count (after TYPE)

\v(xferstat)
Status of most recent file transfer:

-1: No transfer yet
 0: Succeeded
 1: Failed

\v(xfermsg)
If the most recent file transfer failed, this is the reason. If it succeeded, \v(xfermsg) is an empty string.

\v(tftime)
Total elapsed time of most recent file transfer operation, in seconds.

\v(textdir)
Directory that holds (or is supposed to hold) Kermit text files such as installation instructions, release notes, update notes, read-me files, "beware" files, etc.

\v(name)
The name with which the Kermit program was invoked, e.g. "kermit", "wermit", "k95", "k2", etc (see Section 9.1).

\v(osname)
Name of operating system on computer where C-Kermit is running, obtained at runtime (from uname or equivalent).

\v(osversion)
Version of operating system on computer where C-Kermit is running, obtained at runtime (from uname or equivalent).

\v(osrelease)
Release of operating system on computer where C-Kermit is running, obtained at runtime (from uname or equivalent).

\v(model)
The specific hardware model of the computer where C-Kermit is running, if known.

\v(math_pi)
The value of Pi (see Section 7.23)

\v(math_e)
The value of e (see Section 7.23)

\v(math_precision)
How many significant digits in a floating-point number.

\v(f_count)
Result of the most recent FILE COUNT (FCOUNT) command.
\v(f_error)
Numeric error code of most recent FILE command.
\v(f_max)
Maximum number of files open simultaneously.

The math constants are given in the precision of underlying computer's floating-point arithmetic.

Note the distinction between \v(osname), \v(osversion), and \v(platform); the latter refers to the platform for which and/or upon which C-Kermit was built, as opposed to the one on which it is actually running. Also note that each operating system can, and probably will, interpret and fill in the os* variables differently, or not at all.

The SHOW VARIABLES command now accepts a variable name, prefix, or pattern:

  show variables         Shows all variables.
  show variables t       Shows all variables that start with "t".
  show variables *ver*   Shows all variables whose names contain "ver".
  show variables *ver    Ditto (an implied "*" is appended).


7.3. New or Improved Built-In Functions

The following new file-i/o functions are explained in Section 1.22.

  \f_status(channel)           Status of file open on channel
  \f_pos(channel)              Read/write (byte) pointer of given file
  \f_line(channel)             Current line of file
  \f_handle(channel)           Handle of file
  \f_eof(channel)              Whether given file is at EOF
  \f_getchar(channel)          Read a char from given file
  \f_getline(channel)          Read a line from given file
  \f_getblock(channel,n)       Read a block from given file
  \f_putchar(channel,c)        Write a char to given file
  \f_putline(channel,string)   Write a line to given file
  \f_putblock(channel,string)  Write a block to given file

The following new date-time-related functions are explained in Section 1.6:

  \fday()                Returns day of week of given date
  \fnday()               Returns numeric day of week of given date
  \ftime()               Returns time portion of given date-time
  \fntime()              Converts time to seconds since midnight
  \fn2time()             Converts seconds since midnight to hh:mm:ss
  \fcvtdate(date-time)   Converts free-format date to yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss
  \fdayofyear(date-time) Converts date to yyyyddd (day-of-year) format
  \fdoy(date-time)       Synonym for \fdayofyear()
  \fdoy2date(dayofyear)  Converts yyyyddd to yyyymmdd
  \fmjd(date-time)       Converts free-format date to Modified Julian Date
  \fmjd2date(mjd)        Converts modified Julian date to yyyymmdd

The new floating-point arithmetic functions are explained in Section 7.23. f1 and f2 are floating-point (real) numbers; d is the number of decimal places to show:

  \ffpabsolute(f1,d)     Absolute value of f1
  \ffpadd(f1,f2,d)       f1 + f1
  \ffpcosine(f1,d)       Cosine of f1
  \ffpdivide(f1,f2,d)    f1 divided by f2
  \ffpexp(f1,d)          e to the f1 power
  \ffpint(f1)            Integer part of f1
  \ffplog10(f1,d)        Log base 10 of f1
  \ffplogn(f1,d)         Natural log of f1
  \ffpmaximum(f1,f2,d)   Maximum of f1 and f2
  \ffpminimum(f1,f2,d)   Minimum of f1 and f2
  \ffpmodulus(f1,f2,d)   Modulus of f1 and f2
  \ffpmultiply(f1,f2,d)  Product of f1 and f2
  \ffpraise(f1,f2,d)     Raise f1 to power f2
  \ffpround(f1,d)        Round f1 to d places
  \ffpsine(f1,d)         Sine of f1
  \ffpsqrt(f1,d)         Square root of f1
  \ffpsubtract(f1,f2,d)  f2 - f1
  \ffptangent(f1,d)      Tangent of f1

Integer number functions:

\fabsolute(n)
Absolute value of integer n.

\frandom(n)
Returns a random integer between 0 and n-1.

\fradix(s,n1,n2)
If the string s is an integer in radix n1, the result is the same number expressed in radix n2, where n1 and n2 may be any number from 2 through 36, expressed as decimal numbers, or variables (etc) that evaluate to decimal numbers. For the source and result, the digits of any radix, r, are the first r characters in the sequence 0-9,a-z (case doesn't matter for the letters). The string s may have a sign, + or -; if it starts with a minus (-) sign, the result also has a minus sign.

The \fradix() function does not work with floating-point numbers. It does not reveal the internal storage format of a number; for example, \fradix(-1,10,16) is -1, not something like FFFFFFFFFF. If all three arguments are not given, or if n1 or n2 are not numbers between 2 and 36 inclusive, or s is not a number in radix n1, an error occurs and the empty string is returned. \fradix() also does not offer extended-precision arithmetic; number values are limited to those expressed as a long integer in the architecture of the underlying computer, usually 32 or 64 bits. If you give it an argument whose absolute value is larger than can be held in an unsigned long, the result is -1.

The next four are shorthand functions for decimal/hexadecimal and decimal/octal number conversion:

\fn2hex(n)
Returns the hexadecimal (base 16) representation of the integer n. This is different from \fhexify(s), which treats its argument as a string rather than a number. The result is always left-padded with 0's to make its length even. Examples:

  \n2hex(0)   = "00"                    \fhexify(0)   = "30"
  \n2hex(255) = "ff"                    \fhexify(255) = "323535"
  \n2hex(256) = "0100"                  \fhexify(256) = "323536"

\fhex2n(x)
Converts hexadecimal number x to decimal equivalent decimal number. This is the inverse of \fn2hex(). Equivalent to \fradix(s,16,10).

\fn2octal(n)
Returns the octal (base 8) representation of the number n. Examples:
  \n2octal(0) = "0"
  \n2oct(255) = "377"
  \n2oct(256) = "400"
  Equivalent to \fradix(n,10,8).

\foct2n(n)
Returns the decimal representation of the given octal number, n. The inverse of \fn2octal(). Equivalent to \fradix(n,8,10).

String functions:

\s(name[n:m])
Equivalent to \fsubstring(\m(name),n,m) (Section 7.24).

\:(name[n:m])
Equivalent to \fsubstring(name,n,m) (where "name" is any \-quantity) (Section 7.24).

\fleft(s,n)
The leftmost ncharacters of string s; equivalent to \fsubstring(s,1,n).

\fstripx(string,char)
Returns the part of the string up to the rightmost occurrence, if any, of the given character. The default character is period (.) Examples:
  \fstripx(foo/bar,/)                 = "foo"
  \fstripx(foo/bar/baz,/)             = "foo/bar"
  \fstripx(autoexec.bat,.)            = "autoexec"
  \fstripx(autoexec.bat)              = "autoexec"
  \fstripx(fstripx(foo/bar/baz,/),/)  = "foo"

\flop(string,character)
Returns the portion of the string starting after the first occurrence of the given character. The default character is period (.) Examples:
  \flop(autoexec.bat)                 = "bat"
  \flop(baz.foo/bar)                  = "foo/bar"
  \flop(baz.foo/bar,/)                = "bar

\fstripn(string,n)
Returns the string with ncharacters removed from the end. Example:
  \fstripn(12345678,3)                = "12345"

(For more discussion of \fstripx(), \fstripn(), and \flop() see Section 4.2.3).

\fb64encode(s)
Returns the Base-64 encoding of the string s.

\fb64decode(s)
Returns the decoding of the Base-64 string s. Fails if s is not a Base-64 string, or if its length is not a multiple of 4. Note that if any of the result bytes are null (0), the result string stops there. There is no way to represent strings that contain null bytes in C-Kermit (the same is true for \funhexify()).

\fword(s1,n,s2,s3)
Extracts word number nfrom string s1. By default, a "word" is any sequence of ASCII letters or digits; nis 1-based. If nis omitted, "1" is used. Examples:

  \fword(one two three)    = "one"
  \fword(one two three,1)  = "one"
  \fword(one two three,2)  = "two"
  \fword(one two three,3)  = "three"

and:

    \fword(\v(dialresult),2) = "31200"

is "31200" if \v(dialresult) is (e.g.) "CONNECT 31200/ARQ/V32/LAPM/V42BIS".

If you include s2, this replaces the default break set. For example, suppose you have a string \%a whose value is:

  $150.00 $300.00 $39.95

and you want each dollar amount to be a word; use:

  \fword(\%a,\%n,{ })

This returns dollar amount number \%n, e.g. "$300.00" for \%n = 2. "{ }" denotes a space (you must enclose it in braces, otherwise it is squeezed out). Note that ASCII control characters are always included in the break set; you don't have to specify them (and you can't not specify them).

The optional s3 argument lists characters (even control characters) that normally would be considered separators that you want included in words. So the dollars-and-cents example could also be handled this way:

  \fword(\%a,\%n,,$.)

in other words, use the default separator list, but remove "$" and "." from it so they will be considered part of a word.

\fsplit(s1,&a,s2,s3)
This is like \fword(), except instead of extracting and returning a particular word from string s1, it counts the words and optionally assigns them to the array whose identifying letter, a-z, is given after the "&" in the second argument, with the first word going into element 1, the second into element 2, and so on. The rules regarding break and include lists (s2 and s3) are exactly the same as for \fword(). \fsplit() returns the number of words that were assigned, which is either the number of words in the string, or the dimension of the array, whichever is less. If the array is not declared, \fsplit() creates it and returns a number which is both the number of words in s1 and the dimension of the new array. Examples:

  declare \&w[20]        ; (Optional.)
  ...
  read \%s               ; \%s is "This is a sentence with seven words."
  ...
  echo "\fsplit(\%s)"    ; This would print "7".
  echo "\fsplit(\%s,&w)" ; Ditto, and also assigns them to array \&w[].

  echo "\&w[7]"          ; This would print "words".

If the line contained fields that were delimited by colon (:), you would use \fsplit(\%s,&w,:). If the fields were delimited by comma, then you would use \fsplit(\%s,&w,{,}); in this case the literal comma must be enclosed in braces to distinguish it from the comma that separates function arguments. To get a word count without loading an array, but still specify break and/or include lists, leave the array argument empty:

   echo "\fsplit(\%s,,:)" ; Use colon as the separator.

WARNINGS:

  1. If you use the same array repeatedly, \fsplit() leaves any trailing members undisturbed. For example:
      dcl \&w[10]
      \fsplit(1 2 3 4 5,&w) ; Sets \&w[1] thru \&w[5].
      \fsplit(a b c,&w)     ; Sets \&w[1]-[3] leaving [4]-[5] as they were.
    

  2. If you allow \fsplit to create the array (by not declaring it first), it is dimensioned to the number of elements it was created with:
      \fsplit(1 2 3,&x)     ; Creates an array \&x[] with 3 elements.
      \fsplit(a b c d e,&x) ; This overflows the array.
    

Thus if you want to use \fsplit() repeatedly on the same array, either dimension it in advance to the maximum expected size (and then some -- more efficient), or else destroy it after each use (to allow for unexpectedly large arguments). Example using a dynamic array:

  fopen /read \%c some-file
  if fail ...
  set function error on    ; See Section 7.12
  while true {
      dcl \&w[]            ; Destroy \&[w] each time thru the loop
      fread /line \%c \%a
      if fail break
      asg \%x \fsplit(\%a,&w)
      if fail ...
      ; (do what you want with \&w[] here...)
  }
  fclose \%c

\frindex(s1,s2,n)
The "n" argument to \frindex() now works consistently (in mirror image) with the corresponding \findex() argument. In each case, the (n-1)-most characters of s2 are ignored in the search; for findex, this means the starting position of the search is n (the default nis 1, and 0 is treated like 1). For \frindex() it means the default starting point is:

  length(s2) - length(s1) - n (with the same defaults for n).

\fsearch(pattern,string[,position])
Exactly like \findex(), except with a pattern (see Section 7.9) rather than a literal string.

\frsearch(pattern,string[,position])
Exactly like \frindex(), except with a pattern rather than a literal string.

File Functions:

\ffiles(), \fnextfile()
It is no longer necessary to copy the file list to an array before use, as shown on p.398 of Using C-Kermit 2nd Edition. \ffiles() and friends now make their own safe copies of the file list. Thus constructions like the following are now possible:

  for \%i 1 \ffiles(*.txt) 1 { send \fnextfile() }

The same is true for the new function \frfiles(), \fdirectories(), and \frdirectories(), described in Section 4.11.3.

But note that each reference to \fnextfile() still gets you the next file. So "if newer \fnextfile() foo.txt send \fnextfile()" compares one file's age with that of foo.txt, and then sends an entirely different file. If you're going to refer to the same file more than once, assign it to a variable:

  asg \%f \fnextfile()
  if newer \%f foo.txt send \%f

(note: assign, not define).

Also note that \ffiles(), \frfiles(), \fdirectories(), and \frdirectories() all now accept on optional 2nd argument: the name of an array to load with the resulting file or directory list, explained in Section 4.11.3. So you can also load an array with the filelist when you need to refer to the same file more than once:

  for \%i 1 \ffiles(*,&a) 1 { if newer \&a[\%i] foo.txt send \&a[\%i] }

\fpermissions(file)
Returns the platform-specific permissions string for the file, such as "-rw-rw-r--" in UNIX or "(RWE,RWE,RE,E)" in VMS.

\fdirname(f)
Given a file specification f, this function returns the complete pathname of directory the file is in.

Array Functions:

\fdimension(&a)
Returns the dimension declared for the array whose identifying letter, a-z, or special character "_" or "@", is given after the "&" in the argument. If the array is not declared, 0 is returned. Note that when used with the macro argument vector array, \&_[] (see Section 7.5), the value of this function is one less than \v(argc), and when used with the C-Kermit command-line argument vector array, \&@[], it is equal to the \v(args) variable. Examples:

  echo \fdimension(&a)       ; Not declared.
  0
  declare \&a[12]            ; Now it's declared.
  echo \fdim(&a)
  12

\farraylook(pattern,arrayname)
Looks in the given array for the pattern and returns the index of the first element that matches, if any, or -1 if none match. The arrayname can include a range specifier to restrict to search to a segment of the array, e.g. \farraylook(*xyz*,&a[32:63]). For greater detail see Section 7.10.7.

\ftablelook(keyword,arrayname[,delimiter])
Looks in the given "table", which must be sorted, for the given keyword. Returns the index of the table element that uniquely matches the given keyword, or -1 if none match, or -2 if more than 1 match. For greater detail see Section 7.10.7.

Other new functions:

\fip2hex(s)
Converts a dotted decimal IP address to an 8-digit hexadecimal number. \fip2hex(128.59.39.2) = 803b2702.

\fhex2ip(x)
Converts an 8-digit hexadecimal IP address to dotted decimal form, e.g. \fhex2ip(803b2702) = 128.59.39.2. The inverse of \fip2hex().

\fcommand()
\frawcommand()
These run an external command and return its output; see Section 4.2.8.4.

\fdialconvert(s)
s is a phone number in either literal or portable format (not a dialing directory entry name). The function returns the dial string that would actually be used when dialing from the current location (after processing country code, area code, and other SET DIAL values).

\ferrstring(n)
Returns the system error message associated with the (numeric) error code n. UNIX and VMS only. Use in conjunction with \v(errno) or \v(pexitstat). See Section 4.2.5 for a usage example. Note: This function doesn't work in Windows because there is not a consistent error-code-to-message mapping; error code "x" means something completely different depending on whether it comes from the C runtime library, Winsock, a Windows-32 API, TAPI, etc,

\fpattern(s)
Used in INPUT, REINPUT, and MINPUT commands to denote search strings that are to be treated as patterns rather than literally.

Also see Section 7.8 on built-in help for functions.


7.4. New IF Conditions

IF AVAILABLE feature command
Executes the command if the given feature is available. Presently used only to determine if specific authentication and encryption options are available. Type "if available ?" to see which features may be tested.

IF FLOAT f1 command
Executes command if f1 is a legal floating point number (which includes integers). Use this to preverify arguments for the \ffp...() floating-point arithmetic functions, e.g. "if float \%1 echo \ffpint(\%1)".

IF == n1 n2 command
Synonym for "if =" (numeric equality). Note that as of C-Kermit 7.0, this and all other numeric comparison operators also work for floating-point numbers.

IF != n1 n2 command
Executes the command if n1 and n2 are both numbers or variables containing numbers and the value of n1 is not equal to the value of n2. This is equivalent to "if not = n1 n2".

IF <= n1 n2 command
Executes the command if n1 and n2 are both numbers or variables containing numbers and the value of n1 is less than or equal to the value of n2. This is equivalent to "if not > n1 n2".

IF >= n1 n2 command
Executes the command if n1 and n2 are both numbers or variables containing numbers and the value of n1 is greater than or equal to the value of n2. Equivalent to "if not < n1 n2".

IF COMMAND word command
Executes the command if word is a built-in C-Kermit command. Example:

  if not command copy define { copy run copy \%1 \%2 }".

This defines a COPY macro that runs an external COPY command if COPY is not already a built-in command.

IF LOCAL command
Executes the command if Kermit is in local mode, i.e. if it has a SET LINE, SET PORT, or SET HOST (TELNET, RLOGIN, etc) device or connection open. Does not execute the command if in remote mode.

IF MATCH string pattern command
Executes the command if the string matches the pattern. For a description of the syntax for the pattern, see Section 4.9.1. If you want to test if the string contains pattern, use IF \fsearch(pattern,string).

IF OPEN { DEBUG-LOG, SESSION-LOG, TRANSACTION-LOG, ... } command
Executes the command if the given file is open, fails if it is not open. Type IF OPEN ? for a complete list of files that can be checked (all the files that can be opened with the OPEN or LOG commands).

IF QUIET command
Executes the command if SET QUIET is ON, and does not execute it if SET QUIET is OFF. Example: IF NOT QUIET ECHO { This is a message.}.

IF READABLE name
Succeeds if name is the name of an existing file or directory that is readable.

IF WRITEABLE name
Succeeds if name is the name of an existing file or directory that is writeable, e.g.:
  if not writeable \v(lockdir) echo Please read installation instructions!

IF FLAG command
This tests a user-settable condition, which can mean anything you like. SET FLAG ON causes subsequent IF FLAG commands to succeed; SET FLAG OFF causes them to fail. One way to use it would be for debugging your scripts; precede any debugging statements with IF FLAG. Then SET FLAG on to debug your script, SET FLAG OFF to run it without debugging. Another common use is for causing an inner loop to cause an outer loop to exit.

IF C-KERMIT command
C-Kermit, but not Kermit 95 or MS-DOS Kermit, executes the command.

IF K-95 command
Kermit 95, but not C-Kermit or MS-DOS Kermit, executes the command.

IF MS-KERMIT command
MS-DOS Kermit, but not C-Kermit or Kermit 95, executes the command.


7.5. Using More than Ten Macro Arguments

The \v(argc) variable now gives the actual number of arguments, even if the number is greater than 9:

  C-Kermit> define xx echo \v(argc)
  C-Kermit> xx a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z
  27

Remember that \v(argc) includes the name of the macro itself, so it is always at least 1, and is always 1 greater than the actual number of arguments. As in versions 6.0 and earlier, if more than 9 arguments are given, only the first nine are assigned to the variables \%1..\%9.

The \&_[] array, discussed on page 353 of Using C-Kermit, 2nd ed, now holds all the arguments, up to some implementation-dependent limit (64 or greater), rather than only the first 9. To illustrate: the following macro tells the number of arguments it was called with and then prints them:

  define show_all_args {
      local \%i
      echo \&_[0] - Number of arguments: \feval(\v(argc)-1)
      for \%i 1 \v(argc)-1 1 { echo \flpad(\%i,3). "\&_[\%i]" }
  }

Within a macro \&_[0], like \%0, contains the name of the macro.

At top level, the \&_[] array is filled as follows:

The new \%* variable, when used within a macro, is replaced by the text that followed the macro name in the macro invocation. If no arguments were given, \%* is replaced by the empty string. Examples:

  C-Kermit> define xx echo [\%*]
  C-Kermit> define \%a oofa
  C-Kermit> xx
  []
  C-Kermit> xx \%a
  [oofa]
  C-Kermit> xx a
  [a]
  C-Kermit> xx a b
  [a b]
  C-Kermit> xx a b c
  [a b c]
  C-Kermit> xx a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z
  [a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z]

Note that \%* can not be used at top level, since Kermit does not have access to the raw command line (only to its elements separately, after they have been processed by the shell and the C library).

C-Kermit 7.0 also adds a SHIFT command:

SHIFT [ number ]
Shifts the macro arguments (except argument 0) the given number of places to the left and adjusts \v(argc) accordingly. The default number is 1.

To illustrate, suppose macro XXX is invoked as follows:

  xxx arg1 arg2 arg3

Then inside XXX, \%1 is "arg1", \%2 is "arg2", and \%3 is "arg3". After a SHIFT command is given inside XXX, then \%1 is "arg2", \%2 is "arg3", and \%3 is empty. \%0 (the name of the macro) remains unchanged.

If more than 9 arguments were given, then arguments are shifted into the \%1..9 variables from the argument vector array.

At top level, the SHIFT command operates on the \&_[] array and \%1..9 variables; the \&@[] array is not affected. See Section 7.16 for details.

The \%* variable is not affected by the SHIFT command.


7.6. Clarification of Function Call Syntax

Spaces are normally stripped from the front and back of each function argument; to prevent this enclose the argument in braces:

  \fsplit(\%a,&a,{ })

However, function calls that contain spaces can make trouble when the function is to be used in a "word" field, since space separates words. For example:

  for \%i 1 \fsplit(\%a,&a,{ }) 1 {
    echo \%i. "\&a[\%i]"
  }

In most cases, the trouble can be averted by enclosing the function reference in braces:

  for \%i 1 {\fsplit(\%a,&a,{ })} 1 {
    echo \%i. "\&a[\%i]"
  }

or by replacing spaces with \32 (the ASCII code for space):

  for \%i 1 \fsplit(\%a,&a,\32) 1 {
    echo \%i. "\&a[\%i]"
  }

Braces are also used in function calls to indicate grouping. For example:

  \fsubstring(abcd,2,2) = "bc"

But suppose "abcd" needed to contain a comma:

  \fsubstring(ab,cd,2,2)

This would cause an error, since "cd" appears to be the second argument, when really you want the first "2" to be the second argument. Braces to the rescue:

  \fsubstring({ab,cd},2,2) = "b,"

Similarly, leading and trailing spaces are stripped from each argument, so:

  \fsubstring( abcd ,2,2) = "bc"

but braces preserve them:

  \fsubstring({ abcd },2,2) = "ab"

Given these special uses for braces, there is no way to pass literal braces to the function itself. For example:

  \fsubstring(ab{cd,2,2)

causes an error.

So if you need a function to include braces, define a variable containing the string that has braces. Example:

  define \%a ab{cd
  \fsubstring(\%a,2,2) = "b{"

If the string is to start with a leading brace and end with a closing brace, then double braces must appear around the string (which itself is enclosed in braces):

  define \%a {{{foo}}}
  \fsubstring(\%a) = "{foo}"

This also works for any other kind of string:

  define \%a {{ab{cd}}
  echo \fsubstring(\%a) = "ab{cd"


7.7. Autodownload during INPUT Command Execution

As of 6.1 / 1.1.12, C-Kermit can be told to look for incoming Kermit (or Zmodem) packets during execution of an INPUT command. By default (for consistency with earlier releases), this is not done. You can enable this feature with:

  SET INPUT AUTODOWNLOAD ON

(and disable it again with OFF.)

One possible use for this feature is as a server mode with a time limit:

  INPUT 3600 secret-string-to-end-the-INPUT-command

In this example, any GET, SEND, or REMOTE commands received within one hour (3600 seconds) of when the INPUT command was issued will be executed. Here's another example, in which we want to stay open until 11:30pm, or until interrupted by seven consecutive Ctrl-C (\3) characters:

  INPUT 23:30:00 \3\3\3\3\3\3\3

The INPUT AUTODOWNLOAD setting is displayed by SHOW SCRIPTS or SHOW INPUT.


7.8. Built-in Help for Functions.

Beginning in C-Kermit 7.0, you may obtain a description of the calling conventions and return values of any built-in function, such as \fsubstring(), with the new HELP FUNCTION command; give the function's name without the leading "\f", e.g. "help func substring". You can use ?, completion, and abbreviation in the normal manner.


7.9. Variable Assignments

7.9.1. Assignment Operators

Programmers accustomed to languages such as C or Fortran might find Kermit's method of assigning values to variables unnatural or awkward. Beginning in C-Kermit 7.0, you can use the following alternative notation:

 .name = value    is equivalent to   DEFINE name value
 .name := value   is equivalent to   ASSIGN name value
 .name ::= value  is equivalent to   ASSIGN name \feval(value)

When the command begins with a period (.), this indicates an assignment. The name can be a macro name, a \%{digit,letter} variable, or an array element. There can be space(s) between "." and the name. Examples:

  .\%a = This is a string  ; Same as "define \%a This is a string"
  echo \%a
  This is a string

  .xxx = \%a               ; Same as "define xxx \%a"
  echo \m(xxx)
  \%a

  .xxx := \%a              ; Same as "assign xxx \%a"
  echo \m(xxx)
  This is a string

  declare \&a[2]           ; Use with arrays...
  define \%i 2
  .\&a[1] = first
  .\&a[\%i] = second

The following sequence illustrates the differences among three levels of evaluation:

  .\%x = 2          ; Define a variable to have a numeric value
  .\%y = (3 + \%x)  ; Define another variable as an arithmetic expression

  .xxx = 4 * \%y    ; "=" simply copies the right-hand side.
  echo \m(xxx)
  4 * \%y

  .xxx := 4 * \%y   ; ":=" evaluates the variables first, then copies.
  echo \m(xxx)
  4 * (3 + 2)

  .xxx ::= 4 * \%y  ; "::=" evaluates the expression, then copies.
  echo \m(xxx)
  20

You can also use this syntax to clear (undefine) a variable:

  .\%a = oofa       ; Define the variable
  echo "\%a"
  "oofa"
  .\%a              ; Clear the variable
  echo "\%a"
  ""

Extra credit: Can you guess what happens below when the file "abc" does not exist?

  fopen /read \%c abc
  if fail ...


7.9.2. New Assignment Commands

Recall the DEFINE and ASSIGN commands, and their hidden counterparts, _DEFINE and _ASSIGN. The former take the variable name literally, the latter evaluate the variable-name field to form the variable name dynamically. Examples:

  DEFINE \%x foo    ; Sets the value of the variable \%x to "foo".
  DEFINE \%a \%x    ; Sets the value of the variable \%a to "\%x".
  _DEFINE x_\%a \%x ; Sets the value of the variable x_foo to "\%x".
  ASSIGN \%a \%x    ; Sets the value of the variable \%a to the "foo".
  _ASSIGN x_\%a \%x ; Sets the value of the variable x_foo to "foo".

This concept has been carried over to the remaining variable-assignment commands: EVALUATE, INCREMENT, and DECREMENT:

EVALUATE variablename expression
Evaluates the arithmetic expression and assigns its value to the variable whose name is given. Example: "eval \%a 1+1" assigns "2" to \%a.

_EVALUATE metaname expression
Evaluates the arithmetic expression and assigns its value to the variable whose name is computed from the given metaname. Example: "eval foo<\%a>::\%1 \%2 * (\%3 + \%4)" assigns the value of "\%2 * (\%3 + \%4)" to the variable whose name is computed from "foo<\%a>::\%1".

INCREMENT variablename [ expression ]
Evaluates the arithmetic expression and adds its value to the value of the variable whose name is given. Example: "increment \%a".

_INCREMENT metaname [ expression ]
Evaluates the arithmetic expression and adds its value to the value of the variable whose name is computed from the given metaname. Example: "_increment Words::\%1.count[\%2]".

DECREMENT variablename [ expression ]
Evaluates the arithmetic expression and subtracts its value from the value of the variable whose name is given.

_DECREMENT metaname [ expression ]
Evaluates the arithmetic expression and subtracts its value from the value of the variable whose name is computed from the given metaname.

WARNING: The syntax of the EVALUATE command has changed since C-Kermit 6.0 and K95 1.1.17. Previously, it did not include a variable name, only an expression. To restore the old behavior, use SET EVALUATE OLD. To return to the new behavior after restoring the old behavior, use SET EVALUATE NEW.

NOTE: There are no analogs to the "_" commands for the operators described in Section 7.9.1; those operators can not be used to assign values to variables whose names must be computed.


7.10. Arrays

C-Kermit 7.0 adds lots of new array-related features, and groups them together under the NEW ARRAY command:

ARRAY { CLEAR, COPY, DECLARE, DESTROY, RESIZE, SHOW, SORT }

In each of the ARRAY commands, wherever an array name is expected, "short forms" may be used. For example, all of the following are acceptable:

  array show \&a[]  (or SHOW ARRAY...)
  array show &a[]
  array show a[]
  array show &a
  array show a

In addition, ranges are accepted in the ARRAY COPY, ARRAY CLEAR, ARRAY SET, ARRAY SHOW, and ARRAY SORT commands:

  array clear \&a[16]     ; Clears 16 thru end
  array clear &a[16]      ; Ditto
  array clear a[16]       ; Ditto

  array clear \&a[16:32]  ; Clears 16 thru 32
  array clear &a[16:32]   ; Ditto
  array clear a[16:32]    ; Ditto

When using array names as function arguments, you must omit the "\" and you must include the "&". You may optionally include empty brackets. Examples:

  \fsplit(\%a,a)          ; Bad
  \fsplit(\%a,\&a)        ; Bad
  \fsplit(\%a,&a[3])      ; Bad

  \fsplit(\%a,&a)         ; Good
  \fsplit(\%a,&a[])       ; Good


7.10.1. Array Initializers

Beginning in C-Kermit 7.0, you may initialize an array -- in whole or in part -- in its declaration:

[ ARRAY ] DECLARE array-name[size] [ = ] [ value1 [ value2 [...] ] ]

For compatibility with versions 5A and 6.0, the ARRAY keyword is optional. DECLARE can also be spelled DCL.

Initializers are (a) optional, (b) start with element 1, (c) must be enclosed in braces if they contain spaces, and (d) are evaluated according to normal rules by the DECLARE command prior to assignment. Thus the assignments made here are the same as those made by the ASSIGN command. This allows you to initialize array elements from the values of other variables. If you actually want to initialize an array element to variable's name, as opposed to its value, use double backslashes (as in "\\&a", "\\v(time)", etc).

The size (dimension) of the array is optional. If the size is omitted, as in "\&a[]", then the array sizes itself to the number of initializers; if there are no initializers the array is not declared or, if it was declared previously, it is destroyed. If a size is given, any extra elements in the initialization list are discarded and ignored.

NOTE: Unlike in C, the list of initializers is NOT enclosed in braces. Instead, braces are used to group multiple words together. So:

  ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] = { one two three }

would create an array with two elements (0 and 1), with element 1 having the value " one two three ".

Examples:

ARRAY DECLARE \&a[16]
Declares the array \&a with 17 elements (0 through 16), in which all elements are initially empty. If the array \&a[] existed before, the earlier copy is destroyed.

ARRAY DECLARE &a[16]
ARRAY DECLARE a[16]
ARRAY DCL \&a[16]
ARRAY DCL &a[16]
ARRAY DCL a[16]
DECLARE \&a[16]
DECLARE &a[16]
DECLARE a[16]
DCL \&a[16]
DCL &a[16]
DCL a[16]
All of the above are the same as the first example.

ARRAY DECLARE \&a[16] = alpha beta {gamma delta}
Declares the array \&a with 17 elements (0 through 16), initializing \&a[1] to "alpha", \&a[2] to "beta", and \&a[3] to "gamma delta". The remaining elements are empty.

ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] = alpha beta {gamma delta}
Same as the previous example, but the array is automatically dimensioned to 3.

ARRAY DECLARE \&a[3] = alpha beta {gamma delta} epsilon zeta
Too many initializers; only the first three are kept.

ARRAY DECLARE \&a[0]
ARRAY DECLARE \&a[]
ARRAY DECLARE &a[]
ARRAY DECLARE &a
ARRAY DECLARE a
DECLARE \&[0]
DECLARE a
DCL a
All of these are equivalent. Each destroys \&a[] if it exists. Declaring an array with a dimension of 0 is the same as ARRAY DESTROY arrayname.

ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] = \%1 \%2 \%3
Declares the array \&a with 3 elements (0 through 3), initializing \&a[1] to the value of \%1, \&a[2] to the value of \%2, and \&a[3] to the value of \%3. In this case, any reference to one of these array elements is replaced by the value of the corresponding \%n variable at the time the declaration was executed (immediate evaluation; the array element's value does not change if the initializer variable's value changes).

ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] = \\%1 \\%2 \\%3
Declares the array \&a with 3 elements (0 through 3), initializing \&a[1] to the string "\%1", \&a[2] to "\%2", and \&a[3] to "\%3". In this case any reference to one of these array elements is replaced by the CURRENT value of the corresponding \%n variable (deferred evaluation -- the array element's value follows the value of the initializer variable).

The equal sign (=) preceding the initializer list is optional, but is recommended for clarity. If you need to initialize element 1 to a literal equal sign, use two of them, separated by a space, as in this example:

  ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] = = + - * /

Remember, element 0 is not initialized by the DECLARE command. To initialize element 0, use a regular DEFINE or ASSIGN command:

  ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] one two three four five six seven eight nine
  DEFINE \&a[0] zero

Finally, remember that every command level has its own local array, \&_[], containing all the macro arguments (\%0, \%1, ...) for that level. See Section 7.5 for details.


7.10.2. Turning a String into an Array of Words

The \fsplit(s1,&a,s2,s3) function assigns the words of string s1 to successive elements of the array (beginning with element 1) whose identifying letter, a-z, is given after the "&" in the second argument, using break and include characters given in s2 and s3. See Section 7.3 for details.


7.10.3. Arrays of Filenames

See Section 4.11.3 for news about how \ffiles() and related functions can assign a list of filenames to an array. To recapitulate briefly here:

  \ffiles(*,&a)

assigns all files that match the first argument to the array denoted by the second argument. If the array has not been declared, it is declared automatically, with exactly the number of elements needed to hold the file list; if it was previously declared, it is destroyed and reused. The filenames are assigned starting at array element 1. Element 0 holds the number of files in the list.

The DIRECTORY command (Section 4.5.1) can also create filename arrays if you give it the /ARRAY: switch; this allows selection criteria beyond whether the filename matches the given pattern.

All functions and commands that create filename arrays store the number of filenames, n, as element 0 of the array, and the filenames as elements 1 through n.


7.10.4. Automatic Arrays

In a command file or macro, you can now have local (automatic) arrays. Just give the name followed by empty subscript brackets (no spaces inside the brackets please) in a LOCAL command, and then declare the array:

  LOCAL \%a \&a[] oofa
  ARRAY DECLARE \&a[32] = value1 value2 value3 ...

This declares the scalar variable \%a, the array \&a[], and the macro name "oofa" to be local, and then declares the new local copy of \&a[] with 32 elements, perhaps assigning some initial values. When C-Kermit exits from the command file or macro containing these command, the previous \&a[] array is restored (and if there was no \&a[] at any higher level, this will still be true). The process can be repeated to any level. Thus it is now safe to write scripts or macros containing arrays without danger of interfering with global arrays of the same name.

Just as scalars are inherited by lower command levels, so are arrays. So, for example, if \&a[] is declared at top level, all lower levels will see it unless they include a "local \&a[]" statement, in which case all levels at and beneath the level where the LOCAL statement was executed will see the local copy. This too can be repeated to any level.

On the other hand, if you DECLARE an array at a lower command level without also making it LOCAL, this replaces the copy that was declared at the lowest command level above this one.


7.10.5. Sorting Arrays

Although arrays can be sorted using FOR loops as shown on page 383 of Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed., this involves quite a bit of repetitive interpretation by the command parser, and so can be slow for large arrays. For this reason, C-Kermit 7.0 adds a built-in SORT command:

ARRAY SORT [ switches ] array [ array2 ]
Sorts the given array in place. Sorting is strictly lexical (string based). The array name can be given fully, e.g. "\&a[]", or the "\" and/or "&" and/or brackets can be omitted, e.g. "array sort \&a[]", "sort &a", "sort a". Also, a range can be indicated in the brackets as noted in Section 7.10, to restrict the sort to a range of elements (equivalent to the /RANGE switch, described just below), e.g. "array sort &a[20:30]".

A second array may be specified. If it is, and if it is at least as big as the first array, it is sorted according to the first array. For a sample application, see Section 7.10.10.

See Section 1.5 for an explanation of switches. The optional switches are:

/CASE:{ON,OFF}
/CASE:ON means that alphabetic case is significant in comparisons; uppercase letters are sorted before lowercase ones. /CASE:OFF means case is ignored, e.g. "A" is the same as "a". If this switch is not given, sorting is according the current SET CASE setting.

/KEY:n
Comparison begins at position n(1-based) in each string. If no key is given, the entire strings are compared. Only one key can be given. If an array element is shorter than the key value, n, that element is considered empty for comparison purposes, and therefore lexically less than any element at least ncharacters long.

/NUMERIC
If this switch is included, it means sorting should be numeric, rather than lexical. The sort key is the string starting at the key position, skipping any leading blanks or tabs, and then as much of the string from that point on that fits the definition of "numeric", terminating at the first character that does not qualify. A numeric string has an optional sign (+ or -) followed by one or more digits, and (if your version of Kermit was built with floating-point support; see Section 7.23 ) zero or one decimal point (period). If both /CASE and /NUMERIC are given, /NUMERIC takes precedence.

/RANGE:n[:m]
Sort elements nthrough m of the array. By default, the entire array from element 1 to its dimensioned size is sorted, which might produce surprising results if the array is not full; see example in Section 7.10.7. If ":m" is omitted from the range, the dimensioned size is used. Thus, to sort an entire array, \&a[], including its 0th element, use "sort /range:0 &a". You can also sort any desired section of an array, e.g. "sort /range:10:20 &a" or "sort /range:\%i:\%j-1 &b". As noted above, you can also specify a range in the array-name brackets. If you specify a range in the array-name brackets AND with a /RANGE switch, the ones in the brackets take precedence.

/REVERSE
Sort in reverse order. If this switch is not given, the array is sorted in ascending order.

Remember that numeric switch arguments can be numbers, arithmetic expressions, or variables whose values are numbers or expressions, as illustrated in the /RANGE examples above.

A typical sorting application might be to list students' test scores in descending order. Suppose you had the following records:

  olaf      65
  olga      98
  ivan      83
  xena     100

(and so on) stored in array \&s[] (e.g. by reading them from a file as illustrated in section 7.10.7). In these records, the student's name is in columns 1-9 and the score in 10-12. So to rearrange the list in descending order of score:

  sort /key:10 /reverse &s

Then to list your top five students:

  for \%i 1 5 1 { echo \&s[\%i] }

Or more simply (see next section):

  show array a[1:5]

To illustrate the difference between a lexical and a numeric sort, suppose you have the following records (the lines that are numbered, starting at column 1) in array \&a[]:

    Column   1         2
    12345678901234567890

1. Ivan 10.0 2. Olaf 9.95 3. Olga 101.5

ARRAY SORT /KEY:10 &a[] would order them 3,1,2, but ARRAY SORT /KEY:10 /NUMERIC &a[] would order them 2,1,3.


7.10.6. Displaying Arrays

The SHOW ARRAY command (or ARRAY SHOW) now accepts an optional array-name argument:

  SHOW ARRAY \&a[]

(you can leave off the \, the \&, and/or the []'s if you like; "show array a" is equivalent to "show array \&a[]"). When an array is specified, its dimension is shown and all defined (non-empty) elements are listed.

Example:

  assign \%n \ffiles(*,&a)  ; Fill an array with filenames (Section 4.11.3)
  show array \&a[]          ; Show the array we just read
  array show \&a[]          ; Same as previous
  array sort \&a[]          ; Sort the array
  array show \&a[]          ; Show it after sorting
  array show \&a            ; Show it again
  array show &a             ; Show it again
  array show a              ; Show it again

(The final four commands demonstrate the alternative forms that are accepted for the array name.)

If you SHOW ARRAY without giving an array name, all defined arrays are listed by name and dimension, but their contents are not shown.

You can also show a piece of an array by including a subscript or range within the array brackets:

  array show \&a[5]         ; Shows \&a[5]
  array show &a[3:8]        ; Shows \&a[3] through \&a[8]
  array show a[:\%n-1]      ; Shows \&a[0] through \&a[\%n-1]


7.10.7. Other Array Operations

ARRAY DESTROY arrayname
Destroys and undeclares the named array. Subscripts or ranges are not accepted in this command.

ARRAY COPY array1 array2
Copies the first array to the second array. If the target array has not been declared, it is created automatically with the same size as the first. If it has been declared, it will be used as declared; if the source array is larger, only as much of it as will fit is copied to the target array. Syntax for array1 and array2 is as in ARRAY SHOW (SHOW ARRAY). Example:

  .\%n := \ffiles(*,&a)  ; Create and load array A with a file list.
  array copy &a &b       ; Copy array A to array B.

The ARRAY COPY command also lets you copy pieces of arrays by including range specifiers, as in these examples:

ARRAY COPY \&a[4:27] \&b
This copies \&a[] elements 4-27 to \&b[] elements 1-23, creating \&b[] if necessary or, if \&b[] is already declared, stopping early if its size is less than 23.

ARRAY COPY \&a[4:27] \&b[12]
This copies \&a[] elements 4-27 to \&b[] elements 12-35, creating \&b[] if necessary or, if \&b[] is already declared, stopping early if its size is less than 35.

ARRAY COPY \&a[4:27] \&b[12:14]
This copies \&a[] elements 4-6 to \&b[] elements 12-14, creating \&b[] if necessary or, if \&b[] is already declared, stopping early if its size is less than 14.

ARRAY COPY \&a[17] \&b
This copies all the elements of \&a[] starting with 17 until the last to \&b[], creating \&b[] if necessary or, if \&b[] is already declared, stopping early if \&b[] is not big enough.

ARRAY CLEAR arrayname
Sets all the elements of the array to the empty value. You may also include a range specifier to clear only a selected portion of the array; for example "array clear \&a[37:214]". If the range is out of bounds, only the part of the array that is in bounds is cleared.

ARRAY SET arrayname [ value ]
Sets all the elements of the array to the given value. If no value is given, the array is cleared. You may also include a range specifier to set only a selected portion of the array; for example "array set \&a[1:9] -1". If the range is out of bounds, only the part of the array that is in bounds is set.

ARRAY RESIZE arrayname size
Resizes the given array. If the size is greater than the array's current dimension, new empty elements are added to the end. If the size is less than the current dimension, the extra elements are discarded. Note: If you have stored the array size in element 0, ARRAY RESIZE does not change this value. Alternative notation: ARRAY RESIZE arrayname[size]. For a practical example, see Section 7.10.11.

\farraylook(pattern,arrayname)
This function returns the index of the first element of the given array that matches the given pattern (for details about pattern syntax, see section 4.9). The array name can include a range specification to restrict the search to a given segment of the array. If no elements match the pattern, -1 is returned.

\ftablelook(keyword,arrayname[,delimiter])
Looks in the given "table", which must be sorted, for the given keyword. The keyword need not be spelled out in full. Pattern-matching characters should not be included as part of the keyword. The function returns the index of the table element that uniquely matches the given keyword, or -1 if none match, or -2 if more than 1 match.

A "table" is an array that is sorted in lexical order; each of its elements may contain multiple fields, delimited by the given delimiter character or, if no delimiter is specified, a colon (:).

The \farraylook() function does exactly what you tell it. If you give it a pattern that does not include wildcard characters (such as *, ?, etc), it requires an exact match. For example:

  \farraylook(oofa,&a)

searches for the first element of \&a[] whose value is "oofa". But:

  \farraylook(oofa*,&a)

finds the first element whose value starts with "oofa", and;

  \farraylook(*oofa,&a)

finds the first element whose value ends with "oofa", and;

  \farraylook(*oofa*,&a)

finds the first element whose value contains "oofa".

Here's a simple demonstration of looking up patterns in arrays:

  local \&a[] \%x \%n
  declare \&a[] = zero one two three four five six seven eight nine ten
  while true {
      .\%x = 1
      .\%n = 0
      ask \%a { Pattern? }
      if not def \%a exit 0 Done.
      while <= \%x \fdim(&a) {
	  .\%x := \farraylook(\%a,&a[\%x])
	  if ( < \%x 0 ) break
          echo \flpad(\%x,3). \&a[\%x]
          increment \%x
          increment \%n
      }
      if ( < \%n 1 ) echo Pattern not found - "\%a"
  }

The array need not be sorted. When a pattern is given, a search is performed; if there is a match, the matching element's index and the element itself are printed, and the search begins again at the next element. Thus each matching element is printed. If none match, the "Pattern not found" message is printed. The process repeats for as many patterns as the user wants to type, and terminates when the user types an empty pattern.

Now let's build a little command parser, consisting of a keyword table, and a loop to look up the user's commands in it with \ftablelook(). In this case the array elements have "fields" separated by colon (:) -- a keyword and a value. Keyword tables must be sorted if \tablelook() is to work right, so after declaring and initializing the table array, we sort it.

  local \&k[] \%a \%i \%n

  array declare \&k[] = drive:9 do:8 discuss:7 live:6 spend:5 help:4 quit:0

  array sort &k                             ; Make sure array is sorted
  echo Type "help" for help.                ; Print greeting & instructions

  while true {                              ; Loop to get commands
      undefine \%a
      while not defined \%a {               ; Get a command
          ask \%a { Command? }
      }
      .\%n := \ftablelook(\%a,&k)           ; Look up the command
      switch \%n {                          ; Handle errors
        :-1, echo Not found - "\%a"         ; Doesn't match
             continue
        :-2, echo Ambiguous - "\%a"         ; Matches too many
             continue
      }
      switch \fword(\&k[\%n],2) {           ; Dispatch according to value
	 :9, echo Driving..., break
	 :8, echo Doing..., break
	 :7, echo Discussing..., break
	 :6, echo Living..., break
	 :5, echo Spending..., break
         :4, echo { Commands (may be abbreviated):}
             for \%i 1 \fdim(&k) 1 {
                echo {  \%i. \fword(\&k[\%i],1) }
             }
             break
         :0, exit 0 Bye!
         :default, stop 1 Internal error
      }
  }

In this example, keywords are "drive", "do", "discuss", etc, and their values are unique numbers (values need not be numbers, and there need not be only one value -- there can be 0, 1, 2, or more of them). The user types a command, which can be the whole word (like "help") or any abbreviation (like "hel", "he", or just "h"). If this does not match any keywords, \ftablelook() returns -1; if it matches more than one (as would "d"), it returns -2. Otherwise the array index is returned, 1 or higher.

Given the array index \%n, we can get the table values as follows:

  \fword(\&k[\%n],1) is the keyword (first field)
  \fword(\&k[\%n],2) is the value (second field, in this case a number)

In our example, we use the value (number) as the SWITCH variable. As noted, \fablelook() expects the array elements to contain multiple fields separated by colon (:) (or other character that you specify, e.g. \ftablelook(\%a,&a,^)) and when matching the keyword, ignores the first delimiter and everything after it.


7.10.8. Hints for Using Arrays

C programmers are accustomed to out-of-bounds array references causing core dumps or worse. In C-Kermit:

C programmers expect an array of size nto have elements 0 through n-1. Fortran programmers expect the same array to have elements 1 through n. C-Kermit accommodates both styles; when you declare an array of size n, it has n=1 elements, 0 through n, and you can use the array in your accustomed manner, 0-based or 1-based.

However, note that C-Kermit has certain biases towards 1-based arrays:

The distinction between an array's dimensioned size and the number of elements in the array is important when sorting. To illustrate:

  declare \&a[100]                  ; Declare array &a with 100 elements
  fopen /read \%c oofa.txt          ; Open a file
  if fail...
  for \%i 1 \fdim(&a) 1 {           ; Read the file into the array
      fread \%c \&a[\%i]
      if fail break
  }
  fclose \%c
  if > \%i \fdim(&a) end 1 File has too many lines for array.
  .\%n ::= \%i - 1
  echo File has \%n line(s).

Let's say the file had 95 lines. This leaves elements 96-100 of the array empty. Now suppose you sort the array and write out the result:

  sort &a                           ; Sort the whole array
  fopen /write \%o oofa.txt.sorted  ; Open an output file
  if fail ...
  for \%i 1 \%n 1 {                 ; Write out 95 records
      fwrite /line \%o \&a[\%i]
      if fail end 1 Write error
  }
  close write

You might be surprised at the contents of "oofa.txt.sorted" -- five empty elements, 96-100, floated to the top of the array in the sort, and since your write loop only had 95 iterations, the final 5 lines of the sorted file are lost.

Therefore, when dealing with partially filled arrays -- especially when sorting them -- remember to specify the number of elements. A handy way of recording an array's "true" size is to put it in the 0th element. That way, it "travels with the array". To illustrate (continuing the previous example at the "close read" statement):

  close read
  if > \%i \fdim(&a) end 1 File has too many lines for array.
  .\&a[0] ::= \%i - 1     ; Assign number of lines to \&a[0].
  echo File has \&a[0] line(s).
  sort /range:1:\&a[0] &a
  open write oofa.txt.sorted
  if fail ...
  for \%i 1 \&a[0] 1 {
      writeln file \&a[\%j]
      if fail end 1 Write error
  }
  close write

Note the SORT switch, /RANGE:1:\&a[0]. This keeps the sort 1-based, and uses element 0 of the array as its size indicator.

Finally, note that even though some commands or functions might put a size in array element 0, no built-in functions or commands depend on a size actually being there. Thus you are perfectly free to replace the size with something else and treat the array as 0-based.


7.10.9. Do-It-Yourself Arrays

Kermit's \&x[] arrays are nice because of the accompanying built-in functionality -- ARRAY commands, built-in functions that load and search arrays, automatic evaluation of arithmetic expressions within the subscript brackets, and so on. Yet they also have certain limitations:

  1. Except when created by dynamic loading (e.g. by \ffiles()) they must be declared and dimensioned in advance.

  2. Indices must be numeric, positive, and in range.

  3. There can be only one dimension. Matrices or other higher-dimensioned arrays are not available.

But none of this is to say you can't invent any kind of data structure you like. In Section 7.9.2 you can see some examples. Here's another (courtesy of Dat Thuc Nguyen), in which a pair of matrices is created and then added: no dimensioning necessary.

  .row = 4
  .col = 9

  ; MACRO TO PRINT A MATRIX
  define PMATRIX {
      echo Matrix \%1:
      for \%r 1 \m(row) 1 {
	  for \%c 1 \m(col) 1 {
	      xecho \flpad(\m(\%1[\%r][\%c]),4)
	  }
	  echo
      }
      echo
  }
  ; CREATE MATRICES A AND B
  for \%r 1 \m(row) 1 {
      for \%c 1 \m(col) 1 {
	  _eval A[\%r][\%c] \%r + \%c
	  _eval B[\%r][\%c] \%r * \%c
      }
  }
  ; CREATE MATRIX C = SUM OF MATRIX A AND MATRIX B
  for \%r 1 \m(row) 1 {
      for \%c 1 \m(col) 1 {
	  _eval C[\%r][\%c] \m(A[\%r][\%c]) + \m(B[\%r][\%c])
      }
  }
  pmatrix A  ; Print Matrix A
  pmatrix B  ; Print Matrix B
  pmatrix C  ; Print Matrix C

In the example, we use matrix-like notation to create macros with names like "A[1][1]", "B[3][7]", and so on.


7.10.10. Associative Arrays

An associative array is a special kind of Do-It-Yourself array. It differs from a regular array in that its indices need not be numbers -- they can be anything at all -- words, filenames, names of months, any character string at all, and that it doesn't have to be (and in fact can't be) declared. An associative array element is simply a macro whose name ends with an index enclosed in angle brackets, for example:

  file<oofa.txt>

More formally:

  basename<index>

An associative array is a collection of all associative array elements that have the same basename. Any number of associative arrays, each with any number of elements, can exist at the same time.

An associative array element can be assigned a value, such as "1", just like any other macro:

  define file<oofa.txt> 1     ; Give "file<oofa.txt>" the value "1".

or:

  assign file<oofa.txt> \%a   ; Give it the value of the variable \%a.

However, since an associative array element is a macro, it may not have an empty (null) value, since assigning an empty value to a macro undefines the macro.

You can refer to the value of an associative array element using the familiar notation for macro values:

  echo \m(file<oofa.txt>)     ; Echo the value of "file<oofa.txt>".

Associative arrays are most useful, however, when the value of the index is a variable. In that case, you must use the "hidden" forms of the DEFINE or ASSIGN commands that evaluate the macro name before making the assignment (see Using C-Kermit, page 457). Example:

  define \%f oofa.txt
  _define file<\%f> 1
  echo file<\%f> = \m(file<\%f>)

prints:

  file<oofa.txt> = 1

and then:

  _increment file<\%f>
  echo file<\%f> = \m(file<\%f>)

prints:

  file<oofa.txt> = 2

What are associative arrays good for? The classic example is "word counts": finding the number of times each word is used in a text without knowing in advance what the words are. Without associative arrays, your program would have to build a table of some kind, and every time a word was encountered, look it up in the table to find its position and counter, or add it to the table if it wasn't found -- a time-consuming and laborious process. Associative arrays, however, let you use the word itself as the table index and therefore sidestep all the table building and lookups.

Let's work through a practical example. Suppose you have a file-transfer log in which each line is composed of a number of blank-separated fields, and the 9th field is a filename (which happens to be the format of certain FTP server logs, as well as of C-Kermit's new FTP-format transaction log, described in Section 4.17.2), for example:

  Wed Jul 14 09:35:31 1999 22 xx.mit.edu 13412 /pub/ftp/mm/intro.txt ....

and you want to find out how many times each file was transferred. The following code builds an associative array, file<>, containing the counts for each file:

  local name line max \%c \%n          ; Declare local variables
  fopen /read \%c /var/log/ftpd.log    ; Open the log file (Section 1.22)
  if fail exit 1 Can't open log        ; Check
  while true {                         ; Loop for each record
      fread /line \%c line             ; Read a line
      if fail break                    ; Check for end of file
      .name := \fword(\m(line),9,{ })  ; Get 9th field = filename (Sec 7.3)
      _increment file<\m(name)>        ; Increment its counter (Sec 7.9.2)
  }
  fclose \%c                           ; Close file when done.

Note that _INCREMENT (and INCREMENT, and [_]DECREMENT) treat an empty (i.e. nonexistent) variable as having a value of 0, and therefore creates the variable with a value of 1.

At this point, if you told Kermit to "show macro file<", it would list the associative array. But since you don't necessarily know the names of the files in the array, or even how many elements are in the array, how can you use it in a script program?

The idea of creating macro names that include character-string indices enclosed in angle brackets is perfectly arbitrary and doesn't depend on any Kermit features that weren't already there -- we could just as easily have used some other notation, such as "file[index]", "file:index", or "file.index", and the code above would have worked just as well (with the corresponding syntax adjustments). But to be able to use an associative array in a program after the array is built, we need a method of accessing all its elements without knowing in advance what they are. That's where the chosen notation comes in.

First of all, any macro name that ends with "<xxx>" (where "xxx" is any string) is case sensitive, unlike all other macro names, which are case independent. To illustrate, "file<oofa.txt>" and "file<OOFA.TXT>" are two distinct macros, whereas "OOFA", "Oofa", and "oofa", when used as macro names, are all the same.

Second, the new \faaconvert() function converts an associative array (that is, all macros with names of the form "base<index>" that have the same "base" part) into a pair of regular arrays and returns the number of elements:

  \faaconvert(name,&a[,&b])

"name" is the name of the associative array, without the angle brackets or index ("file" in our example).

The second argument is the name of a regular array in which to store the indices of the associative array (filenames in our example); if an array of this name already exists, it is destroyed unless the array is LOCAL. The third argument is the name of another regular array in which to store the values (the counts in our example), with the same rules about array name collisions. If you care only about the indices and not the values, you can omit the third argument to \faaconvert(). In any case, the associative array is converted, not copied: its elements are moved to the specified regular arrays, so after conversion the original associative array is gone.

As with other array-loading functions, \faaconvert() sets element 0 of each array to the number of elements in the array.

To continue our example:

  .max := 0                                   ; Maximum count
  .\%n := \faaconvert(file,&a,&b)             ; Convert
  for \%i 1 \%n 1 {                           ; Loop through values
      echo \flpad(\%i,3). \&a[\%i]: \&b[\%i]  ; Echo this pair
      if ( > \&b[\%i] \m(max) ) {             ; Check for new maximum
          .name := \&a[\%i]
          .max  := \&b[\%i]
      }
  }
  echo Most popular file: \m(name), accesses: \m(max)

This lists the files and counts and then announces which file has the highest count.

Now suppose you want to sort the array pair created from an associative array. In our example, \&a[] contains filenames, and \&b[] contains the associated counts. Here we take advantage of the ARRAY SORT command's ability to sort a second array according to the first one:

  array sort /reverse /numeric &b &a          ; Descending sort by count

Now to see the top five files and their counts:

  echo The top 5 files are:
  for \%i 1 5 1 {                             ; Loop through top 5 values
      echo \flpad(\%i,3). \&a[\%i]: \&b[\%i]  ; Echo this pair
  }


7.10.11. Transferring Array Contents to Other Computers

The SEND /ARRAY:arrayname command (Section 4.7.1) allows you to send the contents of any array, or any contiguous segment of it, in either text or binary mode to another computer, using Kermit protocol. When used in conjunction with C-Kermit's other features (the array features described in this section; the file i/o package from Section 1.22; its decision-making, pattern-matching, and string manipulation capabilities, and so on) the possibilities are endless: extracts of large files, remote database queries, ..., all without recourse to system-dependent mechanisms such UNIX pipes and filters, thus ensuring cross-platform portability of scripts that use these features.

When sending an array in text mode, Kermit appends a line terminator to each array element, even empty ones, and it also converts the character set from your current FILE character-set to your current TRANSFER character-set, if any. No conversions are made or line terminations added in binary mode. For example, the following array:

  dcl \&a[] = One Two Three Four Five Six

is sent as six lines, one word per line, in text mode, and as the bare unterminated string "OneTwoThreeFourFiveSix" in binary mode.

You should always include a /TEXT or /BINARY switch in any SEND /ARRAY command to force the desired transfer mode, otherwise you're likely to be surprised by the effects described in Section 4.3.

Here are some examples:

send /text /array:\&a[]
Sends the entire contents of the array \&a[] in text mode. Since an as-name is not included, the receiver is told the filename is _array_a_.

send /text /array:&a[]
send /text /array:a[]
send /text /array:&a
send /text /array:a
These are all equivalent to the previous example.

send /text /array:&a /as-name:foo.bar
As above, but the array is sent under the name foo.bar.

send /text /array:&a[100:199] /as:foo.bar
As above, but only the elements from 100 through 199 are sent.

In text-mode transfers, character sets are translated according to your current settings, just as for text files. In binary mode, of course, there is no character-set translation or other conversion of any kind. But remember that array elements can not contain the NUL (ASCII 0) character, since they are implemented as NUL-terminated strings.

Here's an example that shows how to send all the lines (up to 1000 of them) from a file animals.txt that contain the words "cat", "dog", or "hog" (see Section 4.9 about pattern matching):

  declare \&a[1000]
  fopen /read \%c animals.txt
  if fail exit 1
  .\%i = 0
  while true {
      fread \%c line
      if fail break
      if match {\m(line)} {*{cat,[dh]og}*} {
          increment \%i
          if ( > \%i \fdim(&a) ) break
          .\&a[\%i] := \m(line)
      }
  }
  fclose \%c
  send /array:a[1:\%i] /text

Note that we are careful to send only the part of the array that was filled, not the entire array, because there are likely to be lots of unused elements at the end, and these would be sent as blank lines otherwise.

This example raises an interesting question: what if we want to send ALL the matching lines, even if there are more than 1000 of them, but we don't know the number in advance? Clearly the problem is limited by Kermit's (and the computer's) memory. If there are a thousand trillion matching lines, they most likely will not fit in memory, and in this case the only solution is to write them first to a temporary file on mass storage and then send the temporary file and delete it afterwards.

However, when the selection is likely to fit in memory, the once-familiar technique of initial allocation with extents can be used:

  if match {\m(line)} {*{cat,[dh]og}*} {
      increment \%i
      if ( > \%i \fdim(&a) ) {
	  array resize a \fdim(&a)+100
	  if fail stop 1 MEMORY FULL
	  echo NEW DIMENSION: \fdim(&a)
      }
      .\&a[\%i] := \m(line)
  }

This grows the array in chunks of 100 as needed.


7.11. OUTPUT Command Improvements

LINEOUT [ text ]
This command is exactly like OUTPUT, except it supplies a carriage return at the end of the text. "lineout exit" is exactly the same as "output exit\13".

SET OUTPUT SPECIAL-ESCAPES { ON, OFF }
This command lets you tell C-Kermit whether to process \N, \L, and \B specially in an OUTPUT command, as distinct from other \ sequences (such as \%a, \13, \v(time), etc). Normally the special escapes are handled. Use SET OUTPUT SPECIAL-ESCAPES OFF to disable them.

Disabling special escapes is necessary in situations when you need to transmit lines of data and you have no control over what is in the lines. For example, a file oofa.txt that contains:

  This is a file
  It has \%a variables in it
  And it has \B in it.
  And it has \L in it.
  And it has \N in it.
  And this is the last line.

can be sent like this:

  local line
  set output special-escapes off
  fopen /read \%c oofa.txt
  if fail stop 1 Can't open oofa.txt
  while success {
      fread \%c line
      if fail break
      ; Add filtering or processing commands here...
      output \m(line)\13
  }


7.12. Function and Variable Diagnostics

In C-Kermit 6.0 and earlier, the only diagnostic returned by a failing function call was an empty value, which (a) could not be distinguished from an empty value returned by a successful function call; (b) did not give any indication of the cause of failure; and (c) did not cause the enclosing statement to fail. C-Kermit 7.0 corrects these deficiencies.

SET FUNCTION DIAGNOSTICS { ON, OFF }
when ON, allows built-in functions to return diagnostic messages when improperly referenced, instead of an empty string. FUNCTION DIAGNOSTICS are ON by default. When OFF, improperly referenced functions continue to return an empty string. This command also affects built-in variables; in this case, an error message is returned only if the variable does not exist. When FUNCTION DIAGNOSTICS are ON, the error message is also printed.

For variables, the only message is:

  <ERROR:NO_SUCH_VARIABLE:\v(name)>

where "name" is the name of the nonexistent variable.

For functions, the diagnostic message is:

  <ERROR:message:\fname()>

where "message" is replaced by a message, and "name" is replaced by the function name, e.g. <ERROR:ARG_NOT_NUMERIC:\fmod()>. Messages include:

  ARG_BAD_ARRAY       An argument contains a malformed array reference.
  ARG_BAD_DATE        An argument contains a malformed date and/or time.
  ARG_BAD_PHONENUM    An argument contains a malformed telephone number.
  ARG_BAD_VARIABLE    An argument contains a malformed \%x variable.
  ARG_INCOMPLETE      An argument is incomplete (e.g. a broken Base64 string).
  ARG_EVAL_FAILURE    An argument could not be evaluated (internal error).
  ARG_NOT_ARRAY       An argument references an array that is not declared.
  ARG_NOT_NUMERIC     An argument that must be integer contains non-digits.
  ARG_NOT_FLOAT       An argument has bad floating-point number format.
  ARG_NOT_VARIABLE    An argument that must be a variable is not a variable.
  ARG_OUT_OF_RANGE    An argument's numeric value is too big or too small,
                      or an argument contains illegal characters (e.g. a hex
                      or Base-64 string).
  ARG_TOO_LONG        An argument's value is too long.
  ARRAY_FAILURE       Failure to create an array.
  DIVIDE_BY_ZERO      Execution of the function would cause division by zero.
  FLOATING_POINT_OP   Execution error in a floating-point operation.
  FILE_NOT_FOUND      Filename argument names a file that can't be found.
  FILE_NOT_READABLE   Filename argument is not a regular file.
  FILE_NOT_ACCESSIBLE Filename argument names a file that is read-protected.
  FILE_ERROR          Other error with filename argument.
  FILE_NOT_OPEN       A file function was given a channel that is not open.
  FILE_ERROR_-n       A file function got error -n (Section 1.22).
  LOOKUP_FAILURE      Error looking up function (shouldn't happen).
  MALLOC_FAILURE      Failure to allocate needed memory (shouldn't happen).
  NAME_AMBIGUOUS      The function is not uniquely identified.
  MISSING_ARG         A required argument is missing.
  NO_SUCH_FUNCTION    An argument references a function that is not defined.
  NO_SUCH_MACRO       An argument references a macro that is not defined.
  RESULT_TOO_LONG     The result of a function is too long.
  UNKNOWN_FUNCTION    Internal error locating function (shouldn't happen).

Examples:

  assign \%m \fmod()
  ?<ERROR:MISSING_ARG:\fmod()>
  echo "\fcontents(\%m)"
  "<ERROR:MISSING_ARG:\fmod()>"
  echo \fmod(3,x)
  ?<ERROR:ARG_NOT_NUMERIC:\fmod()>
  echo \fmod(3,4-2*2)
  ?<ERROR:DIVIDE_BY_ZERO:\fmod()>

Notice the use of \fcontents() in echoing the value of a variable that contains a returned error message. That's because the error message includes the name of the variable or function that failed, so you must use \fcontents() to prevent it from being evaluated again -- otherwise the same error will occur.

The handling of function and variable errors is controlled by:

SET FUNCTION ERROR { ON, OFF }
Tells whether invalid function calls or variable references should cause command errors. FUNCTION ERROR is ON by default. When ON, and an error is diagnosed in a built-in function or variable, the command that includes the function call or variable reference fails. The failing command can be handled in the normal way with IF FAILURE / IF SUCCESS, SET TAKE ERROR, or SET MACRO ERROR.

When FUNCTION DIAGNOSTICS is OFF, there is no error message.

SHOW SCRIPTS displays the current FUNCTION DIAGNOSTICS and ERROR settings.


7.13. Return Value of Macros

In C-Kermit 5A and 6.0, there are two ways to return one level from a macro: RETURN value and END number text. When RETURN is used, the value, which can be a number or a text string, is assigned to \v(return). When END was used, however, \v(return) was not set. SUCCESS/FAILURE was set according to whether the number was zero, and the text was printed, but the actual value of the number was lost.

In C-Kermit 7.0, the END number is available in the \v(return) variable.


7.14. The ASSERT, FAIL, and SUCCEED Commands.

The ASSERT command is just like the IF command, but without a command to execute. It simply succeeds or fails, and this can be tested by a subsequent IF SUCCESS or IF FAILURE command. Example:

  ASSERT = 1 1
  IF SUCCESS echo 1 = 1.

The FAIL command does nothing, but always fails. The SUCCEED command does nothing, but always succeeds.

These commands are handy in debugging scripts when you want to induce a failure (or success) that normally would not occur, e.g. for testing blocks of code that normally are not executed.


7.15. Using Alarms

Alarms may be set in two ways:

SET ALARM number
Sets an alarm for the given number of seconds "from now", i.e. in the future, relative to when the SET ALARM command was given. Examples:
  set alarm 60        ; 60 seconds from now
  set alarm +60       ; The same as "60"
  set alarm -60       ; Not legal - you can't set an alarm in the past.
  set alarm 60*60     ; 60 minutes from now.
  set alarm \%a+10    ; You can use variables, etc.

SET ALARM hh:mm:ss
Sets an alarm for the specified time. If the given time is earlier than the current time, the alarm is set for the given time in the next day. You may give the time in various formats:
  set alarm 15:00:00  ; 3:00:00pm
  set alarm 3:00:00pm ; 3:00:00pm
  set alarm 3:00pm    ; 3:00:00pm
  set alarm 3pm       ; 3:00:00pm

SHOW ALARM
Displays the current alarm, if any, in standard date-time format (see Section 1.6): yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss.

IF ALARM command
Executes the command if an alarm has been set and the alarm time has passed.

IF ALARM { command-list } [ ELSE { command-list } ]
Executes the command-list if an alarm has been set and the alarm time has passed. Otherwise, if an ELSE part is given, its command-list is executed.

CLEAR ALARM
Clears the alarm.

Only one alarm may be set at a time.

Example: Suppose you have a script that is always running, and that transfers files periodically, and that keeps a transaction log. Suppose you want to start a new transaction log each day:

  log transactions \v(date).log
  set alarm 00:00:00                     ; Set an alarm for midnight
  while true {                           ; Main script loop
      xif alarm {                        ; If the alarm time is past...
          close transactions             ; Close current log
          log transactions \v(date).log  ; Start new one
          pause 1                        ; To make sure 00:00:00 is past
          set alarm 00:00:00             ; Set a new alarm
      }
      ; put the rest of the script here...
  }

Note that IF ALARM -- no matter whether it succeeds or fails -- does NOT clear an expired alarm. Thus, once an alarm has expired, every IF ALARM will succeed until the alarm is cleared (with the CLEAR ALARM command) or reset with a new SET ALARM command.


7.16. Passing Arguments to Command Files

Beginning in version 7.0, C-Kermit accepts arguments on the TAKE command line, for example:

  C-Kermit> take oofa.ksc one two {this is three} four

This automatically sets the variables \%1 through \%9 to the arguments, and \%0 to the name of the file, in this case:

  \%0 = /usr/olga/oofa.ksc
  \%1 = one
  \%2 = two
  \%3 = this is three
  \%4 = four

and \%5..\%9 are undefined (empty). Arguments past the ninth are available in the \&_[] argument-vector array ( Section 7.5).

The variables are those at the current macro level. Thus, if the TAKE command is executed from within a macro, the macro's arguments are replaced by those given on the TAKE command line (but only if at least one argument is given). The command shown above is exactly equivalent to:

  assign \%0 /usr/olga/oofa.ksc
  assign \%1 one
  assign \%2 two
  assign \%3 this is three
  assign \%4 four
  assign \%5
  assign \%6
  assign \%7
  assign \%8
  assign \%9
  take oofa.ksc

Remember, the variables \%0..\%9 are on the macro call stack, and command files are independent of the macro stack. Thus, if a command file TAKEs another command file and passes arguments to it, the variables are changed from that point on for both files, and so forth for all levels of nested command files without intervening macro invocations.

It would have been possible to change C-Kermit to use the overall command stack, rather than the macro stack, for arguments -- this would have made TAKE work exactly like DO, which is "nicer", but it would also have broken countless existing scripts. However, the new SHIFT command (Section 7.5) makes it possible to create an alternative TAKE command that does indeed save and restore the argument variables at its own level around execution of a command file:

  define mtake {
     local \%f
     assign \%f \fcontents(\%1)
     shift
     take \%f
  }

C-Kermit 7.0 also supports a new, easier way to pass arguments to scripts from the system command line:

  kermit filename arg1 arg2 arg3 ...

in which arg1, arg2, arg3 (etc) are arguments for the script (whose filename is given), and are assigned to \%1, \%2, ... \%9. The filename is assigned to \%0. This applies equally to "Kerbang" scripts in UNIX (Section 7.19). For example, suppose you have a file called "showargs" containing the following lines:

  #!/usr/local/bin/kermit +
  echo Hello from \%0
  show args
  exit

(except not indented, since the "#!" line must be on the left margin). If you give this file execute permission:

  chmod +x showargs

then you can run it exactly as you would run a UNIX shell script, e.g.:

  $ showargs one two three
  Hello from /usr/olga/showargs
  Top-level arguments (\v(argc) = 4):
   \&_[0] = /usr/olga/showargs
   \&_[1] = one
   \&_[2] = two
   \&_[3] = three

Furthermore, the \&_[] array now contains the filename, if one was given as the first command line argument, or it is a "Kerbang" script, in element 0.

Otherwise element 0 is program name, and elements 1 through \v(argc)-1 contain the command-line arguments, if any, that appear after "--" or "=", if any. This array is saved and restored around macro calls; recall that inside macros it contains the macro argument vector (allowing you to access arguments programmatically, and to have more than 9 of them).

At top level, notice the difference between the \&@[] and \&_[] arrays. The former includes C-Kermit options; the latter omits them.


7.17. Dialogs with Timed Responses

The ASK, ASKQ, GETOK, and GETC commands (let's call them the "ASK-class commands") let you write scripts that carry on dialogs with the user, asking them for text, a Yes/No answer, or a character, respectively. Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, these questions would always wait forever for an answer. In C-Kermit 7.0, you may specify a time limit for them with the new command:

SET ASK-TIMER number
Sets a time-limit on ASK-CLASS commands to the given number of seconds. If the number is 0 or less, there is no time limit and these commands wait forever for a response. Any timer that is established by this command remains in effect for all future ASK-class commands until another SET ASK-TIMER command is given (e.g. with a value of 0 to disable ASK timeouts).

IF ASKTIMEOUT command
An ASK-class command that times out returns a failure status. You can test explicitly for a timeout with:


7.18. Increased Flexibility of SWITCH Case Labels

Prior to C-Kermit 7.0 / K95 1.1.19, the case labels in SWITCH statements were string constants.

Now case labels can be variables, function calls, or any mixture of these with each other and/or with regular characters.

Furthermore, after the case label is evaluated, it is treated not as a string constant, but as a pattern against which the SWITCH variable is matched (Section 4.9.1).

This introduces a possible incompatibility with previous releases, since the following characters in case labels are no longer taken literally:

  \ * ? [ {

Any scripts that previously included any of these characters in case labels must now quote them with backslash (\).


7.19. "Kerbang" Scripts

In UNIX only, Kermit scripts can be stored in files and run "directly", without starting Kermit first (as noted on page 467 of the manual), just as a shell script can be "run" as if it were a program. This section amplifies on that idea a bit, and presents some new aspects of version 7.0 that make it easier to write and run Kermit scripts directly.

NOTE: On non-UNIX platforms, such as VMS or Windows, Kerbang scripts can be run as "kermit + scriptfilename arg1 arg2 arg3 ...". Windows 95/98/NT file associations do not allow for the passing of parameters. In VMS, however, you can achieve the Kerbang effect by defining a symbol, as in this example:

  $ autotelnet :== "$SYS$TOOLS:KERMIT.EXE + AUTOTELNET.KSC"

and then running the script like any other command:

  $ autotelnet xyzcorp.com myuserid

See Section 9.3 for an explanation of the "+" symbol.

UNIX shell scripts can specify which shell should run them by including a "shebang" line at the top, e.g.:

  #!/bin/sh

(but not indented; the shebang line must be on the left margin). The term "shebang" is a contraction of "shell" and "bang". "Bang" is a slang word for the exclamation mark ("!"); "shebang" itself is an American slang word used in in the phrase "the whole shebang".

We can run Kermit scripts directly too, by including a "shebang" line that names Kermit as the "shell"; thus we call these "Kerbang" scripts. This mechanism has been considerably simplified in C-Kermit 7.0 to facilitate C-Kermit's use a scripting tool just like any of the UNIX shells or scripting languages. The rules are the same as for shell scripts:

  1. The first line of the Kermit script must begin with "#!" immediately followed by the full pathname of the program that will execute the script (in this case, C-Kermit rather than a UNIX shell), followed by any Kermit command-line options. To suppress execution of the C-Kermit initialization file and to make command line arguments available to the script, the final option should be "+":

      #!/usr/local/bin/kermit +
    

    Some users have reported that in some circumstances a space might be necessary after the plus sign; this depends on your shell -- it has nothing to do with Kermit. In most cases, no space is needed.

  2. The file must have execute permission (granted via "chmod +x filename").

When C-Kermit is invoked from a Kerbang script (or from the system prompt with a "+" command-line argument, which amounts to the same thing), the following special rules apply:

  1. The C-Kermit initialization file is NOT executed automatically. If you want it to be executed, include a TAKE command for it in the script, e.g. "take \v(home).kermrc". (In previous releases, the initialization file was always executed, with no way to prevent it except for the user to include Kermit-specific command line options which had nothing to do with the script). Many scripts have no need for the standard Kermit initialization file, which is quite lengthy and not only delays startup of the script, but also spews forth numerous messages that are most likely unrelated to the script.

  2. If the initialization file is not executed, neither is your customization file, since the initialization file is the command file from which the customization file is TAKEn. Again, you can include a TAKE command for the initialization file if desired, or for the customization file by itself, or for any other file.

  3. C-Kermit does not process command-line arguments at all. Instead, it passes all words on the command line after the "+" to the script as \%0 (the script name), \%1..\%9 (the first nine arguments), as well as in the argument vector array \&_[]. The variable \v(argc) is set to the total number of "words" (as passed by the shell to Kermit) including the script name. Quoting and grouping rules are those of the shell.

  4. At any point where the script terminates, it must include an EXIT command if you want it to exit back to the shell; otherwise C-Kermit enters interactive prompting mode when the script terminates. The EXIT command can include a numeric status to be returned to the shell (0, 1, etc), plus an optional message.

Here is a simple Kerbang script that prints its arguments:

  #/usr/local/bin/kermit +
  echo Hello from \%0
  for \%i 0 \v(argc)-1 1 {
      echo \%i. "\&_[\%i]"
  }
  exit 0

Save this file as (say) "showargs", then give it execute permission and run it (the \&_[] array is the same as \%0..\%9, but allows you to refer to argument variables programmatically; see Section 7.5). (Yes, you could substitute SHOW ARGUMENTS for the loop.)

  $ chmod +x showargs
  $ ./showargs one "this is two" three

The script displays its arguments:

  Hello from /usr/olga/showargs
  0. "/usr/olga/showargs"
  1. "one"
  2. "this is two"
  3. "three"
  $

Notice that no banners or greetings are printed and that startup is instantaneous, just like a shell script. Also notice that grouping of arguments is determined by *shell* quoting rules, not Kermit ones, since the command line is parsed by the shell before Kermit ever sees it.

Of course you can put any commands at all into a Kerbang script. It can read and write files, make connections, transfer files, anything that Kermit can do -- because it *is* Kermit. And of course, Kerbang scripts can also be executed from the Kermit prompt (or from another script) with a TAKE command; the Kerbang line is ignored since it starts with "#", which is a comment introducer to Kermit just as it is to the UNIX shell. In VMS and other non-UNIX platforms, the Kerbang line has no effect and can be omitted.

It might be desireable for a script to know whether it has been invoked directly from the shell (as a Kerbang script) or by a TAKE command given to the Kermit prompt or in a Kermit command file or macro. This can be done as in this example:

  #!/usr/local/bin/kermit +
  assign \%m \fbasename(\%0)
  define usage { exit 1 {usage: \%m phonenumber message} }
  define apage { (definition of APAGE...) } ; (See book pp.454-456)
  xif equal "\%0" "\v(cmdfil)" {
      if not def \%1 usage
      if not def \%2 usage
      apage {\%1} {\%2}
      exit \v(status)
  }

In a Kerbang script, \%0 and \v(cmdfile) are the same; both of them are the name of the script. When a script is invoked by a Kermit TAKE command, \%0 is the name of the Kermit program, but \v(cmdfile) is the name of the script. In the example above, a macro called APAGE is defined. If the script was invoked directly, the APAGE macro is also executed. Otherwise, it is available for subsequent and perhaps repeated use later in the Kermit session.

An especially handy use for Kerbang scripts is to have the initialization file itself be one. Since the standard initialization file is rather long and time-consuming to execute, it is often overkill if you want to start Kermit just to transfer a file. Of course there are command-line switches to suppress initialization-file execution, etc, but another approach is to "run" the initialization file when you want its features (notably the services directory), and run C-Kermit directly when you don't. A setup like this requires that (a) the C-Kermit initialization file is configured as a Kerbang script (has #!/path.../kermit as first line), has execute permission, and is in your PATH; and (b) that you don't have a .kermrc file in your login directory.


7.20. IF and XIF Statement Syntax

The IF command has been improved in two significant ways in C-Kermit 7.0, described in the following subsections. All changes are backwards compatible.

7.20.1. The IF/XIF Distinction

The distinction between IF and XIF is no longer important as of C-Kermit 7.0. You should be able to use IF in all cases (and of course, also XIF for backwards compatibility). In the past, IF was used for single-command THEN parts, followed optionally by a separate ELSE command:

  IF condition command1    ; THEN part
  ELSE command2            ; ELSE part

whereas XIF was required if either part had multiple commands:

  XIF condition { command, command, ... } ELSE { command, command, ... }

The syntactic differences were primarily that IF / ELSE was two commands on two separate lines, whereas XIF was one command on one line, and that XIF allowed (and in fact required) braces around its command lists, whereas IF did not allow them.

Furthermore, the chaining or nesting of parts and conditions was inconsistent. For example, the IF command could be used like this:

  IF condition command
  ELSE IF condition command
  ELSE IF condition command
  ELSE IF condition command
  ...

but XIF could not. C-Kermit 7.0 accepts the old syntax and executes it the same as previous versions, but also accepts a new unified and more convenient syntax:

IF condition command-list [ ELSE command-list ]

or:

IF condition command-list
ELSE command-list

in which the ELSE part is optional, and where command-list can be a single command (with or without braces around it) or a list of commands enclosed in braces. Examples:

Example 1:

  IF condition { command1, command2 } ELSE { command3, command4 }

Example 2 (same as Example 1):

  IF condition {
     command1
     command2
  } ELSE {
     command3
     command4
  }

Example 3 (same as 1 and 2):

  IF condition {
     command1
     command2
  }
  ELSE { command3, command4 }

Example 4 (same as 1-3):

  IF condition {
     command1
     command2
  }
  ELSE {
     command3
     command4
  }

Example 5 (ELSE can be followed by another command):

  IF condition {
     command1
     command2
  } ELSE IF condition {
     command3
     command4
  } ELSE {
     command5
     command6
  }

Example 5 suggests other possibilities:

  IF condition {
     command1
     command2
  } ELSE FOR variable initial final increment {
     command3
     command4
  }

And this too is possible, except for some non-obvious quoting considerations:

  dcl \&a[6] = one two three four five six

  IF < \%n 3 {
      echo \\%n is too small: \%n
  } ELSE FOR \\%i 1 \\%n 1 {
      echo \\%i. \\&a[\\%i]
  }

(The loop variable must be quoted in this context to prevent premature evaluation.)


7.20.2. Boolean Expressions (The IF/WHILE Condition)

Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the IF and WHILE commands accepted only a single Boolean ("true or false") assertion, e.g. "if > \%m 0 command" or "if exist filename command". There was no way to form Boolean expressions and, in particular, nothing that approached a Boolean OR function (AND could be simulated by concatenating IF statements: "if condition1 if condition2..").

C-Kermit 7.0 (and K95 1.1.19) allow grouping of Boolean assertions using parentheses and combining them using AND (or &&) and OR (or ||). Each of these operators -- including the parentheses -- is a field and must be set off by spaces. AND has higher precedence than OR, NOT has higher precedence than AND, but parentheses can be used to force any desired order of evaluation. The old syntax is still accepted.

Here are some examples:

  define \%z 0                          ; Define some variables
  define \%n 1                          ; for use in the examples.

  if > \%n \%z echo \%n is greater.     ; Original format - still accepted.
  if ( > \%n \%z ) echo \%n is greater. ; Parentheses may be used in 7.0.
  if ( > \%n \%z && not = \%z 0 ) ...   ; Two assertions combined with AND.
  if ( > \%n \%z and not = \%z 0 ) ...  ; Same as previous ("and" = "&&").
  if ( > \%n \%z || not = \%z 0 ) ...   ; Two assertions combined with OR.
  if ( > \%n \%z or not = \%z 0 ) ...   ; Same as previous ("or" = "||").
  if ( > \%n \%z || != \%z 0 ) ...      ; Ditto ("!=" = "not =").
  while ( 1 ) { ... }                   ; Just like C.

Notice the spaces around all operators including the parentheses -- these are required. The following examples show how parentheses can be used to alter the precedence of the AND and OR operators:

  if ( false || false && false || true ) ,..         ; True
  if ( false || ( false && false ) || true ) ...     ; Same as previous
  if ( ( false || false ) && ( false || true ) ) ... ; False

Similarly for NOT:

  if ( not true && false ) ...          ; False (NOT binds to TRUE only)
  if ( ( not true ) && false ) ...      ; Same as previous
  if ( not ( true && false ) ) ...      ; True (NOT binds to (TRUE && FALSE))

Notes:

  1. The syntax of the Boolean expression itself has not changed; each expression begins with a keyword or token such as "EXIST", ">", or "=", etc; operators such as "<", "=", and ">" do not go between their operands but precede them as before; this might be called "reverse reverse Polish notation"; it allows deterministic on-the-fly parsing of these expressions at the C-Kermit> prompt as well as in scripts, and allows ?-help to be given for each item when IF or WHILE commands are typed at the prompt.

  2. Parentheses are required when there is more than one Boolean assertion.

  3. Parentheses are not required, but are allowed, when there is only one Boolean assertion.

  4. Evaluation of Boolean assertions occurs left to right, but the resulting Boolean expression is evaluated afterwards according to the rules of precedence. All Boolean assertions are always evaluated; there is no "early stopping" property and therefore no question about when or if side effects will occur -- if any Boolean assertion has side effects, they will always occur.

Constructions of arbitrary complexity are possible, within reason.

Also see Section 7.4 for new IF / WHILE conditions.


7.21. Screen Formatting and Cursor Control

C-Kermit 7.0 adds a simple way to create formatted screens, the SCREEN command:

SCREEN { CLEAR, CLEOL, MOVE-TO row [ column ] }
Performs screen-formatting actions. Correct operation of these commands depends on proper terminal setup on both ends of the connection -- mainly that the host terminal type is set to agree with the kind of terminal or the emulation you are viewing C-Kermit through. The UNIX version uses terminfo or termcap (not curses); the VMS version uses SMG; K-95 uses its built in screen manager.

SCREEN CLEAR
Moves the cursor to home position and clears the entire screen. Synonyms: CLEAR COMMAND-SCREEN ALL (K-95 only), CLS, CLEAR SCREEN.

SCREEN CLEOL
Clears from the current cursor position to the end of the line. Synonym: CLEAR COMMAND-SCREEN EOL (K-95 only)

SCREEN MOVE-TO row column
Moves the cursor to the indicated row and column. The row and column numbers are 1-based, so on a 24x80 screen the home position is 1 1 and the lower right corner is 24 80. If a row or column number is given that too large for what Kermit or the operating system thinks is your screen size, the appropriate number is substituted.

These escape sequences used by these commands depends on the platform. In UNIX, your TERM environment variable is used to query the terminfo/termcap database; if the query fails, ANSI/VT100 sequences are used. In VMS, the SMG library is used, which sends sequences based on your VMS terminal type. K95 does its own screen control. On other platforms (such as AOS/VS, VOS, etc), screen formatting is not supported, and the SCREEN command does nothing.

The three SCREEN actions can be used in scripts to produce menus, formatted screens, dynamic displays, etc. Related variables include:

  \v(terminal)     The type terminal C-Kermit thinks you have.
  \v(rows)         The number of rows C-Kermit thinks your terminal has.
  \v(columns)      The number of columns C-Kermit thinks your terminal has.

And functions:

  \fscrncurx()     The current X coordinate of the cursor (K-95 only).
  \fscrncury()     The current Y coordinate of the cursor (K-95 only).
  \fscrnstr(x,y,n) The string of length nat position (x,y) (K-95 only).

And commands:

  ECHO string      Writes string + CRLF at the current cursor position.
  XECHO string     Writes string at current cursor position; CRLF not supplied.
  GETC v prompt    Issues prompt, reads one character into variable v, no echo.

And special characters:

  Ctrl-L           At the C-Kermit> command prompt, or in a C-Kermit command,
                   works like Return or Enter, but also clears the screen

Example 1: A macro that prints a message \%1 at cursor position (\%2,\%3):

  define MSG {
      if not def \%3 def \%3 0             ; Default column to 0
      if > \v(argc) 2 screen move \%2 \%3  ; Move to given row/col (if any)
      screen cleol                         ; Clear to end of line
      if def \%1 xecho \fcontents(\%1)     ; Print message (if any)
  }

Example 2: A macro put the cursor on the bottom screen line, left margin:

  define BOT {
      screen move \v(rows) 0
  }

Example 3: A macro to center message \%1 on line \%2.

  define CENTER {
      if not def \%2 def \%2 1
      .\%x ::= (\v(cols)-\flen(\%1))/2
      msg {\%1} {\%2} {\%x}
  }

Example 4: A simple menu (building on Examples 1-3):

  def \%c 0                             ; Menu choice variable
  screen clear                          ; Clear the screen
  center {Welcome to This Menu} 2       ; Display the menu
  msg {Choices:} 4
  msg { 1. File} 6
  msg { 2. Edit} 7
  msg { 3. Exit} 8
  while ( != \%c 3 ) {                  ; Read and verify choice
      while true {                      ; Keep trying till we get a good one
	  screen move 10                ; Move to line 10
	  screen cleol                  ; Clear this line
	  getc \%c {Your choice: }      ; Prompt and get and echo 1 character
	  xecho \%c
	  if ( not numeric \%c ) { msg {Not numeric - "\%c"} 12, continue }
	  if ( >= \%c 1 && <= \%c 3 ) break
	  msg {Out of range - "\%c"} 12
      }
      switch \%c {                      ; Valid choice - execute it.
	:1, msg {Filing... } 12, break
	:2, msg {Editing...} 12, break
	:3, msg {Exiting...} 12, break
      }
  }
  echo Bye                              ; Exit chosen - say goodbye.
  bot                                   ; Leave cursor at screen bottom.
  exit                                  ; And exit.

Similar scripts can work over the communication connection; substitute INPUT and OUTPUT for GETC and ECHO/XECHO.


7.22. Evaluating Arithmetic Expressions

A new arithmetic operator was added to the list recognized by the EVALUATE command, the \feval() function, and which can also be used anywhere else arithmetic expressions are accepted (numeric command fields, array subscripts, etc):

Prefix "!"
This operator inverts the "truth value" of the number or arithmetic expression that follows. If the value of the operand is 0, the result is 1. If the value is nonzero, the result is 0.

Examples:

  set eval old
  evaluate 0
  0

  evaluate !0
  1

  evaluate !3
  0

  evaluate !(-3)
  0

  .\%a = 1
  .\%b = 0
  evaluate !(\%a|\%b)
  0

  evaluate !(\%a&\%b)
  1

  evaluate !(!(\%a&\%b))
  0

Note the distinction between Prefix ! (invert truth value) and Suffix ! (factorial). Also the distinction between Prefix ! and Prefix ~ (which inverts all the bits in its operand). Also note that prefix operators (!, -, and ~) can not be adjacent unless you use parentheses to separate them, as shown in the final example above.


7.23. Floating-Point Arithmetic

C-Kermit 7.0 adds limited support for floating-point numbers (numbers that have fractional parts, like 3.141592653). This support is provided through a small repertoire of functions and in Boolean expressions that compare numbers, but does not apply to number parsing in general, or to expression evaluation, array subscripts, the INCREMENT and DECREMENT commands, or in any context other than those listed in this section.

A floating point number has an optional sign (+ or -), followed by a series of decimal digits containing either zero or one period (.) character, which is the decimal point. The use of comma or any other character besides period as a decimal point is not supported. Scientific notation is not supported either. Examples of legal floating-point numbers:

  0                Integers can be used
  1                Ditto
  2.               A decimal point without decimal digits
  3.0              A decimal point with decimal digits
  3.141592653      Ditto
 -4.0              A negative sign can be included
 +5.0              A positive sign can be included

Examples of notations that are not accepted:

  1,000,000        Separators can not be used
  1.000.000        Ditto (or multiple decimal points)
  6.022137E23      No scientific notation
  6.62606868e-34   Ditto
  12.5+6.25        No "bare" expressions

You can use IF FLOAT test a string or variable to see if it's in acceptable floating-point format. Example:

  ask \%f { Type a number: }
  if not def \%f .\%f = 0.0
  if not float \%f stop 1 Invalid floating-point number: "\%f"

C-Kermit's floating-point support, like its support for whole numbers (integers), relies on the capabilities of the underlying computer. Your computer has only a limited amount of precision for numbers, depending on its architecture. Thus floating-point numbers that have too many digits will not be accurate; adding a very small number to a very large one might have no effect at all; and so on. For details, read a text on numerical analysis. Example:

  .\%a = 11111111111111111111  ; A long number
  .\%b = 22222222222222222222  ; Another one
  echo \ffpadd(\%a,\%b)        ; Add them - the result should be all 3's
  33333333333333330000.0       ; See the result

In this example, the computer has 16 digits of precision; after that, the (low-order) digits are set to 0, since the computer doesn't know what they really are. In fact, the computer returns random digits, but Kermit sets all digits beyond the computer's precision to 0.

C-Kermit's floating-point functions have names of the form "\ffpxxx(args)" ("\f" for function, "fp" for floating-point), where "xxx" is replaced by the name of the function, such as "sqrt", and "args" is the argument list, consisting of one or two floating-point numbers (depending on the function), and an optional "d" argument that says now many decimal places should be shown in the result. Example:

  \ffpdiv(10,3,1) returns "3.3"
  \ffpdiv(10,3,2) returns "3.33"
  \ffpdiv(10,3,3) returns "3.333"

and so on, up to the precision of the computer. If the decimal-places argument is less than zero, the fractional part of the result is truncated:

  \ffpdiv(10,3,-1) returns "3".

If the decimal-places argument is 0, or is omitted, C-Kermit returns as many decimal places as are meaningful in the computer's floating-point precision, truncating any extraneous trailing 0's:

  \ffpdiv(10,8) returns "1.25".
  \ffpdiv(10,4) returns "2.5".
  \ffpdiv(10,2) returns "5.0".
  \ffpdiv(10,3) returns "3.333333333333333" (for 16-digit precision).

There is no way to request that a floating-point function return a decimal point but no decimal places. However, this is easy enough to accomplish in other ways, for example by supplying it outside the function call:

  echo \ffpadd(\%a,\%b,-1).

Kermit's floating-point functions always round the result for the requested number of decimal places when the "d" argument is given and has a value greater than 0 (see the description of \ffpround() just below).

Floating-point arguments can be constants in floating-point format or variables whose values are floating-point numbers. If a floating-point argument is omitted, or is a variable with no value, 0.0 is supplied automatically. Example:

  def \%x 999.999
  undef \%y
  echo \ffpmin(\%x,\%y)
  0.0

Or equivalently:

  echo \ffpmin(999.999)
  0.0

The floating-point functions are:

\ffpround(f1,d)
Returns f1 rounded to d decimal places. For this function only, d = 0 (or d omitted) has a special meaning: return the integer part of f1 rounded according to the fractional part. Examples:
  \ffpround(2.74653,-1) returns "2" (fraction truncated, no rounding).
  \ffpround(2.74653,0)  returns "3" (integer part is rounded).
  \ffpround(2.74653)    returns "3" (d omitted same as d = 0).
  \ffpround(2.74653,1)  returns "2.7".
  \ffpround(2.74653,2)  returns "2.75".
  \ffpround(2.74653,3)  returns "2.747".
  \ffpround(2.74653,4)  returns "2.7465", etc.

\ffpadd(f1,f2,d)
Returns the sum of f1 and f2.

\ffpsubtract(f1,f2,d)
Subtracts f2 from f1 and returns the result.

\ffpmultiply(f1,f2,d)
Returns the product of f1 and f2.

\ffpdivide(f1,f2,d)
If f2 is not 0, divides f1 by f2 and returns the quotient.
If f2 is 0, a DIVIDE_BY_ZERO error occurs.

\ffpraise(f1,f2,d)
If f1 = 0 and f2 <= 0, or if f1 < 0 and f2 has a fractional part, an ARG_OUT_OF_RANGE error occurs; otherwise f1 raised to the f2 power is returned.

\ffpsqrt(f1,d)
If f1 >= 0, returns the square root of f1; otherwise ARG_OUT_OF_RANGE.

\ffpabsolute(f1,d)
Returns the absolute value of f1 (i.e. f1 without a sign). This is the floating-point analog of \fabsolute(n1).

\ffpint(f1)
Returns the integer part of f1. Equivalent to \ffpround(f1,-1).

\ffpexp(f1,d)
The base of natural logarithms, e (2.718282...), raised to the f1 power.

\ffplogn(f1,d)
The natural logarithm of f1 (the power to which e must be raised to obtain f1).

\ffplog10(f1,d)
The base-10 logarithm of f1 (the power to which 10 must be raised to obtain f1).

\ffpmodulus(f1,f2,d)
If f2 is not 0, the remainder after dividing f1 by f2.
If f2 is 0, a DIVIDE_BY_ZERO error occurs.
This is the floating-point analog of \fmod(n1,n2).

\ffpmaximum(f1,f2,d)
Returns the maximum of f1 and f2. This is the floating-point analog of \fmax(n1,n2).

\ffpminimum(f1,f2,d)
Returns the minimum of f1 and f2. This is the floating-point analog of \fmin(n1,n2).

\ffpsine(f1,d)
Returns the sine of f1 radians.

\ffpcosine(f1,d)
Returns the cosine of f1 radians.

\ffptangent(f1,d)
Returns the tangent of f1 radians.

Note that all of these functions can be used with integer arguments. If you want an integer result, specify d = -1 (to truncate) or feed the result to \ffpround(xxx,0) (to round).

Floating-point numbers (or variables or functions that return them) can be used in Boolean expressions (see Section 7.20.2) that compare numbers:

  = x y
  != x y
  < x y
  > x y
  <= x y
  >= x y

In these examples, x and y can be either integers or floating-point numbers in any combination. In an arithmetic comparison of an integer and a floating-point number, the integer is converted to floating-point before the comparison is made. Examples:

  .\%t = 3.000000000
  .\%f = 3.141592653
  .\%i = 3

  if > \%f \%i echo Pi is greater.
  if = \%t \%i echo "\%i" = "\%t".

A floating-point number can also be used in:

  IF number command

where the command is executed if the number is nonzero. If the number is floating-point, the command is not executed if the number is 0.0, and is executed otherwise.

Floating-point numbers can be sorted using ARRAY SORT /NUMERIC (see Section 7.10.5 ).

Two floating-point constants are provided:

  \v(math_pi) = Pi (3.141592653...)
  \v(math_e)  = e, the base of natural logarithms (2.71828...)

These are given to the computer's precision, e.g. 16 digits. This number itself is available in a variable:

\v(math_precision)
How many significant digits in a floating-point number.


7.24. Tracing Script Execution

The TRACE command is handy for debugging scripts.

TRACE [ { /ON, /OFF } ] [ { ASSIGNMENTS, COMMAND-LEVEL, ALL } ]
Selects tracing of the given object.

Optional switches are /ON and /OFF. If no switch is given, /ON is implied. The trace objects are ASSIGNMENTS, COMMAND-LEVEL, and ALL. The default object is ALL, meaning to select all trace objects (besides ALL). Thus TRACE by itself selects tracing of everything, as does TRACE /ON, and TRACE /OFF turns off all tracing.

When tracing of ASSIGNMENTS is on, every time the value of any user-defined variable or macro changes, C-Kermit prints one of the following:

>>> name: "value"
The name of the variable or macro followed by the new value in quotes. This includes implicit macro-parameter assignments during macro invocation.

>>> name: (undef)
This indicates that the variable or macro has been undefined.

<<< name: "value"
For RETURN statements: the name of the macro and the return value.

<<< name: (null)
For RETURN statements that include no value or an empty value.

When tracing of COMMAND-LEVEL is on, C-Kermit prints:

[n] +F: "name"
Whenever a command file is entered, where "n" is the command level (0 = top); the name of the command file is shown in quotes.

[n] +M: "name"
Whenever a macro is entered; "n" is the command level. The name of the macro is shown in quotes.

[n] -F: "name"
Whenever a command file is reentered from below, when a macro or command file that it has invoked has returned.

[n] -M: "name"
Whenever a macro is reentered from below.

For other debugging tools, see SHOW ARGS, SHOW STACK, SET TAKE, SET MACRO, and of course, ECHO.


7.25. Compact Substring Notation

It is often desirable to extract a substring from a string which is stored in a variable, and for this we have the \fsubstring() function, which is used like this:

  define \%a 1234567890
  echo \fsubstring(\%a,3,4) ; substring from 3rd character length 4
  3456

or like this with macro-named variables:

  define string 1234567890
  echo \fsubstring(\m(string),3,4)
  3456

C-Kermit 7.0 adds a pair of alternative compact notations:

\:(variablename[start:length])  <-- Substring of variable's value
\s(macroname[start:length])     <-- Substring of macro's definition

These are exactly equivalent to using \fsubstring(), except more compact to write and also faster since evaluation is in one step instead of two.

The "\:()" notation can be used with any Kermit variable, that is, almost anything that starts with a backslash:

  \:(\%a[2:6])      <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(\%a,2,6)
  \:(\&x[1][2:6])   <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(\&x[1],2,6)
  \:(\m(foo)[2:6])  <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(\m(foo),2,6)
  \:(\v(time)[2:6]) <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(\v(time),2,6)
  \:(\$(TERM)[2:6]) <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(\$(TERM),2,6)
  \:(ABCDEFGH[2:6]) <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(ABCDEFGH,2,6)

Whatever appears between the left parenthesis and the left bracket is evaluated and then the indicated substring of the result is returned.

The "\s()" notation is the same, except after evaluating the variable, the result is treated as a macro name and is looked up in the macro table. Then the indicated substring of the macro definition is returned. Example:

  define testing abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
  define \%a testing

  \s(testing[2:6])  -->  bcdefg
  \:(testing[2:6])  -->  esting
  \:(\%a[2:6])      -->  esting
  \s(\%a[2:6])      -->  bcdefg

Note that the following two examples are equivalent:

  \:(\m(foo)[2:6])
  \s(foo[2:6])

The first number in the brackets is the 1-based starting position. If it is omitted, or less than 1, it is treated as 1. If it is greater than the length of the string, an empty string is returned.

The second number is the length of the desired substring. If the second number is omitted, is less than 0, or would be past the end of the string, then "through the end of the string" is assumed. If it is 0, the empty string is returned.

If the brackets are empty or omitted, the original string is returned.

The starting position and length need not be literal numbers; they can also be variables, functions, arithmetic expressions, or even other \s() or \:() quantities; anything that evaluates to a number, for example:

  \s(block[1025:\fhex2n(\s(block[\%b:\%n+4]))/2])

Syntactically, \m(name) and \s(name) differ only in that the sequence [*] at the end of the name (where * is any sequence of 0 or more characters) is treated as substring notation in \s(name), but is considered part of the name in \m(name) (to see why, see Section 7.10.9).


7.26. New WAIT Command Options

The WAIT command has been extended to allow waiting for different kinds of things (formerly it only waited for modem signals). Now it also can wait for file events.

7.26.1. Waiting for Modem Signals

The previous syntax:

  WAIT time { CD, DSR, RTS, RI, ... }

has changed to:

  WAIT time MODEM-SIGNALS { CD, DSR, RTS, RI, ... }

However, the previous syntax is still accepted. The behavior is the same in either case.


7.26.2. Waiting for File Events

The new WAIT option:

  WAIT time FILE { CREATION, DELETION, MODIFICATION } filename

lets you tell Kermit to wait the given amount of time (or until the given time of day) for a file whose name is filename to be created, deleted, or modified, respectively. The filename may not contain wildcards. If the specified event does not occur within the time limit, or if WAIT CANCELLATION is ON and you interrupt from the keyboard before the time is up, the WAIT command fails. If the event is MODIFICATION and the file does not exist, the command fails. Otherwise, if the given event occurs within the time limit, the command succeeds. Examples:

WAIT 600 FILE DELETION oofa.tmp
Wait up to 10 minutes for file oofa.tmp to disappear.

WAIT 23:59:59 FILE MOD orders.db
Wait until just before midnight for the orders.db file to be changed.

Example: Suppose you want to have the current copy of /etc/motd on your screen at all times, and you want to hear a bell whenever it changes:

  def \%f /etc/motd                      ; The file of interest.
  while 1 {                              ; Loop forever...
      cls                                ; Clear the screen.
      echo \%f: \v(date) \v(time)...     ; Print 2-line heading...
      echo
      if ( not exist \%f ) {             ; If file doesn't exist,
          echo \%f does not exist...     ; print message,
          wait 600 file creat \%f        ; and wait for it to appear.
          continue
      }
      beep                               ; Something new - beep.
      type /head:\v(rows-2) \%f          ; Display the file
      if fail exit 1 \%f: \ferrstring()  ; (checking for errors).
      wait 999 file mod \%f              ; Wait for it to change.
  }

This notices when the file is created, deleted, or modified, and acts only then (or when you interrupt it with); the time shown in the heading is the time of the most recent event (including when the program started).

See Section 1.10, where the \v(kbchar) variable is explained. This lets you modify a loop like the one above to also accept single-character commands, which interrupt the WAIT, and dispatch accordingly. For example:

  wait 999 file mod \%f              ; Wait for the file to change.
  if defined \v(kbchar) {            ; Interrupted from keyboard?
      switch \v(kbchar) {            ; Handle the keystroke...
	:q, exit                     ; Q to Quit
	:h, echo blah blah, break    ; H for Help
	:default, beep, continue     ; Anything else beep and ignore
      }
  }

This lets you write event-driven applications that wait for up to three events at once: a file or modem event, a timeout, and a keystroke.


7.27. Relaxed FOR and SWITCH Syntax

For consistency with the extended IF and WHILE syntax, the FOR and SWITCH control lists may (but need not be) enclosed in parentheses:

  FOR ( \%i 1 \%n 1 ) { command-list... }
  SWITCH ( \%c ) { command-list... }

In the FOR command, the increment item can be omitted if the control list is enclosed in parentheses, in which case the increment defaults appropriately to 1 or -1, depending on the values of the first two variables.

As with IF, the parentheses around the FOR-command control list must be set off by spaces (in the SWITCH command, the spaces are not required since the SWITCH expression is a single arithmetic expression).

Also, outer braces around the command list are supplied automatically if you omit them, e.g.:

  FOR ( \%i 1 %n 1 ) echo \%i


8. USING OTHER FILE TRANSFER PROTOCOLS

In C-Kermit 7.0, alternative protocols can be selected using switches. Switches are described in Section 1.5; the use of protocol-selection switches is described in Section 4.7.1. Example:

  send /binary /protocol:zmodem x.tar.gz

Note that file transfer recovery works only with Kermit and Zmodem protocols. With Zmodem, recovery can be initiated only by the sender.

Only pre-1988 versions of the publicly-distributed sz/rz programs use Standard I/O; those released later than that do not use Standard I/O and therefore do not work with REDIRECT. However, Omen Technology does offer an up-to-date redirectable version called crzsz, which must be licensed for use:

"Unix Crz and Csz support XMODEM, YMODEM, and ZMODEM transfers when called by dial-out programs such as Kermit and certain versions of cu(1). They are clients designed for this use.

"Crz and Csz are Copyrighted shareware programs. Use of these programs beyond a brief evaluation period requires registration. Please print the "mailer.rz" file, fill out the form and return same with your registration."

To use the crzsz programs as your external XYZMODEM programs in C-Kermit, follow the instructions in the book, but put a "c" before each command, e.g.:

  set protocol zmodem {csz %s} {csz -a %s} crz crz crz crz

To use Zmodem protocol over Telnet or other non-transparent connections, you might need to add the -e (Escape) option:

  set protocol zmodem {csz -e %s} {csz -e -a %s} crz crz crz crz


9. COMMAND-LINE OPTIONS

9.0. Extended-Format Command-Line Options

Standard UNIX command line options are a single letter. C-Kermit has run out of letters, so new options are in a new extended format:

 --word[:arg]

where a keyword (rather than a single letter) specifies the function, and if an argument is to be included, it is separated by a colon (or equal sign). Most of the new extended-format command-line options are only for use with the Internet Kermit Service Daemon; see the IKSD Administration Guide for details. However, several of them are also general in nature:

--nointerrupts
Disables keyboard interrupts that are normally enabled, which are usually Ctrl-C (to interrupt a command) and Ctrl-Z (UNIX only, to suspend C-Kermit).

--help
Lists the extended command-line options that are available in your version of C-Kermit. If any options seem to be missing, that is because your copy of C-Kermit was built with compile-time options to deselect them.

--helpfile:filename
Specifies the name of a file to be displayed if the user types HELP (not followed by a specific command or topic), in place of the built-in top-level help text. The file need not fit on one screen; more-prompting is used if the file is more than one screen long if COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING is ON, as it is by default.

--bannerfile:filename
The name of a file containing a message to be printed after the user logs in, in place of the normal message (Copyright notice, "Type HELP or ? for help", "Default transfer mode is...", etc).

--cdmessage:{on,off,0,1,2}
For use in the Server-Side Server configuration; whenever the client tells the server to change directory, the server sends the contents of a "read me" file to the client's screen. This feature is On by default, and operates only in client/server mode when ON or 1. If set to 2 or higher, it also operates when the CD command is given at the IKSD> prompt. Synonym: --cdmsg.

--cdfile:filename
When cdmessage is on, this is the name of the "read me" file to be sent. Normally you would specify a relative (not absolute) name, since the file is opened using the literal name you specified, after changing to the new directory. Example:

  --cdfile:READ.ME

You can also give a list of up to 8 filenames by (a) enclosing each filename in braces, and (b) enclosing the entire list in braces. Example: --cdfile:{{./.readme}{READ.ME}{aaareadme.txt}{README}{read-this-first}} When a list is given, it is searched from left to right and the first file found is displayed. The default list for UNIX is:

  {{./.readme}{README.TXT}{READ.ME}}


9.1. Command Line Personalities

Beginning in version 7.0, if the C-Kermit binary is renamed to "telnet" (or TELNET.EXE, telnet.pr, etc, depending on the platform), it accepts the Telnet command line:

  telnet [ host [ port ] ]

In Unix, you can achieve the same effect with a symlink:

  cd /usr/bin
  mv telnet oldtelnet
  ln -ls /usr/local/bin/kermit telnet

When installed in this manner, C-Kermit always reads its initialization file. If no host (and therefore no port) is given, C-Kermit starts in interactive prompting mode. If a host is given as the first command-line argument, C-Kermit makes a connection to it. The host argument can be an IP host name or address, or the name of a TCP/IP entry in your C-Kermit network directory.

If a port is given, it is used. If a port is not given, then if the hostname was found in your network directory and port was also listed there, then that port is used. Otherwise port 23 (the Telnet port) is used.

When C-Kermit is called "telnet" and it is invoked with a hostname on the command line, it exits automatically when the connection is closed. While the connection is open, however, you may escape back and forth as many times as you like, transfer files, etc.

An rlogin personality is also available, but it is less useful, at least in UNIX and VMS, where the Rlogin TCP port is privileged.

The new variable \v(name) indicates the name with which C-Kermit was invoked ("kermit", "wermit", "k95", "telnet", etc).


9.2. Built-in Help for Command Line Options

"kermit -h", given from the system prompt, lists as many command-line options as will fit on a standard 24x80 screen. For more comprehensive help, use the interactive HELP OPTIONS command that was added in C-Kermit 7.0:

HELP OPTIONS
Explains how command-line options work, their syntax, etc.

HELP OPTIONS ALL
Lists all command-line options and gives brief help about each one.

HELP OPTION x
Gives brief help about option "x".

HELP EXTENDED-OPTIONS
Lists the available extended-format command-line options.

HELP EXTENDED-OPTION xxx
Gives help for the specified extended option.


9.3. New Command-Line Options

Command-line options added since C-Kermit 6.0 are:

+
(plus sign by itself): The next argument is the name of a script to execute; all subsequent arguments are ignored by C-Kermit itself, but passed to the script as top-level copies of \%1, \%2, etc; the \&_[] is also set accordingly. \%0 and \&_[0] become the name of the script file, rather than the pathname of the C-Kermit program, which is its normal value. Primarily for use in the top line of "Kerbang" scripts in UNIX (see Section 7.19). Example from UNIX command line:

  $ kermit [ regular kermit args ] + filename

Sample first line of Kerbang script:

  #!/usr/local/bin/kermit +

--
(two hyphens surrounded by whitespace) Equivalent to "=", for compatibility with UNIX getopt(1,3).

-G
GET (like -g), but send the incoming file to standard output. Example: "kermit -G oofa.txt | lpr" retrieves a file from your local computer (providing it is running a Kermit program that supports the autodownload feature and has it enabled) and prints it.

-O
equivalent to -x (start up in server mode), but exits after the first client command has been executed (mnemonic: O = Only One). This one is handy replacing "kermit -x" in the "automatically start Kermit on the other end" string:

  set protocol kermit {kermit -ir} {kermit -r} {kermit -x}

since -x leaves the remote Kermit in server mode after the transfer, which can be confusing, whereas -O makes it go away automatically after the transfer.

-L
Recursive, when used in combination with -s (mnemonic: L = Levels). In UNIX or other environments where the shell expands wildcards itself, the -s argument, if it contains wildcards, must be quoted to prevent this, e.g.:

  kermit -L -s "*.c"

In UNIX only, "kermit -L -s ." means to send the current directory tree. See Sections 4.10 and 4.11 about recursive file transfer.

-V
Equivalent to SET FILE PATTERNS OFF (Section 4.3) and SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL. In other words, take the FILE TYPE setting literally. For example, "kermit -VT oofa.bin" means send the file in Text mode, no matter what its name is and no matter whether a kindred spirit is recognized at the other end of the connection.

-0
(digit zero) means "be 100% transparent in CONNECT mode". This is equivalent to the following series of commands: SET PARITY NONE, SET COMMAND BYTESIZE 8, SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE 8, SET FLOW NONE, SET TERM ESCAPE DISABLED, SET TERM CHAR TRANSPARENT, SET TERM AUTODOWNLOAD OFF, SET TERM APC OFF, SET TELOPT KERMIT REFUSE REFUSE.


10. C-KERMIT AND G-KERMIT

Every multifunctioned and long-lived software program grows in complexity and size over time to meet the needs and requests of its users and the demands of the underlying technology as it changes.

Eventually users begin to notice how big the application has grown, how much disk space it occupies, how long it takes to load, and they start to long for the good old days when it was lean and mean. Not long after that they begin asking for a "light" version that only does the basics with no frills.

And so it is with C-Kermit. A "light" version of Kermit was released (for UNIX only) in December 1999 under the GNU General Public License; thus it is called G-Kermit (for GNU Kermit). All it does is send and receive files, period. You can find it at:

  http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/gkermit.html

Where the C-Kermit 7.0 binary might be anywhere from 1 to 3 million bytes in size, the G-Kermit binary ranges from 30K to 100K, depending on the underlying architecture (RISC vs CISC, etc).

G-Kermit and C-Kermit may reside side-by-side on the same computer. G-Kermit does not make connections; it does not have a script language; it does not translate character sets. G-Kermit may be used instead of C-Kermit when:

In such cases G-Kermit might be preferred since it generally starts up faster, and yet transfers files just as fast on most (but not necessarily all) kinds of connections; for example, it supports streaming (Section 4.20).

G-Kermit is also handy for bootstrapping. It is easier to load on a new computer than C-Kermit -- it fits on a floppy diskette with plenty of room to spare. Thus if you have (say) an old PC running (say) SCO Xenix and no network connection, you can download the Xenix version of G-Kermit to (say) a DOS or Windows PC, copy it to diskette, read the diskette on Xenix with "dosread", and then use G-Kermit to receive C-Kermit (which does not fit on a diskette). If diskettes aren't an option, other bootstrapping methods are possible too -- see the G-Kermit web page for details.


III. APPENDICES

III.1. Character Set Tables

III.1.1. The Hewlett Packard Roman8 Character Set

dec col/row oct hex  description
160  10/00  240  A0  (Undefined)
161  10/01  241  A1  A grave
162  10/02  242  A2  A circumflex
163  10/03  243  A3  E grave
164  10/04  244  A4  E circumflex
165  10/05  245  A5  E diaeresis
166  10/06  246  A6  I circumflex
167  10/07  247  A7  I diaeresis
168  10/08  250  A8  Acute accent
169  10/09  251  A9  Grave accent
170  10/10  252  AA  Circumflex accent
171  10/11  253  AB  Diaeresis
172  10/12  254  AC  Tilde accent
173  10/13  255  AD  U grave
174  10/14  256  AE  U circumflex
175  10/15  257  AF  Lira symbol
176  11/00  260  B0  Top bar (macron)
177  11/01  261  B1  Y acute
178  11/02  262  B2  y acute
179  11/03  263  B3  Degree Sign
180  11/04  264  B4  C cedilla
181  11/05  265  B5  c cedilla
182  11/06  266  B6  N tilde
183  11/07  267  B7  n tilde
184  11/08  270  B8  Inverted exclamation mark
185  11/09  271  B9  Inverted question mark
186  11/10  272  BA  Currency symbol
187  11/11  273  BB  Pound sterling symbol
188  11/12  274  BC  Yen symbol
189  11/13  275  BD  Paragraph
190  11/14  276  BE  Florin (Guilder) symbol
191  11/15  277  BF  Cent symbol
192  12/00  300  C0  a circumflex
193  12/01  301  C1  e circumflex
194  12/02  302  C2  o circumflex
195  12/03  303  C3  u circumflex
196  12/04  304  C4  a acute
197  12/05  305  C5  e acute
198  12/06  306  C6  o acute
199  12/07  307  C7  u acute
200  12/08  310  C8  a grave
201  12/09  311  C9  e grave
202  12/10  312  CA  o grave
203  12/11  313  CB  u grave
204  12/12  314  CC  a diaeresis
205  12/13  315  CD  e diaeresis
206  12/14  316  CE  o diaeresis
207  12/15  317  CF  u diaeresis
208  13/00  320  D0  A ring
209  13/01  321  D1  i circumflex
210  13/02  322  D2  O with stroke
211  13/03  323  D3  AE digraph
212  13/04  324  D4  a ring
213  13/05  325  D5  i acute
214  13/06  326  D6  o with stroke
215  13/07  327  D7  ae digraph
216  13/08  330  D8  A diaeresis
217  13/09  331  D9  i grave
218  13/10  332  DA  O diaeresis
219  13/11  333  DB  U diaeresis
220  13/12  334  DC  E acute
221  13/13  335  DD  i diaeresis
222  13/14  336  DE  German sharp s
223  13/15  337  DF  O circumflex
224  14/00  340  E0  A acute
225  14/01  341  E1  A tilde
226  14/02  342  E2  a tilde
227  14/03  343  E3  Icelandic Eth
228  14/04  344  E4  Icelandic eth
229  14/05  345  E5  I acute
230  14/06  346  E6  I grave
231  14/07  347  E7  O acute
232  14/08  350  E8  O grave
233  14/09  351  E9  O tilde
234  14/10  352  EA  o tilde
235  14/11  353  EB  S caron
236  14/12  354  EC  s caron
237  14/13  355  ED  U acute
238  14/14  356  EE  Y diaeresis
239  14/15  357  EF  y diaeresis
240  15/00  360  F0  Icelandic Thorn
241  15/01  361  F1  Icelandic thorn
242  15/02  362  F2  Middle dot
243  15/03  363  F3  Greek mu
244  15/04  364  F4  Pilcrow sign
245  15/05  365  F5  Fraction 3/4
246  15/06  366  F6  Long dash, horizontal bar
247  15/07  367  F7  Fraction 1/4
248  15/08  370  F8  Fraction 1/2
249  15/09  371  F9  Feminine ordinal
250  15/10  372  FA  Masculine ordinal
251  15/11  373  FB  Left guillemot
252  15/12  374  FC  Solid box
253  15/13  375  FD  Right guillemot
254  15/14  376  FE  Plus or minus sign
255  15/15  377  FF  (Undefined)


III.1.2. Greek Character Sets

III.1.2.1. The ISO 8859-7 Latin / Greek Alphabet = ELOT 928

dec col/row oct hex  description
160  10/00  240  A0  No-break space
161  10/01  241  A1  Left single quotation mark
162  10/02  242  A2  right single quotation mark
163  10/03  243  A3  Pound sign
164  10/04  244  A4  (UNUSED)
165  10/05  245  A5  (UNUSED)
166  10/06  246  A6  Broken bar
167  10/07  247  A7  Paragraph sign
168  10/08  250  A8  Diaeresis (Dialytika)
169  10/09  251  A9  Copyright sign
170  10/10  252  AA  (UNUSED)
171  10/11  253  AB  Left angle quotation
172  10/12  254  AC  Not sign
173  10/13  255  AD  Soft hyphen
174  10/14  256  AE  (UNUSED)
175  10/15  257  AF  Horizontal bar (Parenthetiki pavla)
176  11/00  260  B0  Degree sign
177  11/01  261  B1  Plus-minus sign
178  11/02  262  B2  Superscript two
179  11/03  263  B3  Superscript three
180  11/04  264  B4  Accent (tonos)
181  11/05  265  B5  Diaeresis and accent (Dialytika and Tonos)
182  11/06  266  B6  Alpha with accent
183  11/07  267  B7  Middle dot (Ano Teleia)
184  11/08  270  B8  Epsilon with accent
185  11/09  271  B9  Eta with accent
186  11/10  272  BA  Iota with accent
187  11/11  273  BB  Right angle quotation
188  11/12  274  BC  Omicron with accent
189  11/13  275  BD  One half
190  11/14  276  BE  Upsilon with accent
191  11/15  277  BF  Omega with accent
192  12/00  300  C0  iota with diaeresis and accent
193  12/01  301  C1  Alpha
194  12/02  302  C2  Beta
195  12/03  303  C3  Gamma
196  12/04  304  C4  Delta
197  12/05  305  C5  Epsilon
198  12/06  306  C6  Zeta
199  12/07  307  C7  Eta
200  12/08  310  C8  Theta
201  12/09  311  C9  Iota
202  12/10  312  CA  Kappa
203  12/11  313  CB  Lamda
204  12/12  314  CC  Mu
205  12/13  315  CD  Nu
206  12/14  316  CE  Ksi
207  12/15  317  CF  Omicron
208  13/00  320  D0  Pi
209  13/01  321  D1  Rho
210  13/02  322  D2  (UNUSED)
211  13/03  323  D3  Sigma
212  13/04  324  D4  Tau
213  13/05  325  D5  Upsilon
214  13/06  326  D6  Phi
215  13/07  327  D7  Khi
216  13/08  330  D8  Psi
217  13/09  331  D9  Omega
218  13/10  332  DA  Iota with diaeresis
219  13/11  333  DB  Upsilon with diaeresis
220  13/12  334  DC  alpha with accent
221  13/13  335  DD  epsilon with accent
222  13/14  336  DE  eta with accent
223  13/15  337  DF  iota with accent
224  14/00  340  E0  upsilon with diaeresis and accent
225  14/01  341  E1  alpha
226  14/02  342  E2  beta
227  14/03  343  E3  gamma
228  14/04  344  E4  delta
229  14/05  345  E5  epsilon
230  14/06  346  E6  zeta
231  14/07  347  E7  eta
232  14/08  350  E8  theta
233  14/09  351  E9  iota
234  14/10  352  EA  kappa
235  14/11  353  EB  lamda
236  14/12  354  EC  mu
237  14/13  355  ED  nu
238  14/14  356  EE  ksi
239  14/15  357  EF  omicron
240  15/00  360  F0  pi
241  15/01  361  F1  rho
242  15/02  362  F2  terminal sigma
243  15/03  363  F3  sigma
244  15/04  364  F4  tau
245  15/05  365  F5  upsilon
246  15/06  366  F6  phi
247  15/07  367  F7  khi
248  15/08  370  F8  psi
249  15/09  371  F9  omega
250  15/10  372  FA  iota with diaeresis
251  15/11  373  FB  upsilon with diaeresis
252  15/12  374  FC  omicron with diaeresis
253  15/13  375  FD  upsilon with accent
254  15/14  376  FE  omega with accent
255  15/15  377  FF  (UNUSED)


III.1.2.2. The ELOT 927 Character Set

dec col/row oct hex  description
 32  02/00   40  20  SPACE
 33  02/01   41  21  EXCLAMATION MARK
 34  02/02   42  22  QUOTATION MARK
 35  02/03   43  23  NUMBER SIGN
 36  02/04   44  24  DOLLAR SIGN
 37  02/05   45  25  PERCENT SIGN
 38  02/06   46  26  AMPERSAND
 39  02/07   47  27  APOSTROPHE
 40  02/08   50  28  LEFT PARENTHESIS
 41  02/09   51  29  RIGHT PARENTHESIS
 42  02/10   52  2A  ASTERISK
 43  02/11   53  2B  PLUS SIGN
 44  02/12   54  2C  COMMA
 45  02/13   55  2D  HYPHEN, MINUS SIGN
 46  02/14   56  2E  PERIOD, FULL STOP
 47  02/15   57  2F  SOLIDUS, SLASH
 48  03/00   60  30  DIGIT ZERO
 49  03/01   61  31  DIGIT ONE
 50  03/02   62  32  DIGIT TWO
 51  03/03   63  33  DIGIT THREE
 52  03/04   64  34  DIGIT FOUR
 53  03/05   65  35  DIGIT FIVE
 54  03/06   66  36  DIGIT SIX
 55  03/07   67  37  DIGIT SEVEN
 56  03/08   70  38  DIGIT EIGHT
 57  03/09   71  39  DIGIT NINE
 58  03/10   72  3A  COLON
 59  03/11   73  3B  SEMICOLON
 60  03/12   74  3C  LESS-THAN SIGN, LEFT ANGLE BRACKET
 61  03/13   75  3D  EQUALS SIGN
 62  03/14   76  3E  GREATER-THAN SIGN, RIGHT ANGLE BRACKET
 63  03/15   77  3F  QUESTION MARK
 64  04/00  100  40  COMMERCIAL AT SIGN
 65  04/01  101  41  CAPITAL LETTER A
 66  04/02  102  42  CAPITAL LETTER B
 67  04/03  103  43  CAPITAL LETTER C
 68  04/04  104  44  CAPITAL LETTER D
 69  04/05  105  45  CAPITAL LETTER E
 70  04/06  106  46  CAPITAL LETTER F
 71  04/07  107  47  CAPITAL LETTER G
 72  04/08  110  48  CAPITAL LETTER H
 73  04/09  111  49  CAPITAL LETTER I
 74  04/10  112  4A  CAPITAL LETTER J
 75  04/11  113  4B  CAPITAL LETTER K
 76  04/12  114  4C  CAPITAL LETTER L
 77  04/13  115  4D  CAPITAL LETTER M
 78  04/14  116  4E  CAPITAL LETTER N
 79  04/15  117  4F  CAPITAL LETTER O
 80  05/00  120  50  CAPITAL LETTER P
 81  05/01  121  51  CAPITAL LETTER Q
 82  05/02  122  52  CAPITAL LETTER R
 83  05/03  123  53  CAPITAL LETTER S
 84  05/04  124  54  CAPITAL LETTER T
 85  05/05  125  55  CAPITAL LETTER U
 86  05/06  126  56  CAPITAL LETTER V
 87  05/07  127  57  CAPITAL LETTER W
 88  05/08  130  58  CAPITAL LETTER X
 89  05/09  131  59  CAPITAL LETTER Y
 90  05/10  132  5A  CAPITAL LETTER Z
 91  05/11  133  5B  LEFT SQUARE BRACKET
 92  05/12  134  5C  REVERSE SOLIDUS, BACKSLASH
 93  05/13  135  5D  RIGHT SQUARE BRACKET
 94  05/14  136  5E  CIRCUMFLEX ACCENT
 95  05/15  137  5F  UNDERSCORE
 96  06/00  140  60  ACCENT GRAVE
 97  06/01  141  61  GREEK LETTER ALPHA
 98  06/02  142  62  GREEK LETTER BETA
 99  06/03  143  63  GREEK LETTER GAMMA
100  06/04  144  64  GREEK LETTER DELTA
101  06/05  145  65  GREEK LETTER EPSILON
102  06/06  146  66  GREEK LETTER ZETA
103  06/07  147  67  GREEK LETTER ETA
104  06/08  150  68  GREEK LETTER THETA
105  06/09  151  69  GREEK LETTER IOTA
106  06/10  152  6A  GREEK LETTER KAPPA
107  06/11  153  6B  GREEK LETTER LAMDA
108  06/12  154  6C  GREEK LETTER MU
109  06/13  155  6D  GREEK LETTER NU
110  06/14  156  6E  GREEK LETTER KSI
111  06/15  157  6F  GREEK LETTER OMICRON
112  07/00  160  70  GREEK LETTER PI
113  07/01  161  71  GREEK LETTER RHO
114  07/02  162  72  GREEK LETTER SIGMA
115  07/03  163  73  GREEK LETTER TAU
116  07/04  164  74  GREEK LETTER UPSILON
117  07/05  165  75  GREEK LETTER FI
118  07/06  166  76  GREEK LETTER XI
119  07/07  167  77  GREEK LETTER PSI
120  07/08  170  78  GREEK LETTER OMEGA
121  07/09  171  79  SPACE
122  07/10  172  7A  SPACE
123  07/11  173  7B  LEFT CURLY BRACKET, LEFT BRACE
124  07/12  174  7C  VERTICAL LINE, VERTICAL BAR
125  07/13  175  7D  RIGHT CURLY BRACKET, RIGHT BRACE
126  07/14  176  7E  TILDE
127  07/15  177  7F  RUBOUT, DELETE


III.1.2.3. PC Code Page 869

(to be filled in...)


III.2. Updated Country Codes

Date: Mon, 7 Apr 1997 23:23:49 EDT
From: Dave Leibold <dleibold@else.net>
Newsgroups: comp.dcom.telecom
Subject: Ex-USSR Country Codes Profile
Organization: TELECOM Digest

Ex-USSR Country Codes Profile
4 April 1997

Below is a summary of the country codes that have formed in the wake of the USSR dissolution, along with some updated findings and reports. Additional or corrected information on any of these nations would be welcome (c/o dleibold@else.net).

In the table, "Effective" means the date at which the country code began service (which could vary according to the nation). "Mandatory" means the date at which the country code 7 is invalid for calls to that nation. There are a number of question marks since exact dates have not been collected in all cases.

CC  Nation            Effective     Mandatory    Notes

370 Lithuania 1993? ??? Announced Jan 1993 371 Latvia 1993? ??? 372 Estonia 1 Feb 1993? March 1993? 373 Moldova 1993? ??? Announced Jan 1993 374 Armenia 1 May 1995 1 July 1995 Announced Jan 1995 (ITU) 375 Belarus 16 Apr 1995 1997? 380 Ukraine 16 Apr 1995 Oct 1995? 7 Kazakstan (no known changes) 7 Russia (presumably not changing) 992 Tajikistan ??? ??? Announced 1996-7? 993 Turkmenistan 3 Jan 1997 3 Apr 1997 Canada as of 29 Nov 1996 994 Azerbaijan Sept 1994? ??? Announced 1992 995 Georgia 1994? ??? ref: Telecom Digest Oct 1994 996 Kyrgyz Republic 1 May 1997 ??? ref: Stentor Canada/CRTC 998 Uzbekistan ??? ??? Announced 1996? (ITU)

Details courtesy Toby Nixon, ITU, Stentor (Canada), CRTC (Canada), TELECOM Digest (including information collected for the country code listings).


IV. ERRATA & CORRIGENDA

The following errors in Using C-Kermit, Second Edition, first printing, have been noted.

First, some missing acknowledgements for C-Kermit 6.0: JE Jones of Microware for help with OS-9, Nigel Roles for his help with Plan 9, Lucas Hart for help with VMS and Digital UNIX, Igor Kovalenko for his help with QNX. And later, to Susan Kleinmann for her help with Debian Linux packaging; Patrick Volkerding for his help with Slackware Linux packaging; Jim Knoble for his help with Red Hat Linux packaging; and to dozens of others for sending individual C-Kermit binaries for varied and diverse platforms.

Thanks to James Spath for both binaries and reporting many of the typos noted below. Also to Dat Thuc Nguyen for spotting several typos.

PAGE    REMARKS
COVER   "COS" is a misprint.  There is no COS.  Pretend it says "SCO" or "VOS".
        (This is fixed in the second printing.)
 xxi    Second line: Fred Smith's affiliation should be Computrition.
 83     Change "commands other" to "commands as other" (1st paragraph)
 87     Change "The the" to "The" (2nd paragraph)
 92     "set modem-type user-defined supra" should be "set modem type ..."
 95     Change "VI" to "vi" (1st paragraph)
 96     Change "it it" to "it is" (1st paragraph)
 97     Change "advantage a literal" to "advantage of a literal" (2nd
        paragraph)
102     The call-waiting example would be better as SET DIAL PREFIX *70W
        (rather than "*70,") because the former will not cause an incorrect
        call to be placed with pulse dialing.
123     Third paragraph from bottom: "..otherwise if a your local username.."
        should be "..otherwise your local username..".
160     Delete the "it" between "and" and "to" (2nd paragraph)
185     In "When TRANSFER DISPLAY is OFF, C-Kermit skips the display...",
        "OFF" should be "NONE".
187     The last paragraph says the "A command" is ignored, should be "S".
194     Change "it known" to "it is known" (4th paragraph).
235     In C-Kermit 7.0, the syntax of the GET command changed.  MGET now
        must be used to get a list of files and there is no more multiline
        GET command.
268     Last paragraph: "effect" should be "affect".
275     In the SET PROTOCOL KERMIT description, the following sentence is
        incorrect and should be removed: 'If you omit the commands, the
        default ones are restored: "kermit -ir" and "kermit -r" respectively".
        The correct information is given at the bottom of page 281.
279     9th line.  The decimal value of ST is 156, not 155.
295     In the stepping stones, skip ahead to Chapter 17 on p. 327.
298     Table 16-2, Portuguese entry.  Column 4/00 should show section sign,
        not acute accent.
316     Other languages written in the Hebrew alphabet include Karaim (a Turkic
        language spoken in Lithuania and Poland), Judeo-Kurdish, and Judeo-
        Georgian.
332     UNDEFINE definition, change "This just" to "This is just".
344     It might be necessary to set the modem's pulse generation rate when
        sending numeric pages; most Hayes compatible modems use the S11
        register for this.
350     Delete "is" from between "It" and "ceases" (4th paragraph)
351     Top - both occurrences of "print \%a" should be "echo \%a".
364     \v(input) and \v(query) out of alphabetical order.
378     In the MYSEND macro, "if not \m(rc) goto bad" should be:
        "if \m(rc) goto bad" (remove the "not").
382-383 It should be stated that the loop control variable must be of the \%a
        type, or else an array element; macro names can not be used for this.
383     In line 3, "\%f[\%i]" should be "\&f[\%i]".
383     In the sort example, it should be stated that the array is 1-based.
387     Change "You can list" to "You can get a list" (5th paragraph)
393     \Fverify() description.  The 3rd sentence could be stated more clearly
        as "If all characters in string2 are also in string1, 0 is returned."
398     Copying \ffiles() results to an array before is not required as of
        C-Kermit 7.0 (see Section 7.3).
403     In "(\%a + 3) * (\%b  5)", a minus sign is missing between b and 5.
407     C-Kermit 7.0 no longer supports multiline GET.  Change
        "get, \%1, \%2" to "get {\%1} {\%2}" or "get /as:{\%2} {\%1}".
409     READ example while loop should be:
        while success { echo \m(line), read line }
409     "WRITE file" should be "WRITE keyword" (you can't put a filename there)
        (The same applies to WRITE-LINE / WRITELN).
414     \Funhexify() missing from Table 18-3.
425     MINPUT definition, change 2nd "text2" to "text3".
436     Several lines are missing from the UNIXLOGIN macro listing.
        After the "xif fail" block, insert:

out \%1\13 ; Send username, carriage return inp 5 Password: ; Wait 5 sec for this prompt if fail end 1 No password prompt pause ; Wait a sec out \%2\13 ; Send password

440 Change "set terminal byteszie" to "set terminal bytesize". Change "input Password:" to "input 10 Password". 448 Franchise script: "access line" should be "access \m(line)". 453 There are two incorrectly coded IF statements in the DELIVER macro definition. Replace both occurrences of "if > \%1 \%3 {" with "xif > \%i \%3 {" (replace "if" by "xif" and "\%1" with "\%i"). 453 "the the" (last paragraph) should be "the". 454 EOT (last paragraph) is End of Transmission, not End of Text. 457 _DEFINE definition: "name constructed" should be "name is constructed". 457 "macro for and" (last paragraph) should be "macro and". 459 Should explain that \v(user) is a legal abbreviation of \v(userid). 480 Figure II-2 is backwards; the least-significant bit is transmitted first, then up to the highest, and the parity bit last. 534 The VMS Appendix section on Odd Record Lengths no longer applies; C-Kermit 7.0 handles odd record lengths as well as even ones. 559 Table VIII-3, Portuguese entry. Column 4/00 should show section sign, not acute accent. 560-563 HP-Roman8 missing from Table VII-4; there wasn't room to squeeze it in. It is listed in section II(6). 565 "d stroke" in Table VII-5 has the wrong appearance; the stem should be upright. The letter shown in the table is actually a lowercase Icelandic eth, which has a curved stem. 601-604 BeBox, BeOS, Plan 9, and probably others not listed in trademarks. 604 The words "SCRIBE TEXT FORMATTER" appear at the end of the last sentence of the first paragraph of the Colophon. They should have been in the Index. Index: Missing entries: SET { SEND, RECEIVE } PATHNAMES, Call waiting, ... \F() Page 605, add also 413-414 \Fbreak 389 \Fcapitalize 390 \Fchecksum 414 \Fcrc16 414 \Fexecute 414 \Fhexify 390 \Fltrim 391 \Frepeat 392 \Fspawn 392 \Ftod2secs 399 \v() built_in Page 606, add also 361-364 \v(_line) 354, 361 \v(apcactive) 361 \v(charset) 362 \v(cpu) 362 \v(crc16) 357, 362 \v(d$xxx) add page 362 \v(dialnumber) 362 \v(dialresult) 362 \v(errno) 362 \v(errstring) 362 \v(exedir) 362 \v(inidir) 363 \v(ipaddress) 363 \v(keyboard) 363 \v(macro) 363 \v(minput) 363 \v(m_xxx) 94, 363 \v(password) 364 \v(query) 364 \v(prompt) 364 \v(speed) 356, 364 \v(startup) 364 \v(status) 364 \v(sysid) 364 \v(system) 364 \v(fsize) at lower half page 606 should read \v(tfsize) \v(xversion) 364 BEEP Command 40 SET FLOW 62, 212

Figure II-5 on page 493. The pin assignments of the Mini Din-8 connector are not described anywhere. As noted in the text, these tend to vary from vendor to vendor. One common arrangement is:

  1. HSKout (Handshake out -- definition depends on software)
  2. HSKin  (Handshake in or external clock)
  3. TxD-
  4. Not used
  5. RxD-
  6. TxD+
  7. Not used
  8. RxD+

Note the "balanced pairs" for Receive Data (RxD) and Transmit Data (TxD), and the utter lack of modem signals. These connectors follow the RS-423 standard, rather than RS-232. In some arrangements, Pin 1 is used for DTR and Pin 2 for CD; in others Pin 1 is RTS and Pin 2 is CTS.

Please send reports of other errors to the authors, as well as suggestions for improvements, additional index entries, and any other comments:

kermit@columbia.edu


APPENDIX V. ADDITIONAL COPYRIGHT NOTICES

The following copyrights cover some of the source code used in the development of C-Kermit, Kermit 95, or Kermit 95 support libraries.

/*****************************************************************************/
/*                                                                           */
/*              Copyright (c) 1995 by Oy Online Solutions Ltd.               */
/*                                                                           */
/*   Distribution of this source code is strictly forbbidden. Use of this    */
/*   source code is granted to the University of Columbia C-Kermit project   */
/*   to be distributed in binary format only. Please familiarize yourself    */
/*   with the accompanying LICENSE.P file.                                   */
/*                                                                           */
/*****************************************************************************/

used for Xmodem, Ymodem, and Zmodem protocol in Kermit 95 (p95.dll, p2.dll)


Copyright (c) 1997 Stanford University

The use of this software for revenue-generating purposes may require a license from the owners of the underlying intellectual property. Specifically, the SRP-3 protocol may not be used for revenue-generating purposes without a license.

Within that constraint, permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted without fee, provided that the above copyright notices and this permission notice appear in all copies of the software and related documentation.

THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS-IS" AND WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR OTHERWISE, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.

IN NO EVENT SHALL STANFORD BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY KIND, OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER OR NOT ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF DAMAGE, AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.

Used for Secure Remote Password (TM) protocol (SRP) in C-Kermit, Kermit 95 (k95.exe, k2.exe, k95crypt.dll, k2crypt.dll)


Copyright 1990 by the Massachusetts Institute of Technology. All Rights Reserved.

Export of this software from the United States of America may require a specific license from the United States Government. It is the responsibility of any person or organization contemplating export to obtain such a license before exporting.

WITHIN THAT CONSTRAINT, permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation, and that the name of M.I.T. not be used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software without specific, written prior permission. M.I.T. makes no representations about the suitability of this software for any purpose. It is provided "as is" without express or implied warranty.

Used for Telnet Authentication Option, Telnet Encryption Option, and Kerberos (TM) authentication in C-Kermit, Kermit 95 (k95.exe, k2.exe, k95crypt.dll, k2crypt.dll)


Copyright (c) 1991, 1993 The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:

  1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
  2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
  3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgement:
    This product includes software developed by the University of California, Berkeley and its contributors.
  4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

Used for Telnet Authentication Option, Telnet Encryption Option, and Kerberos (TM) authentication in C-Kermit, Kermit 95 (k95.exe, k2.exe, k95crypt.dll, k2crypt.dll)


Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) All rights reserved.

This package is an DES implementation written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). The implementation was written so as to conform with MIT's libdes.

This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the following conditions are aheared to. The following conditions apply to all code found in this distribution.

Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright notices in the code are not to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be given attribution as the author of that the SSL library. This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in documentation (online or textual) provided with the package.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:

  1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
  2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
  3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgement: This product includes software developed by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com)

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

The license and distribution terms for any publically available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put under another distrubution license [including the GNU Public License.]

The reason behind this being stated in this direct manner is past experience in code simply being copied and the attribution removed from it and then being distributed as part of other packages. This implementation was a non-trivial and unpaid effort.

Used DES encryption in Kermit 95 (k95crypt.dll, k2crypt.dll)


 * This is version 1.1 of CryptoLib
 *
 * The authors of this software are Jack Lacy, Don Mitchell and Matt Blaze
 *              Copyright (c) 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 by AT&T.
 * Permission to use, copy, and modify this software without fee
 * is hereby granted, provided that this entire notice is included in
 * all copies of any software which is or includes a copy or
 * modification of this software and in all copies of the supporting
 * documentation for such software.
 *
 * NOTE:
 * Some of the algorithms in cryptolib may be covered by patents.
 * It is the responsibility of the user to ensure that any required
 * licenses are obtained.
 *
 *
 * SOME PARTS OF CRYPTOLIB MAY BE RESTRICTED UNDER UNITED STATES EXPORT
 * REGULATIONS.
 *
 *
 * THIS SOFTWARE IS BEING PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
 * WARRANTY.  IN PARTICULAR, NEITHER THE AUTHORS NOR AT&T MAKE ANY
 * REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND CONCERNING THE MERCHANTABILITY
 * OF THIS SOFTWARE OR ITS FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE.

Used for Big Number library in Kermit 95 (k95crypt.dll, k2crypt.dll).

[ Top ] [ C-Kermit ] [ Kermit Home ]


CKERMIT70.HTM / The Kermit Project / Columbia University / 8 Feb 2000